Nigeria National Building Code
Nigeria National Building Code
Nigeria National Building Code
Contents
Contents
• Preface to First Edition • Acknowledgements •
• Part I: Administration • Part II: Technical (Professionals) •
• Pre-Design Stage • Design Stage • Construction Stage • Post-Construction Stage •
• Part III: Enforcement • Part IV: Schedules and References •
• Alphabetical Index •
1. In 1987, the Defunct National Council of Works and Housing directed that a National Building Code
be evolved for Nigeria. All the stakeholders in the Building Industry were duly contacted for input.
Thereafter the defunct Federal Ministry of Works and Housing organised a National workshop at
ASCON, Badagry – Lagos State in 1989. To further fine tune the Draft National Building Code, another
workshop was held at the Gateway Hotel, Ijebu-Ode, Ogun State in 1990. The product of the Ijebu-Ode
Code was approved by the then National Council on Housing in 1991. Unfortunately this document was
not ratified by the then Federal Executive Council for use in the Country.
2. The 1991 approved document was re-presented to the 2nd National Council on Housing and Urban
Development held in Port-Harcourt, November, 2005 and the Council directed that the document be
widely circulated to all stake holders for input to facilitate the production of an acceptable National
Building Code.
3. Consequently, the Draft document underwent some restructuring from three parts to four parts as
follows:
i. Part I changes from Administration and Environment to Administration;
ii. Part II forms Classifications and Requirements, subdivided into two major divisions: Sections 4
and 5 then Sections 6–12 respectively. The second division charges the major stakeholders in the
Building Industry to produce their own requirements as per the working tools from Sections 4 and
5.
iii. Part III forms the Enforcement part of the Codes. The entire Building Process is divided into four
convenient stages and developed under two sub-headings:
a. Pre-Design Stage – Requirements and Enforcement;
b. Design Stage – Requirements and Enforcement;
c. Construction Stage – Requirements and Enforcement; and
d. Post-Construction Stage – Requirements and Enforcement.
This approach does not only make the enforcement functional but its adaptability to the Nigerian
situation makes it efficient.
iv. Part IV is made up of a separate part namely, Schedules, where all supportive documents, data,
tables, information and all sorts of relevant and approved application forms to Part I, II, and III
can be found.
4. The need to evolve a National Building Code arose from the following existing conditions of our cities
and environment:
a. The absence of planning of our towns and cities;
b. Incessant collapse of buildings, fire infernos, built environment abuse and other disasters;
c. Dearth of referenced design standards for professionals;
d. Use of non-professionals and quacks;
e. Use of untested products and materials;
f. Lack of maintenance culture.
5. In view of the above, the National Council on Housing and Urban Development deemed it necessary
and initiated the process of evolving a National Building Code to put a stop to the ugly trends in the
Building Industry.
It is my hope that this National Building Code will open a new vista in the Building Industry and
eliminate or reduce to the bare minimum the incidents of collapsed building syndrome in Nigeria;
promote safety and qualitative housing for every Nigerian. To achieve these laudable objectives, every
tier of government, (federal, state and local) must imbibe the spirit and intent of this Code. To this end,
State Governments are implored to integrate the provisions of this Code into their local laws particularly
those relating to Design, Construction and Maintenance (Post Construction) and efficiently monitor the
implementation of the Code. I also charge the relevant professional bodies who have participated in
producing this Code not to rest on their oars. They should encourage their members to religiously observe
the provisions of this Code by organising various seminars to educate their members on the implications
of this Code. You should self-regulate yourselves to prevent incessant governmental interventions in the
practice of your professions. I must counsel various professional bodies to establish a monitoring unit to
ensure effective compliance with the Code and punish erring members within the confines of the ethics of
the professions in order to compliment the efforts of the Building Code Enforcement Officers.
Acknowledgements
Acknowledgements
The following groups have contributed to the success of the production of this first edition of the National
Building Code:
• The seven professions of the Building Industry and their respective Regulatory Bodies, i.e.
Architecture, Building, Engineering, Estate Surveying and Valuation, Quantity Surveying,
Surveying, and Urban and Regional Planning.
• Resource persons at various stages of the production of the Code.
• All other stakeholders in the Building Industry.
Their valuable contributions are hereby acknowledged.
Part I Administration
Part I
Administration
Section 1
Citation and Commencement
Sections
1.1 Preamble
1.2 Title, Aim and Scope
[Page 5]
1.1 PREAMBLE
The need to evolve a National Building Code arose from the following existing conditions of the cities
and the built environment:
a. Planlessness of our towns and cities;
b. Incessant collapse of buildings, fire infernos, built environment abuses and other disasters;
c. Dearth of referenced design standards for professionals;
d. Use of non-professionals;
e. Use of untested products and materials;
f. Lack of adequate regulations and sanctions against offenders.
In view of the above, the National Council on Housing and Urban Development deemed it necessary to
initiate the process of evolving a National Building Code with a view to proffer a lasting solution to the
hazardous trends in the building construction industry.
Bearing in mind that the draft document approved for the review is based essentially on foreign codes –
some of which may not have direct relevance to our environment, another salient objective of the exercise
is to encourage Professionals in the building industry to produce the most appropriate Code suited to our
environment for subsequent use and application.
Section 2
Interpretations, Definitions and Abbreviations
Sections
2.1 Accessory Structure
2.2 Agricultural Building
2.3 Airplane Hangar (Private)
2.4 Airplane Hangar (Public)
2.5 Alley
2.6 Alter or Alteration
2.7 Apartment House
2.8 Approved
2.9 Appurtenant Structure
2.10 Apron Wall
2.11 As-Built Drawings
2.12 Atrium
2.13 Attic
2.14 Attic (Habitable)
2.15 Balcony
2.16 Balcony
2.17 Basement
2.18 Bay
2.19 Building
2.20 Building Area
2.21 Building Condition Survey Report
2.22 Building Height (In Storeys)
2.23 Building Line
2.24 Building Maintenance Manual
2.25 Building Plans
2.26 Building Works
2.27 Certificate of use and Habitation
2.28 Change of use
2.29 Code Enforcement Officer (C.E.O)
2.30 Combustible Material or Construction
2.31 Conflagration Hazard
2.32 Contract Documents
2 33 Contractor
g
[Page 11]
2.5 ALLEY
Shall mean any public way or thoroughfare between 3.0 and 4.8m in width, which has been dedicated or
reserved for public use.
Part I Administration / Section 2 Interpretations, Definitions and Abbreviations /
2.6 ALTER OR ALTERATION
2.8 APPROVED
Shall mean approval by the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit or other competent authority having
jurisdiction.
2.12 ATRIUM
Shall mean an opening through two or more floor levels other than enclosed stairways, elevators,
hoistways, escalators, plumbing, electrical, air-conditioning or other equipment, which is closed at the top
and not defined as a mall.
[Page 12]
2.13 ATTIC
Shall mean the space between the roof and the ceiling of the top storey or between a dwarf wall and a
sloping roof.
2.15 BALCONY
As pertains to assembly buildings shall mean that portion of the seating space of an assembly room, the
lowest part of which is raised 1.2m or more above the level of the main floor.
2.17 BASEMENT
Shall mean that portion of a building, which is partly or completely below ground level. This section of
the building may be a part of the foundation but shall be specifically different from it, and shall contain
humanly useful spaces, set out on one or more floors, but shall not extend beyond 1.20m above ground
level to the top of ground floor level.
2.18 BAY
As applied to a structure, shall mean the space between two adjacent piers or two adjacent lines of
columns.
2.19 BUILDING
Shall mean any structure or enclosure of space with a roof and walls for protection of life and property.
2.33 CONTRACTOR
Shall mean a person or firm who contracts with an owner or his authorised agent to undertake the
execution of a project.
2.34 CORRIDOR
Shall mean a covered passageway, which limits means of egress to a single path of travel.
2.35 COURT
Shall mean a space open and unobstructed to the sky, bounded on three or more sides by walls of a
building or other enclosing devices.
2.38 DEVELOPMENT
Shall mean the carrying out of any building, engineering, mining or other operations in, on, over or under
any land, or the making of any environmentally significant change in the use of any land or demolition of
buildings including the felling of trees and the placing of free-standing erections used for the display of
advertisements on the land and the expression “develop” with its grammatical variations shall be
construed accordingly.
2.41 DUPLEX
Shall mean a residential unit comprising two identical dwellings separated by a common wall.
2.43 ELEMENT
Shall mean components of a building or structure such as wall, floor, and roof.
2.45 EXIT
Shall mean that portion of a means of egress which is separated from all other spaces of a building or
structure by construction or equipment as required in this Code to provide a protected way of travel to the
exit discharge.
2.46 FACTORY
Shall mean a building or structure where activities such as breaking down, building up, and
manufacturing of elements, products, components, and materials are carried out by at least ten people.
2.55 FOUNDATION
Shall mean a system or arrangement of structural members through which the loads from a building are
transferred to supporting soil or rock.
2.58 GRADE
As applied to the determination of building height shall mean a reference plane representing the average
of finished ground level adjoining the building at all exterior walls. When the finished ground level slopes
away from the exterior walls, the reference plane shall be established by the lowest points within the area
between the building and the plot line or, when the plot line is more than 1.8m from the building, between
the building and a point 1.8m from the building.
2.59 GUARD
Shall mean a protective barrier around openings in floors or at the open sides of stairs, landings,
balconies, mezzanines, galleries, raised walkways or other locations to prevent accidental openings
through it.
2.61 HALLWAY
Shall mean an enclosed passageway which limits means of egress to a single path of travel.
2.64 HEREAFTER
Shall mean after the time that this Code becomes effective.
2.65 HERETOFORE
Shall mean before the time that this Code becomes effective.
2.66 HOLLOW
A masonry unit whose net cross-sectional area in any plane parallel to the bearing surface is less than
75% of its gross cross-essential area measured in the same plane.
2.72 LOAD
Shall mean forces or other actions that arise on structural systems from the weight of all permanent
construction, occupants and their possessions, environmental effects, differential settlement and restrained
dimensional changes.
2.73 MAISONETTE
Shall mean a self-contained residential unit on more than one floor which is vertically or horizontally
separated from one or more similar units in a stack in the same building.
2.77 MEMBRANE
As pertains to membrane structures, shall mean a thin, flexible, impervious material capable of being
supported by air pressure.
2.78 MEZZANINE(S)
Shall mean an intermediate level or levels between the floor and ceiling of any room or storey in a
building and includes an interior balcony of not more than 30% of the lower floor area.
2.79 MINISTER
Shall mean the Minister for Housing and Urban Development.
2.80 MINISTRY
Shall mean the Ministry charged with Housing and Urban Development matters.
2.82 OCCUPANCY
Shall mean the purpose for which a piece of land or building or part thereof, is used or intended to be
used.
2.84 PARTITION
Shall mean an interior wall one storey or part storey in height that is not load bearing.
[Page 17]
2.88 PERMIT
Shall mean an official document or certificate issued by the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit
authorising the performance of a specified activity regulated by this Code.
2.89 PLOT
Shall mean a portion or piece of land considered as a unit as delineated by survey plan.
2.96 REQUIRED
As applied to the provisions of this Code, shall be construed to be mandatory.
2.97 RISER
As applied to plumbing, means the vertical supply pipes in a sprinkler system or straw-pipe system.
2.98 RISER
As applied to stairways shall be the vertical interval between two steps (treads).
2.99 SEMI-DETACHED
Shall mean two dwelling units separated by a common wall.
2.101 SHAFT
Shall mean a vertical opening through a building extending through one or more storeys and may be
covered or open.
2.102 SHALL
As used in this Code shall be construed to be mandatory.
[Page 18]
2.103 STREET
Is any thoroughfare or public way, not less than 10.0m in width (i.e. 6400mm for vehicles, 600mm and
1200mm for drainage and pedestrian walkway on both sides respectively) which has been dedicated or
deeded to the public for public use.
2.104 STRUCTURE
Shall mean that which is built or constructed of parts joined together in some definite manner.
2.106 STOREY
Shall mean that portion of a building which is situated between the top of any floor and the top of the
floor next above it, and if there is no floor above it, that portion between the top of such floor and the
ceiling above it.
Part I Administration / Section 2 Interpretations, Definitions and Abbreviations /
2.107 STOREY, FIRST
2.108 STAIRWAY
Shall mean one or more flights of stairs and the necessary landings and platforms connecting them, to
form a continuous and uninterrupted passage from one floor to another. A flight of stairs for the purposes
of this Code shall have at least three risers.
2.110 SOLID
A masonry unit whose net cross-sectional area in any plane parallel to the bearing surface is 75% or more
of its cross-sectional area measured in the same plane.
2.111 TENURE
Shall mean the duration appointed officers shall serve.
2.113 THEATRE
Shall mean a place of public assembly intended for the production and reviewing of the performing arts or
the screening and viewing of motion pictures, and consisting of an auditorium with permanently fixed
seats intended solely for an audience.
2.115 TREADS
As applied to stairways shall mean the horizontal surfaces separated by a riser.
2.116 USE
Shall mean the purpose for which the building or structure is designed, used or intended to be used.
2.120 VENTILATION
Shall mean the natural or mechanical process of supplying conditioned or unconditioned air to, or
removing stale or foul air from any space.
2.126 YARD
Shall mean an unoccupied open space other than a court.
2.127 ZONING
Shall mean the reservation of certain specific areas within a community or city for specific types of
buildings and structures, or use of land for certain purposes with limitations such as height, plot coverage,
and other stipulated requirements.
Section 3
The Establishment of a Building Code Advisory Committee (BCAC)
[Page 23]
3.1 A Building Code Advisory Committee (BCAC) hereinafter referred to as “The Committee” is hereby
established, and shall be answerable administratively and operationally to the Minister.
It shall be the duty of the Minister to brief the National Council on Housing and Urban Development on
activities of the Committee.
3.1.1 Composition: The Committee members shall consist of duly registered practitioners of not less
than ten years post-registration experience in the following professions:
— Architecture;
— Building;
— Engineering;
— Urban and Regional Planning;
— Estate Surveying and Valuation;
— Quantity Surveying;
— Land Surveying.
And representatives of:
— Federal Ministry of Environment;
— Federal Ministry of Health;
— Federal Fire Service;
— Standards Organisation of Nigeria;
— Federal Ministry of Housing and Urban Development;
— Relevant Non-Governmental Organisation;
— Six state representatives (relevant to the building industry) each from the six geopolitical zones of
the country whose tenure shall be rotational.
3.1.2 Appointment: The Minister charged with the responsibility for housing and urban development
matters shall appoint in consultation with relevant professional bodies members of the Committee.
3.1.3 Constitution of the Committee: The Committee shall consist of a Chairman and nineteen
members.
3.1.4 Appointment of Chairman: The Chairman of the Committee shall be appointed by the Minister.
[Page 24]
3.1.5 Functions
a. The Committee shall be responsible for the periodic review of this Code and any other functions
incidental thereto or assigned to it by the Minister from time to time.
b. The Committee shall recommend for the Minister’s approval members of the Technical
Sub-committees established under this Code.
3.1.6 Tenure: The members of the Committee and the Sub-committees shall be appointed for a period of
three years. They are eligible for re-appointment for another term of three years only.
3.1.7 Quorum: The meeting of the Committee shall form a quorum by the presence of not less than
one-third of the members including the Chairman.
3.1.8 Meetings of the Committee
a. The Committee shall meet at least twice a year.
b. All meetings of the Committee shall be approved by the Minister.
3.1.9 Secretariat: The Ministry shall provide a secretariat for the Committee.
3.1.10 Establishment of Technical Sub-committee: The Minister shall on the recommendation of
BCAC, approve the appointment of Technical Sub-committees, representatives of which shall also be
members of the Committee.
3.1.11 Functions of the Technical Sub-committee: The Sub-committees shall assist the Committee on
specialised matters listed hereafter and others that the Committee may assign to it from time to time.
3.1.12 Types of Sub-committees: The following four Technical Sub-committees shall be established
with the composition consisting of relevant professionals in the building industry and shall be
recommended by the Committee, approved by the Minister:
i Pre-design – Physical Planning, Health and Environmental subcommittee.
ii Designs – Architectural and Engineering Designs and Specifications Sub-committee.
iii Construction – Materials, Methods and Construction Sub-committee.
iv Post-Construction – Occupancy and Maintenance Sub-committee.
3.1.13 Meetings of the Technical Sub-committee: The Technical Sub-committee shall meet as and as
when appropriate.
Part II
Technical (Professionals)
Sections
4.1 General
4.2 Classifications
4.3 Use Group A - Assembly Uses
4.4 Use Group B - Business Uses and Professional Uses
4.5 Use Group C - Educational Uses
4.6 Use Group D - Factory and Industrial Uses
4.7 Use Group E - High Hazard
4.8 Use Group F - Institutional Use
4.9 Use Group G - Mercantile Uses
4.10 Use Group H - Residential Uses
4.11 Use Group I - Storage Uses
4.12 Use Group J - Mixed Use and Occupancy
4.13 Use Group K - Doubtful Use Classification
4.14 Use Group L - Utility and Miscellaneous
[Page 29]
4.1 General
4.1.1 The provisions of this Part shall establish the classification of all buildings and structures as to use
group.
4.1.2 The provisions of this Part shall not be deemed to nullify any provisions of the relevant Urban and
Regional Planning Law or any other statute of the jurisdiction pertaining to the location or use of
buildings.
TABLE 4.4.3
USE GROUP B – BUSINESS USES
[Page 31]
[Page 32]
TABLE 4.6.4
USE GROUP D-1 MODERATE HAZARD FACTORY AND INDUSTRIAL USES
Aircraft. Motion picture and television.
Appliances. Musical instruments.
Athletic equipment. Optical goods.
Automobile and other motor vehicles.
Bakeries. Paper mills or products.
Beverages, alcoholic. Plastic products.
Boat Building. Printing or Publishing.
Brooms or brushes. Recreational vehicles.
Business machines. Shoes.
Cameras and photo equipment. Soaps and detergents.
Canneries, including food products Sugar refineries.
Clothing. Textile mills including canvas, cotton, cloth,
bagging, burlap, carpets and rags.
Condensed and powered milk manufacture. Tobacco.
Construction and agriculture machinery
disinfectants. Upholstery and manufacturing shops.
Dry-cleaning using other than flammable
liquids in cleaning or dyeing operations
or other than classified in Table 5.7.2.(a).
Electric light plants and power houses
Electrolytic reducing works.
Electronics.
Engines, including rebuilding.
Film, photographic.
Food processing.
Furniture and jute products.
Laundries.
Leather and tanneries machinery.
Mill work and wood working, wood
distillation.
TABLE 4.6.5
USE GROUP D-2 LOW HAZARD FACTORY AND INDUSTRIAL USES
TABLE 4.7.2(a)
USE GROUP E – HIGH HAZARD USES
[Page 34]
— Class III-A liquids shall include those having flash points at or above 60 degrees
C. and below 93 degrees C.
— Corrosive liquids which, when in contact with living tissue, will cause severe damage
to such tissue by chemical action or are liable to cause fire when in contact with
organic matter or with certain chemicals such as acids and alkaline caustic liquids.
— Explosive material and any chemical compound, mixture or device, the primary and
common purpose of which is to function by explosion with substantially
simultaneous release of gas and heat, the resultant pressure being capable of
destructive effects.
— Flammable liquids having a flash point below 23 degrees C. (73 degrees F.) and
having a vapour pressure not exceeding (276 kpa at 38 degrees C, and may be
subdivided as follows:
— Class l-A shall include those having flash point below 23 degrees C. (73 degrees F.)
and having a boiling point below 38 degrees.
— Class l-B shall include those having flash point below 23 degrees C. (73 degrees F.)
and having a boiling point at or above 38 degrees C.
— Class l-C shall include those having flash below 23 degrees C. and below 38 degrees.
— The flash point of liquids having a flash point at or below 79 degrees C F.) except for
fuel oils and certain viscous materials, shall be determined in accordance with
ASTM D56 listed in the Schedule.
— The flash point of liquids having a flash point above 79 degrees C., except for fuel
oils, shall be determined with ASTM D92 listed in the Schedule.
— The flash point of fuel oil and certain viscous materials having a flash point or below
75 degrees C. shall be determined in accordance with ASTM D93 listed in the
Schedule.
— Flammable gas having a flammability range with air greater than 1 percent by volume
which is a liquid while under pressure and having a vapour pressure in excess of
186 KPa at a temperature of 38 degrees C.
— Flammable solids and any similar solid substance other than one classified as
explosive, which is liable to cause fires through friction, through absorption of
moisture, through spontaneous chemical change or as a result of retained heat
from manufacturing or processing.
— Liquefied petroleum gas which is composed predominantly of the following
hydrocarbons or mixtures of them, such as: propane, propylene, butane (normal
butane or isobutane) and butylenes.
) y
— Nitromethane which is a combustible liquid which at 315 degrees C. and to 6309 KPa
decomposes explosively and is an unstable material.
— Oxidising materials and any similar substances that readily yield oxygen to stimulate
combustion, such as sodium-nitrate, potassium chlorate and pyroxylin plastic.
— Organic peroxide.
— Unstable materials which polymerise, decompose, condense or become self-reactive
when exposed to air, water, stock or pressure.
[Page 35]
TABLE 4.7.2(b)
EXEMPT AMOUNTS OF HAZARDOUS MATERIALS LIQUIDS AND CHEMICALS
Notes:
a. Containing not more than the exempt amounts of Class l-A, l-B or l-C flammable liquids.
b. The maximum quantities shall be increased by 100 percent in areas which are not accessible to
the public. In buildings where automatic fire suppression systems are installed, the maximum
quantities shall be increased by 100 percent in the areas accessible to the public.
c. Tank storage up to 2,640 litres for fuel burning equipment meeting the requirements of the
mechanical code or the fire prevention code listed in the Schedule shall be permitted.
[Page 36]
d. Maximum quantities in the amount specified by NFiPA 495 shall be permitted when stored in
accordance with NFiPA 495 listed in the Schedule.
e. 1 gallon = 0.00379m3 or 4 litres: 1 cubic foot = 0.028m3: 1 pound = 0.454kg.
TABLE 4.11.1
USE GROUP I-1 STORAGE USES, MODERATE HAZARD
[Page 39]
TABLE 4.11.2(a)
USE GROUP I-1 STORAGE USES, NON-COMBUSTIBLE
Asbestos.
Beer or wine up to 12% alcohol in metal, glass or ceramic containers.
Cement in bags.
Chalk.
Foods in non-combustible containers.
Fresh fruits and vegetables in non-plastic trays or containers.
Frozen foods.
Glass.
Glass bottles, empty or filled with washers and dryers.
Gypsum.
Meats.
Metal cabinets.
Metal desks with plastic tops and trim metal parts.
Mirrors.
New empty metal cans.
py
Porcelain and pottery.
TABLE 4.11.2(b)
USE GROUP I-1 STORAGE USES LOW – HAZARD
Cement bags.
Crayons.
Dairy products in non-waxed coated paper containers.
Electrical motors.
Ivory.
New empty plastic cans.
Open parking structures.
Oil filled and types of distribution transformers.
Public garages (Group 2).
Stoves.
Talc and Soap stones.
Sections
5.1 Scope
5.2 Construction Classification
5.3 Type 1 Construction
5.4 Type 2 Construction
5.5 Type 3 Construction
5.6 Type 4 Construction
5.7 Type 5 Construction
5.8 Construction and General Requirements
5.9 Structural Frame
5.10 Usable Space Under Floors
5.11 Roof
5.12 Shaft Enclosures
5.13 Weather protection
5.14 Members Carrying Masonry or Concrete
5.15 Parapet
5.16 Projections
5.17 Guardrails
5.18 Foam Plastic Insulation
5.19 Insulation
5.20 Solar Energy Collectors
5.21 Atriums
5.22 Mezzanines
[Page 43]
5.1 SCOPE
5.1.1 The provisions of this Part shall control the classification of all buildings as to type of construction.
The provisions of this Part shall not be deemed to nullify any provisions of the zoning law or any other
statute of the jurisdiction pertaining to the location, or type of construction of buildings, except as is
specifically required by the provisions of this code.
5.2.1 General:
All buildings and structures erected or to be erected, altered or extended in height or area shall be
classified in any one or in a combination of the five construction types defined in Table 5.1 and Sections
5.2.2 through to 5.2.6.
A building shall not be designated a given type of construction unless it conforms to the minimum
requirements for that type. It shall be unlawful to post, or use, or designate, or advertise a building as of a
given type of construction for the higher type but the designed construction classification of the building
shall be that of the lesser type, unless all the requirements for the higher type are fulfilled.
When a type of construction is used that is superior to the minimum herein required for any specified use,
height and area of the building, nothing in this Code shall be construed to require full compliance with the
specifications for the higher type; but the designated construction classification of the building shall be
that of the lesser type, unless all the requirements for the higher type are fulfilled.
Part II Technical (Professionals) / Section 5 Building Construction Classifications
/ 5.2 CONSTRUCTION CLASSIFICATION / 5.2.4 Non combustibility requirements:
Combustible elements in roofs, floors and walls are permitted by this Code to be used for the following
components:
a. Interior finish and trim materials as regulated by Sections 12.2.24, 12.2.25 and 12.2.26.
b. Light-transmitting plastics as permitted by this Code.
c. Fire-retardant treated wood as permitted by Section 12.2.24.
d. Mastic and caulking materials applied to provide flexible seals between components of exterior
wall construction.
e. Roof covering materials as regulated by Section 10.26.5.
f. Thermal and sound insulation as permitted by Sections 12.2.10.4, 12.2.30.
[Page 44]
g. Exterior veneer and trim as permitted by Sections 12.2.28.2.
h. Nailing or furring strips as permitted by Sections 12.2.1.4 and 12.2.25.
i. Windows and doors as permitted by Section 12.2.9.5.
j. Heavy timber as permitted by Sections 10.8.11 and 12.2.16.2.
k. Partitions as permitted by Section 12.2.7.6.
l. Roof structures as permitted by Section 12.2.29.
5.2.6 Ducts:
Combustible piping materials as permitted by the mechanical and plumbing codes listed in the Schedule.
5.2.8 Electrical:
Insulated electrical wiring and related components as regulated by Electrical Code listed in the Schedule.
5.2.9 Telephone:
Insulated telephone wiring and related components as regulated by the telephone code listed in the
Schedule.
5.3.1 General:
Buildings and structures of Type 1 Construction are those in which the walls, partitions, structural
elements, floors, ceilings, roofs, and the exits are constructed and protected with approved
non-combustible materials to afford the fire resistance rating specified in Table 6.1. except as otherwise
specifically regulated by the provisions of Section 12.2. Type 1 buildings shall be further classified as
Types 1A and 1B. Fire-retardant treated wood shall only be used as specified in Table 6.1. and Section
12.2.5.
Type 1 Fire-Resistive Buildings
5.3.1.1 Definition: The structural elements in Type 1 fire-resistive buildings shall be of steel, iron,
concrete or masonry. Walls and permanent partitions shall be of non-combustible fire-resistive
construction except that permanent non-load bearing partitions of one-hour or two-hour fire-resistive
construction, which are not part of a shaft enclosure, may have fire-retardant treated wood (see Section
4.2) within the assembly. Materials of construction and fire-resistive requirements shall be as specified in
Section 6.
Part II Technical (Professionals) / Section 5 Building Construction Classifications
/ 5.3 TYPE 1 CONSTRUCTION / 5.3.2 Structural framework:
Structural framework shall be of structural steel or iron (please refer to Section 5.4 on material - wood
and steel). For additional requirements for Group E Occupancies, see Section 7.5.2.
5.3.3.1 Exterior walls: Exterior walls and all structural members shall comply with the requirements
specified in Section 7.1.3 and the fire-resistive provisions set forth in Table 6.1.
Exceptions
i Non-load bearing walls fronting on public ways or yards having a width of at least 12 m may be of
unprotected non-combustible construction.
ii In Group H, Division 1, and B Occupancies, exterior load bearing walls may be of two-hour
fire-resistive non-combustible construction where openings are permitted.
[Page 45]
iii Other than in Group E Occupancies, exterior non-load bearing walls may be of one-hour
fire-resistive non-combustible construction where unprotected openings are permitted and two-hour
fire-resistive non-combustible construction where fire protection of openings is required.
5.3.3.2 Openings in walls: All openings in exterior walls shall conform to the requirements of Section
7.1.3.2 and shall be protected by a fire assembly having a three-fourths-hour fire-protection rating when
they are less than 6.0m from an adjacent property line or the centre line of a public way.
No openings shall be permitted in exterior walls of Groups A, C, F, E and B, Division 1, 2 and 3
Occupancies less than 1.5m from the property line, and no openings in Group B, Division 4, H and G
Occupancies less than 0.9m from the property line.
5.3.4 Floors:
Where wood sleepers are used for laying wood flooring on masonry or concrete fire-resistive floors, the
space between the floor slab and the under-side of the wood flooring shall be filled with non-combustible
material or fire-stopped in such a manner that there will be no open spaces under the flooring which will
exceed 9.3m2 in area and such space shall be filled solidly under all permanent partitions so that there is
no communication under the flooring between adjoining rooms.
Exceptions
i Fire-stopping need not be provided in such floors when at or below grade level in gymnasiums.
ii Fire-stopping need be provided only at the juncture of each alternate lane and at the ends of each
lane in a bowling facility.
Stairs and stair platforms shall be constructed of reinforced concrete, iron or steel with treads and risers of
concrete, iron or steel. Brick, marble, tile or other hard non-combustible materials may be used for the
finish of such treads and risers.
Stairs shall be designed and constructed as specified in Section 7.3.
5.3.6 Roofs:
Roofs and their members other than the structural frame more than 7.5m above any floor, balcony or
gallery may be of unprotected non-combustible materials. Heavy timber members in accordance with
Section 6.6.5 may be used for such unprotected members in one-storey buildings (ground and first floor).
When every part of the structural framework of the roof of a Group A or H Occupancy is not less than
7.5m above any floor, balcony or gallery, fire protection of all members of the roof construction including
those of the structural frame may be omitted. Heavy timber members in accordance with Section 6.6.5
may be used for such unprotected non-combustible or heavy timber construction conforming to Section
6.6.5.2 may be less than 7.5m above any floor, balcony or gallery of a Group A, Division 2.1 Occupancy
having an occupant load of 10,000 persons or more when all of the following conditions are met:
a. The building is not more than one storey in height, except for multilevel area located under the
roof and used for locker rooms, exits, concession stands, mechanical rooms and others with
access to the assembly room.
b. The area in which the roof clearance is less than 7.5m does not exceed 35 percent of the area
encompassed by the exterior walls.
c. An approved supervised automatic sprinkler system shall be installed throughout.
[Page 46]
Where every part of the structural steel framework of the roof of a Group A or H Occupancy is more than
5.4m and less than 7.5m above any floor, balcony or gallery, the roof construction shall be protected by a
ceiling of not less than one-hour fire-resistive construction. Roof covering shall be fire-retardant roofing
as specified in Section 10 (please refer to Chapter on material). Special provisions for Group B, Division
2 office buildings and Group H, Division 1 Occupancies.
This section shall apply to all Group B, Division 2 office buildings and Group H, Division 1 Occupancies,
each having floors used for human occupancy located more than 22.5m above the lowest level of fire
department vehicle access. Such buildings shall be provided with either an approved automatic sprinkler
system in accordance with Section 6.3.7.3 or safe areas of refuge (compartmentation) in accordance with
Section 6.3.7.12.
5.3.7.1 Certificate of compliance: All mechanical and electrical equipment and other required life safety
systems shall be approved and installed in accordance with approved plans and specifications pursuant to
this section and shall be tested and proved to be in proper working condition to the satisfaction of the
building maintained in accordance with the National Fire Safety Code as may be prescribed from time to
time.
5.3.7.2 Automatic sprinkler system: When provided as required in Section 6.3.7 the automatic sprinkler
system shall be provided as appropriate. The sprinkler system shall be designed using the parameters set
forth in U.B.C. Standard No. 38-1 and the following:
a. Shut-off valves and a water flow device shall be provided for each floor. The sprinkler riser may
be combined with the standpipe riser.
b. In seismic zones, in addition to the main water supply, a secondary on-site supply of water equal
to the hydraulically calculated sprinkler design demand plus 3800 litres per minute additional
for the total standpipe system shall be provided. This supply shall be automatically available if
the principal supply fails and shall have a duration of 30 minutes.
5.3.7.3 Smoke detection systems: At least one approved smoke detector suitable for the intended use
shall be installed:
a. In every mechanical equipment, electrical, transformer, telephone equipment, elevator machine
or similar room.
b. In the main return and exhaust air plenum of each air-conditioning system and located in a
serviceable area downstream of the last duct inlet.
c. At each connection to a vertical duct or riser serving two or more stories from a return-air duct
or plenum of an air-conditioning system. In Group H, Division 1 Occupancies, an approved
smoke detector may be used in each return-air-riser carrying not more than 2.40m3 and serving
not more than 10 air inlet openings.
The actuation of any detector required by this section shall operate the voice alarm system and shall place
into operation all equipment necessary to prevent the recirculation of smoke.
5.3.7.4 Alarm and communication systems: The alarm and communication systems shall be designed
and installed so that damage to any terminal unit or speaker will not render more than one zone of the
system inoperative. The voice alarm and public [Page 47] address system may be a combined system.
When approved the fire department communications system may be combined with the voice alarm
system and the public address system. Three communication systems which may be combined as set forth
above shall be provided as follows:
5.3.7.4.1 Voice alarm system: The operation of any smoke detector, sprinkler, water flow device or
manual fire alarm station shall automatically sound an alert signal to the desired areas followed by voice
instructions giving appropriate information and direction to the occupants. The central control station
shall contain controls for the voice alarm system so that a selective or general voice alarm may be
manually initiated.
The system shall be supervised to cause the activation of an audible trouble signal in the central control
station upon interruption or failure of the audio path including amplifiers, speaker wiring, switches and
electrical contacts and shall detect openings, shorts and grounds which might impair the function of the
system. The alarm shall be designed to be heard clearly by all occupants within the building or designated
portions thereof as is required for the public address system.
5.3.7.4.2 Public address system: A public address communication system designed to be clearly heard
by all occupants of the building shall operate from the central control station. It shall be established on a
selective or general basis to the following terminal areas:
a. Lifts.
b. Lift lobbies.
c. Corridors.
d. Exit stairways.
e. Rooms and tenant spaces exceeding 93m2 in area.
f. Dwelling units in apartment houses.
g. Hotel guest rooms or suites.
5.3.7.4.3 Fire department communication system: A two-way fire department communication system
shall be provided for fire department use. It shall operate between the central control station and every
lift, lift lobby and entry to every enclosed exit stairway.
5.3.7.4.4 Central control station: A central control station for fire department operations shall be
provided in a location approved by the fire department. It shall contain:
a. The voice alarm and public address system panels.
b. The fire department communications panel.
c. Fire detection and alarm system enunciator panels.
d. Enunciator visually indicating the location of the lifts and whether they are operational.
e. Status indicators and controls for air-handling systems.
f. Controls for unlocking all stairway doors simultaneously.
g. Sprinkler valve and water-flow detector display panels.
h. Standby power controls and status indicators.
i. A telephone for fire department use with controlled access to the public telephone system.
[Page 48]
5.3.7.5 Smoke control: Natural or mechanical ventilation for the removal of products of combustion
shall be provided in every storey and shall consist of one of the following:
i Panels or windows in the exterior walls which can be opened remotely from an approved location
other than the fire floor. Such venting facilities shall be provided at the rate of 1.86m2 per 15 lineal
metre2 of exterior wall in each storey and shall be distributed around the perimeter at not more than
15m intervals. Such windows or panels and their controls shall be clearly identified.
Exception: When a complete automatic sprinkler system is installed, windows or panels manually
openable from within the fire floor or approved fixed tempered glass may be used in lieu of the
remotely operated openable panels and windows. Such windows shall be clearly identified and
shall be of the size and spacing called for in this section.
ii When a complete and approved automatic sprinkler system is installed, the mechanical air-handling
equipment may be designed to accomplish smoke removal. Under fire conditions, the return and
exhaust air shall be moved directly to the outside without recirculation to other sections of the
building. The air-handling system shall provide a minimum of one exhaust air change every 10
minutes for the area involved.
iii Any other approved design which will produce equivalent results.
5.3.7.6 Lifts. Lifts and lift lobbies shall comply with the provisions of Section 9.1 and the following:
Note: A bank of lifts is a group of lifts or a single lift controlled by a common operating system; that is,
all those lifts which respond to a single call button constitute a bank of lifts. There is no limit on the
number of cars which may be in a bank or group but there may be not more than four cars within a
common hoistway.
a. Lifts on all floors shall open into lift lobbies which are separated from the remainder of the
building, including corridors and other exits, by walls extending from the floor to the underside
of the fire-resistive floor or roof above. Such walls shall be of not less than one-hour
fire-resistive construction. Openings through such walls shall conform to Section 10.11.8.
Exceptions
i The main entrance level lift lobby in office buildings.
ii Lift lobbies located within an atrium complying with the provisions of Section 9.
b. Each lift lobby shall be provided with an approved smoke detector located on the lobby ceiling.
When the detector is activated, elevator doors shall not open and all cars serving that lobby are
to return to the main floor and be under manual control only. If the main floor detector or a
transfer floor detector is activated, all cars serving the main floor or transfer floor shall return to
a location approved by the fire department and building official and be under manual control
only. The smoke detector is to operate before the optical density reaches 0.09 per meter. The
detector may serve to close the lobby doors.
[Page 49]
c. Lift hoistways shall not be vented through a lift machine room. Cable slots entering the machine
room shall be sleeved beneath the machine room floor and extend to not less than 30cm below
the shaft vent to inhibit the passage of smoke into the machine room.
5.3.7.7 Standby Power, Light and Emergency Systems
1. Standby power: Standby power generating system conforming to U.B.C. Standard No. 18-1
shall be provided. The system shall be equipped with suitable means for automatically starting
the generator set upon failure of the normal electrical supply systems and for automatic transfer
of all functions required by this section at full power within 60 seconds of such normal service
failure. Systems supervisions with manual start and transfer features shall be provided at the
central control station. An on-premise fuel supply sufficient for not less than two hours full
demand operation of the system shall be provided. The standby system shall have a capacity and
rating that would supply all equipment required to be operational at the same time. The
generating capacity need not be sized to operate all the connected electrical equipment
simultaneously. All power, lighting, signal and communication facilities specified in (d), (e), (f),
(g), (h), (i) and (j) as applicable; fire pumps required to maintain pressure, standby lighting and
normal circuits supplying exit signs and exit illumination shall be transferable to the standby
source.
2. Standby lighting: Standby lighting shall be provided as follows:
a. Separate lighting circuits and fixtures sufficient to provide light with an intensity of not
less than one foot-candle measured at floor level in all exit corridors, stairways, smoke
proof enclosures, elevator cars and lobbies and other areas which are clearly a part of the
escape route.
b. All circuits supply lighting for the central control station and mechanical equipment
room.
3. Emergency system: The following are classified as emergency systems and shall operate within
10 seconds of failure of the normal power supply:
a. Exit sign and exit illumination is required by Sections 10.24 and 10.25.
b. Lift car lighting.
5.3.7.8 Exits: Exits shall comply with other requirements of this Code and the following:
1. All stairway doors which are locked from the stairway side shall have the capacity of being
unlocked simultaneously without unlatching upon a signal from the central control station.
2. A telephone or other two-way communications system connected to an approved emergency
service which operates continuously shall be provided at not less than every fifth floor in each
required stairway where other provisions of this Code permit the doors to be locked.
5.3.7.9 Seismic considerations: In Seismic Zones, the anchorage of mechanical and electrical equipment
required for life safety systems, including fire pumps and lift drive and suspension systems, shall be
designed in accordance with the requirements of Section (refer to Section 8).
[Page 50]
5.3.7.10 Areas of Refuge (Compartmentation) Alternate: Areas of refuge conforming to the following
may be provided as an alternate to the automatic sprinkler system.
a. Every storey shall be divided into two or more areas of approximately the same size with no
single area exceeding 139m2. The wall and door shall be constructed as required for a horizontal
exit in Section 10.15.
b. Each area of refuge (compartment) shall contain one lift to the main floor and a minimum of one
enclosed exit stairway.
c. Openings in exterior walls, where such openings are within 1.5m of each other horizontally on
vertically adjacent floors, shall be protected by approved flame barriers either extending 76cm
beyond the exterior wall in the plane of the floor or by approved vertical panels not less than
0.9m in height above the floor.
d. Horizontal exit walls used for compartmenting a building shall have a fire-resistance rating of
not less than two hours. Duct penetrations of this wall shall not be permitted. Ferrous or copper
piping and conduit may penetrate or pass through the wall only if the openings are caulked with
impervious non-combustible materials sufficiently tight to prevent the transfer of smoke or
combustion gases from one side of the wall to the other and are so maintained. The fire door
serving as the horizontal exit between compartments shall be so installed, fitted and gasketed
that it will provide a substantial barrier to the passage of smoke.
e. The fire-resistive floor or the floor-ceiling construction shall extend to and be tight against the
exterior wall so that the fire-resistive integrity between storeys is maintained. Penetrations or
other installations shall not impair the fire-resistive integrity of the floor-ceiling assembly.
f. A manual fire alarm system (pull boxes) shall be installed in accordance with U.B.C. Standard
No. 18.1.
5.3.7.11 Automatic sprinkler system alternatives: When a complete approved automatic sprinkler
system complying with this Section is installed in a building, the following modifications of code
requirements are permitted.
a. The fire-resistive time periods set forth in Table 6.1 may be reduced by one hour for interior
load bearing walls, exterior load bearing and non-load bearing walls, roofs and the beams
supporting roofs, provided they do not frame into columns. Vertical shafts other than stairway
enclosures and lift shafts may be reduced to one hour when sprinklers are installed within the
shafts at alternate floors. The fire-resistive time period reduction as specified herein shall not
apply to exterior load bearing and non-load bearing walls whose fire-resistive rating has already
been reduced under the exceptions contained within Section 6.3.3.1 or 6.3.4.
b. Except for corridors in Group B, Division 2 and Group H, Division 1 Occupancies and
partitions separating dwelling units or guest rooms, all interior non-load bearing partitions
required to be one-hour fire-resistive construction by Table 6.1 may be of non-combustible
construction without a fire-resistive time period.
c. Fixed tempered glass may be used in lieu of openable panels for smoke control purposes.
d. Travel distance from the most remote point in the floor area to a horizontal exit or to an
enclosed stairway may be 90m.
[Page 51]
e. The manually operated fire alarm system required in the compartmented building is not
required.
f. Spandrel walls, eyebrows and compartmentation are not required; however, the fire-resistance
of the floors and juncture of exterior walls with each floor must be maintained.
g. Fire dampers, other than those needed to protect floor-ceiling assemblies to maintain the fire
resistance of the assembly, are not required except for those which may be necessary to bypass
smoke to the outside, those provided to convert from recirculated air to 100 percent outside air,
and those which may be required to protect the fresh air supply intake against smoke which may
be outside the building.
h. Emergency windows required by Section 7.8.4 are not required.
5.4.1 General:
Buildings and structures of Type 2 construction are those in which the walls, partitions, structural
elements, floors, ceilings, roofs, and the exits are constructed of approved non-combustible materials
meeting the fire resistance rating requirements specified in Table 6.1, except as further regulated in
Section 12.2 Type 2 buildings shall be further classified as Types 2A, 2B, and 2C. Fire-retardant treated
wood shall only be used as specified in Table 6.1 and Section 12.2.5.
Type 2 Buildings
5.4.1.1 Definition
a. The structural elements in Type 2 fire-resistive buildings shall be of steel, iron, concrete or
masonry.
b. The structural elements of Type 2 one-hour or 2-N buildings shall be of non-combustible
materials.
c. Walls and permanent partitions of Type 2-F.R. buildings shall be of non-combustible
fire-resistive construction, except that permanent non-load bearing partitions of one-hour or
two-hour fire-resistive construction which are not part of a shaft enclosure may have
fire-retardant treated wood (see Section 4.2) within the assembly, provided fire-resistive
requirements are maintained.
d. Walls and permanent partitions of Type 2-N buildings shall be of non-combustible materials.
e. Materials of construction and fire-resistive requirements shall be as specified in Section 6.
For requirements due to occupancy, see Section 7.
Structural framework shall be as specified (refer to Chapter on materials - iron, concrete and masonry).
Exterior walls: Exterior walls and all structural members shall comply with the requirements specified in
Section 7.1.3 and the fire resistive provisions set forth in Table 6.1 in Type 2-N and Type 2 one-hour
buildings, exterior walls shall comply with the fire-resistive requirements set forth in Section 7.1.3. and
Table 7.1.3.
[Page 52]
Exceptions
i Non-load bearing walls fronting on public ways or yards having a width of at least 12m may be of
unprotected non-combustible construction.
ii In Groups H, Division 1, and B Occupancies, exterior non-load bearing walls of Type 2-F.R.
buildings may be of two-hour fire-resistive non-combustible construction where openings are
permitted.
iii In other than Group E Occupancies, exterior non-load bearing walls of Type 2-F.R. buildings may
be of one-hour fire-resistive non-combustible construction where unprotected openings are
permitted and two-hour fire-resistive non-combustible construction where fire protection of
openings is required.
iv In a Group B Occupancy a fire-resistive time period will not be required for an exterior wall of a
one-storey Type 2-N building, provided the floor area of the building does not exceed 93m2 and
such wall is located not less than 1.5m from a property line.
5.4.3.1 Openings in walls: All openings in exterior walls of Type 2-F.R. buildings shall conform to the
requirements of Section 7.1.3.2 and shall be protected by a fire assembly having a one-hour
fire-protection rating when they are less than 6m from an adjacent property line or the center line of a
public way. No openings shall be permitted in exterior walls of Type 2-F.R. buildings housing Groups A,
C, F, H and B, Division 1, 2 and 3 Occupancies less than 1.5m from the property line, and no openings in
Groups B, Division 4, H, and G Occupancies less than 900mm from the property line. Openings in
exterior walls located where protected openings are required by Table 7.1.3 shall be protected by fixed
fire windows or automatic-closing fire windows or self-closing doors having a fire protection rating of at
least one hour and shall comply with Section 7.1.3.
5.4.4 Floors:
Where wood sleepers are used for laying wood flooring on masonry or concrete fire-resistive floors of
Type 2-F.R. buildings, the space between the floor slab and the underside of the wood flooring shall be
filled with non-combustible material or fire stopped in such a manner that there will be no open spaces
under the flooring which will exceed 9.3m2 in area and such space shall be filled solidly under all
permanent partitions so that there is no communication under the flooring between adjoining rooms.
Exception: Firestopping need not be provided in such floors when at or below grade level in
gymnasiums.
Floor construction of Type 2 one-hour and Type 2-N buildings shall be of non-combustible material,
provided, however, that a wood surface or finish may be applied over such non-combustible material.
Roofs shall be of non-combustible construction, except that in Type 2-F.R and Type 2 one-hour
buildings, roofs may be as specified in Section 6.3.6. Roof covering shall be a fire-retardant roofing as
specified (refer to Chapter on material).
[Page 53]
Special Provisions for Group B, Division 2 Office Buildings and Group H, Division 1 Occupancies
5.4.7 Type 2-F.R, buildings shall comply with the special provisions on high-rise buildings in Section
6.3.7.
Exception: The reduction provisions for roofs in Section 6.3.7.13.(a) are not permitted.
5.5.1 General:
Buildings and structures of Type 3 construction are those in which the exterior, fire and party walls are
constructed of masonry or other approved non-combustible materials of the required fire resistance rating
and structural properties, and the floors, roofs and interior framing are wholly or partly of wood or of
metal or other approved construction; the fire and party walls are ground supported, except that girders
and their supports carrying walls of masonry shall be protected to afford the same degree of
fire-resistance rating of the walls supported thereon; and all structural elements shall have the required
fire resistance rating specified in Table 6.1.
Structural framework shall be of steel or iron as specified (refer to Chapter on materials, concrete, wood).
5.5.4.1 Exterior Walls: Exterior walls shall be constructed of non-combustible materials and shall
comply with the fire-resistive requirements set forth in Section 7.1.3 and Table 6.1.
Exceptions
i Non-load bearing walls fronting on public ways, or yards having a width of at least 12m may be
unprotected when entirely of non-combustible materials.
ii In other than Groups E and F Occupancies, exterior non-loadbearing walls may be non-combustible
one-hour fire-resistive where unprotected openings are permitted and non-combustible two-hour
fire resistive where protection of openings is required.
iii In Group H, Division 1 and B Occupancies, exterior non-loadbearing walls may be two-hour fire
resistive where openings are permitted.
iv Approved fire-retardant treated wood framing may be used within the assembly of exterior walls as
permitted by Exceptions i, ii and iii, provided the required fire resistance is maintained and the
exposed outer and inner faces of such walls are non-combustible.
[Page 54]
v Wood columns and arches conforming to heavy timber sizes may be used externally where exterior
walls are permitted to be unprotected; non-combustible exterior walls are permitted.
5.5.4.2 Openings in walls: Openings in exterior walls shall conform to the requirements of Section
7.1.3.2 and shall be protected by a fire assembly having a three-fourths-hour fire-resistive rating when
they are less than 6m from an adjacent property line or the centre line of a public way. No openings shall
be permitted in exterior walls of Groups A, C, F, E and B, Division 1, 2 and 3 Occupancies less than 1.5m
from the property line, and no openings in Groups B, Division 4. H and G Occupancies less than 900mm
from the property line.
5.5.4.3 Partitions: Load bearing partitions, when constructed of wood, shall comply with Section
29.16.3.
5.5.5 Stair construction: Stairs in buildings not exceeding three storeys in height may be constructed of
any material permitted by this Code. In buildings more than three storeys in height, stairs shall be
constructed as required for Type I buildings.
5.5.6 Roofs: Roof coverings shall be as specified (refer to Chapter on materials, roof).
5.6.1 General:
Buildings and structures of Type 4 construction are those in which the exterior walls are of
non-combustible materials having a fire resistance rating not less than that specified in Table 6.1 and the
interior structural members are of solid or laminated wood without concealed spaces. The elements of
Type 4 construction shall comply with the provisions of this Section (see Section 10.22 for construction
details).
5.6.1.1 Definition: Structural elements of Type 4 buildings may be of any materials permitted by this
Code.
Type 4 construction shall conform to Section 10.5 except that permanent partitions and members of the
structural frame may be of other materials, provided they have a fire resistance of not less than one hour.
5.6.2.1 Columns: Wooden columns shall be sawn or glued laminated and shall be not less than 203mm
nominal, in any dimension when supporting floor loads and not less than 150mm nominal, in width and
not less than 203mm, in depth when supporting roof and ceiling loads only. Columns shall be continuous
or superimposed and connected in an approved manner.
5.6.2.2 Floor framing: Beams and girders of wood shall be sawn or glued laminated timber and shall be
not less than 150mm, in width and not less than 254mm, in depth. Framed sawn or glued laminated
timber arches which spring from the floor line and support floor loads shall be not less than 203mm in
any dimension. Framed timber trusses supporting floor loads shall have members of not less than 203mm,
in any dimension.
5.6.2.3 Roof framing: Framed or glued laminated arches for roof construction which spring from the
floor line or from base and do not support floor loads shall have members not less than 150mm, in width
and not less than 203mm, in depth for the lower half of the height and not less than 150mm, in depth for
the upper half. Framed or glued laminated arches for roof construction which spring from the top of walls
or wall abutments, framed timber trusses, and other roof framing which does not support floor loads [Page
55] shall have members not less than 100mm, in width and not less than 150mm, in depth. Spaced
members shall be composed of two or more pieces not less than 75mm, in thickness when blocked solidly
throughout their intervening spaces or when such spaces are tightly closed by a continuous wood cover
plate of not less than 50mm, in thickness, secured to the underside of the members. Splice plates shall be
not less than 75mm, in width.
5.6.2.4 Flooring: Floors shall be without concealed spaces and shall be of sawn or glued laminated
timber, splined, or tongue and groove, of not less than 75mm in thickness covered with 25mm, dimension
tongue and groove flooring, laid crosswise or diagonally, or 12mm plywood or 12mm particle board, or
of timber not less than 100mm, in width, set on edge close together and well spiked, and covered with
25mm flooring, or 12mm plywood, or 25mm particle board. The timber shall be laid so that no
continuous line of joints will occur except at points of support. Floors shall be covered by a moulding
fastened to the wall such that 25mm spaces shall be covered by a moulding fastened to the wall either
above or below the floor and so arranged that it will not obstruct the swelling or shrinkage movements of
the floor, or corbelling of masonry walls under floor shall be used in place of moulding.
5.6.2.5 Roofs: Roofs shall be without concealed spaces and roof decks shall be sawn or glued laminated,
splined or tongue and groove plank, not less than 50mm, in thickness, 280mm thick interior plywood
(exterior quality glue) or of timber not less than 75mm, in width, set on edge close together and laid as
required for floors. Other types of decking shall only be used if providing equivalent fire resistance rating
and structural properties.
5.6.2.6 Walls: Walls shall be of solid wood construction formed by not less than two layers or 25mm
matched boards or laminated construction or a 100mm thickness, or of 1-hour fire resistance rated
construction.
5.6.2.7 Exterior structural members: Wood columns and arches conforming to heavy timber sizes shall
only be used externally where a fire separation distance of 6100mm or more is provided.
5.6.3.1 Exterior Walls: Exterior walls shall be constructed of non-combustible materials and shall
comply with the fire-resistive requirements set forth in Section 7.13 and Table No. 6-A.
Exceptions
i Non-load bearing walls fronting on public ways, or yards having a width of at least 12m may be
unprotected when entirely of non-combustible material.
ii In other than Groups E and F-1 occupancies exterior non-load bearing walls may be
non-combustible one-hour fire resistive where unprotected openings are permitted and
non-combustible two-hour fire resistive where protection of openings is required.
iii In Groups H, Division 1, and B Occupancies exterior non-combustible loadbearing walls may be
two-hour fire-retardant treated wood framing may be used within the assembly of exterior walls as
permitted by exceptions i, ii and iii, provided the required fire resistance is maintained and the
exposed outer and inner faces of such walls are non-combustible.
[Page 56]
iv Wooden columns and arches conforming to heavy timber sizes may be used externally where
exterior walls are permitted to be unprotected, non-combustible construction or where one-hour
fire-resistive non-combustible exterior walls are permitted.
5.6.3.2 Openings in walls: Openings in exterior walls shall conform to the requirements of Section
7.1.3.2 and shall be protected by a fire assembly having a three-fourths-hour fire-resistive rating when
they are less than 6m from an adjacent property line or the centre line of a public way. No openings shall
be permitted in exterior walls of Groups A, C, F, E and B, Division 1, 2 and 3 Occupancies less than 1.5m
from the property line and no openings in Groups B, Division 4, H and G Occupancies less than 1.5m
from the property line.
5.6.3.3 Partitions: Load bearing partitions, when constructed of wood, shall comply with Section
29.16.3.
Stairs shall be constructed as specified in Section 6.6.5. In buildings more than three storeys in height,
stairs shall be constructed as for Type 1 buildings. Stairs shall comply with the requirements of Section
10.
5.6.5.1 General: Details of heavy timber construction shall be in accordance with the provisions of this
section. Unless otherwise specified, all dimensions are as defined in Section (refer to Section 10.22).
5.6.5.2 Columns: Wood columns may be of sawn timber or structural glued-laminated timber not less
than 200mm in any dimension when supporting roof or floor loads except as specified in Section 6.6.5.4.
Columns shall be continuous or superimposed and connected in an approved manner.
5.6.5.3 Floor framing: Beams and girders may be of sawn timber or structural glued-laminated timber
and shall be not less than 150mm in width and not less than 250mm in depth. Framed sawn timber or
structural glued-laminated timber arches, which spring from the floor line and support floor loads, shall
be not less than 200mm in any dimension.
5.6.5.4 Roof framing: Framed sawn timber arches or structural glued-laminated timber arches for roof
construction, which spring from the floor line and do not support floor loads, shall have members not less
than 150mm in width and not less than 200mm in depth for the lower half of the height and not less than
150mm in depth for the upper half. Framed sawn timber or structural glued-laminated timber arches for
roof construction which spring from the top of walls or wall abutments, framed timber or structural
glued-laminated timber trusses, and other roof framing which does not support floor loads, shall have
members not less than 100mm in width and not less than 150mm in depth. Spaced members may be
composed of two or more pieces not less than 75mm in thickness, when blocked solidly throughout their
intervening spaces, or when such spaces are tightly closed by a continuous wood cover plate of not less
than 50mm in thickness, secured to the underside of the members. Splice plates shall be not less than
750mm in thickness. When protected by an approved automatic sprinkler system under the roof deck,
framing members shall be not less than 750mm in thickness.
[Page 57]
5.6.5.5 Floors: Floors shall be without concealed spaces. Floors shall be of timber, splined or tongue and
groove, of not less than 7.5cm or 75mm in thickness covered with 2.50cm tongue-and-groove flooring
laid crosswide or diagonally, or 12.5mm plywood, or of timber not less than 100mm in width set on edge
close together and well spiked, and covered with 25mm flooring or 12.5mm plywood. The timber shall be
laid so that no continuous line of joints will occur except at points of support. Floors shall not extend
closer than 12.5mm to walls. Such 12.5mm space shall be covered, by a moulding fastened to the wall
and so arranged that it will not obstruct the swelling or shrinkage movements of the floor. Corbelling of
masonry walls under floors may be used in place of such moulding.
5.6.5.6 Roof decks: Roofs shall be without concealed spaces and roof decks shall be of timber, splined
or tongue and groove, of not less than 50mm thickness, or 25mm boards with tongue and groove plywood
with exterior quality glue, or of a double thickness of 25mm boards with tongue-and-groove joints, or
with staggered joints, of timber not less than 75mm in width, set on edge close together and laid as
required for floors.
5.6.5.7 Construction details. Approved wall plate or hangers shall be provided where wooden beams,
girders or trusses rest on masonry or concrete walls. Girders and beams shall be closely fitted around
columns, and adjoining ends shall be cross-strutted and tied to each other, or interstrutted and tied by caps
or ties, to transfer horizontal loads across the joints. Wooden wedge may be placed on top of columns
which support roof loads only. Where intermediate beams are used to support a floor, they shall rest on
top of the girders, or shall be supported by ledgers or blocks securely fastened to the sides of the girders,
or they may be supported by approved metal hangers into which the ends of the beams shall be closely
fitted.
In heavy timber roof construction, every roof girder and at least every alternate roof beam shall be
anchored to its supporting member; roof decks, where supported by a wall, shall be anchored to such wall
at intervals not exceeding 6m. Every monitor and every sawtooth construction shall be anchored to the
main roof construction. Such anchors shall consist of steel or iron bolts of sufficient strength to resist
vertical uplift of the roof.
5.6.5.8 Mechanically laminated floors and roof decks: Mechanically laminated floors and roof decks
conforming to Section 12.2.16.4 may be used as heavy timber floors or roof decks, provided the
minimum thickness and other applicable requirements of the section are followed.
5.6.5.9 Partitions: Partitions shall be of solid wood construction formed by not less than two layers of
25mm matched boards or laminated construction of 100mm thickness, or of one-hour fire-resistive
construction.
5.6.5.10 Stairs: Stairs shall be constructed with wood treads and risers of not less than 50mm thickness,
except where built on laminated or timber inclines as required for floors, when they may be of 37.5mm
thickness or may be constructed as required in Type I buildings. Stair stringers shall be a minimum of
75mm in thickness and not less than 250mm in depth.
5.7.1 General:
Buildings and structures of Type 5 construction are those in which the exterior walls, load bearing walls,
partitions, floors and roofs are constructed of any materials permitted by this Code and in which the
structural elements have the required [Page 58] fire resistance ratings specified in Table 6.1. Type 5
buildings shall be further classified as Types 5A and 5B.
5.7.2 Definition:
Type 5 buildings may be of any materials allowed by this Code. Type 5 one-hour buildings shall be of
one-hour fire-resistive construction throughout. Materials of construction and fire-resistive requirements
shall be as specified in Section 6. For requirements due to occupancy, see Section 6 to 7 inclusive.
Structural framework shall be of steel or iron as specified (refer to Section on materials, concrete,
masonry and wood).
Exterior walls and openings: Exterior walls shall comply with fire-resistive requirements set forth in
Section 7.1.3 and Table 7.1.3. Opening in exterior walls located where protected openings are required by
Table 7.1.3 shall be protected by fixed fire windows or automatic-closing fire windows or self-closing
doors having a fire-protection rating of at least one-hour and shall comply with Section 7.1.3.
Stair construction may be of any type permitted in this Code and shall conform to the requirements of
Section 10.
5.8.1 General:
The requirements of Section 5 are for the various types of constructions and represent varying degrees of
public safety and resistance to fire. Every building shall be classified by the Code Enforcement Officer
into one of the types of construction set forth in Table 6.1. Any building which does not entirely conform
to a type of construction set forth in Table 6.1 shall be classified by a building official into a type having
an equal or lesser degree of fire resistance. A building or portion thereof shall not be required to conform
to the details of a type of construction higher than that type which meets the minimum requirements based
on occupancy (Part II) even though certain features of such building actually conform to a higher type of
construction.
Where specific materials, types of construction or fire-resistive protection are required, such requirements
shall be the minimum requirements, and any materials, types of construction or fire-resistive protection
which will afford equal or greater public safety or resistance to fire, as specified in Section 7.1.4.5 may be
considered a separate building for classification of types of construction. When there is no such
separation, the area of the entire building shall not exceed the least area permitted for the types of
construction involved.
5.11 ROOF
Roof coverings shall be as specified in Section 5.18.2.5
Exception to Table No. 6.1
5.11.1 General:
The provisions of this Section are exceptions to the construction requirements of Table No. 6.1, Sections
4, 5 and 7.
5.11.2.1 Stores and offices: Interior non-load-bearing partitions dividing portions of stores, offices or
similar places occupied by one tenant only and which do not establish a corridor serving an occupant load
of 30 persons or more may be constructed of:
a. Non-combustible materials.
b. Fire-retardant-treated wood.
c. One-hour fire-resistive construction.
d. Wood panels or similar light construction up to three quarters the height of the room in which
placed; when more than three quarters the height of the room, such partitions shall have not less
than the upper one quarter of the partition constructed of glass.
5.11.2.2 Hotels and apartments: Interior no-load bearing partitions within individual dwelling units in
apartment houses and guest rooms or suites in hotels when such dwelling units, guest rooms or suites are
separated from each other and from corridors by not less than one-hour fire-resistive construction may be
constructed of:
a. Non-combustible materials or fire-retardant-treated wood in buildings of any type of
construction; or
b. combustible framing with non-combustible materials applied to the framing in buildings of
Type 3 or 4 construction. Openings to such corridors shall be equipped with doors conforming
to Section 10.11 regardless of the occupant load served.
5.11.2.3 Light-transmitting plastic: may be used in or as partitions, provided they meet the
requirements of this Code.
5.11.2.4 Folding, portable or moveable partitions: Approved folding, portable or moveable partitions
need not have a fire-resistive rating, provided:
i They do not block required exits (without providing alternative conforming exits) and they do not
establish an exit corridor.
ii Their location is restricted by means of permanent tracks, guides or other approved methods.
iii Flammability shall be limited to materials having a flame-spread classification conforming to
Section 12.
5.11.2.5 Walls fronting on streets or yard: Regardless of fire-resistive requirements for exterior walls
certain elements of the walls fronting on streets or yards having a width of 12m may be constructed as
follows:
i Bulkheads below show windows, show-window frames, aprons and show-cases may be of
combustible materials, provided the height of such construction does not exceed 4.5m above grade
level.
[Page 60]
ii Wood veneer of boards not less than 37.5mm thickness or exterior type panels not less than 12mm
nominal thickness may be applied to walls, provided the veneer does not exceed 4.5m above
ground base level, and further provided such veneer shall be placed either directly against
non-combustible surfaces or furred out from such surfaces not to exceed 41mm with all concealed
spaces fire-stopped as provided in Section 12. Where boards, panels and furring as described above
comply with Section 4 as fire-retardant treated wood suitable for exterior exposure, the height
above grade may be increased to 10.5m.
5.11.3 Trim:
Trims, picture moulds, chair rails, baseboards, handrails and show-window backing may be of wood.
Unprotected wood doors and windows may be used except where openings are required to be fire
protected. Foam plastic trim covering not more than 10 percent of the wall or ceiling area may be used,
provided such trim i has a density of no less than 320kg per cubic meter, ii has a maximum thickness of
12mm and a maximum width of 100mm, and iii has a flame-spread rating no greater than 75 percent.
Materials used for interior finish of walls and ceiling, including wainscoting, shall be specified in Section
12.
Exterior loading platforms may be of heavy timber construction with wood floors not less than 50mm
thickness. Such timber construction shall not be carried through the exterior walls.
5.12.1 General:
Openings extending vertically through floors shall be enclosed in a shaft of fire-resistive construction
having the time period set forth in Table No. 6.1 for “Shaft Enclosures” Protection for stairways shall be
as specified in Sections 10.11 to 10.19 see Section 9.2.4 for exception in Group B, Division 4
Occupancies and Section 8.8 and 12.1.5 for open parking garages.
Exceptions
i Other than Group I occupancies, an enclosure will not be required for openings which serve only
one adjacent floor and are not connected with openings serving other floors and which are not
concealed within the building construction.
ii In buildings housing Group B Occupancies equipped with automatic sprinkler systems throughout,
enclosures shall not be required for escalators where the top of the escalator opening at each storey
is provided with a draft curtain and automatic fire sprinklers are installed around the perimeter of
the opening within 600mm of the draft curtain. The draft curtain shall enclose the perimeter of the
unenclosed opening and extend from the ceiling downward at 30cm on all sides. The spacing
between sprinklers shall not exceed 1.8m.
iii In Type 5 buildings, chutes and dumbwaiter shafts with a cross-sectional area of not more than
0.84m² may be unenclosed if lined on the inside with lath and plaster or gypsum wallboard, with
not less than Gauge 26 galvanised sheet metal gauge with all joints in such sheet metal lock lapped.
All openings into any such enclosure shall be protected by metal or metal-clad jambs, casing or
frames.
[Page 61]
iv Exit enclosures shall conform to the applicable provisions of Sections 10.11 to 10.19.
v In one and two-storey buildings of other than Group I Occupancies, shafts for air vents and for
ducts or piping which extend through not more than two floors need not comply wit Table 6.1.
vii Air vents and non-combustible piping installed in walls of buildings passing through three floors or
less need not comply with Table 6.1. Such shafts shall be effectively draft-stopped at each floor or
ceiling.
viii Non-combustible pipe and conduit may be installed and maintained within the cavity of
fire-resistive walls, provided both the floor and wall penetrations are tightly sealed with a
non-combustible material impervious to the passage of smoke.
x In buildings with Group E, Division 6 Occupancies, a fabrication area may have mechanical, duct
and piping penetrations which extend through not more than two floors within that fabrication area.
Penetrations for tubing, piping, conduit or duct shall be effectively draft-stopped at the top floor
level. The fabrication area, including the area through which the ductwork and piping extend, shall
be considered a single conditioned environment.
Every opening into a shaft shall be protected by a self enclosing fire assembly conforming to Section
12.2.4.5 and having a fire protection rating of one-hour for openings through one and a half hours
openings through two-hour walls.
Exceptions
i Openings to the exterior may be unprotected when permitted by Table 7.1.3.
ii Openings produced by air ducts piercing shaft enclosure walls may be protected by fire dampers
conforming to U.B.C. Standard No. 43-7.
In other than Group H, Division 3 Occupancies, rubbish and linen chutes shall terminate in rooms
separated from the remainder of the building by a one-hour fire-resistive occupancy separation. Openings
into chutes and termination rooms shall not be located in exit corridors or stairways.
All weather-exposed surfaces shall have a weather-resistive barrier to protect the interior wall covering.
Such barrier shall be equal to that provided for in U.B.C. Standard No. 17-1 for Kraft waterproof building
paper or U.B.C. Standard No. 32-1 for asphalt-saturated rag felt. Building paper and felt shall be free
from holes and breaks other than those created by fasteners and construction system due to attaching of
the building paper, and shall be applied over studs or sheathing of all exterior walls. Such felt or paper
shall be applied weatherboard fashion, lapped not less than 50mm at horizontal joints and not less than
150mm at vertical joints. Weather-protected barrier may be omitted in the following cases:
i When exterior covering is of approved weatherproof panels.
ii In black-plastered construction.
iii When there is no human occupancy.
iv Over water-repellent panel sheathing.
[Page 62]
v Under approved paper backed metal or wire fabric lath.
vi Behind lath and Portland cement plaster applied to the underside of roof and eave projections.
Exterior openings exposed to the weather shall be flashed in such a manner as to make them
weatherproof. All parapets shall be provided with coping of approved materials. All flashing,
counter-flashing and coping, when of metal, shall be of not less than 26 guage corrosion-resistant metal.
Balconies, landings, exterior stairways and similar surfaces exposed to the weather and sealed underneath
shall be waterproofed.
Unless otherwise approved by the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit, foundation walls enclosing a
basement below finished grade shall be damp proofed outside by approved methods and materials.
5.14.1 General:
All members carrying masonry or concrete walls in buildings over one storey in height shall be fire
protected with not less than one-hour fire protection.
Exception
i Fire protection may be omitted from the bottom flange of lintels spanning not over 1.8m shelf
angles, or plates that are not a part of the structural frame.
5.15 PARAPET
5.15.1 General:
Where parapets are provided on exterior walls of buildings, the following shall apply in the construction;
method:
i Parapets shall have the same degree of fire resistance required for the wall upon which they are
erected and on any side adjacent to a roof surface shall have non-combustible faces for the
uppermost 450mm, including counter-flashing and coping materials.
ii The height of the parapet shall not be less than 750mm above the point where the roof surface and
the wall intercept. Where the roof slopes toward a parapet at slopes greater than 1.6, the parapet
shall extend to the same height as any portion of the roof that is within the distance where
protection of walls would be required, but in no case shall the height be less than 750mm.
5.16 PROJECTIONS
5.16.1 General:
Cornices, eave overhangs, exterior balconies and similar architectural appendages extending beyond the
floor area as defined in Section 4, shall conform to the requirements of this section (see Section 10 for
additional requirements applicable to exterior exit balconies and stairways). Projections from walls of
Type 1 or 2 construction shall be of non-combustible materials. Projections from walls of Type 3, 4 or 5
construction may be of non-combustible or combustible materials. Combustible projections located where
openings are not permitted or where protection of openings is required shall be of one-hour fire-resistance
or heavy timber construction conforming to Section 12.2. Projections shall not extend more than 300mm
into the areas where openings are prohibited. For combustible ornamentation, see Section 6.
[Page 63]
5.17 GUARDRAILS
5.17.1 General:
All unenclosed floor and roof openings, open and glazed sides of landings and tramps, balconies or
porches which are more than 750mm above ground level or floor grade below, and roofs used for other
than service of the building shall be protected by a guardrail. Guardrails shall not be more than 1100mm
in height. Open guardrail and stair railings shall have intermediate rails or an ornamental pattern such that
a sphere 150mm in diameter cannot pass through. The height of stair railings on open sides may be as
specified in Sections 10.17 and 10.20 in lieu of providing a guardrail. Ramps shall, in addition, have
handrails when required by Section 10.29.
Exceptions
i Guardrails need not be provided on the loading side of loading docks.
ii Guardrails for Group H, Division 3 Occupancies may be 900mm in height.
iii Interior guardrails within individual dwelling units or guest rooms of Group U, Division 1
Occupancies may be 900mm in height.
iv The open space between the intermediate rails or ornamental pattern of guardrails in areas of
commercial and industrial-type occupancies which are not accessible to the public may be
increased such that a 300mm diameter sphere cannot pass through.
v Guardrails on a balcony immediately in front of the first row of fixed seats and which are not at the
end of an aisle may be 660mm in height.
vi Guardrails need not be provided on the auditorium side of a stage or enclosed platform.
5.18.1 General:
The provisions of this section shall govern the requirements and uses of foam plastic in buildings and
structures. For trim, see Section 6.11.6. Except where otherwise noted in this Section, all foam plastics
used in building shall have a flame-spread rating of not more than 75 and shall have a smoke-developed
rating of not more than 450 when tested in the maximum thickness intended for use in accordance with
U.B.C. Standard No. 42-1. All packages and containers of the foam plastic ingredients shall bear the label
of an approved agency showing either the flame-spread rating or smoke-developed rating of the product
at the thickness tested or the use for which the product has been listed. The interior of the building shall
be separated from the foam plastic by an approved thermal barrier having an index of 15 when tested in
accordance with U.B.C. Standard No. 17-3. The thermal barrier shall be installed in such a manner that it
will remain in place for the time of its index classification based upon approved diversified tests.
Unless otherwise specifically approved as provided by section 6.18 or by other sections of this code, foam
plastics may be used as follows:
5.18.2.1 Masonry or concrete construction: Foam plastics may be used without the thermal barrier
described above, regardless of the type of construction, when the foam plastic is covered by a minimum
of 25mm thickness of masonry or concrete in a wall, floor or roof system.
[Page 64]
5.18.2.2 Attics and crawl spaces: Within an attic or crawl space where entry is made only for service of
utilities, foam plastics shall be protected against ignition by 38mm thick mineral fibre insulation, 6mm
thick plywood, hardboard or gypsum wallboard, corrosion-resistant sheet metal having a base metal
thickness in a manner that the foam plastic is not exposed.
5.18.2.3 Cold storage construction: Foam plastics installed and meeting the requirements of Section
6.18.1 above when tested in a thickness of 100mm may be used in a thickness up to 254mm in cold
storage buildings, ice plants, food-processing rooms and similar areas. For rooms within a building, the
foam plastic shall be protected by a thermal barrier on both sides having an index of 15.
Foam plastics may be used in free-standing coolers and freezers without the thermal barrier when the
foam plastic has a flame-spread rating of 25 or less when tested in the thickness intended for use, is
covered by not less than 0.81mm of aluminium or corrosion-resistant steel having a base metal thickness
not less than 0.40mm at any point and is protected by an automatic sprinkler system. When such a cooler
or freezers is within a building, both the cooler and freezer and that part of the building in which the room
is located shall be sprinklered.
Exception
Freestanding walk-in coolers and freezer units having an aggregate floor area less than 37.2m2 need meet
only the flame-spread and smoke requirements of Section 6.18.1 above.
5.18.2.4 Metal-clad building units: Foam plastic insulation having a flame spread of 25 or less may be
used without the thermal barrier in or on walls in a thickness of not more than 100mm when the foam
plastic is covered by a thickness of not less than 0.80mm aluminium or corrosion-resistant steel having a
base metal thickness not less than 0.40mm at any point and the area is protected with automatic
sprinklers. Such walls shall not be used where non-combustible or fire-resistive construction is required.
5.18.2.5 Roofing: Foam plastics meeting the requirements of Section 6.18.1 may be used as part of a
roof covering assembly, provided the assembly with the foam plastic insulation is a Class A, B or C roof
covering when tested in accordance with U.B.C. Standard No. 32-7. Foam plastic which is part of a Class
A, B or C roof covering assembly need not meet the requirements of Section 6.18.2.1 provided the
assembly with the foam plastic also meets the requirements of U.B.C. Standard No. 17-4.
Any roof covering installed with this Code and the manufacturer’s instructions may be applied over foam
plastic when the foam is separated from the interior of the building by plywood sheathing not less than
12mm in thickness bonded with exterior quality glue, with edges supported by blocking,
tongue-and-grooved joints or other approved type of edge support, or an equivalent material. The thermal
barrier requirement is waived. For all roof applications, the smoke-developed rating shall not be limited.
5.18.2.6 Doors: Where doors are permitted without a fire-resistive rating, foam plastic having a
flame-spread rating of 75 or less may be used as a core material when the door facing is metal having a
minimum thickness of 0.80mm aluminium or steel having a base metal thickness not less than 0.41mm at
any point. The thermal barrier requirement is waived.
[Page 65]
5.18.2.7 Siding backer board: Foam plastic of not more than 196.3KJ per square metre as determined
by U.B.C. Standard No. 17-2 may be used as siding backer board with a maximum thickness of 12mm,
provided it is separated from the interior of the building by not less than 50mm of mineral fibre insulation
or equivalent in lieu of the thermal barrier, or when it is applied as residing over existing wall
construction.
Plastic foam or assemblies using foam plastics may be specifically approved based on approved test such
as, but not limited to, tunnel tests conducted in accordance with U.B.C. Standard No. 175 and an ignition
temperature test establishing a minimum self-ignition temperature of 323.9oC, under U.B.C.
StandardNo. 52-3. The specific approval may be based on the end use, quantity, location and similar
considerations where such tests would not be applicable or practical.
5.19 INSULATION
Thermal and acoustic insulation located on or within floor-ceiling and roof-ceiling assemblies, attic
spaces, crawl spaces, walls, partitions and insulation on pipes and tubing shall comply with this section.
Duct insulation and insulation in plenums shall conform to the requirements of the Mechanical Code this
as listed in the Schedule.
Exception
The use of combustible roof insulation shall be permitted, provided it is covered with approved roof
covering applied directly thereto. For foam plastic, see Section 6.18. Insulation shall be of a rigid type
suitable for application to a roof covering. Where fire-retardant roof coverings are required, insulation
shall be of a type approved for the type of deck and the built-up roofing applied. Vapour barrier shall be
installed between the deck and the insulation where excessive moisture conditions are anticipated within
the building.
5.19.2 Insulation and covering on pipe and tubing: Insulation and covering on pipe and tubing shall
have a flame-spread rating not exceeding 25 and a smoke density not exceeding 450 when tested in
accordance with (U.B.C. Standard No. 42-1.)
Exception
Foam plastic insulation shall comply with Section 6.18.
5.19.3 Insulation: All insulation materials including facings, such as vapour barriers or breather papers
installed within floor-ceiling assemblies, roof-ceiling assemblies, walls, crawl spaces or attics, shall have
a flame spread rating not to exceed 25 and a smoke density not to exceed 450 when tested in accordance
with U.B.C. Standard No. 42-1 of this Code.
Exceptions
i Foam plastic insulation shall comply with Section 6.18.
ii When such materials are installed in concealed spaces of Types 3, 4 and 5 construction, the flame
spread and smoke-developed limitations do not apply to facings, provided that the facing is
installed in substantial contact with the unexposed surface of the ceiling, floor or finish.
5.20.1 General:
Collectors which function as building components shall comply with the applicable provisions of this
Code. Collectors located above or upon a roof and not functioning as a building component shall not
reduce the required fire resistance nor fire-retardant classification of the roof covering materials.
[Page 66]
Exceptions
i Collectors installed on one- and two-family dwellings.
ii Non-combustible conductors located on buildings not over three storeys in height or 837m2 in total
floor area.
iii Collectors that comply with the requirements for solar collectors.
5.21 ATRIUMS
5.21.1 General:
Buildings of other than Group E Occupancy with automatic sprinkler protection throughout may have
atriums complying with the provisions of this Section. Such atriums shall have a minimum operating area
and dimension as set forth in Table No. 6.21.
A mechanically operated air-handling system shall be installed that will exhaust smoke either entering or
developed within the atrium. Exhaust openings shall be located in the ceiling or in a smoke trap area
immediately adjacent to the ceiling of the atrium. The lowest level of the exhaust openings shall be
located above the top of the highest portion of door openings into the atrium. Supply opening sized to
provide minimum of 50 percent of the exhaust volume shall be located at the lowest level of the atrium.
When the height of the atrium is 16.5m or less, supply air may be introduced by gravity, provided smoke
control is accomplished. When the height of the atrium is more than 16.5m, supply air shall be introduced
mechanically from the floor of the atrium and be directed vertically toward the exhaust outlets. In atriums
over six storeys in height or where tenant spaces above the second storey are open to the atrium,
supplemental supply air may be introduced at upper levels. The exhaust and supply system for the atrium
shall operate automatically upon the actuation of the automatic sprinkler system within the atrium or areas
open to the atrium or by the actuation of two or more smoke detectors required by this section. The
exhaust and supply equipment shall also be manually operable by controls designed for fire department
use. The smoke-control system may be separate or integrated with other air-handling systems. When the
smoke-control mode is actuated, air-handling systems which would interfere with the smoke-control
system shall be automatically shut down.
Enclosed tenant spaces shall be provided with a smoke-control system complying with the requirements
of a sprinklered building in Section 12.1.20.
The atrium smoke-control system shall exhaust not less than the following quantities of air:
5.21.2.1 For atriums having a volume of not more than 18000m3, including the volume of any levels not
physically separated from the atriums, not less than six air-changes per hour or less than 1200m3 per
minute. A lesser rate is acceptable if it can be shown by test that smoke will not spread beyond the
perimeter of the atrium.
5.21.2.2 For atriums having a volume of more than 18000m3, including the volume of any levels not
physically separated from the atrium, not less than four air changes per hour. Smoke detectors which will
automatically operate the atrium smoke-control system shall be installed at the perimeter and on the
ceiling of the atrium and on the ceiling of each floor level that is open to the atrium. In floor levels open
to the atrium, such detectors shall be within 4.5m of the atrium. Detectors shall be located in accordance
with their listing.
[Page 67]
Atriums shall be separated from adjacent spaces by not less than one-hour fire-resistive construction.
Exceptions
i Open exit balconies are permitted within the atrium.
ii Openings in the atrium enclosure other than fixed glazing shall be protected by smoke-and
draft-control assemblies conforming to Section 10.11.
iii Other tight-fitting doors which have automatic closing system, in accordance with Section 4, by
actuation of a smoke detector, or used when protected as required for glazed opening in exception
vi b below.
iv Fixed glazed openings in the atrium enclosures shall be equipped with fire windows having a
fire-resistive rating of not less than one-hour, and the total area of such openings shall not exceed
25 percent of the area of the common wall between the atrium and the room into which the opening
is provided.
v In Group H, Division 1 Occupancies, openings may be unprotected when the floor area of each
guest room or dwelling unit does not exceed 93m2 and each room or unit has an approved exit not
entering the atrium.
vi Guest rooms, dwelling units and tenant spaces may be separated from the atrium by approved fixed
wired glass set in steel frames. In lieu thereof, tempered or laminated glass may be used, subject to
the following:
a. The glass shall be protected by a sprinkler system equipped with 64oC heads. The
sprinkler system shall completely wet the entire surface of the glass wall when actuated.
Where there are walking surfaces on both sides of the glass, both sides of the glass shall
be so protected.
b. The glass shall be in a gasketed frame so installed that the glazing system may deflect
without breaking the glass before the sprinkler system operates.
c. Obstructions such as curtain rods, drapery traverse rods, curtains, drapes or similar
materials, shall not be installed between the sprinkler and the glass. The separation
between the tenant space and the atrium as specified within exception iv may be omitted
on a maximum of any three floors levels, provided the remaining floor levels are
separated as specified herein.
d. Travel distance: When a required exit enters the atrium space, the travel distance from
the doorway of the tenant space to an enclosed stairway, horizontal exit, exterior door or
exit passageway shall not exceed 30m.
e. Group F Occupancy exits: In Occupancies, other than jails, prisons and reformatories,
sleeping rooms shall not be permitted to have required exits through the atrium.
f. Occupancy separation exceptions: The vertical portion of the occupancy separation which
is adjacent to the atrium may be omitted between a Group B, Division 2 Occupancy office
or sales area of Group A, Division 3 Occupancy and Group H, Division 1 apartment or
guest room located on another level.
g. Standby power: The smoke-control system for the atrium and the smoke-control system
for the tenant space are to be provided with standby power as required in Section 9.2.9.8.
[Page 68]
h. Interior finish: The interior finish or walls and ceilings of the atrium and all unseparated
tenant spaces allowed under the last paragraph of sub-section c above shall be Class I
with no reduction in class for sprinkler protection.
i. Inspection of the smoke-control system: All operating parts of the smoke-control
systems shall be tested by an approved inspection agency or by the owner or his
representative when so approved. Such inspections shall be made every three months and
a log of the tests be kept by the testing agency. The log shall be on the premises and
available for examination by fire department personnel.
k. Combustible furnishing in atriums: The quantity of combustible furnishings in atriums
shall not exceed that specified in the National Fire Safety Code.
5.22 MEZZANINES
5.22.1 General:
Rooms may contain mezzanine floors when constructed in accordance with the following:
5.22.1.1 The construction of a mezzanine shall be consistent with the requirements for the type of
construction in which the mezzanine is located, but the fire-resistive time period need not exceed one
hour for unenclosed mezzanine constructed in accordance with Section 6.22.1.4. The clear height above
and below the mezzanine floor construction shall be not less than 2.1m.
5.22.1.2 There shall be not more than two levels of mezzanines in a room. However, there is no
limitation on the number of mezzanines within a room.
5.22.1.3 The aggregate area of mezzanines within a room shall not exceed one third the area of the room
in which they are located. Intermediate floor levels that are 2m or more above grade shall be considered a
storey when the area of such level exceeds one third the area of the room in which it is located.
5.22.1.4 All portions of a mezzanine shall open to the room in which it is located. The side of the
mezzanine which is open to the room shall be unobstructed except for columns and posts and protective
walls or railings not more than 1100mm in height.
Exceptions
i Partitioning may be installed, provided the aggregate floor area of the enclosed space does not
exceed 10 percent of the area of the mezzanine or an occupant load not exceeding 10, whichever is
greater.
ii Mezzanines having two or more exits need not open into the storey in which they are located,
provided at least one of the exits gives direct access to a protected exit corridor, an exit court,
enclosed exit stairway, exterior exit, balcony or exit passageway.
iii In industry facilities, mezzanines used for control equipment may be glazed on all sides.
iv Two exits shall be provided from a mezzanine when two exits are required by Table No. 10.10 or
when the area of the mezzanine exceeds 186m2 whichever is the more restrictive.
v The occupant load of the mezzanine shall be added to the occupant load of the storey or room in
which it is located.
[Page 69]
TABLE 5.1
TYPES OF CONSTRUCTION-FIRE RESISTIVE REQUIREMENTS (IN HOURS)
For details see chapters under Occupancy and Types of Construction and for exception see Section 6.11.2
TYPE 1 TYPE 2 NON-COMBUSTIBLE TYPE 3 TYPE 4 T
BUILDING Fire Fire 1-hr N 1-hr N H.T 1-hr
ELEMENT resistive resitive
Exterior bearing 4 Sec 4 Sec 1 N 4 29.8 4 29.8 4 29.8 1
walls 12.2.8.9 12.2.8
Interior bearing 3 2 1 N 1 N 1 1
walls
Exterior 4 Sec 4 Sec 1 Sec N 4 29.8 4 29.8 4 29.8 1
non-loadbearing 12.2.8.9 12.2.8 12.2.8
walls
Structural frame 3 2 1 N 1 N 1 or H.T 1
Partitions- 12 12 12 N 1 N 1 or H.T 1
permanent
Shaft enclosures 2 2 1 1 1 1 1 1
12.2.17
Floors-ceilings/ 2 2 1 N 1 N H.T 1
floors
Roofs-ceilings/ 2 Sec 1 Sec 1 Sec N 1 N H.T 1
roofs 12.2.10.7 12.2.10.7 12.2.10.7
Exterior doors Sec 12.2.8.9 12.2.8.9 12.2.8.9 12.2.8.9 12.2.8 12.2.8 12.2.8 12.2.8
and windows
[Page 70]
N – No general requirements for fire resistance.
H.T – Heavy Timber.
1. Structural frame elements in the exterior wall shall be protected against external fire exposure as
required for exterior load bearing walls or the structural frame, whichever is greater.
2. Fire-retardant treated wood (see Section 8.4.1.1) may be used in the assembly, provided
fire-resistance requirements are maintained. See.
TABLE 5.2.1
ATRIUM OPENING AND AREA
1. The specified dimensions are the diameter of inscribed circles whose centres fall on a common
axis for the full height of the atrium.
Pre-Design Stage
Pre-Design Stage
Section 6
Environmental and General Building Requirements
Sections
6.1 Environmental Requirements
6.2 Interior Requirements
6.3 General Building Limitations
[Page 73]
6.1.1 General:
The provisions of this Section shall govern the means of light, ventilation and sound transmission control
required in all buildings intended for human occupancy. Every building and structure hereafter erected
and every building, room or space which use has been changed shall be constructed, arranged and
equipped to conform to the requirements of this Section.
Where more than one building is hereafter placed on a plot, or where a building is placed on the same plot
with existing buildings, for the purpose of this Chapter the uncovered plot area should constitute adequate
sources of light and ventilation for all buildings intended for human occupancy.
6.1.3.1 General: Plans for all buildings and structures other than buildings of Use Group H-2, H-3, and
F-1 which are designed for human occupancy and for which means of artificial lighting and ventilation
are required, the application shall include sufficient details and description of the mechanical system to be
installed as herein required or as specified in the mechanical code listed in the Schedule.
6.1.3.2 Alterations: A building shall not hereafter be altered or rearranged so as to reduce either the size
of a room, or the fresh air supply, or the amount of available natural light to less than that required for
buildings hereafter erected; or to create an additional room unless made to conform to the requirements of
Section 7.3.3 and 7.3.8. The Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit shall permit new rooms to be of the
same height as existing rooms in the same storey unless in the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit’s
opinion greater provision of artificial light and ventilation is deemed necessary to insure healthful living
conditions.
6.1.3.3 Uncovered yard and court area: A building shall not be hereafter enlarged, nor shall the plot on
which it is located be diminished, so as to decrease the required courts or yards to less than that prescribed
in this Part for the lighting and ventilation of new buildings.
6.2.1.1 Light required: Every room or space intended for human occupancy shall have natural and or
artificial light.
a. Bathroom and toilet room lighting: Every bathroom and toilet room shall be provided with
natural and or artificial light. The illumination shall have an average intensity of 50 lux
measured at a level of 75cm above the floor.
[Page 74]
b. Ventilation required: Every room or space intended for human occupancy shall be provided
with natural and or mechanical ventilation.
6.2.2.1 General: In the application of the provisions of this Part, the standard of natural light for all
habitable and occupiable rooms, unless otherwise specifically required by the provisions of Section 7.2
for special uses and occupancies, shall be based on 2691 lux of illumination on the vertical plane adjacent
to the exterior of the light transmitting device in the enclosure wall and shall be adequate to provide an
average illumination of 64.58 lux over the area of the room, at a height of 75cm above the floor level.
6.2.2.1.1 Adjoining spaces: Where natural light for rooms or spaces without exterior glazing areas is
provided through an adjoining room, the unobstructed opening to the adjoining room shall be at least 8
percent of the floor area of the interior room or space, but not less than 2.4m2. The exterior glazing area
shall be based on the total floor area being served.
6.2.2.2 Stairways: Interior stairways shall be provided with an exterior glazing area of not less than
1.0m2 on every floor through which the stairway passes.
6.2.3.1 General: Artificial light shall be capable of providing a minimum illumination as specified for
natural light.
6.2.4.1 General: Natural ventilation of an occupied space shall be through windows, doors, louvres or
other natural openings to the outdoor air.
6.2.4.2 Ventilation area required: The minimum openable area to the outdoors shall be 4 percent of the
floor area being ventilated.
6.2.4.2.1 Adjoining spaces: Where rooms and spaces without openings to the outdoors are ventilated
through an adjoining room, the unobstructed opening to the adjoining rooms shall be at least 8 percent of
the floor area of interior room or space, but not less than 2.4m2. The ventilation openings to the outdoors
shall be based on the total floor area being ventilated.
6.2.4.2.2 Openings below grade: Openings below grade shall be acceptable for natural ventilation
provided the outside horizontal clear space measured perpendicular to the opening is one and one-half
times the depth below the average adjoining grade.
6.2.4.3 Contaminants exhausted: Contaminants in the breathing atmosphere shall be exhausted to the
outdoor air in accordance with the mechanical code listed in the Schedule.
6.2.4.4 Openings on yards or courts: Natural ventilation shall be provided by openings onto yards or
courts which comply with the requirements of Sections 6.2.8, 6.2.9 and 6.2.10.
6.2.5.1 General: Mechanical ventilation shall conform to the requirements of the mechanical code listed
in the Schedule.
[Page 75]
6.2.6.1 Ceiling heights: Habitable (spaces) rooms, other than kitchens, storage rooms and laundry rooms
shall have a ceiling height of not less than 2.4m. Hallways, corridors, bathrooms, toilet rooms, kitchens
and habitable basements for use as a recreation room only shall have a ceiling height of not less than 2.2m
measured to the lowest projection from the ceiling.
Exception: In buildings of Use Group H-3, the maximum projection below the required ceiling height of
beams and girders spaced not less than 1.2m on center shall be 15cm.
a. Use Group A, B, C and G. A clear height from finished floor to ceiling or lowest projection of
not less than 2.4m shall be provided in all exit access and occupiable rooms of structures of Use
Group A, B, C and G.
b. Sloping ceilings: If any room in a building has a sloping ceiling, the prescribed ceiling height
for the room is required in only one-half the area thereof. In no case should any portion of a
habitable space, have a ceiling height of less than 1.5m.
c. Dropped ceiling: If any room has a dropped ceiling, the prescribed ceiling height is required in
two-thirds of the area thereof, but the height of the dropped portion of the ceiling shall not be
less than 2.2m.
6.2.6.2 Floor area: Every dwelling unit shall have at least one room which shall have not less than 14m2
of floor area. Other habitable rooms except kitchens shall have an area of not less than 10.8m2.
6.2.6.3 Width: A habitable room other than a kitchen shall not be less than 3.0m in any dimension.
6.2.8 Courts
6.2.8.1 General: All courts required to serve rooms for natural light or ventilation purposes shall comply
with the requirements of this section.
6.2.8.2 Minimum width: Every such court shall have a minimum width to height ratio of 1.4 but not less
than 1.5m for outer courts and not less than 3.0m for inner courts.
a. Irregular court width: In the case of irregular or gore shaped courts, the required minimum
width of a court shall be the average width, provided that such a court shall not be less than
1.5m at any point.
6.2.8.3 Area of court: The cross-sectional area of a required court shall be not less than one and one-half
times the square of its width; nor shall the length of any court be more than twice its width.
6.2.8.4 Access to court: A door or other means of access shall be provided at the bottom of every court
that is not otherwise conveniently accessible for purposes of cleaning.
6.2.8.5 Air intakes: Every court serving one or more habitable rooms that are enclosed on all sides, shall
be connected at the lowest end by an open passage of fire resistance construction.
Such intake or passage shall have a cross-sectional area of not less than 2.0m2 and shall remain fully open
at both ends and unobstructed for its full size and lengths, except that grilles of non-combustible
construction are permitted at the ends of the intake.
a. Fire resistance rating: The walls, floors and ceiling of such intakes or passages shall have fire
resistance rating of not less than two-hours in buildings of Types 1, 2, 3, or 4 construction and
not less than one-hour in Type 5 construction.
6.2.8.6 Court drainage: The bottom of every court shall be properly graded and drained to a public
sewer or other approved disposal system comply with the plumbing code listed in the Schedule.
6.2.8.7 Open wells or shafts: When a court has a cross-sectional area of width to height dimensions less
than as specified in sections 6.2.8.1 and 6.2.8.3, the court shall be regarded as an open well or a shaft and
shall not be habitable.
6.2.8.8 Set-back: There shall be provided adequate set-back and air-spaces as stipulated by local
regulations by-laws to ensure adequate levels of ventilation and lighting.
6.2.8.9 Other use groups: In buildings of other than Use Group H2, H3, F1 or F3, rear yards shall be
provided to serve all habitable and occupiable rooms requiring light and ventilation from such source.
The lowest level of such yards shall begin at the sill level of the second storey windows, with a depth of
not less than 3m for a height of 10m and shall increase 75mm for each additional 30cm of height above
that level.
[Page 77]
6.2.9.1 Permissible projections: Every required court and yard shall remain unobstructed for its
required area and full height, except for the projections permitted in Section 6.3.7. In Use Groups H and
F, clothes poles, arbors, garden trellises and other such accessories shall not be prohibited in the open
spaces at ground level.
6.2.9.2 Motor vehicle parking: When approved, the use of required court and yard areas for automobile
parking spaces or private garages not exceeding one storey in height when accessory to and only for the
use of the occupants of a Use Group H building is permitted, provided required windows for light and
ventilation are not obstructed thereby and local setback regulations are met.
6.2.10.1 General: All buildings and structures over 15m or four storeys in height, in which the windows
are cleaned from the outside, shall be provided with anchors or other approved safety devices for all
window openings. Such anchors, belt terminals or other devices shall be of approved design, and
constructed of corrosion-resistive materials securely attached to the window frames or anchored in the
enclosure walls of the building. Cast iron or cast bronze anchors shall be prohibited.
6.2.11.1 Scope: This section shall apply to all common interior walls, partitions and floor/ceiling
assemblies between adjacent dwelling units or between a dwelling unit and adjacent public areas such as
halls, corridors, stairs or service areas in all buildings of Use Group H.
6.2.11.2 Airborne noise: Walls, partitions and floor/ceiling assemblies separating dwelling units from
each other or from public or service areas shall have a sound transmission class (STC) of not less than 45
for airborne noise when tested in accordance with ASTM E90 listed in the Schedule. This requirement
shall not apply to dwelling unit entrance doors, but such doors shall be tight-fitting to the frame and sill.
6.2.11.3 Airborne sound: Floor/ceiling assemblies between dwelling units and between a dwelling unit
and a public or service area within the structure shall have an impact insulation class (IIC) rating of not
less than 45 when tested in accordance with ASTM E492 listed in the Schedule.
6.2.11.4 Tested assemblies: When approved, assemblies of building construction listed in GA 600,
NCMA TEK 69A and BIA TN 5A listed in the Schedule shall be accepted as having the STC and IIC
ratings specified therein for determining compliance with the requirements of this Section.
6.3.1 General
6.3.1.1 The provisions of this Part shall control the height and area of all buildings hereafter erected, and
extensions to existing buildings hereafter altered or enlarged as a function of the type of construction, use
group, exterior exposure and accessibility of buildings and structures for fire fighting purposes.
[Page 78]
6.3.2.1 General: The areas and heights of all buildings and structures shall be governed by the type of
construction and the use group classification as defined in Sections 4 and 5 and shall comply with the
applicable provisions of the local building regulations and by-laws.
6.3.2.2. Street Encroachments
6.3.2.3 General: Except as herein provided, a part of any building hereafter erected and additions to an
existing building heretofore erected shall not project beyond the plot line or beyond the building line
when such line is established by the zoning law or any other statute controlling building construction.
6.3.2.4 Below grade: A part of a building hereafter erected below grade that is necessary for structural
support of the building shall not project beyond the plot lines, except that the footings of street walls or
their supports located at least 2.4m below grade shall not project more than 30cm beyond the street plot
line.
6.3.2.5 Projections necessary for safety: In any specific application, the Code Enforcement
Division/Section/Unit is authorised to designate by approved rules such architectural features and
accessories which are deemed desirable or necessary for the health and safety of the public and the
maximum extent to which they shall project beyond the street plot line or the building line where such is
established by statute, subject to all provisions and restrictions that are otherwise prescribed by law,
ordinance or rule of the authorities having jurisdiction over streets or public spaces.
6.3.2.6 Permit revocable: Any permit granted or permission expressed or implied in the provisions of
this code to construct a building so as to project beyond the street plot line or building line shall be
revocable by the jurisdiction at will.
6.3.2.7 Existing encroachments: Parts of existing buildings and structures which already project beyond
the street plot line or building line are not required to be altered until their removal is directed by the
proper authorities of the jurisdiction.
6.3.3.1 General: Subject to such provisions as are otherwise prescribed by law or ordinance, or by rules
of the authorities having jurisdiction over streets, highways, and public spaces, the following projections,
as described in Sections 6.3.6.2 through 6.3.6.7, shall be permitted beyond the street plot line or the
building line in existing built-up neighbourhoods.
6.3.3.2 Cornices and eaves: Main cornices or roof eaves located at least 3.6m above the curb level shall
project not more than 900mm.
6.3.3.3 Architectural decorations: Belt courses, lintels, sills, architraves, pediments and similar
architectural decorations shall project not more than 100mm when less than 3m above the curb level, and
not more than 250mm when 3m or more above the curb level.
6.3.3.4 Ornamental columns: Ornamental columns, or pilasters, including the bases and moldings
which emphasize the main entrance of the building, shall project not more than 300mm.
6.3.3.5 Entrance steps: Entrance steps and doors shall project not more than 300mm and shall be
guarded by check pieces not less than 900mm high, or shall be located between ornamental columns or
pilasters.
[Page 79]
6.3.3.6 Oriel windows: Oriel windows with the lowest portion at least 3m above the curb level shall
project not more than 750mm.
6.3.3.7 Balconies: Balconies located at least 3m above the curb level shall project not more than 900mm,
except that when the balcony is required in connection with a fore escape or exterior stairway as an
element of a means of egress, the projection shall not exceed 1.2m.
6.3.3.8 Awnings: Retractable or fixed awnings shall have clearances above the grade, and shall be
installed in accordance with the requirements of Section 6.3.6.3.
6.3.3.9 Awning covers or boxes: Awning covers or boxes located at least 2.4m above the curb level
shall not projected more than 900mm. Awnings or boxes should be located within the property line.
6.3.3.10 Marquee: For the purpose of this section, a marquee shall include any object or decoration
attached to or a part of the said marquee. No marquee should project beyond the property line.
6.3.3.10.1 Projection and clearance: The horizontal clearance between a marquee and the curb line
shall be not less than 600mm. A marquee projecting more than two-thirds of the distance from the
property line to the curb line shall not be less than 3m above the ground or pavement below.
6.3.3.10.2 Thickness: The maximum height or thickness of a marquee measured vertically from its
lowest to its highest point shall not exceed 900mm when the marquee projects more than two-thirds of the
distance from the property line to the curb line, and shall not exceed 2.7m when the marquee is less than
two-thirds of the distance from the property line to the curb line.
6.3.3.10.3 Roof construction: Where the roof or any part thereof is a skylight, the materials shall consist
of approved plastics, or wired glass not less than 6mm thick with a single pane not more than 450mm
wide. Every roof and skylight of a marquee shall be sloped to downspouts which shall conduct any
drainage from the marquee in a manner not to spill over the sidewalk.
6.3.3.10.4 Location prohibited: Every marquee shall be so located as not to interfere with the operation
of any exterior standpipe, and not to obstruct the clear passage of stairways or exit discharge from the
building or the installation or maintenance of street lighting.
6.3.3.10.5 Construction: A marquee shall be supported entirely from the building and constructed of
non-combustible material. Marquees shall be designed and constructed to withstand wind or other lateral
loads and live loads as required in Part 5 of this Code. Structural members shall be protected to prevent
deterioration.
6.3.3.10.6 Vaults: Vaults below the sidewalk level shall extend not closer than 900mm to the curb line,
and the construction and use of such vaults shall be subject to the terms and conditions of the authority of
legislative body having jurisdiction.
6.3.3.10.7 Areaways: Areaways shall not project more than 1.2m beyond the street plot line provided
that every such areaway shall be covered over at the street grade by an approved grating of metal or other
non-combustible material.
[Page 80]
6.3.4.1 General: A part of any building or structure shall not extend into side courts, inner courts or
yards required for light and ventilation of habitable and occupiable rooms by the provisions of this
Chapter or by the zoning law or other statutes controlling building construction, except as hereinafter
provided; but the encroachment shall not exceed 20 percent of the area of yard or court required for light
and ventilation purposes.
6.3.4.2 Exterior stairways and fire escape: Outside stairways, smoke proof tower balconies, fire
escapes or other required elements of a means of egress shall not project more than 1.2m beyond the face
of the wall.
Pre-Design Stage / Section 6 Environmental and General Building Requirements /
6.3 GENERAL BUILDING LIMITATIONS / 6.3.5 Special and Temporary Projections
6.3.5.1 Alley projections: The permissible projection beyond street plot lines shall apply in general to
building projections into alleyways, except as is modified by the authority having jurisdiction or by
special restriction.
6.3.5.2 Special permits: When authorised by special permit, vestibule and storm doors shall be erected
for periods of time not exceeding seven months in any one year, and shall not project more than 900mm
or more than one-fourth the width of the sidewalk beyond the street plot line. Temporary entrance
awnings shall be erected with a minimum clearance of 2.1m to the lowest portion of the hood or awning
when supported on removable steel, or other approved non-combustible supports.
6.3.6.1 Permit: A permit shall be obtained from the Code Enforcement Officer for the erection, repair or
replacement of any fixed awning, canopy or hood except as provided in Section 11.10.2, and for any
retractable awning located at the first floor level and extending over the public street or over any portion
of a court or yard beside a building serving as a passage from a required exit or exit discharge to a public
street.
6.3.6.2 Exemption from permit: A permit shall not be required for the erection, repair or replacement of
fixed or retractable awnings installed on buildings of Use Group H-3 unless they project over public
property, or for retractable awnings installed above the first floor or where the awning does not project
over the public street or over any court or yard serving as a passage from a required exit to a public street.
6.3.6.3 Retractable awnings: There shall be a minimum clearance of 2.1m from the sidewalk to the
lowest part of the framework to any fixed portion of any retractable awning, except that the bottom of the
valance of canvas awning shall have a minimum clearance of 2m above the sidewalk. Retractable
awnings shall be securely fastened to the building and shall not extend closer than 300mm from the curb
line. They shall be equipped with a mechanism or device for raising and holding the awning in a retracted
or closed position against the face of the building. Retractable awnings should not project beyond the
property line.
6.3.6.4 Fixed or permanent awnings: The clearance from the sidewalk to the lowest part of any fixed or
permanent awnings shall be the same as required in Section 6.3.6.3 for retractable awnings. Fixed or
permanent awnings installed above the first floor shall not project more than 1.2m. Fixed or permanent
awnings should not project beyond the property line.
[Page 81]
6.3.6.5 Canopies: Canopies shall be constructed of a metal framework, with an approved covering,
attached to the building at the inner end and supported at the outer end by not less than 600mm in from
the curb line. The horizontal portion of the framework shall be not less than 2.4m nor more than 3.6m
above the sidewalk and the clearance between the covering or valance and the sidewalk shall be not less
than 2.1m.
6.3.6.6 Special applications of awnings: Rigid awnings supported in whole or part by members resting
on the ground and used for patio covers, car ports, country house or other similar uses shall comply with
the requirements of Section 6.3.6.7 for design and construction.
Such structures shall be braced as required to provide rigidity.
6.3.6.7 Design and construction: Fixed awnings, canopies and similar structures shall be designed and
constructed to withstand wind or other lateral loads and live loads as required by Part 5 of this Code with
due allowance for shape, open construction and similar features that relieve the pressures or loads.
Structural members shall be protected to prevent deterioration.
6.3.7.1 General: Pursuant to a variance granted by the Board of Appeals under the provisions of Section
13.8, the Code Enforcement Officer shall issue a permit for temporary construction as approved by the
Board of Appeals. Such permits shall be limited as to time of service, but such temporary constructions
shall not be permitted for more than one year.
6.3.7.2 Special approval: All temporary construction shall conform to structural strength, fire safety,
means of egress, light, ventilation and sanitary requirements of this Code necessary to ensure the public
health, safety and general welfare.
6.3.7.3 Termination of approval: The Code Enforcement Officer is hereby authorised to terminate such
special approval and to order the demolition of any such construction at his discretion, or as directed by a
decision of the Board of Appeals.
6.3.8.1 Where required: The provisions of this Section shall apply to all buildings and portions thereof
of Use Groups A, B, C, F, G and H.
6.3.8.2 Exceptions
i Mechanical, storage and similar types of incidental spaces.
ii Mezzanines and balconies in Use Groups A and C provided accessible seating accommodations are
available and the services are identical.
iii Use Group H-3.
iv Use Group F-1 with 20 or less occupants.
6.3.8.3 Modifications: Where it can be demonstrated that one or more of the following provisions is not
applicable to the proposed use and occupancy, requests for modifications shall be considered in
accordance with Section 10.23.
6.3.8.4 General level access: Buildings having accessibility at occupiable grade levels, where a public
elevator is not provided, shall not be required to comply with this section at floors above such levels if
facilities normally sought and used by the public elevator service.
[Page 82]
6.3.8.5 Use Group B: This Section shall not apply to the floors above grade in buildings of Use Group B
where such buildings do not exceed 93m2 in area per floor, do provide accessibility at grade floor levels,
and do not provide public elevator service.
6.3.8.6 Use Group H-1: Those buildings of Use Group H-1 containing more than 20 bedroom units shall
be made accessible to physically handicapped persons in accordance with this section. The number of
bedroom units accessible to physically handicapped persons shall not be less than the following:
i 21 through 99, one unit; and
ii 100 and over, one unit plus one for each additional 100 units or fraction thereof.
To determine the total number of accessible units, more than one structure on a building site shall be
considered as one building. The bedroom units allocated for the physically handicapped shall be
proportionately distributed throughout all types of units. Access to additional floors without public
facilities is not required.
6.3.8.7 Use Group H-2: Those building of Use Group H-2 containing more than 20 dwelling units shall
be made accessible to physically handicapped persons in accordance with this Section.
The number of dwelling units accessible to physically handicapped persons shall be not less than the
following:
i 21 through 99, one unit; and
ii 100 and over, one unit plus one for each additional 100 units or fraction thereof.
To determine the total number of accessible units, more than one structure on a building site shall be
considered as one building. The dwelling units allocated for the physically handicapped shall be
proportionately distributed throughout all types of units. Laundry and storage facilities shall be accessible
from the barrier-free units. Access to additional floors without public facilities is not required.
6.3.8.8 Accessible buildings and facilities: Buildings and facilities required to be accessible by this
Section shall comply with A117.1 listed in the Schedule, except as provided in Section 10.16.0 for ramps.
6.3.8.9 Seating accommodations: Places of assembly and education shall have not less than two seating
arrangements for persons in wheelchairs.
6.3.9.1 Approval: The provisions of this Code relating to the construction, repair, alteration,
enlargement, restoration and moving of buildings or structures shall not be mandatory for existing
buildings or structures identified and classified by the State or Local Government Authority as historic
buildings, subject to the approval of the board of appeals, when such buildings are judged by the Code
Enforcement Officer to be safe and in the interest of public health, safety and welfare regarding any
proposed construction, alteration, repair, enlargement and relocation. All such approvals shall be based on
the applicant’s complete submission of professional architectural and engineering plans and specifications
bearing the professional seal of the designer.
Design Stage
Design Stage
Section 7
Architectural Design Requirements
Sections
7.1 Building Design Requirements
7.2 Special Building Design Requirements
7.3 Means of Egress
7.4 Prohibited Use
7.5 Existing Buildings
7.6 Maintenance of Exits
7.7 Occupant Load
7.8 Types and Location of means of Egress
7.9 Capacity of Egress Components
7.10 Number of Exits
7.11 Exit Access Passageways and Corridors
7.12 Level of Exit Discharge Passageways used as an Exit Element
7.13 Means of Egress Doorways
7.14 Revolving Doors
7.15 Horizontal Exits
7.16 Ramps
7.17 Interior Stairways
7.18 Smokeproof Enclosures
7.19 Exterior Stairways
7.20 Escalators and Moving Walks
7.21 Fire Escapes
7.22 Slide Escape
7.23 Exit Signs and Lights
7.24 Means of Egress Lighting
7.25 Hazards to Means of Egress
7.26 Assembly Aisles
7.27 Guards
7.28 Handrails
7.29 Signage
7.30 Exceptions
7.31 Unsafe and Unlawful Signs
7.32 Existing Signs
7 33 Maintenance and Inspection
[Page 85]
7.1.1 General
7.1.1.1 Occupancy classified: Every building or structure whether existing or hereafter erected shall be
as classified in this Code according to its use or character of its occupancy into one of the Use Groups
listed in paragraph 5.2.1 and as defined in Part 3, Table 7.1.3 below.
Any occupancy not mentioned specifically or in doubt shall be as classified in this Code and included in
the Use Group which it most nearly falls into, based on the existing fire hazard rating of that Group.
7.1.1.2 Change in use: No change shall be made in the character of occupancies or use of any building
which would place the building in a different division of the same group of occupancy or in a different
group of occupancies, unless such building is made to comply with the requirements of this Code for such
division or group of occupancy.
Exception
i The character of the occupancy of existing buildings may be changed subject to the approval of the
code enforcement officer and the building may be occupied for purposes in other groups without
conforming to all the requirements of this Code for those groups, provided the new or proposed use
is less hazardous, based on life and fire risk, than the existing use.
ii No change in the character of occupancy of a building shall be made without a Certificate of Use
and Occupancy as required in Section 3.10.2 of this Code.
The Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit may issue a Certificate of Use and Occupancy pursuant to
the intent of the above exception having certified that the building complies with all provisions of this
Code.
7.1.1.3 Mixed occupancy
7.1.1.3.1 General: When a building is used for more than one occupancy purpose, each part of the
building comprising a distinct “Occupancy,” as described in Part III, shall be separated from any other
occupancy as specified in Section 7.1.2.5.
Exceptions
i Where an approved spray booth constructed in accordance with the National Fire Safety Code is
installed, such booth need not be separated from other Group C Occupancies or from Group B
Occupancies.
ii The following occupancies need not be separated from the uses to which they are accessory:
a. Assembly rooms having a floor area of not over 70m2.
[Page 86]
b. Administrative and clerical offices and similar rooms do not exceed 25 percent of the
floor area of the major use when not related to Group E Division 1 and Group E, Division
1 and 2 Occupancies.
c. Gift shops, administrative offices and similar rooms in Group H, Division 1 Occupancies
not exceeding 10 percent of the floor area of the major use.
d. The kitchen serving the dining area of which it is a part.
iii An occupancy separation need not be provided between a Group H, Division 1 Occupancy and a
carport having no enclosed uses above, provided the carport is entirely open on two or more sides.
7.1.1.3.2 When a building houses more than one occupancy, each portion of the building shall conform
to the requirements for the occupancy housed therein. The area of the building shall be such that the sum
of the ratios of the actual area for each separate occupancy divided by the total allowable area for each
separate occupancy shall not exceed one.
Where minor accessory uses do not occupy more than 10 percent of the area of any floor of a building,
nor more than the basic area permitted in the occupancy by Table 7.1.4 for such minor use, for the
purpose of determining allowable area, the major use of the building shall determine the occupancy
classification, provided the uses are separated as specified in Section 7.1.2.5. Except for buildings
containing Group H, Division 1 through Division 1 and Division 6 Occupancies, the provisions of this
Paragraph are applicable to buildings constructed under the provisions of Section 7.1.5.2 for unlimited
area.
An occupancy shall not be located above the storey or height set forth in Table 7.1.6 except as provided
in Section 7.1.6. When a mixed occupancy building contains a Group E, Division 6 Occupancy, the
portion containing the Group E, Division 6 Occupancy shall not exceed three storeys or 16.8m in height.
7.1.1.3.3 Forms of occupancy separation: Occupancy separations shall be vertical or horizontal or both
or, when necessary, of such other form as may be required to afford a complete separation between the
various occupancy divisions in the building.
Where the occupancy separation is horizontal, structural members supporting the separation shall be
protected by equivalent fire-resistive construction.
7.1.1.3.4 Types of occupancy separations: Occupancy separations shall be classed as “four-hour
fire-resistive”, “three-hour fire-resistive”, “two-hour fire-resistive”, and “one-hour fire-resistive”. (see
U.B.C. Standard No.43-7 for fire dampers in air ducts piercing occupancy separations.)
i A “four-hour fire-resistive occupancy separation” shall have no openings therein and shall be of not
less than four-hour fire-resistive construction.
ii A “three-hour fire-resistive occupancy separation” shall be of not less than three-hour fire-resistive
construction. All openings in walls forming such separation shall be protected by a fire assembly
having a three-hour fire protection rating. The total width of all openings in any three-hour
fire-resistive occupancy separation wall in any one storey shall not exceed 25 percent of the length
of the wall in that storey and no single opening shall have an area greater than 11m2.
All openings in floors forming a “three-hour fire-resistive occupancy separation” shall be protected
by vertical enclosures extending above and below such [Page 87] openings. The walls of such
vertical enclosures shall be of not less than two-hour fire-resistive construction and all openings
therein shall be protected by a fire assembly having a one and a half hour fire-protection rating.
iii A “two-hour fire-resistive occupancy separation” shall be of not less than two-hour fire-resistive
construction. All openings in such separation shall be protected by a fire assembly having a one
and a half-hour fire-protection rating.
iv A “one-hour fire-resistive occupancy separation” shall be of not less than one-hour fire-resistive
construction. All openings in such separation shall be protected by a fire assembly having a
one-hour fire-protection rating.
7.1.1.3.5 Fire ratings for occupancy separations: Occupancy separations shall be provided between the
various groups and divisions of occupancies as set forth in Table 7.1.2.
Exceptions
i In Group A, Division 1 Occupancies a three-hour occupancy separation is permitted from a Group
B, Division 1 Occupancy used only as a garage for the parking of passenger motor vehicles
provided no repair or fueling is done.
ii In Group H, Division 1 Occupancies, a one-hour occupancy separation is permitted from a Group
B, Division 1 Occupancy used only as a parking garage for private or pleasure-type motor vehicles
with no repair or fueling.
iii In the one-hour occupancy separation between a Group H, Division 3 and Group C occupancy, the
separation may be limited to the installation of materials approved for one-hour fire-resistive
construction on the garage side and a self-closing, tight-fitting solid wood door 35mm in thickness
will be permitted in lieu of a one-hour fire assembly. Fire dampers need not be installed in air ducts
passing through the wall, floor or ceiling separating a Group H, Division 3, Occupancy from a
Group G Occupancy, provided such ducts within the Group G Occupancy are constructed of steel
having a thickness not less than 0.48mm (galvanized sheet gauge 26) and have no openings into the
Group G Occupancy.
7.1.1.4 LOCATION ON PROPERTY
7.1.1.4.1 General: Buildings shall adjoin or have access to a public way or yard on not less than one
side. Required yards shall be permanently maintained. For the purpose of this Section, the centre line of
an adjoining public way shall be considered an adjacent property line. Eaves over required windows shall
be, not less than 762mm from the side and rear property lines. For eaves, see Section 6.16.
7.1.1.4.2 Fire resistance walls. Exterior walls shall have fire resistance and opening protection as set
forth in Table 7.1.3, Part III, and in accordance with such additional provisions as are set forth in Part IV
and Part VII. Distance shall be measured at right angles from the property line. The above provisions
shall not apply to walls at right angles to the property line.
Projections beyond the exterior wall shall not extend beyond:
i A point one-third the distance to the property line from an exterior wall; or
ii a point one-third the distance from an assumed vertical plane located where fire-resistive protection
of openings is first required due to location on property, whichever is the least restrictive;
[Page 88]
iii when openings in exterior walls are required to be protected due to distance from property line, the
sum of the area of such openings shall not exceed 50 percent of the total area of the wall in each
storey.
7.1.1.4.3 Buildings on same property and buildings containing courts: For the purposes of
determining the required wall and opening protection and roof-covering requirements, buildings on the
same property and court walls of buildings over one storey in height shall be assumed to have a property
line between them.
Exception: In court walls where opening protection is required such protection may be omitted, provided:
a. not more than two levels open into the court,
b. the aggregate area of the building including the court is within the allowable area, and
c. the building is not classified as a Group 1 occupancy.
When a new building is to be erected on the same property as an existing building, the location of the
assumed property line in relation to the existing building shall be such that the exterior wall and opening
protection of the existing building meet the criteria as set forth in Table 7.1.3 and Part 4.
Exceptions
i Two or more buildings on the same property may be considered as portions of one building if the
aggregate area of such buildings is within the limits specified in Section 7.1.4 for a single building.
ii When the buildings so considered house different occupancies or are of different types of
construction, the area shall be that allowed for the most restricted occupancy or construction.
7.1.1.5 Allowable floor area
7.1.1.5.1 One-storey areas: The area of a one-storey building shall not exceed the limits set forth in
Table 7.1.4. except as provided in Section 7.1.5.
7.1.1.5.2 Areas of buildings over one storey: The total combined floor area for multi-storey buildings
may be twice that permitted by Table 7.1.4 for one storey buildings, and the floor area of any single
storey shall not exceed that permitted for a one-storey building.
7.1.1.5.3 Mezzanines: Unless considered as a separate storey, the floor area of all mezzanines shall be
included in calculating the allowable floor area of the storeys in which the mezzanines are located.
7.1.1.5.4 Basements: A basement need not be included in the total allowable area, provided such
basement does not exceed the area permitted for a one storey building.
7.1.1.5.5 Area separation walls: Each portion of a building separated by one or more area separation
walls may be considered a separate building, provided the area separation walls meet the following
requirements:
Area separation walls shall be not less than four-hour fire resistive construction in Types 1,2-F.R,3 and 4
buildings and two-hour fire-resistive construction in Types II one-hour, 2-N or 5 buildings. The total
width of all openings in such walls shall not exceed 25 percent of the length of the wall in each storey. All
openings shall be protected by a [Page 89] fire assembly having a three-hour fire-protection rating in
four-hour fire-resistive walls and one and a half fire-protection rating in two-hour fire-resistive walls.
Area separation walls shall extend to the outer edges of horizontal projecting elements such as balconies,
roof overhangs, canopies, awnings or architectural projections.
When horizontal projecting elements do not contain concealed spaces, the area separation wall need only
extend through the concealed space to the outer edges of the projecting elements. The exterior walls and
the projecting elements above shall be of not less than one-hour fire-resistive construction for a distance
not less than the depth of the projecting elements on both sides of the area separation wall. Openings
within such widths shall be protected by fire assemblies having a fire-protection rating of not less than
one-hour.
Area separation walls and the projecting elements above shall be of not less than one-hour fire-resistive
construction for a distance not less than the depth of the projecting elements on both sides of the area
separation wall. Openings within such widths shall be protected by fire assemblies having a
fire-protection rating of not less than one-hour.
Area separation walls shall extend from the foundation to a point at least 762mm above the roof.
Exceptions
i Area separation walls terminate at the underside of the roof sheathing, deck or slab, provided the
roof-ceiling assembly is of at least two-hour fire-resistive construction.
ii Two-hour fire-resistive area separation walls may terminate at the underside of the roof sheathing,
deck or slab, provided:
a. Where the roof-ceiling framing elements are parallel to the walls, such framing and
elements supporting such framing shall be of not less than one-hour fire-resistive
construction for a width of not less than 1524mm on each side of the wall.
b. Where roof-ceiling framing elements are perpendicular to the wall, the entire span of such
framing and elements supporting such framing shall be of not less than one-hour
fire-resistive construction.
c. Openings in the roof shall not be located within 1524mm of the area separation wall.
iii Two-hour area separation walls may terminate at roofs of entirely non-combustible construction.
iv Parapets of area separation walls shall have non-combustible faces for the uppermost 450mm,
including counterflashing and coping materials.
v Where an area separation wall separates portions of a building having different heights, such wall
may terminate at a point 750mm above the lower roof level, provided the exterior wall for a height
of 3048mm above the lower roof is of one-hour fire-resistive construction with openings protected
by assemblies having a one-hour fire-protection rating.
[Page 90]
7.1.1.5.6 The area separation wall may terminate at the underside of the roof sheathing, deck or slab of
the lower roof, provided:
a. Where the roof-ceiling framing elements are parallel to the wall, such framing and elements
supporting such framing shall be of not less than one-hour fire-resistive construction for a width
of 3048mm along the wall at the lower roof.
b. Where the lower roof-ceiling framing elements are perpendicular to the wall, the entire span of
such framing and elements supporting such framing shall be of not less than one-hour
fire-resistive construction.
c. Openings in the lower roof shall not be located within 3048mm of the area separation wall. (see
Chapter 4 for special occupancy provisions.)
7.1.1.6 Allowable area increase
7.1.1.6.1 General: The floor area specified in Section 7.1.4 may be increased by one of the following:
7.1.1.6.1.1 Separation on two sides: Where public ways or yards more than 6100mm in width extend
along and adjoin two sides of the building, floor areas may be increased at a rate of 4 percent for each
meter by which the minimum width exceeds 6100mm, but the increase shall not exceed 50 percent.
7.1.1.6.1.2 Separation on three sides: Where public ways or yards more than 6100mm in width extend
along and adjoin three sides of the building, floor areas may be increased at a rate of 8 percent for each
meter by which the minimum width exceeds 6100mm but the increase shall not exceed 100 percent.
7.1.1.6.1.3 Separation on all sides: Where public ways or yards more than 6100mm in width extend on
all sides of a building and adjoin the entire perimeter, floor areas may be increased at a rate of 16 percent
for each meter by which the minimum exceeds 6100mm. Such increases shall not exceed 100 percent,
except that greater increases shall be permitted for the following occupancies:
i Group B, Division 3, aircraft storage hangars not exceeding one storey in height.
ii Group B, Division 4 Occupancies not exceeding two storeys in height.
iii Group E, Division 5 aircraft repair hangars not exceeding one storey in height. Area increases shall
not exceed 500 percent for aircraft repair hangars except as provided in Section 7.1.5.2.
7.1.1.6.1.4 Unlimited area: The area of any one-or two-storey building of Groups B and E, Division 5
occupancies shall not be limited, if the building is provided with an approved automatic sprinkler system
throughout, as specified in and entirely surrounded and adjoined by public ways or yards not less than
1830mm in width.
The area of a Group B, Division 4 Occupancy in a one-storey Type 2 and Type 3 one-hour or Type 4
building shall not be limited if the building is entirely surrounded and adjoined public ways or yards not
less than 1830mm in width.
7.1.1.6.1.5 Automatic sprinkler systems: The areas specified in Table 7.1.4 and Section 7.1.4.2 may be
tripled in one-storey buildings and doubled in buildings of sprinkler system throughout. The area
increases permitted in this Section 7.1.5.1 may be compounded with that specified in Section 7.1.5.1.1,
7.1.5.1.2, 7.1.5.1.3. if the sprinkler systems are installed under the following provisions:
a. Section 7.1 4 for an increase in allowable number of storeys.
[Page 91]
b. Section 12.1 for Group E, Division 1 and 2 Occupancies.
c. Substitution for one-hour fire-resistive construction pursuant to Section 7.1.7.
d. Section 6.21 Atriums.
7.1.1.6.1.6 Maximum height of buildings and increases: The maximum height and number of storeys
of every building shall be dependent upon the character of the occupancy and the type of construction and
shall not exceed the limits set forth in Table 7.1.6, except as provided in this section and as specified in
Section 7.1.2.1 for mixed occupancy buildings.
Exceptions
i Towers, spires and steeples erected as a part of a building and not used for habitation or storage are
limited as to height only by structural design if completely of non-combustible materials, or may
extend not to exceed 6.1m above the height limit in Table No. 7.1.6 if of combustible materials.
ii The height of one-storey aircraft hangars shall not be limited if the building is provided with
automatic sprinkler systems throughout as specified in Section 12.1 and is entirely surrounded by
public ways or yards not less in width than one and one-half times the height of the building.
The storey limits set forth in Table 7.1.6 may be increased by one storey if the building is provided with
an approved automatic sprinkler system throughout. The increase in the number of storeys for automatic
sprinkler systems shall not apply when the automatic sprinkler systems throughout are installed under the
following provisions:
a. Section 12.1.13.7 for Group E, Division 1, 2 and 6 Occupancies.
b. Section 7.1.5 for an increase in allowable area.
c. Substitution for one-hour fire-resistive construction pursuant to Section 7.1.7.
d. Section 6.21, Atriums.
See section 4 inclusive for special occupancy provisions.
7.1.1.7 Fire-resistive substitution: Where one-hour fire-resistive construction throughout is required by
this Code, an approved automatic sprinkler system, as specified in Section 12.1, may be substituted,
provided such system is not otherwise required throughout the building.
Exception: Such substitution shall not waive nor reduce required fire-resistive construction for:
i Occupancy separations [Section 7.1.2.4]
ii Exterior wall protection due to proximity of property lines [Section 7.1.3.2]
iii Area separations [Section 7.1.4.5]
iv Shaft enclosures [Section 6.12]
v Corridors [Section 6.12]
vi Stair enclosures [Section 10.17]
vii Exit passageways [Section 10.11]
viii Type of construction separation [Section 6.2.1]
ix Atriums constructed in accordance with Section 6.21.
[Page 92]
7.1.1.8 Pedestrian walkways
7.1.1.8.1 General: A pedestrian walkway shall be considered a building when determining the roof
covering permitted by Section 10.7. Pedestrian walkways connecting separate buildings need not be
considered as buildings and need not be considered in the determination of the allowable floor area of the
connected buildings when the pedestrian walkway complies with the provisions of this Section.
7.1.1.8.2 Construction: Pedestrian walkways shall be constructed of non-combustible materials.
Exceptions:
i Pedestrian walkways connecting buildings of Type 3, 4 or 5 construction in accordance with
requirements for Heavy Timber construction (see Chapter on materials).
ii Pedestrian walkways located on grade having both sides open by at least 50 percent and connecting
buildings or Type 3, 4 or 5 construction may be constructed with any materials allowed by this
Code.
7.1.1.8.3 Openings between pedestrian walkways and buildings: Openings from buildings to
pedestrian walkways shall conform to the requirements of Table 7.1.3 and Sections 12.1.8.10, 12.2.9.1
and 7.1.3. In addition, pedestrian walkways connecting buildings shall be either provided with opening
protection at connections to buildings in accordance with Section 10.13 or constructed with both sides of
the pedestrian walkway at least 50 percent open with the open area distributed so as to prevent the
accumulation of smoke and toxic gases.
7.1.1.8.3.1 Width: The unobstructed width of pedestrian walkways shall be not less than 1100mm.
7.1.1.8.3.2 Maximum length: The length of a pedestrian walkway shall not exceed 91.4m.
Exceptions
i Pedestrian walkways that are fully sprinklered may be 122m in length.
ii Unenclosed walkways at grade.
7.1.1.8.3.3 Multiple pedestrian walkways: The distance between any two pedestrian walkways on the
same horizontal plane shall be not less than 12.2m.
7.1.1.8.3.4 Required exits: Pedestrian walkways at other than grade level shall not be used as required
exits. Pedestrian walkways at grade level used as required exits shall provide an unobstructed means of
egress to a public way and shall have a minimum width in accordance with Section 10.9.2.
7.1.1.8.3.5 Pedestrian walkways over public streets: Pedestrian walkways over public streets shall be
subject to the approval of local jurisdictions.
7.1.1.9 Sanitation
7.1.1.9.1 Water closet separation: A room in which a water closet is located shall be separated from
food preparation or storage rooms by a tight-fitting door.
7.1.1.9.2 Floors and walls in water closet compartment and showers: In other than dwelling units,
toilet room floors shall have a smooth, hard, non-absorbent surface such as Portland cement, concrete tiles
or other approved material which extends upward [Page 93] onto the walls at least 127mm. Walls within
water closet compartments and walls within 800mm of the front and sides of urinals shall be similarly
finished to a height of 1.2m and, except for structural elements; the materials used in such shall be of a
type which is not adversely affected by moisture.
Showers in all occupancies shall be finished as above to a height of not less than 1.8m above the drain
inlet. Materials other than structural elements used in such walls shall be of a type which is not adversely
affected by moisture.
In all occupancies, accessories such as grab bars, towel bars, paper dispensers and soap dishes, etc.,
provided on or within walls, shall be installed and sealed to protect structural elements from moisture.
7.1.1.9.3 Access to toilets and other facilities
7.1.1.9.3.1 Access to water closets: Each water closet stool shall be located in a clear space not less than
762mm in width and have a clear space in front of the water closet stool of not less than 600mm.
Where toilet facilities are provided on any floor where access by the physically challenged is required by
Table 10.10, at the least one such facility for each sex or a separate facility usable by either sex shall
comply with the requirement of this Section. Except in dwelling units and guest rooms, such facilities
must be available to all occupants and both sexes. All doorways leading to such toilet rooms shall have a
clear and unobstructed width of not less than 813mm each such toilet room shall have the following:
A clear space of not less than 1200mm on each side of doors providing access to toilet rooms. This
distance shall be measured at right angles to the face of the door when in the closed position. Not more
than one door may encroach into the 1200mm space.
Except in dwelling units and guest rooms, a clear space within the toilet room of sufficient size to inscribe
a circle with a diameter not less than 1.5m. Doors in any position may encroach into this space by not
more than 3000mm.
A clear space not less than 1100mm wide and 1250mm long in front of at least one water closet stool for
the use of the physically challenged persons. When such water closet stool is within a compartment, entry
to the compartment shall have a clear width of 900mm when located at the end and a clear width of
900mm when located at the side. A door, if approved, shall not encroach into the required space in front
of the water closet. Except for door swing, a clear unobstructed access not less than 122cm in width shall
be provided to toilet compartments designed for use by the physically challenged persons.
Grab bars near each side or one side and the back of the toilet securely attached 84cm to 850mm to
950mm above and parallel to the floor. Grab bars at the side shall be 1200mm long with the front end
positioned 600mm in front of the water closet stool. Grab bars at the back shall be not less than 600mm
long for room installations and 950mm long where the water closet is installed in a stall. Grab bars shall
have an outside diameter of not less than 35mm nor more than 40mm and shall provide a clearance of
40mm between the grab bar and adjacent surface. Grab bars need not be provided in Group H, Division 1
apartment houses.
When it can be established that the facilities are usable by a person in a wheelchair, dimensions other than
those above shall be acceptable.
[Page 94]
7.1.1.9.3.2 Access to lavatories, mirrors and towel fixtures: In other than Group H, Division 3, Group
G and H, Division 1 apartment houses and Group B, Division 2 and 4 storage occupancies, toilet room
facilities shall be as follows:
Except for the projection of bowls and water piping, a clear unobstructed space 800mm in width and
750mm in height and 450mm in depth shall be provided under at least one lavatory.
Where mirrors are provided, at least one shall be installed so that the lowest part of the mirror is within
1000mm from the floor.
Where towel and disposal fixtures are provided, they shall be accessible to the physically challenged
persons and at least one shall be within 1000mm from the floor.
7.1.1.9.3.3 Water fountains: Where water fountains are provided, at least one shall have a spout within
850mm from the floor and shall have up-front, hand-operated controls. When fountains are located in an
alcove, the alcove shall be not less than 850mm in width.
7.1.1.9.3.4 Telephones: Where public telephones are provided, at least one shall be installed so that the
handset, dial and coin receiver are within 1250mm from the floor. Unobstructed access within 300mm of
the telephone shall be provided. Such access shall be not less than 800mm in width.
7.1.1.9.3.5 Compressed gases: The storage and handling of compressed gases shall comply with the
National Fire Safety Code.
7.1.1.9.3.6 Premises identification: Approved numbers of addresses shall be provided for all new
buildings in such a position as to be plainly visible and legible from the street or road fronting the
property.
TABLE 7.1.3
WALL AND OPENING PROTECTION OF OCCUPANCIES BASED ON LOCATION ON
PROPERTY
TYPES II ONE-HOUR, II-N AND V CONSTRUCTION:
For exterior wall and opening protection of Types 2 One-hour, 2-N and 5 buildings, see Table below and
Sections 7.1.3, 7.3.9, 7.1.3, 7.3.9, 6.2.3 and 6.2.6. This Table does not apply to Types 1, 2, F-R, 3 and 4
construction, see Sections 6.2.2, 6.2.3, 6.2.4 and 6.2.5.
[Page 95]
[Page 96]
[Page 97]
[Page 98]
For agricultural buildings, see Schedule Section 7.7 .
NOTES: 1. See Section 7.1.3 for types of walls affected and requirements covering percentage or
openings permitted in exterior walls.
2. For additional restrictions, see chapter under Occupancy and Types of Construction.
3. For walls facing yards and public ways, see Section 4.
4. Openings shall be protected by a fire assembly having a three-fourths-hour
fire-protection rating.
[Page 99]
TABLE 7.1.2
REQUIRED SEPARATION IN BUILDINGS OR MIXED OCCUPANCY (IN HOURS)
A-1 A-2 A-2.1 A-3 A-4 B-1 B-2 B-3 B-4 C E-1 E-2 E-3 E-4-5 E-6 F G H-1
A-1 N N N N 4 3 3 3 N 4 4 4 4 4 3 1 1
A-2 N N N N 3 1 1 1 N 4 4 4 4 4 3 1 1
A-2.1 N N N N 3 1 1 1 N 4 4 4 4 4 3 1 1
A-3 N N N N 3 N 1 N N 4 4 4 4 3 3 1 1
A-4 N N N N 3 1 1 1 N 4 4 4 4 4 3 1 1
B-1 4 3 3 3 3 1 1 1 3 2 1 1 1 1 4 1 31
B-2 3 1 1 N 1 1 1 1 1 2 1 1 1 1 2 1 1
B-3 3 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 2 1 1 1 1 4 1 1
B-4 3 1 1 N 1 1 1 1 1 2 1 1 1 1 4 N 1
C N N N N N 3 1 1 1 4 4 4 4 3 1 1 1
E-1 4 4 4 4 4 2 2 2 2 4 1 1 1 2 4 1 4
E-2 4 4 4 4 4 1 1 1 1 4 1 1 1 1 4 1 3
E-3 4 4 4 4 4 1 1 1 1 4 1 1 1 1 4 1 3
[Page 100]
A-1 A-2 A-2.1 A-3 A-4 B-1 B-2 B-3 B-4 C E-1 E-2 E-3 E-4-5 E-6 F G H-1
E-4-5 4 4 4 4 4 1 1 1 1 4 1 1 1 1 4 1 3
E-6 4 4 4 3 4 1 1 1 1 3 2 1 1 1 4 3 4
F 3 3 3 3 3 4 2 4 4 1 4 4 4 4 4 1 1
G 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 N 1 1 1 1 1 3 1 1
H-1 1 1 1 1 1 31 1 1 1 1 4 3 3 3 4 1 1
H-3 1 1 1 1 1 1 N N N 1 4 3 3 3 4 1 1 N
Note: For detailed requirements and exceptions and exceptions, see Section 7.1.2.
1. The three-hour separation may be reduced to two hours where the Group B, Division 1
Occupancy is limited to the storage of passenger motor vehicles having a capacity of
not more than nine persons. This shall not apply where provisions of Section 7.3.2.1
apply.
2. For agricultural buildings, see also Schedule Section 7.7.
[Page 101]
TABLE 7.1.6
MAXIMUM HEIGHT OF BUILDINGS
Unlimited 50 50 18 20M 18 20 15 12
B)1.2.3.1 Unlimited 12 4 2 2 1 2 2 2
B-4 Unlimited 12 4 2 4 2 4 3 2
C Unlimited 4 2 1 2 1 2 2 1
E-1 Unlimited 2 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
E)2.3.4.5 Unlimited 5 2 1 2 1 2 2 1
E-6 3 3 3 2 3 2 3 3 1
F-1 Unlimited 3 1 1 Not 1 1 Not
Permitted Permitt
F-2 Unlimited 3 2 Not 2 Not 2 2 Not
Permitted Permitted Permitt
F-3 Unlimited 2 Not 4
Permitted
[Page 102]
H-3 Unlimited 3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3
TABLE 7.1.4
BASIC ALLOWABLE FLOOR AREA FOR BUILDINGS
ONE STOREY IN HEIGHT
(SQUARE METERS)
OCCU- I II III IV V
PANCY
F.R F.R ONE N ONE N H.T ONE
HOUR HOUR HOUR
[Page 103]
OCCU- I II III IV V
PANCY
B)1-2.33 Unlimited 3,711 1,674 1,116 1,674 1,116 1,674 1,302 744
B.4 Unlimited 5,571 2,511 1,674 2,511 1,674 2,511 1,953 1,116
C Unlimited 4,207 1,819 1,256 1,879 1,256 1,878 1,460 846
E)1-24 Unlimited 1,153 521 349 521 319 521 409 233
E)3-4.5 Unlimited 2,306 1,012 698 1,012 689 1,012 818 474
E.6 Unlimited 3,711 1,674 1,116 1,674 1,116 1,674 1,302 744
F 1-2 Unlimited 1,403 632 Not 632 Not 632 484 Not
Permitted Permitted Permitted
F-3 Unlimited 1,403 Not Permitted 5
G See Section 7.1
H-1 Unlimited 2,697 1,256 816 1,256 816 1,256 977 558
H-3 Unlimited
7.1.3.6.2 The clear height of a parking tier shall be not less than 2.1m, except that a lesser clear height
may be permitted in mechanical-access open parking garages when approved by the Code Enforcement
Division/Section/Unit.
7.1.3.6.3 Area and height increases
7.1.3.6.3.1 The area and height of structures with cross ventilation throughout may be increased in
accordance with the provisions of this subsection.
7.1.3.6.3.2 Structures with sides open [as defined in Section 7.3.9.2] on three-fourths of the building
perimeter may be increased by 25 percent in area and one tier in height.
7.1.3.6.3.3 Structures with sides open [as defined in Section 7.3.9.2] around the entire building perimeter
may be increased 50 percent in area and one tier in height.
7.1.3.6.3.4 Open parking garages constructed to heights less than the maximum established by Table
7.3.9 may have individual tier areas exceeding the otherwise permitted, provided the gross tier area of the
structure does not exceed that permitted for the higher structure. At least three sides of each such larger
tier shall have continuous horizontal openings not less than 760mm in clear height extending for at least
80 percent of the sides, and no part of such larger tier shall be more than 60mm horizontally from such an
opening. In addition, each such opening shall face a street or yard accessible to a street with a width of at
least 720mm for the full length of the opening, and standpipes shall be provided in each such tier.
7.1.3.6.3.5 Structures of Type 2-F.R, Type 2 one-hour or Type 2-N construction, with all sides open,
may be unlimited in area when the height does not exceed 23m. For a side to be considered open, the total
area of the openings along the side shall be not less than 50 percent of the exterior area of the side at each
tier, and such openings shall be equally distributed along the length of the tier. All portions of tiers shall
be within 60.1m horizontally from such openings.
7.1.3.6.3.6 Location and property: When located adjacent to interior property lines, exterior walls shall
be of the degree of fire resistance set forth in Table 7.1.3 and such walls shall be without openings.
7.1.3.6.3.7 Stairs and exits: Where persons other than parking attendants are permitted, stairs and exits
shall meet the requirements of Section 10, based on an occupant load of 18.0m2 per occupant. Where no
persons other than parking attendants are permitted there shall be not less than two stairs 900mm wide.
Lifts may be installed for use of employees only, provided they are completely enclosed by
non-combustible materials.
7.1.3.6.3.8 Standpipes: Standpipes shall be installed when required by the provisions of Section 12.1.13.
7.1.3.6.3.9 Sprinkler systems: When required by other provisions of this Code, automatic sprinkler
systems and standpipes shall be installed in accordance with the provisions of Section 12.1.13 and
12.1.22
7.1.3.6.3.10 Enclosure of vertical openings: Enclosures shall not be required for vertical openings
except as specified in Section 7.3.9.7 for stairs, exits and lifts.
7.1.3.6.3.11 Ventilation: Ventilation, other than the percentage of openings specified in Section 7.3.9.2
shall not be required.
[Page 112]
7.1.3.6.3.12 Prohibitions: The following uses and alterations are not permitted:
a. Automobile repair work.
b. Parking of buses, trucks or similar vehicles.
c. Partial or complete closing of required openings in exterior walls by tarpaulins or any other
means.
7.1.3.7 Helipads
7.1.3.7.1 General: Helipads may be erected on buildings or other locations if they are constructed in
accordance with this section.
7.1.3.7.2 Size: The landing or area for helipads of less than 1575kg shall be a minimum of 6m by 6m in
size. The landing area shall be surrounded on all sides by a clear area having a minimum average width at
roof level of 4.5m but with no width less than 1.5m.
7.1.3.7.3 Design: Helicopter landing areas and supports therefore on the roof of a building shall be of
non-combustible construction. Landing area shall be designed to confine any Class l, ll or lll-A liquid
spillage to the landing area itself and provision shall be made to drain such spillage away from any exit or
stairway serving the helicopter landing area or from a structure housing such exit or stairway.
7.1.3.7.4 Exits and stairways: Exits and stairways from helipads shall comply with the provisions of
Section 7.3 of this code, except that all landing areas located on buildings or structures shall have two or
more exits. For landing platforms or roof areas less than 18m, or less than 186m2 in area, the second exit
may be a fire escape or ladder leading to the floor below.
7.1.3.7.5 Federal aviation approval: Before operating helicopters from helipads, approval must be
obtained from the Federal Civil Aviation Authority.
TABLE 7.3.9
OPEN PARKING GARAGES AREA AND HEIGHT
MECHANICAL-ACCESS
Automatic Fire-Extinguishing System
[Page 113]
TABLE 7.3.9.6
OPEN PARKING GARAGES EXTERIOR WALLS
Boys Girls
Elementary Schools 1:100 1:35
Secondary Schools 1:100 1:45
[Page 115]
In addition, urinals stalls shall be provided for boys on the basis of 1:30 in elementary and secondary
schools. There shall be provided at least two water closets and/or urinals where applicable in one lavatory
and at least one drinking fountain on each floor for elementary and secondary schools.
For other requirements on water closets, see Section 7.1.9.
7.1.4.5 Shaft enclosure: Exits shall be enclosed as specified in Chapter 10. Elevator shafts, vent shafts
and other vertical openings shall be enclosed, and the enclosure shall be as specified in Section 12.
7.1.4.6 Sprinkler and standpipe systems: Where required, automatic sprinkler systems and standpipes
shall be installed as specified in Section 12.1.3 (FIRE EXTINGUISHING SYSTEMS).
7.1.4.7 Special hazards
7.1.4.7.1 Chimneys and heating apparatus shall conform to the requirements of this Code dealing with
Materials and the current Engineering Code of Practice. Motion picture machine room shall conform to
the requirements of Section 7.
All exterior openings in a boiler room or rooms containing central heating equipment, if located below
openings in another storey or if less than 3.0m from other doors or windows of the same building, shall be
protected by a fire assembly having a one hour fire-protection rating. Such fire assemblies shall be fixed,
automatic or self-closing. Every room containing a boiler, central heating plant or hot-water supply boiler
shall be separated from the rest of the building by not less than a one-hour fire-resistive separation.
Exceptions
i Boilers, central heating plants or hot-water supply boilers where the largest piece of fuel equipment
does not exceed 400,000 Btu per hour input.
ii When the opening for a heater or equipment room is protected by a pair of fire doors, the inactive
leaf shall be normally secured in the closed position and shall be openable only by the use of a tool.
An astragal shall be provided and the active leaf shall be self-closing.
iii Class l, ll or lll-A liquids shall not be placed, stored or used in any Group C Occupancies, except in
approved quantities as necessary in laboratories and approved utility rooms, and such liquids shall
be kept in tight or sealed containers when not in actual use and shall be stored within a storage
cabinet for Class l, ll or lll-A liquid approved by the fire department.
7.1.4.8 Fire alarms: Approved fire alarms shall be provided for all Group C Occupancies with an
occupant load of more than 50 persons. In every Group C Occupancy provided with an automatic
sprinkler or detection system, the operation of such system shall automatically activate the school fire
alarm system, which shall include an alarm mounted on the exterior of the building.
When required by other provisions of this code, automatic sprinkler systems and standpipes shall be
installed as specified in Section 12.1.
7.1.8.1 Chimneys and heating apparatus shall conform to the requirements of this Code dealing with
Materials and the current Engineering Code of Practice.
7.1.8.1.1 Every boiler, central heating plant or hot-water supply boiler shall be sepa-rated from the rest of
the building by a two-hour fire-resistive occupancy separation.
7.1.8.1.2 In Division 1 and 2, there shall be no openings in such occupancy separations except for
necessary ducts and piping. In any room in a Group E, Division i, ii, or iii Occupancy in which Class I
liquids or hazardous materials are stored or used, energy-consuming equipment shall not be used unless
equipment has been listed specifically for the hazardous atmosphere that may develop.
7.1.8.1.3 In Division 4 Occupancies, devices which generate a spark or glow capable of igniting gasoline
vapours shall not be installed or used within 450mm of the floor.
The use, handling and sale of Classes l, ll and lll-A liquids shall be in accordance with the National Fire
Safety Code.
7.1.8.1.4 Dry cleaning plants shall comply with the National Fire Safety Code.
Equipment or machinery which generates or emits combustible or explosive dust or fibres shall be
provided with an adequate dust-collecting and exhaust system installed [Page 120] in conformance with
the applicable section of this Code. The storage and handling of cellulose nitrate plastics other than film
shall be in accordance with the National Fire Safety Code. Storage and handling of combustible fibre in
amounts beyond the exemptions of Table 7.5.11 shall be in accordance with the National Fire Safety
Code.
7.1.8.1.5 Combustible fibre storage rooms or vaults having a capacity exceeding 14m3 shall be separated
from the remainder of the building by a two-hour fire-resistive occupancy separation.
Buildings erected or converted to house high-piled combustible stock shall comply with the National Fire
Safety Code.
An approved fire alarm system shall be installed in Group E, Division 2 Occupancies used for the
manufacturing of organic coatings as specified in the National Fire Safety Code.
7.1.10.1 Flammable dusts: Rooms or portions of a building wherein flammable dusts are stored,
manufactured, processed or used and may be in suspension in the air continuously or intermittently shall
conform with the following:
a. Wall and ceiling surfaces shall be smooth. Ledges shall be beveled at 60 degrees to the
horizontal to prevent the accumulation of dust.
b. Every dust-producing process shall be provided with a dust-collection system adequate in
capacity to prevent hazardous concentrations of dust within the room.
c. Effective venting devices equal in area to at least 0.093m2 for each 2.4m3 of volume shall be
provided for every flammable dust-connection or storage container having a volume exceeding
7m3.
7.1.10.1.1 The venting devices shall be of light non-combustible construction and shall vent directly to
the exterior of the building. Venting devices shall be located in walls facing yards 9.0m or more in width,
or located in roofs.
b. Flammable liquids: Rooms used for dispensing of Class l-B liquids and rooms used for storage
or dispensing of Class l-A liquids shall have roofs or walls designed to relieve internal
explosion forces.
c. Group E, Division 2 Occupancies involving chemical operations such as oxidation, reduction,
polygenisation, hydrogenation, alcoholisation, polymerisation and similar chemical processes
shall have roofs or walls designed to relieve explosion forces.
7.1.11.1 General: In addition to the requirements set forth elsewhere in this Code, Group E, Division 6
Occupancies shall comply with the provisions of this Section and the National Fire Safety Code.
7.1.11.1.1 Fabrication Area
Separation: Fabrication areas, whose size is limited by the quality of HPM permitted by the National
Fire Safety Code, shall be separated from each other, from exit corridors, and from other parts of the
building by not less than one-hour fire-resistive occupancy separations.
[Page 121]
Exceptions
i Doors within such occupancy separation, including doors to corridors, shall be only self-closing
fire assemblies having a fire-protection rating of not less than three-fourths hour.
ii Windows between fabrication areas and exit corridors may be in accordance with Section 10.11.
iii Floors: Except for surfacing, floors within fabrication areas shall be of non-combustible
construction. Openings through floors of fabrication areas may be unprotected when the
interconnected levels are used solely for mechanical equipment directly related to such fabrication
area. See also Section 6.12.
When forming a part of an occupancy separation, floors shall be water-tight.
iv Ventilation: Mechanical ventilation, which may include recirculated air, shall be provided
throughout the fabrication area at the rate of not less than 0.32m3/Min/m2 of floor area. The exhaust
air duct system of one fabrication area shall not connect to another duct system outside that
fabrication area within the building.
Ventilation systems shall comply with the applicable section of this Code except that the automatic
shutoff need not be installed in the circulating airstream and shall initiate a signal at the emergency
control station.
Except for exhaust systems, at least one manually operated remote control switch that will shut
down the fabrication area ventilation system shall be installed at an approved location outside the
fabrication area.
v Transporting hazardous production materials: Hazardous production materials shall be
transported to fabrication area through enclosed piping or tubing systems that comply with Section
7.5.11.6 through service corridors or in exit corridors as permitted in the exception to Section
7.5.11.3. The handling or transporting of hazardous production materials within service corridors
shall comply with the National Fire Safety Code.
vi Electrical: Electrical equipment and devices within the fabrication area shall comply with the
Electrical Code. The requirements for hazardous locations need not be applied when the average air
change is at least four times that set forth in Section 7.5.11.3 and when the number of air changes at
any location is not less than three times that required by Section 7.5.11.3 and the National Fire
Safety Code.
7.1.11.1.2 Exit corridors: Exit corridors shall comply with Section 10.11 and shall be separated from
fabrication areas as specified in Section 7.5.11.2 (i) Exit corridor shall not be used for transporting
hazardous production materials except as provided in Section 7.5.11.6 (2).
Exceptions: In existing Group E, Division 6 Occupancies when there are alterations or modifications to
existing fabrication areas, the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit may permit the transportation of
hazardous production materials (HPM) in exit corridors subject to the requirements of the National Fire
Safety Code and as follows:
i Corridors adjacent to the fabrication area where the alteration work is to be done shall comply with
Section 10.11 for a length determined as follows:
a. The length of the common wall of the corridor and the fabrication area, and,
[Page 122]
b. for the distance along the exit corridor to the point of entry of Hazardous Production
Materials (HPM) into the exit corridor serving that fabrication area.
ii There shall be an emergency telephone system or a local alarm manual pull station or approved
signal device within exit corridors at not more than 45.7m intervals or fraction thereof and at each
exit stair doorway. The signal shall be relayed to the emergency control station and a local
signaling device shall be provided.
iii Sprinkler protection shall be designed in accordance with U.B.C. Standard No. 38-1 for Ordinary
Hazard Group 3, except that when one row of sprinklers is used in the corridor protection, the
maximum number of sprinklers that need be calculated is 13.
7.1.11.1.3 Service corridors: Service corridors shall be classified as Group E, Division 6 Occupancies.
Service corridors shall be separate from exit corridors as required by Section 7.5.11.1 Service corridors
shall be mechanically ventilated as required by Section 7.5.11.3 or at not less than six air changes per
hour, whichever is greater.
The maximum distance of travel from any point in a service corridor to an exterior exit door, horizontal
exit, exit passageway, enclosed stairway or door into a fabrication area shall not exceed 23m. Dead ends
shall not exceed 1.2m in length. There shall be not less than two exits, and not more than one half of the
required exits shall be into the fabrication area. Doors from service corridors shall swing in the direction
of exit travel and shall be self-closing.
7.1.11.1.4 Storage of Hazardous Production Materials (HPM)
7.1.11.1.5 Construction: The storage of hazardous production materials in quantities greater than those
listed in Table 7.5.11 shall be in inside rooms complying with Section 7.5.2.3 or shall be in HPM storage
rooms not exceeding 558m2 in area. Such HPM storage rooms shall be separated from all other areas by
not less than a two-hour-fire-resistive separation when the area is 28m2 or more and not less than
one-hour fire-resistive construction when the area is less than 28m2. The provisions of Section 7.1.2 shall
apply.
When an HPM storage room is also used for dispensing of Class I or II flammable liquids or flammable
gases, the area of the room shall not exceed 93m2. Except for surfacing, floors of storage rooms shall be
of non-combustible liquid-tight construction. Raised grating over floors shall be of non-combustible
materials. See Section 7.5.2.3 for sill requirements for liquid storage rooms.
7.1.11.1.6 Location within building: When HPM storage rooms are provided, they shall have at least
one exterior wall and such wall be not less than 9m from property lines, including property lines adjacent
to public ways. Explosion venting shall be provided when required by Section 7.5.10.1.
7.1.11.1.7 Exits: When two exits are required from HPM storage rooms, one shall be directly to the
outside of the building. See Section 7.5.11.2 (i).
7.1.11.1.8 Ventilation: Mechanical exhaust ventilation shall be provided in storage rooms at the rate of
not less than 0.32m3/Minute/m2 of floor area or six air changes per hour, whichever is greater, for all
categories of material.
[Page 123]
7.1.11.1.9 Emergency alarm: An alarm pull station or approved signal device shall be installed outside
of each interior exit door from HPM storage rooms. Operation of such alarm or signal device shall
provide a local alarm and relay a signal to the emergency control station.
7.1.11.1.10 Electrical: HPM storage rooms containing flammable liquids or gases shall be classified as
Class I, Division 1 hazardous location. Electrical wiring and equipment within such rooms shall comply
with the applicable electrical section of this Code.
7.1.11.2 Piping and tubing
7.1.11.2.1 General: HPM piping and tubing shall comply with this subsection and shall be installed in
accordance with nationally recognised standards. Piping and tubing systems shall be metallic unless the
material being transported is incompatible with such system. Systems supplying gaseous HPM shall be
welded throughout, except for connections, valves and fittings, to the systems which are within a
ventilation enclosure. HPM supply piping or tubing in service corridors shall be exposed to view.
7.1.11.2.2 Installation in exit corridors and above other occupancies: Hazardous production materials
shall not be located within exit corridors or above areas not classified as Group E, Division 6
Occupancies except as permitted by this subsection.
Hazardous production material piping and tubing may be installed within the space defined by the walls
of exit corridors and the floor or roof above or in concealed spaces above other occupancies under the
following conditions:
a. Automatic sprinklers shall be installed within the space unless the space is less than 150mm in
least dimension.
b. Ventilation at not less than six air changes per hour shall be provided. The space shall not be
used to convey air from any other area.
c. When the piping or tubing is used to transport HPM liquids, a receptor shall be installed below
such piping or tubing. The receptor shall be designed to collect any discharge or leakage and
drain it to an approved location. The one-hour enclosure shall not be used as part of the
receptor.
d. All HPM supply and tubing and HPM non-metallic waste lines shall be separated from the exit
corridor and from any occupancy other than Group E, Division 6 by construction as required for
walls or partitions that have a fire-protection rating of not less than one hour. When gypsum
wallboard is used, joints on the piping side of the enclosure need not be taped, provided the
joints occur over framing members. Access openings into the enclosure shall be protected by
approved fire assemblies.
e. Readily accessible manual or automatic remotely activated fail-safe emergency shutoff valves
shall be installed on piping and tubing other than waste lines at the following locations:
i At branch connections into the fabrication area.
ii At entries into exit corridors.
Excess flow valves shall be installed as required by the National Fire Safety Code.
f. Electrical wiring and equipment located in the piping space shall be approved for Class I,
Division 2 Hazardous Location.
[Page 124]
Exception
i Occasional transverse crossing of the corridors by supply piping which is enclosed within a ferrous
pipe or tube for the width of the corridor need not comply with items a. through f.
7.1.11.2.3 Identification: Piping, tubing and HPM waste lines shall be identified in accordance with
nationally recognized standards to indicate the material being transported.
TABLE 7.5.11
EXEMPT AMOUNTS OF HAZARDOUS MATERIALS
LIQUIDS AND CHEMICALS
1. Flammable liquids
Class 1-A 114 litres2
Class 1-B 228 litres2
Class 1-C 342 litres2
2. Combustible liquids
Class II 456 litres2
Class III-A 950 litres2
[Page 125]
1. The quantities of alcoholic beverages in retail sales or storage uses are unlimited, provided the
liquids are packaged in individual containers not exceeding 4 liters.
The quantities of medicines, foodstuffs and cosmetic, containing not more than 50 percent by
volume of water-miscible liquids and with the remainder of the solution not being flammable, in
retail sales or storage occupancies are unlimited when packaged in individual containers not
exceeding 4 litres.
2. Quantities may be increased by 100 percent in areas which are not accessible to the public. In
buildings where automatic fire-extinguishing systems are installed, the quantities may be
increased by 100 percent in areas accessible to the public.
3. Containing not more than the exempt amounts of Class 1-A, 1-B or 1-C flammable liquids.
4. Quantities of smokeless powder may be increased to a maximum of 2.25kg, provided those
amounts exceeding 9kg are stored in an approved Class II magazine as specified in the Uniform
Fire Code.
5. Quantities of black sporting powder may be increased to a maximum of 2.25kg, provided such
amount is stored in an approved Class II magazine as specified in the National Fire Safety Code.
7.2.2.1 Scope: The provisions of this section shall apply to buildings or structures defined herein as
covered mall buildings not exceeding three floor levels in height at any one point. Except as specially
required by this section, covered mall buildings shall meet all applicable provisions of this code.
7.2.2.2 Exceptions: When approved by the code enforcement officer, the following uses are not required
to comply with the provisions of this Section.
a. Terminals for transportation facilities.
b. Foyers and lobbies in buildings of Use Groups H-1, H-2 or B.
c. Buildings which comply totally with all other applicable provisions of this Code.
7.2.2.3 Definitions: Terms used in this section shall have the following meanings:
a. Anchor store: An exterior perimeter department store or major merchandising or magnet centre
having direct access to a mall and having its required exits independent of the mall.
b. Gross leasable area: The gross leasable area is the total floor area designed for tenant
occupancy and exclusive use. The area of tenant occupancy is measured from the centre lines of
joint partitions to be outside of the tenant walls.
c. Mall: A mall is a roofed-over common pedestrian area serving more than one tenant located
within a mall building.
d. Mall building, covered: A building enclosing a number of tenants and occupancies such as
retail stores, drinking and dining establishments, entertainment and amusement facilities, offices
and other similar uses wherein two or more tenants have a main entrance into one or more malls.
Anchor stores shall not be considered as part of the covered mall building.
7.2.2.4 Lease plan: The permit holder shall provide both the building and fire departments with a lease
plan showing the locations of each occupancy and it means of egress after the certificate of occupancy has
been issued. Such plans shall be kept current. Modifications or changes in occupancy or use shall not be
made from that shown on the lease plan without prior approval.
7.2.2.5 Tenant separations: Each tenant space shall be separated from other tenant spaces by a wall
having a fire resistance rating of not less than 1 hour. The separation wall shall extend from the floor to
the underside of the ceiling. Except as required by other provisions of this Code, the ceiling need not be a
fire resistive assembly. A separation is not required in attic spaces above tenant separation walls nor is a
tenant separation wall required between any tenant space and a mall, except for occupancy separations
required elsewhere in this Code.
a. Anchor store openings: Openings between an anchor store and the pedestrian area of a mall
need not be protected.
7.2.2.6 Egress: Each individual occupancy within the covered mall building shall be provided with a
means of egress in accordance with other provisions of this code. Measurements shall be made to the
entrance to the mall.
a. Travel distance: The maximum length of exit access travel from any point within the mall to an
approved exit along the natural and unobstructed path of travel shall not exceed 60m.
[Page 135]
b. Anchor store exits: Anchor stores shall provide the required number of exits and units of exit
width directly to the exterior. The occupant load of anchor stores opening into the mall shall not
be included in determining exit requirements for the mall.
c. Dead ends: The dead end of a mall shall not exceed twice its width.
d. Design occupant load: In determining required exit facilities of the mall, the number of
occupants for whom exit facilities are to be provided shall be based on gross leasable area of the
covered mall building (excluding anchor stores) and shall be based on Table 8.2.
e. Exit access width: The minimum width of exit access passageways and corridors from a mall
shall be 1.8m.
f. Exit distribution: The required units of exit width and exits shall be distributed equally
throughout the mall.
g. Storage prohibited: Storage is prohibited in exit corridors which are also used for serving to
the tenants. Such corridors shall be provided with conspicuous signs so stating.
TABLE 7.2.1
FLOOR AREA ALLOWANCE PER OCCUPANT FOR COVERED MALLS
7.2.2.7 Mall width: The minimum width of the mall shall be 6.0m. There shall be a minimum of 3m
clear exit width to a height of 2.4m between any projection of a tenant space bordering the mall and the
nearest kiosk, vending machine, bench, display opening, or other obstruction to egress travel.
The mall width shall be sufficient to accommodate the occupant load emptying into the immediately
adjacent mall as determined by Section 8.2.4.4 for all occupancies except Use Group A and C which shall
be determined by Section 10.7.
7.2.2.8 Structural elements: Covered mall buildings shall be of Types 1, 2 or 4 construction. Covered
mall buildings three storeys or less in height are exempt from the area limitations of Table 11.2.7.
a. Floor/ceiling assemblies: Floor/ceiling assemblies and their supporting columns and beams
within multi-level covered malls shall be of 1-hour fire resistance rated non-combustible
construction or of Type 4 construction meeting the requirements of Section 6.25.
b. Structural elements, anchor stores: An anchor store three storeys or less in height shall be of
Type 1, 2 or 4 construction and is exempt from the area limitations of Table 11.2, provided that
a smoke control system conforming to Section 12.1.20.12 is installed in the anchor store.
For the purposes of the design and operation of the fire emergency ventilation system, the anchor store
shall be considered a tenant space zone.
[Page 136]
7.2.2.9 Roof covering: Roof coverings for covered mall buildings shall be Class A, B or C as required
by (Section on roofing materials.).
7.2.2.10 Use Group A-1 and A-2 occupancies: Use Group A-1 and A-2 occupancies shall be located in
the covered mall building so that their main entrance is immediately adjacent to principal entrance to the
mall and shall have not less than one-half of their required exits opening directly to the exterior of the
covered mall building.
7.2.2.11 Fire suppression: The covered mall and all buildings connected thereto shall be provided
throughout with an approved automatic fire suppression system. The system shall be installed in such a
manner that when any portion of the system serving tenant spaces is shut down, the portion of the system
serving the mall will remain operational.
7.2.2.12 Supervision: All sprinkler control valves shall be electrically supervised and connected to either
the fire department or to an approved supervisory service.
7.2.2.13 Standpipe: There shall be a fire department standpipe outlet connected to a supply capable of
delivering 1,135 liters per minute (0.022m3) located within the mall at each entrance to an exit
passageway, corridor or enclosed stairway and at exterior exits.
7.2.2.14 Smoke control: The mall and adjacent tenant spaces shall be equipped with a smoke control
system conforming to Section 12.1.20.12.
7.2.2.15 Fire department access to equipment: Controls for air conditioning systems, sprinkler risers
and valves, or other fire detection, suppression or control elements shall be accessible to and properly
identified for use by the fire department.
7.2.2.16 Plastic panels and plastic signs: Within every storey or level and from side wall to side wall of
each tenant space, approved plastic panels and signs shall be limited as specified in Section 8.2.15
through 8.2.18.
7.2.2.17 Area: The panels and signs shall not exceed 20 percent of the wall area facing the mall.
7.2.2.18 Height and width: The panels and signs shall not exceed a height of 900mm, except if the panel
or sign is vertical, the height shall not exceed 2.4m and the width shall not exceed 900mm.
7.2.2.19 Location: The panels and signs shall be located at a minimum distance of 450mm from adjacent
tenants.
7.2.2.20 Encasement: All edges and the backs shall be fully encased in metal.
7.2.2.21 Kiosks: Kiosks and similar structures (temporary or permanent) shall meet the requirements of
Section 8.2.20 through 8.2.23.
7.2.2.22 Construction: Combustible kiosks or other structures shall not be located within the covered
mall unless constructed of fire-retardant treated wood throughout conforming to Section 12.2.5.
7.2.2.23 Fire suppression: Kiosks or similar structures that are covered or have roofs and are located
within the covered mall shall be protected by an approved automatic fire suppression system.
7.2.2.24 Horizontal separation: The minimum horizontal separation between kiosks and other
structures within the covered mall shall be 6.0m.
7.2.2.25 Maximum area: Kiosks or similar structures shall have a maximum area of 30m2.
[Page 137]
7.2.2.26 Parking structures: An attached garage for the storage of passenger vehicles or an open
parking structure shall be considered as separate building where it is separated from the covered mall
building by a fire separation wall having a fire-resistance rating of not less than 2-hours or shall be
considered as part of the covered mall building.
7.2.3.1 Applicability: The provisions of this section shall apply to all buildings of Use Group B, H-1 and
H-2 when such buildings have floors used for human occupancy located more than 15m above the lowest
level of fire department vehicles access, except that the provisions of this section shall not apply to airport
traffic control towers conforming to the requirements of Section 8.18.
7.2.3.1.1 Maintenance and inspection: All fire protection systems shall be maintained in an operative
condition at all times and shall be periodically inspected and tested in accordance with the fire prevention
code listed in Schedule A. Maintenance inspections shall be made quarterly and logged in a journal kept
available for inspection.
7.2.3.1.2 Options: All buildings and structures shall be provided with either an approved automatic fire
suppression system according to Section 8.3.3.1, or safe areas of refuge (compartmentation) according to
Section 8.3.3.2.
7.2.3.1.3 Automatic fire suppression system: When provided as required herein, the automatic fire
suppression system shall be installed throughout the building. The system shall be designed using the
parameters set forth in Section 12.1.3 and the requirements of Sections 8.3.3.1 a-c.
a. Shutoff valves and waterflow devices: Shutoff valves and a water flow-device shall be
provided for each floor.
b. Valve supervision: Valves shall be supervised by a continuously manned control station or
central station.
c. Secondary water supply: In addition to the main water supply, in Seismic Zones 2 and 3, a
secondary on-site supply of water equal to the hydraulically calculated sprinkler design demand
plus 454 liters per minute (0.0063m3/s) additional for the total standpipe system shall be
provide. This supply shall have a duration of 30 minutes, but need not exceed 45,400 liters
(38m3).
d. Automatic fire suppression system alternatives: When a complete automatic fire suppression
system is installed throughout, modifications to this Code are permitted as described in Section
8.3.3.1e (i-vii)
e. (i) Type of construction: The minimum type of construction required by this Code shall be
modified as indicated in Table 8.3.
(ii) Fire resistance rating of walls and doors: The fire resistance rating of exit access
corridors, vertical separation of tenant spaces and dwelling unit separations shall be in
accordance with Sections 10.11.7 and 10.11.8.
(iii) Shaft enclosures: The required fire resistance rating of vertical shafts other than
stairway enclosures and elevator hoistway enclosures shall be reduced to 1-hour
fire-resistance rating when sprinklers are installed within the shafts at alternate floor.
[Page 138]
TABLE 7.2.2.3
TYPES OF CONSTRUCTION MODIFICATION
PERMITTED FOR HIGH-RISE BUILDINGS
Types of Construction set forth in Table 6.1 Modified type of construction permitted
hereunder
1A 1B
1B 2A
2A 2B
(iv) Standpipe system: The 38mm hose line, nozzle, rack and cabinet are not required in
accordance with Section 12.1.13.26.
(v) Travel distance: The exit access travel distance limitations set forth in Table 10.8 shall
be increased to 90m.
(vi) Smoke proof enclosures: Smokeproof enclosures as set forth in Section 8.3.5.1 are not
required, but required stairways greater than 23m in height shall be pressurised to a
minimum of 38mm of water column (37.33 Pa) and a maximum of 9mm of water column
(87.10 Pa) in the shaft relative to the building with all stairway doors closed. The
stairway pressurisation system shall be activated by all devices which are required to
activate the voice alarm system in Section 6.2.5.1.
(vii) Fire dampers: Fire dampers, other than those needed to maintain the fire resistance
rating of the floor/ceiling assembly, are not required. Where fire dampers will interfere
with the operation of the smoke control system, approved alternative protective devices
shall be utilised.
7.2.3.1.4 Areas of refuge (compartmentation): Areas of refuge conforming to Sections 8.3.3.2 (a to e)
shall be provided when an automatic fire suppression system is not provided in buildings up to 12 storeys
or 45m in height (see Section 12.1.3.7).
a. Division of floor areas: Every storey shall be divided into two or more areas of approximately
the same size without a single area exceeding 1,400m2. The wall and doors between the areas of
refuge shall be constructed as required for a horizontal exit in Section 10.15.
b. Stairways and lifts: Each area of refuge compartment shall contain a minimum of one enclosed
exit stairway and each compartment shall have access to a lift which shall serve one or more
compartments. When lifts are directly accessible and serve more than one compartment, the
elevator lobby shall be separated from the compartments by not less than 2-hour fire-resistance
rated construction with tight-fitting fire doors complying with Section 12.2.18.
c. Wall constructions: Walls used for compartmenting a building shall have a fire resistance
rating of not less than 2 hours. Duct penetrations of this wall shall not be permitted. Ferrous or
copper piping and conduit shall only penetrate or pass through the wall if the openings around
such piping and conduit are sealed with impervious non-combustible materials sufficiently tight
to prevent the transfer of [Page 139] smoke or combustion gases from one side of the wall to the
other and are so maintained. The fire door serving as the horizontal exit between compartments
shall be so installed, fitted and gasketed that it will provide a substantial barrier to the passage of
smoke and shall comply with Section 10.15.2.
d. Floor/ceiling construction: The fire resistive floor or the floor/ceiling construction shall extend
to and be tight against the exterior wall so that the fire resistive integrity between storeys is
maintained. Penetrations or other installations which will impair the fire resistive integrity of the
floor or floor/ceiling assembly shall not be permitted (see Section 12.2.4.1).
e. Manual fire alarm system: A manual fire alarm system (pull boxes) shall be provided.
7.2.3.1.5 Smoke detection system: A smoke detector suitable for the intended use shall be installed in
accordance with Section 8.3.4.1 through to 8.3.4.3.
7.2.3.1.6 Room locations: A smoke detector shall be installed in every mechanical equipment, electrical
transformer, telephone equipment, lift machine or similar room unless such rooms are protected with an
automatic fire suppression system.
7.2.3.1.7 Duct locations: A smoke detector shall be installed in each connection to a vertical duct or riser
serving two or more storeys from return air ducts or plenums of heating, ventilating and air conditioning
systems. In buildings of Use Group H, an approved smoke detector shall be installed as required above or
shall be installed in each return air riser carrying not more than 2.36m3/s and serving not more than ten air
inlet openings.
7.2.3.1.8 Operation: The actuation of any detector required by this shall operate the voice alarm system
and shall place into operation all equipment necessary to prevent the re-circulation of smoke.
7.2.3.2 Alarm and communication systems: Alarm and communication systems shall be provided. The
alarm and communication systems shall be so designed and installed that damage to any terminal unit or
speaker will not render more than one zone of the system inoperative.
One or more communication systems shall be designed to serve the voice alarm, public address and fire
department communication system as indicated in Section 8.3.5.1 through 8.3.5.3.
7.2.3.2.1 Voice alarm system: The operation of any smoke detector, sprinkler, water flow device or
manual fire alarm station shall automatically activate a voice alarm system.
Activation of the system shall automatically sound an alert signal to the desired areas. The voice alarm
system shall provide a predetermined message on a selective basis to the area where the alarm originated
and shall provide information and give direction to the occupants. The alarm shall be designed to be heard
clearly by all occupants within the building or designated portions thereof as is required for the public
address system.
The central control station shall contain controls for the voice alarm system having the capability to
manually initiate a selective or general voice alarm.
The system shall be continuously electrically supervised against component failure of the audiopath,
including amplifiers, speaker wiring, switches and electrical contacts and shall detect opens, shorts and
grounds which might impair the function of the system.
[Page 140]
7.2.3.2.2 Public address system: A public address communication system designed to be clearly heard
by all occupants of the building shall operate from the central control station.
It shall be established on a selective or general basis to the following terminal areas: lifts, lift lobbies,
corridors, exit stairways, rooms and tenant spaces exceeding 90m2 in area, ds system: A public address
communication system designed to be clearly heard by all occupants of the building shall operate from
the central control station.
It shall be established on a selective or general basis to the following terminal areas: lifts, lift lobbies,
corridors, exit stairways, rooms and tenant spaces exceeding 90m2 in area, dwelling units in Use Group
H-2 and guest rooms or suites in Use Group H-1
7.2.3.2.3 Fire department communication system: A two-way fire department communication system
shall be provided for fire department use. It shall operate between the central control station and every
lift, lift lobby and entry to an enclosed exit stairway.
7.2.3.3 Central control station: A central control station for fire department operations shall be
provided in a location approved by the fire department. It shall contain the voice alarm and public address
system panels, the fire department communications panel; fire detection and alarm system annunciator
panels; an annunciator which visually indicates the floor location of lifts and whether they are
operational; status indicators and controls for air handling systems; controls for unlocking all stairway
doors simultaneously; sprinkler valve and water flow detector display panels; emergency power, light and
system controls; and status indicators and a telephone for fire department use with controlled access to the
public telephone system.
7.2.3.4 Smoke control: A smoke control system conforming to Section 12.1.20.6 shall be installed.
7.2.3.5 Lifts: Lift operation and installation shall be in accordance with Section 9.1.
Lift service shall be provided for fire department emergency access to all floors.The said lift cab shall be
of such size to accommodate an ambulance cot 600mm by 2000mm in its horizontal open position.
Except for the main entrance level, all elevators shall open into a lobby separated from the remainder of
the building by 1-hour fire-resistance rated construction. Exit stairways, chutes, janitor closets, tenant
spaces in Use Group H and service rooms shall not open into the lift lobby and shall be provided with
other means of exit access that does not require passage through the lift lobby.
7.2.3.5.1 Exception: Lift lobbies are not required when a smoke control system is installed in accordance
with Section 30.20.11.
7.2.3.6 Standby power, light and emergency systems: Standby power, light and emergency systems
shall comply with the requirements of Section 8.3.9.1 through 8.3.9.6.
7.2.3.7 Standby power: A standby power system conforming to Section 9.2.8 shall be provided. If the
standby system is a generator set inside a building, it shall be located in a separate room of 2-hour
fire-resistance rated construction. System supervision with manual start features shall be provided at the
central control station.
7.2.3.8 Fuel supply: An on-premises fuel supply sufficient for not less than 2-hours full demand
operation of the system shall be provided.
[Page 141]
7.2.3.8.1 Exception: Where the system is supplied with pipeline natural gas and is approved.
7.2.3.8.2 Capacity: The standby system shall have a capacity and rating that would supply all equipment
required to be operational at the same time. The generating capacity need not be sized to operate all the
connected electrical equipment simultaneously.
7.2.3.8.3 Connected facilities: All power, lighting, signal and communication facilities specified in
Sections 8.3.4, 8.3.5, 8.3.6, 8.3.7, 8.3.8 and 8.3.9 as applicable, and electrically-powered fire pumps
required to maintain pressure, shall be transferable to the standby source. Services shall be provided for
access to all floors by at least one elevator when standby power is connected.
7.2.3.9 Exception: Smoke control systems in accordance with Section 12.2.13.
7.2.3.10 Separate circuits and fixtures: Separate lighting circuits and fixtures shall be required to
provide sufficient light with an intensity of not less than (10.76 lux) measured at floor level in all egress
corridors, stairways, smoke proof enclosures, lift cars and lobbies and other areas which are clearly a part
of the escape route.
7.2.3.11 Other circuits: All circuits supplying lighting for the central control station and mechanical
equipment rooms shall be transferable to the standby source.
7.2.3.12 Emergency systems: Exit signs, exit illumination as required by Section 10.25, and lift car
lighting, are classified as emergency systems and shall operate within 10 seconds of failure of the normal
power supply.
7.2.3.13 Exits: Exits shall comply with other requirements of this Code and Sections 8.3.10.1 and
8.3.10.2.
7.2.3.13.1 Door operation: All stairway doors which are to be locked from the stairway side shall have
the capability of being unlocked simultaneously without unlatching upon a signal from the central station.
7.2.3.13.2 Stairway communication system: A telephone or other two-way communications system
connected to an approved emergency service which operates continuously shall be provided at not less
than every fifth floor in each required stairway where other provisions of this code permit the doors to be
locked.
7.2.3.14 Seismic consideration: Anchorage of lift drive and suspension systems, emergency power and
lighting facilities, fire pumps and all other fire protection equipment and systems shall be designated in
accordance with the section on structural loading.
7.2.4.1 Scope: The provisions of these sections shall apply to buildings and structures using hazardous
production materials (HPM), such as in semi-conductor fabrication facilities and areas of comparable
research and development. Except as specifically required by this section, such buildings shall comply
with the applicable requirements of this code. The specific code provisions of Sections 5.7, 11.3.3 and
Tables 10.9 and 29.3 applicable to high hazard use shall not apply unless stated herein.
7.2.4.1.1 Fabrication area, general: A fabrication area is one in which there are processes involving
hazardous production materials, and includes ancillary rooms or areas such as dressing rooms and offices
that are supplemental to the area processes.
[Page 142]
7.2.4.1.2 Allowable heights, storeys and area: The allowable height, number of storeys and basic areas
permitted for buildings and structures used for facilities using HPM shall not exceed the limits specified
in Table 8.4.1.2 The provisions of Section 11.5 shall not apply. The area limitations are for one or
two-storey buildings facing on one street or public space not less than 9m wide. The increases permitted
in Sections 11.3.2 and 11.3.3 shall apply.
TABLE 8.4.1.2
HEIGHT, NUMBER OF STOREYS AND AREA LIMITATION FOR HPM USE FACILITIES
TABLE 8.4.1.3a
PERMITTED QUANTITIES OF HPM IN A SINGLE FABRICATION AREA
[Page 143]
TABLE 8.4.1.3b
PERMITTED QUANTITIES OF HMP IN A SINGLE HPM
USE FACILITY - DENSITY BASIS
Note a: HPM within piping shall not be included in the calculated quantities.
Note b: The maximum permitted quantities of flammable and combustible liquids shall not exceed the
following quantities:
Class (l-A) + (l-B) + (l-C) (Combinating flammable liquids)........................0010
Class II.......................................................................................................... 0001
Class III-A......................................................................................................0004
Note c: Highly toxic materials and poisonous gases shall be limited by the maximum quantities specified
in Table 8.4.1.3a.
7.2.4.1.4 Egress: There shall be not less than two means of egress provided for by any fabrication area or
any HPM use facility subdivision thereof larger than 20m2. The maximum length of exit access travel in
HPM use facilities shall be 30m.
[Page 144]
7.2.4.1.5 Separation: Fabrication areas shall be separated from each other, from egress corridors and
from other parts of the building by not less than 1-hour fire resistance rated assemblies in compliance
with Section 12.2.4, with fire doors complying with Section 12.2.18. Floors part of the required
separation shall be liquid-tight.
7.2.4.1.6 Floors: Floors within fabrication areas shall be of non-combustible construction. Unprotected
openings through floors of fabrication areas are permitted when the interconnected levels are used solely
for mechanical equipment directly related to such fabrication areas. Mechanical, duct and piping
penetrations within a fabrication area shall not extend through more than two floors. Penetrations shall be
effectively draft-stopped at the floor level. The fabrication area, including the areas through which
ductwork and piping extend, shall be considered a single conditioned space or fire area.
7.2.4.2 Ventilation, general: Ventilation systems shall comply with the applicable mechanical section of
this code listed in the Schedule except as otherwise provided herein. Ventilation including recirculated air
shall be provided throughout the fabrication area at the rate of not less than 5000cm3/s/m2 of floor area.
a. Interconnection: the exhaust system of one fabrication area shall not connect to another
exhaust system outside that fabrication area within the building. The return air system from one
fabrication area shall not connect to any other system.
b. Smoke detector: Smoke detectors shall be installed in the recirculating airstream and shall
initiate a signal at the emergency control station.
c. Shutoff switches: Automatic shut-off are not required to be installed on air-moving equipment.
A manually-operated remote switch to shut off the fabrication area supply or recirculation air
system, or both, shall be provided at an approved location outside the fabrication area.
d. Gas detection: When HPM gas is used or dispensed and the physiological warning properties
for the gas are at a higher level than the accepted permissible exposure limit for the gas, a
continuous gas-monitoring system shall be provided to detect the presence of a short-term
hazard condition. When dispensing occurs with the possibility of generating flammable gases or
vapours in quantities exceeding 20 percent of the lower explosive limit, a continuous
gas-monitoring system shall be provided. The monitoring system shall be connected to the
emergency control station.
7.2.4.3 Transporting HPM: HPM shall be transported to fabrication areas through enclosed piping or
tubing systems that comply with Section 8.4.5, through service passages, or in egress corridors as
permitted in the exception to Section 8.4.2.
7.2.4.4 Electrical: Electrical equipment and devices within the fabrication area shall comply with
approved standards. The requirements for hazardous locations need not be applied when the average rate
of air change is at least 20300cm3/s/m2 of floor area and when the rate of air change at any location is not
less than 15200cm3/s/m2.
7.2.4.5 Egress corridors: Egress corridors shall comply with Section 10.11.6 and shall be separated
from fabrication areas as specified in Section 8.4.1.5. Egress corridors shall not be used for transporting
HPM except as provided in Section 8.4.5.2.
[Page 145]
7.2.4.5.1 Exception: In existing HPM use facilities, when there are alterations on modification to
existing fabrication areas, the transportation of HPM in egress corridors shall be permitted when all the
following requirements are met:
i Corridors adjacent to the fabrication area under alteration shall comply with Table 6.1, item 7, for a
length determined as follows:
a. the length of the common wall of the corridor and that fabrication area; and
b. for the distance along the egress corridor to the point of entry of HPM into the egress
corridor serving that fabrication area.
ii There shall not be openings between an egress corridor and an HPM storage cabinet in a fabrication
area other than those in compliance with all of the following:
a. one-hour fire doors are installed between the egress corridor and the cabinet;
b. the cabinet is enclosed with a one-hour fire-resistance rated assembly between it and the
corridor;
c. the cabinet shall be internally sprinklered.
7.2.4.6 Service passages: Service passages shall be considered as HPM use facilities.
Service passages shall be separated from egress corridors as required by Section 8.4.1.5.
7.2.4.6.1 Ventilation: Service passages shall be ventilated as required by Section 8.4.1.7.
7.2.4.6.2 Egress: There shall be not less than two means of egress from a service passage. Not more than
one-half of the required means of egress shall be into the fabrication area. Doors from service passages
shall be self-closing and swing in the direction of egress travel.
7.2.4.6.3 Travel distance: The maximum distance of travel from any point in a service passage to an exit
or door into a fabrication area shall not exceed 22m. Dead ends shall not exceed 1.2m in length.
7.2.4.6.4 Alarms: Alarms shall be provided in accordance with Section 8.4.4.5.
7.2.4.7 Storage of HPM, general: Rooms used for the storage of HPM in quantities greater than the set
forth in Table 5.7.2b, except for that permitted within a fabrication area, shall comply with the relevant
standards (see NFiPA 30), provided that the area of an HPM cut-off room shall not exceed 558m2. The
storage area for any liquid HPM shall be provided with drains.
7.2.4.7.1 Location within building: When HPM cut-off rooms are provided, they shall be not less than
9m from plot lines.
7.2.4.7.2 HPM drainage systems: Drainage systems shall be provided to direct liquid leakage and fire
protection water to a safe location away from the building, any important valve or adjoining property.
HPM flammable liquid drains shall be separated from other HPM liquid drains. Other HPM liquids in
drains that are not compatible shall be separated from each other, provided that they are permitted to be
combined when they have been rendered acceptable for discharge by an approved means into the public
sewers.
[Page 146]
7.2.4.7.3 Egress: There shall be two means of egress from a separate inside HPM storage room when the
room exceeds 18.6m2 in area. When two means of egress are required from HPM cutoff rooms, one shall
be directly to the outside of the building. All storage room egress doors shall be self-closing and swing in
the direction of egress travel.
7.2.4.7.4 Ventilation: Exhaust ventilation shall be provided in accordance with Section 8.4.1.7 for all
categories of HPM.
7.2.4.7.5 Emergency alarm: An emergency telephone system or local manual alarm pull station shall be
installed outside of each interior egress door from HPM cutoff rooms. The signal shall be relayed to the
emergency control station and a local signalling device provided.
7.2.4.7.6 Electrical: HPM cutoff rooms containing flammable liquids or gases shall be classified
appropriately under hazardous locations in the relevant standards (see NFiPA 70).
7.2.4.7.7 Gas detection: Gas detection shall be provided in accordance with Sections 7.2.20.17d and
7.2.4.7.8.
7.2.4.7.8 Piping and tubing: HPM piping and tubing shall comply with this section and shall be
installed in accordance with the relevant standards.
7.2.4.7.8.1 General: Piping and tubing system shall be metallic unless the material being transported is
incompatible with such system. Systems supplying gaseous HPM, having a health hazard of 3 or 4 as
ranked by NFiPA 704 listed in Schedule A, shall be welded throughout, except for connections, valves
and fittings which are within an exhausted enclosure. HPM piping or tubing in service passages shall be
exposed to view.
7.2.4.7.8.2 Installation in egress corridors or above other use groups: HPM shall not be located
within egress corridors or above areas not containing HPM use facilities except as permitted by this
section. HPM piping and tubing shall be permitted within the space defined by the walls of egress
corridors and the floor or roof above, or in concealed spaces above other use groups under the following
conditions:
a. Automatic sprinklers shall be installed within the space unless the space is less than 15cm in
least dimension.
b. Ventilation at not less than 6 air changes per hour shall be provided. The space shall not be used
to convey air from any other area.
c. All HPM supply piping and tubing and HPM non-metallic waste lines shall be separate from the
egress corridor and from any use group other than an HPM use facility by construction having a
fire-resistance rating of not less than 1 hour as permitted for walls or partitions. When gypsum
wallboard is used, joints on the piping side of the enclosure need not be taped, provided the
joints occur over framing members.
d. When the piping or tubing is used to transport HPM liquids, a receptor shall be installed below
such piping or tubing. The receptor shall be designed to collect any discharge or leakage and
drain it to an approved location. The 1-hour enclosure required by item c. herein shall not be
used as part of the receptor.
[Page 147]
e. Readily accessible manual or automatic remotely-activated fail-safe emergency shutoff valves
shall be installed on piping and tubing, other than waste lines, at the following locations:
i At branch connections into the fabrication area;
ii at entries into egress corridors.
f. Where HPM supply gas is carried in pressurised piping, a fail-safe system for excess flow
control shall shut off flow due to a rupture in the piping.
g. Electrical wiring and equipment located in the piping space shall be approved for Class I
Division 2 hazardous locations in accordance with NFiPA 70 listed in the Schedule.
h. Gas detection shall be provided per Section 8.4.1.7d.
Exceptions to items g. through h.: Transverse crossings of the corridors by supply piping coaxially
enclosed within a ferrous pipe or tube for the width of the corridor. An enclosing pipe or tube open to an
HPM use facility is permitted.
7.2.4.7.8.3 Identification: Piping, tubing and HPM waste lines shall be identified in accordance with
ANSI A13.1 listed in the Schedule.
7.2.5.1 General: The provisions of this Section shall apply to air-supported, air-inflated,
membrane-covered cable and membrane-covered frame structures, collectively known as membrane
structures, erected for a period of 90 days or longer. Those erected for a shorter period of time shall
comply with applicable provisions of the fire prevention code listed in the Schedule and Section 8.28.
Membrane structures covering water storage facilities, water clarifiers, water treatment plants, sewage
treatment plants and similar facilities not used for human occupancy are required to meet only the
requirements of Section 8.5.2.2 and Section 8.5.5 of this Section.
7.2.5.1.1 Construction requirements: Construction of membrane structures shall comply with Section
8.5.2.1 through to 8.5.2.5.
7.2.5.1.2 Type of construction: All non-combustible membrane structures shall be classified as Type 2C
construction. Non-combustible frame-or cable-supported structures covered by an approved membrane in
accordance with Section 8.5.2.2 shall be classified as Type 2C construction. Heavy timber
frame-supported structures covered by an approved membrane in accordance with Section 8.5.2.2 shall be
classified as Type 3B construction. A non-combustible membrane structure used exclusively as a roof and
located more than 6m above any floor, balcony or gallery is deemed to comply with the roof construction
for Type 1 and Type 2 construction, provided that such a structure complies with the requirements of this
Section. All other membrane structures shall be classified as Type 5B construction.
7.2.5.1.3 Membrane material: Membranes shall be either non-combustible as defined by Section
12.2.4.6, or flame-resistance conforming to NFiPA 701 listed in the Schedule.
7.2.5.1.4 Exception: Plastic less than 500um thickness used in green houses when occupancy by the
general public is not permitted and for aquaculture pond covers are not required to be flame-resistant.
[Page 148]
7.2.5.1.5 Applicability of other provisions: Except as otherwise specifically required by this section,
membrane structures shall meet all applicable provisions of this code. The membrane shall meet roof
covering requirements of the section on roofing materials.
7.2.5.1.6 Allowable floor areas: The area of a membrane structure shall not exceed the limits set forth in
Table 11.2.7 except as provided in Section 11.3.
7.2.5.1.7 Maximum height: Membrane structures shall not exceed one storey nor shall they exceed the
height limits in metres set forth in Table 11.2.7.
7.2.5.1.8 Exception: Non-combustible membrane structures serving as roof construction only.
7.2.5.2 Inflation systems: Air-supported and air-inflated structures shall be provided with primary and
auxiliary inflation systems to meet the minimum requirements of Section 8.5.3.1 and 8.5.3.2.
7.2.5.2.1 Equipment requirements: The inflation system shall consist of one or more blowers and shall
include provisions for automatic control to maintain the required inflation pressures. The system shall be
so designed as to prevent over pressurisation of the system.
In addition to the primary inflation system, in buildings exceeding 140m2 in area, an auxiliary inflation
system shall be provided with sufficient capacity to maintain the inflation of the structure in case of
primary system failure. The auxiliary inflation system shall operate automatically if there is a loss of
internal pressure or if the primary blower system becomes in-operative.
Blowers equipment shall meet the following requirements:
a. Blowers shall be powered by continuous rated motors at the maximum power required for any
flow condition as required by the structural design.
b. Blowers shall be provided with inlet screen, belt guards and other protective devices as required
by the code enforcement officer to provide protection from injury.
c. Blowers shall be housed within a weather-protecting structure.
d. Blowers shall be equipped with backdraft check dampers to minimise air loss when
in-operative.
e. Blower inlets shall be located to provide protection from air contamination. Location of inlets
shall be approved by the Code Enforcement Officer.
7.2.5.2.2 Standby power: Whenever an auxiliary inflation system is required, an approved standby
power generating system shall be provided. The system shall be equipped with a suitable means for
automatically starting the generator set upon failure of the normal electrical services and for automatic
transfer and operation of all the required electrical functions at full power within 60 seconds of such
normal service failure. Standby power shall be capable of operating independently for a minimum of 4
hours.
7.2.5.2.3 Support provisions: A system capable of supporting the membrane in the event of deflation
shall be provided in all air-supported and air-inflated structures having an occupant load of more than 50
or when covering a swimming pool regardless of occupant load. The support system shall be capable of
maintaining membrane structures used as a roof for Type 1 or Type 2 construction not less than 6m above
floor or seating [Page 149] areas. The support system shall be capable of maintaining all other membranes
at least 2.4m above the floor, seating area or surface of the water.
7.2.5.2.4 Engineering design: All membrane structures shall be structurally designed in accordance with
criteria approved by the Code Enforcement Officer and developed by a registered engineer or architect.
7.2.6 MEZZANINES
7.2.6.1 General: A mezzanine or mezzanines in compliance with this Section shall be considered a
portion of the floor below. Such mezzanines shall not contribute to the number of storeys or height as
regulated by Section 11.2.6.
7.2.6.2 Area limit: The aggregate area of a mezzanine or mezzanines within a storey shall not exceed
one-third of the area of that storey.
7.2.6.2.1 Exception: The aggregate area of mezzanines in buildings and structures of Type 1 or 2
construction for special industrial uses according to Section 11.2.2 shall not exceed two-thirds of the area
of that storey.
7.2.6.3 Egress: Each occupant of a mezzanine with an occupant load of more than 50 or in which the
travel distance to an exit exceeds 20m shall have access to at least two independent means of egress.
7.2.7.1 General: The term “Open well” shall mean a floor opening, series of floor openings or an atrium
connecting two or more storeys which does not meet requirements for a covered shaft with respect to
enclosure. Open wells are to be classified as either atriums (Section 8.7.2) or floor openings (Section
8.7.3) and shall be permitted in all buildings in other than Use Group E when provided with the protection
herein required.
Exceptions: The provisions of this section shall not apply to the following:
i Stairways permitted to be unenclosed in accordance with Section 10.17.23.
ii In other than Use Group F openings which serve only one adjacent floor, are not connected with an
exit access corridor, not connected with openings serving other floors and are not concealed within
the building construction.
7.2.7.1.1 Fire suppression: An approved, electrically supervised automatic fire suppression system shall
be installed throughout all floor area connected by the open well in accordance with the provisions of
Section 12.1.3, except those floor areas separated from the open well by fire separation assemblies
conforming to Table 6.1 and for floor openings meeting the exceptions in Section 8.7.3.
7.2.7.1.2 Use: The floor of the open well shall not be used for other than low fire hazard uses and only
approved materials and decorations shall be used in the open well space.
7.2.7.1.3 Exception: The use of the open well floor area for any approved purpose shall not be restricted
when the individual space is provided with an approved automatic fire suppression system.
7.2.7.1.4 Atriums: Atriums shall be constructed in accordance with Sections 8.7.2.1 through 8.7.2.4.
7.2.7.1.5 Smoke control: A smoke control system complying with Section 12.2.20.17 shall be installed
in all atriums that connect more than two storeys.
[Page 150]
7.2.7.1.6 Enclosure of atriums: Atrium spaces shall be separated from adjacent spaces by a 1-hour fire
separation wall as required for corridors.
7.2.7.1.7 Exceptions
i In residential occupancies, protected openings are not required when the floor area of each guest
room or dwelling unit does not exceed 93m3 and each room or unit has an approved means of
egress not entering the atrium.
ii Adjacent spaces shall be separated from the atrium by fire windows or by a tempered, wired or
laminated glass wall subject to the following:
a. The glass shall be protected by a specially designed automatic fire sprikler system. The
sprinkler system shall completely wet the entire surface of the glass wall when actuated.
When there are walking surface on both sides of the glass, both sides of the glass shall be
so protected.
b. The glass shall be in a gasketed frame and installed in such a manner that the framing
system will deflect without breaking the glass before the sprinkler system operates.
c. Obstructions, such as curtain rods, drapery traverse rods, curtains, drapes or similar
materials shall not be installed between the sprinkler heads and the glass.
iii The adjacent spaces of any three floors of the atrium shall not be required to be separated from the
atrium; however, these spaces shall be included in the atrium volume for the design of the smoke
control system (see Section 12.1.20.17).
7.2.7.1.8 Alarm: In all buildings with an atrium, a fire alarm system shall be required. The alarm shall be
initiated by either the fire suppression system or the activation of two or more smoke detectors in the
atrium. Such buildings of Use Group A, C or G shall be provided with voice alarms complying with the
requirements of Section 8.3.5.1.
7.2.7.1.9 Travel distance: In other than the lowest level of the atrium, when the required means of
egress is through the atrium space, the exit access travel distance shall not exceed 45m.
7.2.7.2 Floor openings: Floor openings including unenclosed supplemental stairways or escalators
conforming to section 9.1 shall be permitted when protected on every floor pierced by the opening in
accordance with Sections 8.7.3.1 and 8.7.3.2.
Exception: In buildings having an approved automatic fire suppression system throughout, escalator
openings which are protected by a draft curtain and a closed sprinkler water curtain conforming to the
relevant standards (see NFiPA B).
7.2.7.2.1 Smoke Control: A smoke control system conforming to Section 12.1.20.23 shall be installed.
7.2.7.2.2 Draftstop: An approved draftstop shall be installed at each storey of the floor opening. The
draftstop shall enclose the perimeter of the opening and shall extend from the ceiling downward at least
450mm on all sides. Automatic sprinklers shall be provided around the perimeter of the opening and
within 600mm of the draftstop. The distance between the sprinklers shall not exceed 1.8m centre to
centre.
[Page 151]
7.2.8.1 General: Open passenger vehicle parking or storage of passenger motor vehicles, wherein two or
more sides of such structures are not less than 50% open on each floor or level for 5% of the distance
from the floor to the ceiling, and wherein provision for the repairing of such vehicles is not made and
include the two general types indicated in Section 8.8.1.1 and 8.8.1.2. Open parking structures are not
classified as public garages.
7.2.8.1.1 Ramp-type parking structures: Ramp-type parking structures are those employing a series of
continuously rising floors or a series of interconnecting ramps between floors permitting the movement of
passenger automobiles under their own power to and from the street level.
7.2.8.1.2 Mechanical parking structures: Mechanical-type parking structures are those employing
specially designed parking machines, elevator, lifts, conveyors, moving cranes, dollies or other devices
for moving passenger automobiles to and from the street level.
7.2.8.1.3 General construction requirements: Passenger vehicles structures shall be constructed of
non-combustible materials throughout, including structural framing, floors, roofs and walls. Any enclosed
rooms or spaces on the premises shall comply with the applicable requirements of this Code.
7.2.8.2 Basement: Basements which are not classified as open parking structures in accordance with
Section 8.8.1, but are used for parking vehicles shall be sprinklered in accordance with the provisions of
Section 12.1.3 and shall be ventilated in accordance with applicable mechanical section of this code listed
in the Schedule.
7.2.8.3 Fueling dispensing: Areas where fuel is dispensed shall conform to the requirements of Section
8.10.5.
7.2.8.4 Heights and areas: Heights and areas of open parking structures shall not exceed the limits
specified in Table 7.3.9, except that when at least 50 percent open on all sides and when the horizontal
distance from any point on any level to an exterior wall opening on a street, alley courtyard or any other
permanent open space does not exceed 60m, the maximum height of open parking structures of Type 2B
and 2C construction shall be 20m and the area shall not be limited.
TABLE 8.8
HEIGHT AND AREA LIMITATION FOR OPEN PARKING STRUCTURES
Note a: For exceptions to height and area limitations, see Section 8.8.5. The allowable areas of structures
wherein more than 25 percent of the perimeter has frontage on [Page 152] street or other open space
leading to a street, each of which is not less than 9m wide, shall be increased as provided in Section
11.3.2. When an automatic sprinkler system is installed in accordance with Section 12.2 in Types 2B and
2C construction, the area shall be unlimited. The above limits of height permit parking on the roof.
7.2.8.5 Protective guardrail: All wells, shafts and other open, exposed spaces throughout, except
ground floor, shall be enclosed and protected with continuous walls or protective guardrail constructed in
accordance with Section 10.28, except that in those structures wherein vehicles are hoisted to the desired
level and placed in the parking space entirely by approved mechanical means, the continuous wall or
protective guardrail is not required on the side of the parking levels adjacent to the space occupied by the
hoisting and placing equipment.
7.2.8.6 Wheel guards: Wheel guards made of non-combustible material shall be placed wherever
required.
7.2.8.7 Means of egress: For means of egress requirements, see Section 8.9.3.
7.2.9.1 Attached garages: Private garages located beneath rooms in buildings of Use Groups H1, H2,
H3 or F1 shall have walls, partitions, floors and ceilings seperating the garage space from the adjacent
interior spaces constructed of not less than 1-hour fire resistance rating. Attached private garages shall be
completely separated from the adjacent interior spaces and the attic area by means of 12mm gypsum
board or equivalent applied to the garage side. The sills of the door openings between the garage and the
adjacent interior spaces shall be raised not less than 100mm above the garage floor. The door opening
protectives shall be 42mm solid core wood doors or approved equivalent.
7.2.9.1.1 Separation by breezeway: Where a garage separated by a breezeway not less than 3m in
length from the building of Use Group H-3 is of Type 5B construction, the junction of the garage and
breezeway shall be firestopped to comply with Section 12.2.23.
7.2.9.1.2 Other conditions: All private garages not falling within the purview of Sections 8.8.1 or
8.8.1.1 attached to or located beneath a building shall comply with the requirements of Section 8.10 for
public garages.
7.2.9.1.3 Means of egress: Where living quarters are located above a private garage, required means of
egress facilities shall be separated from the garage area with 1-hour fire-resistance rated construction.
7.2.10.1 General: Public garages shall comply with the applicable requirements of this Section. The
portions of such buildings and structures in which paint spraying is done shall comply with the
requirements of Section 8.24.
7.2.10.2 Construction: All group 1 building garages hereafter erected shall be classified as Use Group
1-1 and all Group 2 public garages shall be classified as Use Group 1-2 and both shall conform to the
height and area limitations of Table 11.2.7 except as herein specifically provided.
[Page 153]
7.2.10.3 Special height limitations: Public garage buildings shall comply with the height and area
limitations of Table 11.2.7 for the classification of the use as specified in Section 8.10.2. The height
limitations shall be increased one additional storey when the building is equipped with an approved
automatic fire suppression system.
7.2.10.4 Basement: The first floor construction of public garages of all classifications and public hangers
with basements shall be constructed of not less than 2-hour fire-resistance rating and shall be water- and
vapour-proof. Where openings are provided in the floor, they shall be protected by a curb or ramp not less
than 150mm high above the floor to avoid the accumulation of explosive liquids of vapours and prevent
spilling to the lower floor. There shall be not less than two means of egress from such areas.
7.2.10.5 Roof storage of motor vehicles: When the roof of a building is used for parking or storage of
motor vehicles, it shall be provided with a parapet wall or a guardrail constructed in accordance with
Section 10.28 and a wheel guard not less than 150mm in height, located so as to prevent any vehicle from
striking the parapet wall or guardrail.
7.2.10.6 Floor construction and drainage: Floors of public garages and air-plane hangars shall be
graded to drain through oil separators or traps to avoid accumulation of explosive vapours in building
drains or sewers as provided in the applicable plumbing section of this Code listed in the Schedule. The
floor finish shall be of concrete or other approved non-combustible material.
Exception: Floor drains are not required for detached public garages for the storage of four or less
commercial motor vehicles without provision for repairing or servicing such vehicles nor the dispensing
of gasoline, oil, or similar products.
7.2.10.7 Fuel dispensing areas: Fuel dispensing areas shall be located on the level nearest grade. Public
garages with fuel dispensing areas shall be completely separated from any other use, both horizontally
and vertically, by fire separation walls and floor/ceiling assemblies having a minimum fire-resistance
rating of 2 hours. The floors of the fuel dispensing areas shall be graded to a floor drainage system such
that any fuel spill or leak is contained in that area. The drainage system shall conform to the requirements
of the applicable plumbing section of this Code listed in the Schedule. The fuel dispensing area shall be
protected with an approved automatic fire suppression system in accordance with Section 12.1.1.2.
7.2.10.8 Fuel dispensing systems: All fuel and storage dispensing systems shall conform to the
requirements of the applicable mechanical section of this Code listed in the Schedule.
7.2.10.9 Ventilation: All public garages shall be ventilated in accordance with the applicable mechanical
section of this Code listed in the Schedule. Fuel dispensing areas shall be mechanically ventilated.
7.2.10.9.1 Special hazards: Any process conducted in conjunction with public garages involving
volatile flammable solvents shall be segregated or located in a detached building or structure, except as
provided in Section 8.21 for the storage and handling of gasoline and other volatile flammables. The
quantity of flammable liquids stored or handled in public garages other than in underground storage and
in the tanks of motor vehicles shall not be more than 0.019m3 in approved safety cans.
[Page 154]
7.2.11 Use Group F-2
7.2.11.1 General: All buildings thereof of Use Group F-2 shall comply with the provisions of this
Section and all other applicable provisions of this Code.
7.2.11.2 Specific use areas: The specific use areas listed in Table 8.11.2 shall be separated from other
areas of buildings of Use Group F-2 in accordance with the requirements of Table 8.11.2.
7.2.11.3 Separation walls: Where the separation use areas are not required to have a fire-resistance
rating by Table 8.11.2, the separation walls shall be constructed of materials consistent with the building
type of construction and be capable of resisting the passage by smoke. The separation of walls extends
from floors to the underside of a floor/ceiling assembly or to the floor/roof deck above. All doors shall be
self-closing or automatic closing upon detection of smoke, Door in walls required to be fire-resistance
rated shall have a minimum of fire-resistance rating of 3/4-hour and shall comply with Section 12.2.18
TABLE 7.11.2
SPECIFIC USE AREAS WITHIN AN F-2 USE
Storage rooms more than 4.65m2 in area 1 hour or automatic fire suppression with
2 separation walls
but not more than 9.3m in area storing
combustible material
Storage rooms more than 9.3m2 storing 1 hour and automatic fire suppression
combustible rooms
Trash collection rooms 1 hour and automatic fire suppression
[Page 155]
7.2.11.4 Corridors: All corridors in buildings of Use Group F-2 shall be continuous to the exits and
separated from all other use areas except waiting areas, nurses, stations, and mental health treatment areas
conforming to Section 8.11.4.1 through to 8.11.4.4.
7.2.11.4.1 Waiting areas on patient sleeping floors: Waiting areas on patient sleeping floors shall not
be open to the corridor, except where:
a. the area does not exceed 24m2; and
b. the area is located to permit direct supervision by facility staff;
c. the area is equipped with an approved electrically supervised smoke detection system;
d. not more than one such waiting area is permitted in any one smoke compartment;
e. the walls and ceilings of the space are constructed as required for corridors.
7.2.11.4.2 Waiting areas in sprinklered buildings: In buildings equipped throughout with an approved
automatic fire suppression system, spaces constructed as required for corridors shall not be open to a
corridor, except where:
a. The spaces are not used for patient sleeping rooms, treatment rooms or hazardous areas as
defined in Section 8.11.2.
b. Each space is located to permit supervision by the facility staff.
c. The space and corridors which the space opens onto in the same smoke compartment are
protected by an approved electrically supervised automatic smoke detection system.
d. The space is arranged so as not to obstruct access to required exits.
7.2.11.4.3 Nurses’ stations: Space for doctor’s and nurses’ charting communications and related clerical
areas shall not be open to the corridor, except where the space is constructed as required for corridors.
7.2.11.4.4 Mental health treatment areas: Areas wherein only mental health patients who are capable
of self-preservation are housed, group meeting or multi-purpose therapeutic spaces, other than specific
use areas as defined in Section 6.10.2, under continuous supervision by facility staff, shall not be open to
the corridor, except where:
a. Each area does not exceed 140m2
b. the area is located to permit supervision by the facility staff;
c. the area is arranged so as not to obstruct any access to required exits;
[Page 156]
d. the area is equipped with an approved electrically supervised automatic smoke detection system;
e. not more than one such space is permitted in any one smoke compartment;
f. the walls and ceiling of the space are constructed as required for corridors.
7.2.11.5 Corridor walls: Corridor walls shall have a 1-hour fire-resistance rating extending from the
floor to the underside of the floor or roof deck above. In buildings equipped throughout with an approved
automatic fire suppression system, the corridor wall fire resistance rating is not required provided the
corridor walls form a barrier to limit the transfer of smoke. The walls shall extend from the floor to the
underside of the floor or roof deck above or to the underside of the fire-resistance rated floor/ceiling or
roof/ceiling assembly above when the ceiling membrane is constructed to limit the transfer of smoke.
7.2.11.5.1 Corridor doors: All doors shall conform to Section 12.2.18. Doors to patient sleeping rooms
shall be automatic-closing by smoke detection. All other doors shall be self-closing or automatic closing
by smoke detection. In buildings equipped throughout with an approved automatic fire suppression
system, corridor doors other than those in a wall required to be rated by Section 8.11.2 or for the
enclosure of a vertical opening shall not have a required fire resistance rating, but shall provide an
effective barrier to limit the transfer of smoke. In buildings equipped throughout with an approved
automatic fire suppression system, all doors except those to sleeping rooms shall be self-closing or
automatic closing by smoke detection.
7.2.11.5.2 Locking devices: Locking devices which restrict access to the patient room from the corridor,
which are openable only by staff from the corridor side, shall not restrict egress from the patient room
except for mental health patient rooms.
7.2.11.6 Smoke barrier: Each floor of a building of Use Group F-2 shall have at least one smoke barrier
creating not less than two compartments per floor with a maximum compartment length and width of
45m. The smoke barrier shall be in accordance with Section 12.2.13.
7.2.11.6.1 Refuge area: At least 2.8m2 per occupant shall be provided within the aggregate area of
corridors, patient rooms, treatment rooms, lounge of dining areas and other low hazard areas on each side
of each smoke barrier. On floors not housing bed or litter patients at least 0.56m2 per occupant shall be
provided on each side of each smoke barrier for the total number of occupants in adjoining compartments.
7.2.11.6.2 Independent egress: A means of egress shall be provided from each compartment created by
smoke barriers without returning through the compartment from which egress originated.
7.2.11.7 Smoke/heat detectors: An automatic fire alarm system conforming to Section 12.1.19 shall be
provided in patient sleeping rooms, corridors and common spaces open to the corridor as permitted by
Section 8.11.3. Heat detectors shall be provided in unsprinklered specific use areas listed in Section
8.11.2 and shall sound a local alarm at a constantly attended location.
7.2.11.7.1 Rooms: Patient sleeping rooms shall be provided with a smoke detector permanently
connected to house current and complying with the relevant standards (see UL 217 or UL 268). Such
detectors shall provide a visual display on the corridor side of each patient room and shall provide an
audible and visual alarm at the nursing [Page 157] station attending that room. Where such detectors and
related devices are not combined with the nursing call system, the total system shall be electrically
supervised.
7.2.11.7.2 Exception: Smoke detectors are not required in patient rooms equipped with automatic
door-closing devices with integral smoke detectors on the room sides installed in accordance with their
listing, provided the integral detectors perform the required alerting function.
7.2.11.7.3 Corridors: An approved automatic smoke detection system shall be installed in all corridors
in buildings of Use Group F-2 which are not equipped throughout with an approved automatic fire
suppression system. The automatic smoke detection system required by this section shall be electrically
inter-connected to the fire alarm system.
7.2.12.1 General: All buildings or portions thereof of Use Group F-3 shall comply with the provisions of
this section and all other applicable provisions of this Code (see Section 5.2.7.4).
7.2.12.1.1 Definitions: Terms used in this section shall have the following meaning:
Residential housing area: Includes sleeping areas and any contiguous day room, group activity space or
other common spaces for customary access of residents.
Sallyport (security vestibule): A compartment provided with two or more doors where the intended
purpose is to prevent the continuous and unobstructed passage by allowing the release of only one door at
a time.
7.2.12.1.2 Mixed occupancies: Portions of buildings of Use Group F-3 which are classified as a
different occupancy group shall meet the applicable requirements of this code for such occupancies.
Where security operations necessitate the locking of required means of egress, provisions shall be made
for the release of occupants during all times of use.
7.2.12.1.3 Means of egress: Except as modified or provided for in this Section, the provisions of Section
7.3 shall apply.
7.2.12.1.4 Door width: Doors to resident sleeping rooms shall have a clear width of not less than
900mm.
7.2.12.1.5 Sliding doors: When doors in a means of egress are of the horizontal sliding type, the force to
slide the door to its fully open position shall not exceed 222 Newtons with a perpendicular force against
the door of 222 Newtons.
7.2.12.1.6 Horizontal exits: Horizontal exits shall not be substituted for other exits unless the maximum
exit travel distance specified in Table 10.8 is not exceeded. Horizontal exits shall be permitted to
comprise 100 percent of the exits required. At least 0.56m2 of accessible space per occupant shall be
provided on each side of the horizontal exit for the total number of people in adjoining compartments.
Every fire compartment for which credit is allowed in connection with a horizontal exit shall not be
required to have a stairway or door leading directly outside, provided the adjoining fire compartments
have stairways or doors leading directly outside.
7.2.12.1.7 Spiral stairs: Spiral stairs meeting the requirements of Section 10.17.18 are permitted for
access to and between staff locations.
[Page 158]
7.2.12.1.8 Exit discharge: Exits are permitted to discharge into a fenced or walled courtyard, provided
that not more than two walls of the courtyard are the building walls from which exit ie being made.
Enclosed yards or courts shall be of sufficient size to accommodate all occupants, a minimum of 15.0m
from the building with a net area of 1.4m2 per person.
7.2.12.1.9 Sallyports: Sallyports shall be permitted in a means of egress where there are provisions for
continuous and unobstructed passage through the sallyport during an emergency condition.
7.2.12.2 Locks: Doors from an area of refuge to the exterior are permitted to be locked with a key lock in
lieu of locking methods described in Section 8.12.5.1. The locks shall be openable from the outside.
7.2.12.2.1 Remote release: All remote release in a means of egress shall be provided with reliable means
of operation, remote from the resident living areas, to release locks on all required doors.
Exception: Provisions for remote unlocking are not required provided not more than ten locks are
necessary to be unlocked in order to move all occupants from one smoke compartment to an area of
refuge as promptly as required for remote unlocking.
The opening of all necessary doors shall be accomplished with not more than two separate keys.
7.2.12.2.2 Power operated doors and locks: All power operated sliding doors or power operated locks
for swinging doors shall be openable by a manual release mechanism at the door, and either emergency
power or a remote mechanical operating release shall be provided.
7.2.12.2.3 Redundant operation: Remote release, mechanically operated sliding doors or remote
release, mechanically operated locks shall be provided with a mechanically operated release mechanism
at each door, or shall be provided with a redundant release control.
7.2.12.2.4 Relock capability: Doors remotely unlocked under emergency conditions shall not
automatically relock when closed unless specific action is taken at the remote location to enable doors to
relock.
7.2.12.2.5 Vertical openings: Vertical openings shall be enclosed in accordance with Section 12.2.17.1.
7.2.12.2.6 Exception: Two communicating floor levels are permitted without enclosure protection
between the two levels, provided all the following conditions are met:
i The entire normally occupied area, including all communicating floor levels, is sufficiently open
and unobstructed that a fire or other dangerous condition in any part will be immediately obvious
to the occupants or supervisory personnel in the area.
ii Egress capacity is simultaneously sufficient for all the occupants of all communicating levels and
areas, all communicating levels in the same fire area being considered as a single floor area for
purposes of determination of required egress capacity.
[Page 159]
iii Each floor level, considered separately, has at least one-half of its individual required egress
capacity accessible by exit access leading directly out of that level without traversing another
communicating floor level.
7.2.12.3 Specific use areas: The specific use areas listed in Table 8.12.7 shall be separated from other
areas of buildings of Use Group 1 - 3 in accordance with the requirements of Table 8.12.7.
TABLE 7.12.7
SPECIFIC USE AREAS WITHIN AN F-3 USE
Storage rooms more than 5m2 in area but 1 hour: or automatic fire suppression with
2 separation walls
not more than 9.5m in area storing
combustible material
Storage rooms more than 5m storing 1 hour and automatic fire suppression
combustible material
Trash collection rooms 1 hour and automatic fire suppression
Padded cells 1 hour and automatic fire suppression
7.2.12.3.1 Separation walls: Where the separation walls around specific use areas are not required by
Table 8.12.7 to have a fire resistance rating, the separation walls shall be constructed of materials
consistent with the building type of construction and be capable of resisting the passage of smoke. The
separation walls extend from the floor to the underside of a fire resistance rated floor/roof assembly or to
the floor/roof deck above. All doors shall be self-closing or automatic-closing upon detection of smoke.
[Page 160]
7.2.12.3.2 Smoke barrier: All buildings of Use Group F-3 shall have smoke barriers as follows:
a. To divide every storey used by residents for sleeping, or any other storey having an occupant
load of 50 or more persons, into at least two compartment;
b. to limit the housing of a maximum of 200 residents in any smoke compartment.
c. To limit the travel distance to a door in a smoke barrier:
i From any room door required as exit access to 30m;
ii from any point in a room to 45m.
At least 0.60m2 per occupant shall be provided on each side of the smoke barrier for the total number of
occupants in adjoining compartments.
7.2.12.3.3 Refuge area: At least 0.60m2 per occupant shall be provided on each side of each smoke
barrier for the total number of occupants in adjoining compartments.
7.2.12.3.4 Independent egress: A means of egress shall be provided from each compartment created by
smoke barriers without returning through the compartment from which exiting originates.
7.2.12.3.5 Sub-division of resident housing areas: Any individual cell, dormitory, or other space where
residents are housed shall be separated from all other spaces by substantial construction of
non-combustible materials in accordance with Table 6.11.9.
7.2.12.3.6 Fire resistance rated doors: Doors in openings in partitions required to be fire resistive by
Table 8.12.9 in other than required enclosures of exits or hazardous areas shall be substantial doors, of
construction that will resist fire for at least 20 minutes. Wired glass vision panels are permitted. Latches
and door closers are not required on cell doors.
7.2.12.3.7 Smoke-tight doors: Doors in openings in partitions required to be smoke-tight by Table
8.12.9 shall be substantial doors, of construction that will resist the passage of smoke. Latches and door
closers are not required on cell doors.
TABLE 7.12.9
SUBDIVISION OF RESIDENT HOUSING AREAS
Section 5.2.7.4
[Page 161]
7.2.14.1 General: Bleachers, grandstands and folding or telescopic seating shall be constructed as
required by this code and in accordance with the relevant standards listed in the Schedule. (see NFiPA
102).
7.2.14.1.1 Handrails: Means of egress stairways shall be provided with a handrail on at least one side
and shall conform to Section 10.29. The handrail shall be broken as necessary to provide for entrance to
the seating platforms.
7.2.14.1.2 Spaces underneath seats: Spaces underneath grandstand seats shall be kept free of all
combustible and flammable materials and shall not be occupied or used for other than exits; except that
when enclosed in not less than 1-hour fire- resistance rated construction, the code enforcement officer
shall approve the use of such spaces for other purposes provided that the safety of the public is not
endangered.
7.2.15 Motion picture projection rooms, screening rooms and sound stages
7.2.15.1 General: The provisions of this section shall apply to rooms in which ribbon-type cellulose
acetate or other safety film is used in conjunction with electric arc, xenon or other light source projection
equipment which develops hazardous gases, dust or radiation. Where cellulose nitrate film is used or
stored, such rooms shall comply with the relevant standards. (see NFiPA 40).
Every motion picture machine projecting film as mentioned within the scope of this section shall be
enclosed in a projection room. Appurtenant electrical equipment, such as rheostats, transformers and
generators, shall be within the projection room or in an adjacent room of equivalent construction. There
shall be posted on the outside of each projection room door and within the projection room itself a
conspicuous sign with 25mm block letters stating: SAFETY FILM ONLY PERMITTED IN THIS
ROOM.
7.2.15.1.1 Construction of projection rooms: Every projection room shall be of permanent construction
consistent with the construction requirements for the type of building in which the projection room is
located. Openings need not be protected.
The room shall have a floor area of not less than 7.5m2 for a single machine. Each motion picture
projector, floodlight, spotlight or similar piece of equipment shall have a clear working space of not less
than 750mm x 750mm on each side and at the rear thereof, but only one such space shall be required
between two adjacent projections.
The projection room and the rooms appurtenant thereto shall have a ceiling height of not less than 2.3m.
The aggregate of openings for projection equipment shall not exceed 25 percent of the area of the wall
between the projection room and the auditorium. All openings shall be provided with glass or other
approved materials, so as to completely close the opening.
7.2.15.1.2 Projection booth and equipment ventilation: Projection booths and equipment shall be
ventilated in accordance with the mechanical code listed in the Schedule.
7.2.15.1.3 Lighting control: Provision shall be made for control of the auditorium lighting and the
emergency lighting systems of theatres from inside of the room and from at least one other convenient
point in the building are required in Section 7.24.1.
7.2.15.1.4 Miscellaneous equipment: Each projection room shall be provided with rewind and film
storage facilities.
[Page 163]
7.2.15.1.5 Screening rooms: Screening rooms shall provide a seating capacity of not more than 30
persons, with not less than two approved means of egress complying with Section 7.3. Such rooms shall
be enclosed in 1-hour fire separation walls with fire doors complying with Section 12.2.18 All seats shall
be permanently fixed in position and the arrangements shall comply with the requirements of Section
10.27.
7.2.15.2 Sound stage construction: All buildings designed or used as sound stages for motion picture or
television film productions shall be protected with an approved two-source automatic sprinkler system
complying with the provisions of Section 12.1.3; except that where approved, suppression of rooms
designed for housing electrical equipment is not required when such rooms are constructed of Type 1
construction.
7.2.15.3 Film laboratories: Film laboratories shall not be operated in other than buildings and structure
of Type 1A construction, equipped throughout with an approved automatic sprinkler system.
7.2.15.4 Film exchanges: All film exchanges and depots shall be housed in buildings and structures of
Type 1A construction equipped throughout with an approved automatic sprinkler system. All flammable
film other than that in process of receipt, delivery or distribution shall be stored in vaults complying with
the requirements of Section 8.15.9.1.
7.2.15.5 Vaults: Flammable film quantities of more than 454kg and not more than 4540kg shall be
stored be in vaults enclosed in floors, walls and ceilings of not less than 4-hour fire- resistance rating with
3-hour fire doors complying with Section 12.2.18. The interior storage volume of the vault shall be not
more than 42m3. The vault shall be drained and provided with scuppers.
7.2.16.1 General: This governs the design and construction of rooftop facilities intended to
accommodate the landing of helicopters. The use of a roof for landing shall be subject to the approval of
the Civil Aviation Authority.
7.2.16.1.1 Structural loads: The roof and all pertinent building components shall be designed for the
dead loads, impact loads and vibration imparted to the structure due to helicopter landing, including the
single skid point landing.
7.2.16.1.2 Referenced standard: All rooftop helipads shall comply with the relevant standards listed in
the Schedule (see NFiPA 418).
7.2.17.1 Applicability: The provisions of this Section shall apply to all parts of buildings and structures
which contain stages or platforms and similar appurtenances as here defined.
7.2.17.1.1 Stages: A stage is a partially enclosed portion of a building which is designed or used for the
presentation of plays, demonstrations or other entertainment. A stage shall be further classified as either a
legitimate stage, regular stage or thrust stage.
a. Legitimate stage: A stage wherein curtains, drops, leg drops, scenery, lighting devices or other
stage effects are retractable horizontally or suspended overhead.
b. Regular stage: A stage wherein curtains, fixed leg drops, valances, scenery and other stage
effects are hung and are not retractable.
[Page 164]
c. Thrust stage: A platform extending beyond the proscenium arch and into the audience.
7.2.17.1.2 Stage floor construction: Openings through all stage floors shall be equipped with
tight-fitting, solid wood trap doors not less than 50mm thickness with approved safety locks or other
materials of equal physical and fire endurance properties.
a. Legitimate stages: Legitimate stages shall be constructed as required for the type of
construction, but not less than Type 1B construction except that the portion of the legitimate
stage extending back from and 1.8m beyond the full width of the proscenium opening on each
side shall be permitted to be constructed of non-combustible or heavy timber construction
covered with a wood floor or not less than 50mm thickness. Except for the finished floor,
combusting construction shall not extend beyond the plane of the proscenium opening.
b. Regular and thrust stages: Regular stages and thrust stages shall be constructed of materials as
required for floors for the type of construction of the building in which they are located.
7.2.17.1.3 Stage rigging loft: The rigging loft, also referred to as a loft or fly, is the space over the stage
where scenery and equipment can be out of view. The fly gallery is the narrow raised platform at the side
of the legitimate stage from which the lines for flying scenery are manipulated. The gridiron the
machinery for arrangement of beams over a legitimate stage supporting the machinery for flying scenery
and hanging battens from which lighting is hung. The pin rail is the beam at one side of a legitimate stage
through which wooden or metal pins are driven and to which lines from the flies are fastened. The rigging
loft, fly galleries, gridiron and pin rails shall be constructed of approved non-combustible materials.
7.2.17.1.4 Footlights and stage electrical equipment: Footlights and border lights shall be installed in
troughs constructed of non-combustible materials. The switchboard shall be so located as to be readily
accessible at all times and the storage or placing of stage equipment against it shall be prohibited.
7.2.17.1.5 Exterior stage doors: Where protection of openings is required, exit discharge door openings
to the outer air shall be protected with fire doors complying with Section 29.18. All exterior openings
which are located on the stage for means of egress or loading and unloading purposes, and which are
likely to be open during occupancy of the theatre, shall be constructed with vestibules to prevent air drafts
into the auditorium.
7.2.17.1.6 Proscenium wall: Legitimate stages shall be completely separated from the seating area by a
proscenium wall of not less than 2 hour fire-resistance rating extending continuously from foundation to
at least 1.2m above the roof. There shall be no other openings in the wall separating a legitimate stage
from the auditorium except the main proscenium opening; two doorways at the stage level, one on each
side thereof; and one doorway to the musician’s pit from the space below the stage floor. Each such
doorway shall not exceed 4m2 in area and shall be protected with fire doors complying with Section
29.18.
a. Trim, finish and decorative hangings: All moldings and decorations around the proscenium
opening shall be constructed entirely of non-combustible materials.
[Page 165]
7.2.17.1.7 Proscenium curtain: The proscenium opening shall be provided with an approved curtain of
non-combustible of fire retardant material so designed and installed that it will protect against passage of
flame and smoke for 5 minutes. The curtain shall be operated by an automatic heat activated device to
descend instantly and safety and to completely close the proscenium opening at a rate of temperature rise
of 15 to 20 degrees F. per minute (0.14 degrees C. to 0.19 degrees C. per second); and by an auxiliary
operating device to permit prompt and immediate manual closing of the proscenium opening.
7.2.17.1.8 Scenery: All combustible materials used in sets and scenery shall be rendered flame resistant
to comply with Section 12.2.
7.2.17.1.9 Stage ventilation: Metal or other approved non-combustible ventilators, equipped with
movable shutters or sash shall be provided over stages larger than 46m2 in floor area, constructed to open
automatically by approved heat activated devices, with an aggregate clear area of opening not less than 5
percent of the area of the stage, except as otherwise provided in Section 8.17.2.9 Supplemental means
shall be provided for manual operation of the ventilator. Curbs shall be provided as required for skylights
in Section (refer sections on materials - Glazing).
7.2.17.1.10 Super-imposed theatres: An addition or extension shall not be erected over the stage section
of a theatre, nor shall a second theatre be erected above another. Where approved, the prohibition against
super-imposed theatres and construction above the stage shall not apply when approved access is
provided for fire fighting with direct means of ventilation to the outer air from the stage portion.
7.2.17.1.11 Platforms: A platform is that raised area within a building used for the presentation of
music, plays or other entertainment; the head table for special guests; the raised area for lectures and
speakers, boxing and wrestling rings; theatre-in-the-round; and similar purposes wherein there are no
overhead hanging curtains, drops, scenery or stage effects other than lighting. A temporary platform is
one installed for use for not more than 30 days.
7.2.17.1.12 Materials: In buildings required to be of Type 1 or Type 2 construction, where the platforms
are not more than 750mm above the main floor level the minimum type of construction for a permanent
platform shall be Type 2C. For all types of construction, where the platforms are not more than 750mm
above the main floor level, not larger in area than 10 percent of the room floor area and not more than
20m2 in area, the minimum type of construction, where the platforms are not more than 750mm above the
main floor level, not larger than one-third of the room floor area and not more than 280m2 in area of the
minimum type of construction for a permanent platform shall be Type 4 or the platform shall be
constructed of approved materials as required for floors for the required type of construction of the
building in which it is located. Temporary platforms shall be constructed of any approved materials.
7.2.17.1.13 Space beneath: The space between the floor and a temporary platform above shall not be
used for any purpose other than electrical wiring to platform equipment. Where the space between the
floor and a permanent platform above is used for any purpose other than electrical wiring or plumbing,
the platform shall provide a 1-hour fire-resistance rating.
[Page 166]
7.2.17.2 Dressing and appurtenant rooms: Dressing and appurtenant rooms shall comply with Section
8.17.4.1 through 8.17.4.3.
7.2.17.2.1 Construction: Dressing rooms, scene docks property rooms, workshops and storerooms and
all compartments appurtenant to the stage shall be separated from each other and from the stage and all
other parts of the building by walls of not less than 1 hour fire-resistance rating with approved opening
protectives. Such rooms shall not be placed immediately over or under the operating stage area.
7.2.17.3 Exception: Separation from the stage is not required for stages having a floor area of 46m2 or
less.
7.2.17.3.1 Opening Protectives: Openings other than to trunk rooms and the necessary doorways at
stage level shall not connect such rooms with the stage, and such openings shall be protected with fire
doors complying with Section 12.2.18.
7.2.17.3.2 Dressing room and stage exits: Each tier of dressing rooms shall be provided with at least
two means of egress. Egress stairways from dressing and storage rooms are not required to be enclosed
when located in the stage area behind the proscenium wall. At least one approved means of egress shall
be provided from each side of the stage, each side of the space under the stage, each fly gallery and the
gridiron. A steel ladder shall be provided from the gridiron to a scuttle in the stage roof.
7.2.18.1 General: The provisions of this section shall apply to airport traffic control towers not
exceeding 140m2 per floor used only for air traffic control, electrical and mechanical equipment rooms,
radar and electronics rooms, office spaces incidental to tower operation and lounges for employees
including rest-rooms.
7.2.18.2 Type of construction: Air traffic control towers shall be constructed to conform with the height
and area limitation of Table 8.18.2.
TABLE 8.18.2
HEIGHT AND AREA LIMITATION FOR AIRPORT
TRAFFIC CONTROL TOWERS
7.2.18.3 Egress: A minimum of one exit stairway shall be permitted for airport traffic control towers of
any height provided the occupant load per floor does not exceed 15. The stair shall conform to the
requirements of Section 10.17 and 10.19. The stair shall be separated from elevators by a minimum
distance of one-half the diagonal of the area served.
[Page 167]
7.2.18.3 Exception: Smokeproof enclosures as set forth in Section 10.19 are not required when required
stairways are pressurized to a minimum of 37.33 Pa and a maximum of 87.10 Pa in the shaft relative to
the building with all stairway doors closed.
7.2.18.4 Automatic fire alarm systems: Airport traffic control towers shall be provided with an
automatic fire alarm system complying with Section 12.1.19.
7.2.18.5 Standby power, light and emergency systems: A standby power system conforming to
Section 26.8 shall be provided in airport traffic control towers over 20m in height. Services shall be
provided to smokeproof enclosure mechanical equipment and lighting, lift operational equipment, and
automatic fire alarm systems.
7.2.19.1 General: The provisions of this section shall apply to all buildings in which materials producing
flammable dusts and particles which are readily ignitable and subject to explosion hazards are stored or
handled, including among others, grain bleachers and lifts, malt houses, flour, feed or starch mills, wood
flour manufacturing and manufacture and storage of pulverized aluminum, coal, cocoa, magnesium,
spices, sugar or similar material producing dust. The provisions of NFiPA 61A, 61B, 61C, 61D, 65, 85F,
651, 653, 654, 655, 664 and the fire prevention code listed in Schedule, except as herein specifically
required, shall be deemed to conform to the requirements of this Code.
7.2.19.2 Buildings: All such buildings and other occupied structures shall be of Type 1, Type 2 or of
laminated timber or timber sizes qualified for Type 4 construction, within the height and area limits of
Table 501 for Use Group E except that when erected of Type 1 or Type 2 construction, the height and
area of grain elevators and similar structures shall be unlimited, and when of Type 4 construction, the
maximum height shall be 20m and except further that, in isolated areas, the maximum height of Type 4
structures shall be increased to 25m.
7.2.19.2.1 Grinding rooms: Every room or space for grinding or other operations producing flammable
dust shall be enclosed with floors and walls of not less than 2-hour fire-resistance rating when the area is
not more than 280m2 and of not less than 4-hour fire-resistance rating when the area is greater than
280m2.
7.2.19.2.2 Conveyors: All conveyors, chutes, piping and similar equipment passing through the
enclosures of such rooms or spaces shall be constructed dirt- and vapo-rtight, and of approved
non-combustible materials complying with Section 9.1.29.
7.2.19.3 Explosion relief: Means for explosion relief shall be provided as specified in Section 8.20, or
such spaces shall be equipped with the equivalent mechanical ventilation complying with the applicable
mechanical section of this Code listed in the Schedule.
7.2.19.4 Grain elevators: Grain elevators, malt houses and buildings for similar uses shall not be located
within 9m of interior lot lines or structures on the same lot, except when erected along a railroad right of
way.
7.2.19.5 Coal pockets: Coal pockets located less than 9m from interior plot lines or structures on the
same plot shall be constructed of not less than Type 2A construction. Where more than 9m from interior
plot lines, or erected along a railroad right of way, the minimum type of construction of such structures
shall be Type 4, provided they are not more than 20m in height.
[Page 168]
7.2.20.1 Explosion relief: Every structure, room or space occupied for uses involving explosion hazards
shall be equipped and vented with explosion relief systems and devices arranged for automatic release
under predetermined increase in pressure as herein provided for specific uses.
7.2.20.2 Venting devices: Venting devices to relieve the pressure resulting from explosive air-vapour
mixtures shall consist of windows, skylights, vent flues or releasing roof or wall panels which discharge
directly to the open air or to a public place or other unoccupied space not less than 6m in width on the
same plot. Such releasing device shall be so located that the discharge end shall be not be less than 3m
vertically and 6m horizontally from window openings or means of egress facilities in the same or
adjoining buildings or structures. The exhaust shall always be in the direction of least exposure and never
into the interior of the building.
7.2.20.3 Area of vents: The aggregate clear vent relief area shall be regulated by the type of construction
of the building and shall be not less than prescribed below:
a. Heavy reinforced concrete frame, 0.093m3 for 2.24m3 of volume.
b. Light structural steel frame and ordinary construction. 0.093m2 for 1.82m3 of volume.
c. Light wood frame construction 0.093m2 for 1.40m3 of volume.
The combined area of open windows, pivoted sash or wall panels arranged to open under internal pressure
shall not be less than 10 percent of the area of the enclosure walls, with not less than 50 percent of the
opening arranged for automatic release.
7.2.20.4 Construction of vents: All explosion relief devices shall be of an approved type constructed of
lightweight, non-combustible and corrosion resistive materials, and the discharge end shall be protected
with approved screens of not more than 20mm mesh, arranged to blow out under relatively low pressures.
7.2.21.1 Main storage: Main storage systems of flammable and combustible liquids shall be constructed
and installed in accordance with the relevant standards (see NFiPA 30) and the National Fire Safety Code
listed in the Schedule.
7.2.21.2 Construction of enclosures: Process rooms shall be separated from other uses and occupancies
by walls, floors and ceilings of not less than 2bhour fire-resistance rating with 1½-hour fire doors
complying with Section 12.2.18. The interior door openings shall be provided with non-combustible sills
not less than 15cm high and the room shall be vented as required in Section 8.20.1. Floors shall be
waterproofed and drained to comply with Section (refer sections on Foundations and Roof Walls)
7.2.21.3 Enclosure openings: Openings shall not be permitted in the enclosure walls within 3m of
adjoining property lines or with a fire separation distance of less than 3m from any building or structure
not part of the installation.
7.2.21.4 Dry cleaning plants: The construction and installation of dry cleaning plants shall be in
accordance with the requirements of this code, the mechanical code, the plumbing code and other relevant
standards used in the Schedule (see NFiPA 32).
[Page 169]
7.2.22.1 General: The design and construction of propane, butane, propylene, butylene and other
liquefied petroleum gas distribution facilities shall conform to the applicable provisions of this Section.
The storage and handling of liquefied petroleum gas systems shall conform to the fire safety code listed in
the Schedule. The design and installation of piping, equipment and systems which utilise liquefied
petroleum gas shall be in accordance with the applicable mechanical section of this Code. Liquefied
petroleum gas facilities shall be ventilated in accordance with the mechanical applicable section of the
Code and Section 8.22.1.1.
7.2.22.2 LPG distribution facilities: Liquefied petroleum gas distribution facilities shall be provided
with air inlets and outlets arranged so that air movement across the floor of the facility will be as uniform
as possible. The lowest level of such openings shall not be more than 150mm above the floor.
7.2.22.3 Construction: Liquefied petroleum gas distribution facilities shall be constructed in accordance
with Section 8.22.3 for separation buildings, Section 8.22.4 for attached buildings or Section 8.22.5 for
rooms within buildings.
7.2.22.4 Separate buildings: When located in separate buildings, such buildings shall be used
exclusively for that purpose or for other purposes having similar hazards. Such buildings shall be limited
to one storey in height.
7.2.22.5 Floors: The floor shall not be located below ground level and any spaces beneath the floor shall
be solidly filled or shall be left unenclosed.
7.2.22.6 Materials: Walls, floors, ceilings, columns and roofs shall be constructed of non-combustible
materials. Exterior walls, ceilings and roofs shall be constructed of light weight material designed for
explosion venting or, if of heavy construction on such as solid brick masonry, concrete block or
reinforced concrete construction, explosion venting windows or panels in walls or roofs shall be provided
having an explosion venting area of at least 0.093m2 for each 1.40m3 of the enclosed volume.
7.2.22.7 Attached buildings: Where liquefied petroleum gas facilities are located in an attached
structure, the attached perimeter shall not exceed 50 percent of the perimeter of the space enclosed and
the facility shall comply with Sections 8.22.3.
7.2.22.8 Where the attached perimeter exceeds 50 percent, such facilities shall comply with Section
8.22.5.
7.2.22.9 Walls: Common walls at points at which structures are attached shall have a fire resistance
rating of not less than 1 hour and shall not have openings. Common walls for attached structures used
only for storage of LP-gas are permitted to have doors complying with Section 12.2.18. Such walls shall
be designed to withstand a static pressure of at least 488.2kg/m2, except where the building to which the
structure is attached is occupied by operations or processes having a similar hazard.
7.2.22.10 Rooms within buildings: When liquefied petroleum gas facilities are located in rooms within
buildings, such rooms shall be located in the first storey and shall have at least one exterior wall with
sufficient exposed area to permit explosion venting as provided in Section 8.22.5.1. The building in
which the room is located shall not have a basement or unventilated crawl space and the room shall
comply with Section 8.22.5.1 and 8.22.5.2.
[Page 170]
7.2.22.11 Materials: Walls, floors, ceilings, and roofs of such rooms shall be constructed of
non-combustible materials. Exterior walls and ceilings shall be either of light weight material designed
for explosion venting, or, if of heavy construction such as solid brick masonry concrete block or
reinforced concrete construction shall be provided with explosion venting area of at least 0.093m2 for
each 1.40m3 of enclosed volume.
7.2.22.12 Common construction: Walls and floor ceiling assemblies common to the room and to the
building within which it is located shall have a fire resistance rating of not less than 1 hour with no
openings. Common walls for rooms used only for storage of LP-gas are permitted to have doorways
which shall be equipped with one-hour opening protectives. Such walls and ceiling shall be designed to
withstand a static pressure of at least 488.2kg/m2, where approved, these provisions shall not apply when
the building within which the room is located is occupied by operations or processes having a similar
hazard.
7.2.23.1 General: Mobile units, as defined in Part 2 shall be designed, constructed and maintained to be
transported from one location to another and not mounted on a permanent foundation. A mobile unit
placed on a permanent foundation or on foundation piers shall be designed and constructed to comply
with all of the requirements of this Code for on-site and prefabricated construction.
7.2.23.2 Construction: Residential mobile units shall be of an approved design and constructed in
accordance with the applicable ordinances and statutes. All other mobile units shall be designed and
constructed in accordance with the requirements of this Code. All mobile units on a permanent foundation
shall be evaluated, inspected and labeled in-plant in accordance with Section 3.6.
7.2.23.3 Location: Mobile units shall be located in spaces approved for such use. The provision of this
Code shall not be construed to repeal, modify or constitute an alternative to any lawful zoning
regulations. In case of conflict between this Code or any other Ordinance or Statute, the most rigid
requirements shall apply.
7.2.23.4 Anchorage and tie-down: Every parking space for mobile units shall be provided with devices
for anchoring the unit to prevent overturning or uplift. The owner of the parking space shall anchor or
cause to be anchored all mobile units located on the parking space. Where concrete platforms are
provided for the parking of the units, anchorage shall be provided by eyelets embedded in the concrete
with adequate anchor plates or hooks, or other suitable means. The anchorage shall be adequate to
withstand wind forces and uplift as required in Part 2 for buildings and structures, based upon the size and
weight of the units.
7.2.24.1 General: The provisions of this Section shall apply to the construction, installation and use of
buildings and structures or parts thereof for the spraying of flammable paints, varnishes and lacquers or
other flammable materials, mixtures or compounds used for painting, varnishing, staining or similar
purposes. All such construction and equipment shall comply with the relevant standards listed in the
Schedule (see NFiPA 33 34).
[Page 171]
7.2.24.2 Location of spraying processes: Such processes shall be conducted in a spraying space, spray
booth, spray room or shall be isolated in a detached building or as otherwise approved by the code
enforcement officer in accordance with the National Fire Safety Code and other relevant standards listed
in the Schedule (see NFiPA 70).
7.2.24.3 Spray spaces: All spray spaces shall be ventilated with an exhaust system to prevent the
accumulation of flammable mist or vapours in accordance with the applicable mechanical section of this
Code. When such spaces are not separately enclosed, non-combustible spray curtains shall be provided to
restrict the spread of flammable vapours.
7.2.24.4 Spray booths: All spray booths shall be constructed of non-combustible materials and equipped
with mechanical ventilating systems in accordance with the applicable mechanical section of this Code.
7.2.24.5 Spray rooms: All spray rooms shall be enclosed in partitions of not less than 1-hour fire
resistance rating. Floors shall be waterproofed and drained in an approved manner.
7.2.24.6 Spray storage rooms: Spraying materials in quantities of not more than 0.076m3 shall be stored
in approved cabinets ventilated at top and bottom. When in quantities of more than 0.076m3 and not more
than 0.38m3 the spraying materials shall be stored in approved double walled non-combustible cabinets
vented directly to the outer air. All spraying materials in quantities of more than 0.38m3 shall be stored in
an enclosure of not less than 2 hour fire-resistance rating or in a separate exterior storage building. Such
storage shall not be in quantities of more than 0.95m3 except when stored in storage buildings; and except
further that not more than 0.095m3 of spraying material shall be stored in buildings in which pyroxylin
products are manufactured or stored.
7.2.24.7 Fire protection: Sprinkler heads shall be provided in all spray, dip and immersing spaces and
storage rooms, and shall be installed in accordance with Section 12.1.3. Where buildings containing spray
areas are not equipped with an approved automatic sprinkler system, the sprinklers in booths and other
spray areas and storage rooms are permitted to be supplied from the building water supply when approved
and conforming to Section 12.1.6.
7.2.25.1 General: Subject to the structural provisions of (refer Section on Structural Loads) for wind
loads and the requirements of Section 12.2.29 governing the fire resistance ratings of buildings for the
support of roof structures, all radio and television towers shall be designed and constructed as herein
provided.
7.2.25.2 Location and access: The towers shall be so located and equipped with step bolts and ladders to
be readily accessible for inspection purposes. Guy wires or other accessories shall not cross or encroach
upon any street or other public space, or over any electric power lines, or encroach upon any other
privately owned property without written consent of the owner.
7.2.25.3 Construction: All towers shall be constructed of approved corrosion-resistive non-combustible
material. The minimum type of construction of isolated radio towers not more than 30m in height shall be
Type 4.
7.2.25.4 Loads: The structure shall be designed to resist wind loads in accordance with ANSI A58.
[Page 172]
7.2.25.4.1 Dead load: Towers shall be designed for the dead load plus other incidental loads.
7.2.25.4.2 Uplift: Adequate foundations and anchorage shall be provided to resist two times the
calculated wind uplift.
7.2.25.5 Grounding: All towers shall be permanently and effectively grounded.
7.2.26.1 Permits not required: A building permit is not required for roof installation of antennae
structures not more than 3.6m in height for private radio or television reception. Such a structure,
however, shall not be erected so as to injure the roof covering, and when removed from the roof, the roof
covering shall be repaired to maintain weather and water-tightness. The installation of any antennae
structure mounted on the roof of a building shall not be erected nearer to the plot line than the total height
of the antennae structure above the roof, nor shall such structure be erected near electric power lines or
encroach upon any street or other public space.
7.2.26.2 Permits required: Approval shall be secured for all roof mounted antennae structures more
than 3.6m in height above the roof. The application shall be accompanied by detailed drawings of the
structure and methods of anchorage. All connections to the roof structure must be properly flashed to
maintain water-tightness. The design and materials of construction shall comply with the requirements of
Section 8.25.3 for character, quality and minimum dimension.
7.2.27.1 General: Pools used for swimming or bathing shall be in conformity with the requirements of
this section, provided, however these regulations shall not be applicable to any such pool less than
600mm deep or having a surface area less than 24m2 except when such pools are permanently equipped
with a water recirculating system or involve structural materials. For purposes of this Code, pools are
classified as private swimming pools or public swimming pools, as defined in Section 8.27.2. Materials
and constructions used in swimming pools shall comply with the applicable requirements of this Code.
7.2.27.2 Classification of pools: Any constructed pool which is used, or intended to be used, as a
swimming pool in connection with a building of Use Group H-3 and available only to the family of the
household and private guests shall be classified as a private swimming pool. Any swimming pool other
than a private swimming pool shall be classified as a public swimming pool.
7.2.27.3 Plans and permits: A swimming pool or appurtenances thereto shall not be constructed,
installed, enlarge or altered until plans have been submitted and a permit has been obtained from the Code
Enforcement Officer. The approval of all city, local government and state authorities having jurisdiction
over swimming pools shall be obtained before applying to the code enforcement officer for a permit.
Certified copies of these approvals shall be filed as part of the supporting data for the application for the
permit.
7.2.27.3.1 Plans: Plans shall accurately show dimensions and construction of the pool and appurtenances
and properly established distances to plot lines, buildings, walks and fences, as well as details of the water
supply system, drainage and water disposal systems, and all appurtenances pertaining to the swimming
pool. Detail plans of structures, vertical elevations, and through the pool showing depth shall be included.
[Page 173]
7.2.27.3.2 Locations: Private swimming pools shall not encroach on any front or side yard required by
this Code, or the governing zoning law, except by specific rules of the jurisdiction in which is located. A
wall of a swimming pool shall not be located less than 1.8m from any rear or side property line or 3m
from any street property line, except by specific rules of the jurisdiction in which it is located.
7.2.27.3.3 Structural design: The pool structure shall be engineered and designed to withstand the
expected forces to which it will be subjected.
7.2.27.3.4 Wall slopes: To a depth up to 800mm from the top, the wall slope shall not be more than one
unit horizontal in five units vertical (1.5).
7.2.27.3.5 Floor slopes: The slope of the floor on the shallow side of the transition point shall not exceed
one unit vertical to seven units horizontal (1:7). For public pools greater than 110m2, the slope of the
floor on the shallow side of transition point shall not exceed one unit vertical to ten units horizontal
(1:10). The transition point between shallow and deep water shall not be more than 1.5m deep.
7.2.27.3.6 Surface cleaning: All swimming pools shall be provided with a recirculating skimming
device or overflow gutters to remove scum and foreign matter from the surface of the water. Where
skimmers are used for private pools, there shall be at least one skimming device for each 90m2 of surface
area or fraction thereof. For public pools where water skimmers are used, there shall be at least one
skimming device for each 55.0m2 of surface area or fraction thereof. Where overflow gutters are used,
they shall not be less than 750mm deep, pitched to a slope of one unit vertical to 48 units horizontal
(1:48) toward drains, and constructed so they are safe, cleanable and that matter entering the gutters will
not be washed out by a sudden surge of entering water.
7.2.27.3.7 Walkways: All public swimming pools shall have walkways not less than 5.2m in width
extending entirely around the pool. Where curbs or sidewalks are used around any swimming pool, they
shall have a slip-resistant surface for a width of not less than 300mm at the edge of the pool, and shall be
so arranged to prevent return of surface water to the pool.
7.2.27.3.8 Steps and ladders: At least one means of egress shall be provided from private pools. Public
pools shall provide ladders or other means of egress at both side of the diving section and at least one
means of egress at the shallow section; or at least one means of egress in the deep section and the shallow
section if diving boards are not provided. Treads of steps and ladders shall have slip-resistant surfaces and
handrails on both sides, except that handrails are not required when there are not more than four steps or
when they extend the full width of the side or end of the pool.
7.2.27.3.9 Water supply: All swimming pools shall be provided with a potable water supply, free of
cross connections with the pool or its equipment.
7.2.27.3.10 Water treatment: Public swimming pools shall be designed and installed so that there is a
pool water turnover at least once every 8 hours. Filters shall not filter water at a rate in excess of
0.0020m3/s.m2 of surface area. The treatment system shall be so designed and installed to provide in the
water, at all times when the pool is in use, excess chlorine of not less than 0.4 parts per million (ppm) or
more than 0.6 ppm, or excess chloramine between 0.7 and 1.0 ppm, or disinfection shall be provided by
other approved means. Acidity/alkalinity of the pool water shall not be below 7.0ph or more than 7.5ph.
All recirculating systems shall be provided with an approved hair and lint strainer installed in the system
ahead of the pump.
[Page 174]
Private swimming pools shall be designed and installed so that there is a pool water turnover at least once
every 18 hours. Filters shall not filter water at a rate in excess of 0.0034m3/S/m2 of surface area. The pool
owner shall be instructed in proper care and maintenance of the pool by the supplier or builder, including
the use of high test calcium hypochlorite (dry chlorine) or sodium hypochlorite (liquid chlorine) or
equally effective germicide and algicide, and the importance of proper pH (alkalinity and acidity) control.
7.2.27.3.11 Drainage systems: The swimming pool and equipment shall be equipped to be completely
emptied of water and the discharged water shall be disposed of in an approved manner that will not create
a nuisance to adjoining property.
7.2.27.3.12 Appurtenant structures: All appurtenant structures, installations, and equipment, such as
showers, dressing rooms, equipment houses or other buildings and structures, including plumbing,
heating, and air conditioning, amongst others appurtenant to a swimming pool, shall comply with all
applicable requirements of this Code and the zoning law.
7.2.27.3.13 Accessories: All swimming pool accessories shall be designed, constructed, and installed so
as not to be a safety hazard. Installations or structures for diving purposes shall be properly anchored to
insure stability.
7.2.27.3.14 Equipment installations: Pumps, filters, and other mechanical and electrical equipment for
public swimming pools shall be enclosed in such a manner as to be accessible only to authorized persons
and not to bathers. Construction and drainage shall be such as to avoid the entrance and accumulation of
water in the vicinity of electrical equipment.
7.2.27.3.15 Swimming pool safety devices: Every person owning land on which there is situated a
swimming pool, which contains 60cm or more of water in depth at any point, shall erect and maintain
thereon an adequate enclosure either surrounding the property or pool area, sufficient to make such body
of water inaccessible to small children. Such enclosure, including gates therein, shall be not less than
1.2m above the underlying ground. All gates shall be self-closing and self-latching with latches placed
1.2m above the underlying ground and otherwise made inaccessible from the outside to small children.
A natural barrier, hedge, pool cover or other protective device approved by the governing body shall be
an acceptable enclosure so long as the degree of protection afforded by the substituted devices or
structures is not less than the protection afforded by the enclosure, gate and latch described herein.
7.2.27.3.16 Diving boards: Minimum water depths and distances for diving hoppers for pools, based on
board height above water, shall comply with Table 8.27 for public pools and Table 8.27a for private
pools.
Diving boards higher than 3m shall conform to relevant standards.
The maximum slope permitted between point D2 and the transition point shall not exceed one unit
vertical to three units horizontal (1:3) in public pools and one unit vertical to one unit horizontal (1:1) in
private pools. D1 is the point directly under the end of the diving boards. D2 is the point at which the
floor begins to slope upwards to the transition point. (see Figure 8.27, below).
[Page 175]
TABLE 8.27
MINIMUM WATER DEPTHS AND DISTANCE BASED ON BOARD
HEIGHT FOR PUBLIC POOLS
TABLE 8.27a
MINIMUM WATER DEPTHS AND DISTANCE BASED ON BOARD
HEIGHT FOR PRIVATE POOLS
7.2.28.1 General: The provisions of this section shall apply to tents, membrane structures and other
structures, erected for a period of less than 180 days. Those erected for a longer period of time shall
comply with Section 8.5 or all applicable sections of this code when Section 8.5 is not applicable.
7.2.28.2 Permit required: All temporary structures including tents or membrane structures covering an
area in excess of 12m2 including all connecting areas or spaces with a common means of egress or
entrance, and used or intended to be used for gathering together of ten or more persons shall not be
erected, operated or maintained for any purpose without obtaining a permit from the code enforcement
officer. Tents used exclusively for recreational camping the location of egress facilities, seating capacity,
construction and all mechanical and electrical equipment.
[Page 176]
7.2.28.3 Location: All temporary structures shall be located in accordance with the requirements of
Table 29.8 based on the fire resistance rating of the exterior walls for the proposed type of construction.
7.2.28.4 Construction: Tents and air-supported structures shall be constructed as required by this code
and the relevant standards listed in the Schedule (see NFiPA 102).
7.2.28.5 Membrane material: All tents shall be constructed of flame resistive materials or materials
treated to render the material flame resistant in a manner approved by the code enforcement officer. The
membrane material shall be either non-combustible as defined in Section 12.2.29.4 or flame resistant.
7.2.28.6 Certification: An affidavit or affirmation shall be submitted to the code enforcement officer and
a copy retained on the premises on which the tent or air-supported structure is located attesting to the
following in formation relative to the flame resistance of the fabric.
a. It shall also include the names and addresses of the owners of the tent or air-supported structure.
7.2.28.7 Inflation pressure: Operating pressure shall be maintained at the design pressure specified by
the manufacture to assure structural stability and to avoid excessive distortion during high wind.
7.2.28.8 Door operation: Under high wind over 80km/h, the use of doors in air-supported structures
shall be controlled to avoid excessive air loss. Doors shall not be left open under any conditions.
7.2.28.9 Means of egress: All temporary structures including tents and membrane structures shall
conform to the means of egress requirements of Section 7.3 and shall have a maximum length of exit
access travel of 30m.
7.3.1 GENERAL
7.3.1.1 Scope: The provisions of this Part shall control the design, construction and arrangement of
building elements required to provide a reasonably safe means of egress from all buildings and structures
hereafter erected, and from all buildings hereafter altered to a new occupant load, or manner of use, or
inherent fire hazard. Existing buildings and uses shall be controlled by the provisions of Section 10.5 in
conformity with subsisting Development Control Regulations
7.3.1.2 Modification of egress requirements: Where strict compliance with the provisions of this Code
is not practical, the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit shall approve alternative means of egress
which will accomplish the same purpose, by the procedure established in Part I for modification of this
Code, or by adoption of approved rules. Existing buildings shall not be occupied during repairs or
alterations unless all existing means of egress and any existing fire protection are continuously
maintained, or in lieu thereof, other measures are taken which will provide equivalent safety.
7.3.1.3 Minimum requirements: It shall be unlawful to alter any building or structure in any manner
that will reduce the number of exits or the capacity of exits below the requirements of this code for new
buildings of the proposed use and occupancy.
[Page 177]
7.3.2.1 Arrangement of egress: The plans shall show in sufficient, detail, the location, construction, size
and character of all exits together with the arrangement of aisles, corridors, passageways and hallways
leading thereto in compliance with the provisions of this Code.
7.3.2.2 Number of occupants: In other than buildings of Use Groups H-2, H-3 and F-1, the plans and
the application for a permit shall designate the number of occupants to be accommodated on every floor,
and in all rooms and spaces when required by the Building Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit.
When not otherwise specified, the minimum number of occupants to be accommodated by the exits shall
be determined by the occupant load prescribed in Section 10.7. The specified occupant load of the
building shall be limited to that number.
7.3.3.1 New buildings: Every building and structure and part thereof hereafter erected shall have the
prescribed number of exits of one or more of the approved types defined in this part. Exits, in
combination with the exit access and exit discharge, shall provide safe and continuous means of egress to
a street or to an open space with direct access to a street.
7.3.3.2 Mixed use groups: Where a building is occupied for two or more uses, the means of egress
requirements shall apply to each portion of the building based on the use of that space.
7.3.3.3 Multiple tenants: When more than one tenant occupies any one floor of a building or structure,
each tenant shall be provided with direct access to approved exits.
TABLE 10.7
MAXIMUM FLOOR AREA ALLOWANCE PER OCCUPANT
TABLE 10.8
LENGTH OF EXIT ACCESS TRAVEL [M]
Notes: See the following sections for modifications to travel distance requirements
Section 8.2.4.1: For the exit access travel distance limitation in covered malls.
Section 8.3.3.1 e (v): For the exit access travel distance limitation in high-rise buildings under
the automatic fire suppression system alternatives.
Section 8.4.1.4: For the exit access travel distance limitation in HPM use facilities.
Section 8.7.2.4: For the exit access travel distance limitation through an atrium space.
Section 8.28.9: For the exit access travel distance limitation in temporary structures.
Section 10.8.15: For increased limitation in Use Group D and J.
Section 10.8.16: For increased limitation in Use Group A-5.
Section 10.10.3: For buildings with one exit.
7.8.4 Assembly buildings: All buildings used for assembly purposes shall front on at least one street on
which the main entrance and exit discharge shall be located. Where there is a single main entrance, the
entrance shall be capable of serving as the main exit and shall provide an egress capacity for at least
one-half of the total occupant load. In addition to having access to a main exit, each level of a building of
Use Group A shall be provided with additional exits which shall provide an egress capacity for at lest
two-thirds of the total occupant load served by that level.
7.8.5 Foyers and waiting spaces: The term “foyer” shall mean an enclosed space surrounding or in the
rear of the auditorium of a theatre or other place of assembly which is [Page 181] completely separated
from the auditorium and is used as an assembly or waiting space for the occupants. In Use Group A-1, a
foyer, waiting space, or lobby shall be provided with a net floor area, exclusive of stairs or landings, of
not less than 0.14m2 for each occupant having access thereto. The use of foyers and lobbies and other
available spaces for harboring occupants until seats become available shall not encroach upon the clear
floor area herein prescribed or upon the required clear width of front exits.
7.8.6 Egress: When the foyer is not directly connected to the public street through the main lobby, an
unobstructed corridor or passage shall be provided which leads to, and equals the required minimum
width of, main entrances and exits. A mirror shall not be placed so as to give the appearance of a
doorway, exit or passageway.
7.8.7 Gradient: The rear foyer shall be at the same level as the back of the auditorium and the means of
egress leading therefrom shall not have a steeper gradient than one unit vertical in eight units horizontal
(1:8).
7.8.8 Construction: The partitions separating the foyer from the auditorium and other adjoining rooms
and spaces of a theatre shall be constructed of not less than 2-hour fire-resistance rating. Where opening
protectives are constructed of non-combustible materials, fire resistance rating of the opening protectives
is not required.
7.8.9 Exit discharge: All exits shall discharge directly at a public way or at a yard, court or open space
of the required width and size to provide all occupants with a safe access to a public way.
7.8.10 Level of exit discharge protection: In all buildings having habitable or occupiable stories or
basements below grade, the floor/ceiling assemblies and supports below the level of exit discharge shall
provide a fire resistance rating of not less than 1 hour.
Exceptions
i Buildings of Use Group H-3.
ii Buildings of Type 1 construction.
iii When such floor/ceiling assemblies and supports are constructed of Type 4 construction.
iv When the floor areas below the level of exit discharge are equipped throughout with an approved
automatic fire suppression system.
7.8.11 Remote location: Whenever more than one exit is required from any room, space or floor of a
building, they shall be placed as remote from each other as practicable, and shall be arranged and
constructed to provide direct access in separate possibility that both would be blocked by any one fire or
other emergency condition.
7.8.12 Remoteness: Where two exits or two exit access doors are required, they shall be placed a
distance apart equal to not less than one-half of the length of the maximum overall diagonal dimension of
the building or area to be served. Where exit enclosures are provided as a portion of the required means of
egress and are interconnected by a corridor conforming to the requirements for corridor construction, the
exit separation distance shall be measured along the line of travel within the corridor. In all other cases,
the separation distance shall be measured in a straight line between exits or exit access doors.
7.8.12.1 Exception: In buildings equipped throughout with an approved automatic fire suppression
system, the minimum separation distance shall be one-fourth the length of the maximum overall diagonal
dimension.
[Page 182]
7.8.13 Three or more: When three or more exits or exit access doors are required, at least two exits or
exit access doors shall be separated as provided in Section 10.8.12.
7.8.14 Length of travel: Except as modified by provisions of Section 10.10.3 for buildings with one
exit, all exits shall be so located that the maximum length of exit access travel, measured from the most
remote point to an approved exit along the natural and unobstructed line of travel, shall not exceed the
distances given in Table 10.8. In single exit buildings covered by Section 10.10.3 where the area is
subdivided into rooms or compartments, and the egress travel in the room or compartment is not greater
than 15.24m or 30.48m in buildings equipped throughout with an approved automatic fire suppression
system, the exit access travel distance shall be measured from the exit access entrance to the nearest exit.
7.8.15 Roof vent increase: In buildings of Use Group D or J one storey in height, equipped with
automatic heat and smoke roof vents complying with Section 12.2.32 and equipped throughout with an
approved automatic fire suppression system, the exit access travel distance limitation in Table 10.8.14
shall be increased to 122m.
7.8.16 Use Group A-5: Buildings and structures of Use Group A-5, where all portions of the means of
egress are essentially open to the outside, shall have an exit access travel distance of not more than 122m,
except that such buildings and structures of Type 1 or 2 construction shall not have an exit access travel
distance limit.
7.8.17 Elevators: Elevators shall not be accepted as a required element of the means of egress.
TABLE 10.9
EGRESS WIDTH PER OCCUPANT
WITHOUT FIRE WITH FIRE SUPPRESSION SYSTEM
SUPPRESSION SYSTEM (MILLIMETER PER PERSON)
(MILLIMETER PER PERSON)
USE GROUP STAIRWAYS DOORS, STAIRWAYS DOORS, RAMPS
RAMPSS AND CORRIDORS
AND
CORRIDORS
A, B, C, D - - - -
G, H, I 7.62 5.08 5.08 3.81
E - - 7.62 5.08
F1 10.16 5.08 5.08 5.08
F2 25.40 17.78 15.24 12.70
F3 7.62 5.08 7.62 5.08
[Page 183]
7.9.3 Exit design per floor: Where exits serve more than one floor, only the occupant load of each floor
considered individually shall be used in computing the required capacity of the exits at that floor,
provided that the exit capacity shall not decrease in the direction of egress travel.
7.9.4 Egress convergence: When means of egress from floors above and below converge at an
intermediate floor, the capacity of the means of egress from the point of convergence shall not be less
than the sum of the two.
TABLE 10.10.2
MINIMUM NUMBER OF EXITS FOR OCCUPANT LOAD
7.10.3 Building with one exit: Only one exit shall be required in buildings of Use Group H-3 and in
buildings of the use groups and characteristics specified in Table 10.10.3; and in stories at the level of exit
discharge having an occupant load not exceeding 50 persons and an exit access travel distance not
exceeding 22.86m in buildings of any use group; in airport traffic control towers which comply with
Section 8.18.
TABLE 10.10.3
BUILDINGS WITH ONE EXIT
Note a: For the required number of exits for open parking structures, see Section 10.10.5.
[Page 184]
7.10.4 Emergency escape: Every sleeping room below the fourth storey buildings of Use Groups H and
F-1 shall have at least one operable window or exterior door approved for emergency egress or rescue.
The units shall be operable from the inside without the use of separate tools. Where windows are
provided as a means of egress or rescue, the windows shall have a sill height not more than 1.1m above
the floor. All egress or rescue windows from sleeping rooms must have a minimum net clear openings of
0.55m2. The minimum net clear opening height dimension shall be 610 mm. The minimum net clear
opening width dimension shall be 508mm.
* Bars, grilles or screens placed over emergency escape windows shall be releasable or removable from
the inside without the use of a key, tool or excessive force.
7.10.4.1 Exceptions
1. The minimum net clear opening for grade floor windows shall be 5m2.
2. In buildings where the sleeping room is provided with a door to a corridor having access to two
remote exits in opposite directions, an outside window or an exterior door for emergency escape
from each such sleeping room is not required.
3. Buildings equipped throughout with a complete automatic fire suppression system.
TABLE 10.10
MINIMUM EGRESS AND ACCESS REQUIREMENTS
[Page 185]
[Page 186]
TABLE 10.14.5
REVOLVING DOOR SPEED
[Page 193]
7.14.6 Adjacent area: Each revolving door shall have a conforming side-hinged swinging door in the
same wall as, and within 3048mm of the revolving door.
7.14.6.1 Exception: The adjacent swinging door is not required for street floor elevator lobbies if a
stairway, escalator, or door from other parts of the building does not discharge through the lobby and the
lobby does not have any occupancy or use other than as a means of travel between the elevators and
street.
7.14.7 Means of egress: A revolving door to be considered as a component of a means of egress shall
comply with Section 10.14.2 through to 10.14.6 and the following conditions:
1. Revolving doors shall not be given credit for more than 50 percent of the required exit capacity
of the building.
2. Each revolving door shall not be credited with more than a 50-person capacity.
3. Each revolving door shall be capable of being collapsed when a force of not more than 635 N is
applied within 76 mm of the outer edge of a wing.
Design Stage / Section 7 Architectural Design Requirements / 7.15 HORIZONTAL
EXITS
7.16 RAMPS
7.16.1 Capacity: The capacity of a ramp used as an egress component shall be computed in accordance
with Section 10.9.
7.16.2 Minimum dimensions: The minimum dimensions of egress ramps shall comply with section
10.16.3 through 10.16.5.
7.16.3 Width: The minimum width of an egress ramp shall be not less than that required for corridors by
Section 10.11.5.
7.16.4 Headroom: The minimum headroom in all parts of the egress ramp shall be not less than
2100mm.
7.16.5 Restriction: Egress ramps shall not reduce in width in the direction of egress travel. Projections
into the required ramp and landing width are prohibited except for handrails and stringers. Doors opening
on to a landing shall not reduce the clear width to less than 1100mm.
7.16.6 Maximum gradient: The maximum gradient of egress ramps shall be one unit vertical in 8 units
horizontal 1:8; except ramps required for the physically challenged according to Section 10.12, in which
case the maximum gradient shall be one unit vertical in 8 units horizontal 1:8 if the rise is limited to
75mm, one unit vertical in ten units horizontal (1:10) if the rise is limited to 150mm or one unit vertical in
12 units horizontal (1:12) otherwise.
7.16.7 Landings: Landings shall be provided at all points of turning, entrance and exit and at doors.
Ramps with a gradient of greater than one unit vertical in ten units horizontal 1:10 shall not have a
vertical rise of greater than 3658 mm between landings. Ramps required for the physically challenged
according to Section 10.12 shall not have a vertical rise greater than 762mm between landings. All
landings shall have a minimum length of 1524mm.
7.16.8 Guards and handrails: Guards shall be provided on both sides. Handrails conforming to Section
10.29.2 shall be provided on at least one side of every ramp having a gradient greater than one unit
vertical in 12 units horizontal 1:12. Ramps required by Section 10.12 for the physically challenged shall
have handrails on both sides of the ramp whenever the vertical rise between landings exceeds 152 mm.
7.16.9 Ramp construction: Ramps used as an exit shall conform to the applicable requirements of
Section 10.17.21 as to materials of construction and enclosure.
7.16.10 Surface: For all gradients exceeding one unit vertical in 12 units horizontal (1:12) and wherever
the use is such as to involve danger of slipping, the ramp shall be surfaced with approved slip-resistant
materials.
7.27 GUARDS
7.27.1 General: Where required by the provisions of Sections 8.10.2.3, 10.16.8, 10.16.9, 10.26.5 and
8.9.24.5 guards shall be designed and constructed in accordance with the requirements of this Section and
Section 25.23.5. A guardrail system is a system of building components located near the open sides of
elevated walking surfaces for the purpose of minimizing the possibility of an accidental fall from the
walking surface to the lower level.
7.27.2 Height: The guards shall be at least 1.1m in height measured vertically above the leading edge of
the tread or adjacent walking surface.
7.27.2.1 Exceptions
1. In other than buildings of Use Group C, guards shall be not less than 792mm in height above the
leading edge of the tread along stair which are not more than 6096mm in height or which
reversed direction at an intermediate landing with 305mm or less measured horizontally
between successive flights.
2. Guards in buildings of Use Group H-3 shall be not less than 914mm in height.
7.27.3 Construction: Open guards shall have intermediate rails, balusters or other construction such that
a sphere with a diameter of 152mm cannot pass through any opening.
7.27.3.1 Exception: In buildings of Use Groups D, E or I, the construction shall not permit a sphere with
a diameter of 350mm to pass through any opening.
[Page 207]
7.27.4 Railings: Metal or other approved non-combustible railings shall be provided on balconies and
galleries as prescribed in Sections 10.28.5 through 10.28.7.
7.27.5 At fascia: At the fascia of boxes, balconies and galleries not less than 660mm in height; not less
than 9w14mm in height at the end of aisles extending to the fascia for the full width of the aisle; and not
less than 1067mm in height at the foot of steps for the full width of the steps.
7.27.6 At cross aisles: Along cross aisles, not less than 660mm in height except where the backs of the
seats along the front of the aisles project 610mm or more above the floor of the aisle.
7.27.7 Successive tiers: Where seating are arranged in successive tiers, and the height of rise between
platforms exceeds 457mm, not less than 660mm in height along the entire row of seats at the edge of the
platform.
7.28 HANDRAILS
7.28.1 General: Where required by the provisions of Sections 8.14.2, 10.16.8, 10.17.13, 10.17.25, and
10.27.11, handrails shall be designed and constructed in accordance with this Section and Section
8.8.10.7. A handrail is a horizontal or sloping rail grasped by hand for guidance or support, and for
arresting falls on the adjacent walking surface.
7.28.2 Handrail details: Handrails shall conform to the requirements of Sections 10.29.1 through
10.29.7.
7.28.3 Projection: Handrails shall not project more than 89mm into the required stair or ramp width.
7.28.4 Height: Handrails shall not be less than 864mm nor more than 965mm, measured vertically,
above the nosing of the treads or above the finished floor of the landing or walking surfaces.
7.28.4.1 Exception: Handrails that form part of a guardrail shall have a height not less than 864mm and
not more than 1067mm.
7.28.5 Handrail ends: Except for stairways within a dwelling unit, handrails shall extend at least 305mm
beyond the top riser and at least 305mm plus the width of one tread beyond the top riser. At the top, the
handrail extension shall be parallel to the walking surface. At the bottom, the handrail shall continue to
slope for a distance of the width of one tread from the bottom riser with the remainder parallel to the
walking surface. The handrails ends shall be returned to a wall or post. Handrails between runs of stairs
shall be continuous around newel posts or shall terminate 305mm beyond the last riser as required above.
7.28.6 Handrail grip size: For all stair handrails located within a dwelling unit, the maximum horizontal
cross-sectional dimension of the handrail shall not exceed 67mm.
7.28.7 Handrails of alternating tread stairways: Stair handrails of alternating tread stairways shall be
of such a configuration as to provide an adequate hand-hold for a person grasping the handrail to avoid
falling. A minimum distance of 152mm shall be provided between the stair handrail and any other object.
A minimum of 305mm shall be provided between the stair handrails of adjacent alternating treads
stairways. Handrails on alternating tread stairways shall be spaced a minimum width of 432mm, not to
exceed 610mm, between the handrails.
[Page 208]
7.29 SIGNAGE
7.29.1 General
7.29.1.1 Scope: The provisions of this Chapter shall govern the construction, alteration, repair and
maintenance of all signs together with their appurtenant and auxiliary devices in respect to structural and
fire safety.
7.29.1.2 Zoning law: Where more restrictive in respect to location, use, size or height of signs, the
limitations of the zoning laws affecting light and ventilation requirements and use of land shall take
precedence over the regulations of this Code.
7.29.1.3 Plans, specifications and permits
7.29.1.3.1 Owner’s consent: Before any permit is granted for the erection of a sign, plans and
specifications shall be filed with the code enforcement officer showing the dimensions, materials and
required detail of construction, including loads, stresses and anchorage. The applications shall be
accompanied by the written consent of the owner or lessee of the premises upon which the sign is to be
erected.
7.29.1.3.2 New signs: A new sign shall not hereafter be erected, constructed, altered or maintained
except as herein provided, and until after a permit has been issued by the code endorsement officer and
the required bond shall have been filed in accordance with Section 14.6.
7.29.1.3.3 Identifications: Every sign for which a permit has been issued and hereafter erected,
constructed or maintained shall be plainly marked with the name of the person, firm or corporation
owning, erecting, maintaining or operating such sign. The method and location of this identification shall
appear on the plans and within the specifications filed with the code endorsement officer.
7.29.1.3.4 Alterations: A sign shall not be enlarged or relocated except in conformity to the provisions
of this chapter of new signs, until a proper permit has been secured. The changing of movable parts of an
approved sign that is designed for such changes, or the repainting or reposting of display matter, shall not
be deemed an alteration, provided the conditions of the original approval and the requirements of this
chapter are not violated.
7.30 EXCEPTIONS
7.30.1 General: A permit shall not be required for the signs covered by the provisions of this section.
Such exceptions, however, shall not be construed to relieve the owner of the sign from responsibility for
its erection and maintenance in a safe manner.
7.30.2 Wall signs: A sign painted on the surface of a fence or approved building wall, or any
non-illuminated wall sign on a building or structure which is not more than 1m2 in area.
7.30.3 Ground signs: The ground signs listed in Section 14.2.4 through to 14.2.6 shall not require a
permit.
7.30.4 Sale or rent: Signs erected to announce the sale or rent of the property so designated, provided
such signs are not more than 2.5m2 in area.
7.30.5 Transit signs: The erection or maintenance of a sign designating the location of a transit line, a
railroads station or other public carrier when not more than 0.3 square meter in area.
[Page 209]
7.30.6 Street signs: Signs erected by a jurisdiction for street direction.
7.30.7 Projecting signs: A projecting sign not exceeding 0.25m2 of display surface shall not require a
permit.
7.44 IMPLEMENTATION
7.44.1 Investigation and evaluation: For all proposed work covered by this section, the building owner
shall cause the existing building to be investigated and evaluated by the relevant professionals.
7.44.2 Structural analysis: The owner shall have a structural analysis of the existing building made to
determine adequacy of all structural systems for the proposed alteration, addition or change of use. The
existing building shall be capable of supporting the minimum required loads.
[Page 214]
7.44.3 Submittal: The results of the investigation and evaluation required in Section 12.2.1, along with
all proposed compliance alternatives, shall be submitted to the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit.
7.44.4 Determination of compliance: The code enforcement officer shall determine whether the
existing building, with the proposed additions, alteration or change of use, complies with the provisions
of this Section and the provisions of Sections 7.3, 12.2 and 12.3.
7.47 MAINTENANCE
7.47.1 General: All construction equipment and safeguards shall be constructed, installed and properly
maintained and shall be so operated as to ensure protection to the workers engaged thereon and to the
general public. It shall be unlawful to remove or render inoperative any structural, fire protection or
sanitary safeguard or device herein required except when necessary for the actual installation and
prosecution of the work.
7.55 SCAFFOLDS
7.55.1 Load capacity: Scaffolds and their components shall be capable of supporting without failure at
least four times the maximum intended load. All platform and supporting elements of scaffolds shall be
designed and constructed to support uniform minimum live loads in kilograms per meter square of the
platform area in accordance with the classifications described in Table 13.10.
7.55.2 Erection: Built-up, swinging and suspended scaffolds shall be erected by competent workers
only.
7.55.3 Scaffolding: All scaffolding shall be constructed in accordance with Section 13.10.4 and 13.10.5
as follows:—
7.55.4 All buildings: All scaffolding exceeding 26m or seven floors in height used in construction
operations involving the erection, alteration or maintenance of buildings, shall be constructed of
non-combustible or fire-retardant materials complying with the provision of Section 12.3.4.
TABLE 13.10
SCAFFOLD LOAD CAPACITY
7.55.5 Use Group F: All scaffolding used in construction operations involving the repair or partial
demolition during occupancy of buildings of Use Group F-2 and F-3 shall be constructed of
non-combustible or fire-retardant materials complying with the provisions of Section 12.3.4.
7.56 HOISTS
7.56.1 Hoist protection: All material hoists shall be adequately protected. When erected on the outside
of a building over 26m or seven floors in height, the hoist structure shall be built of non combustible or
approved fire-retardant materials with the exception of the loading platform.
7.56.2 Passengers prohibited: Persons shall not be permitted to ride a material hoist. Temporary
elevators shall be installed when necessary to transport workers as provided in Section 9.1.
[Page 220]
7.56.3 Guarding of cables: All hoisting cables and signal cords shall be guarded whenever they pass
through working spaces to prevent injury to persons.
7.56.4 Rigger’s licence: All persons engaged in the erection of derricks and other hoisting apparatus
shall secure a licence or certificate of fitness for the performance of such work from the authorised
administrative official.
7.58 LIGHTING
7.58.1 General: All stairways and parts of buildings under demolition, erection or repair shall be
adequately lighted while persons are engaged at work, to comply with the provisions of Sections 7.24 and
9.2.9.2.7.
7.61 SANITATION
7.61.1 General: Every building in the course of demolition, erection or repair shall be provided with
toilet and drinking water facilities which shall be constructed and installed in accordance with the
Plumbing Code listed in the Schedule.
7.61.2 DISPUTES
7.61.2.1 GENERAL: The Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit when requested by any person,
aggrieved or otherwise, shall serve a written notice on any owner, tenant and their agents who fail to
conform to the requirements of this Chapter, directing such person to take the necessary remedial action.
If the person whose duty it is to protect his own or adjoining property under those provisions fails to
proceed to fully comply with such notice within seven days of receipt thereof, or within a reasonable time
thereafter as determined by the Code Enforcement Officer, the code enforcement officer is authorised to
cause the necessary work to be done when the health, safety and general welfare of the public are
involved. The cost of such work shall become a lien against the property of the offending owner, and the
legal authority of the jurisdiction shall institute appropriate action for its recovery.
[Page 222]
TABLE 13.15(a)
ACCEPTABLE NOISE LEVEL
The Table below shows recommended maximum daily exposure
TABLE 13.15(b)
DUST
THRESHOLD LIMIT VALUES in mg/m3
(Total and Respirable Mass) FOR
SOME DUSTS
[Page 223]
TABLE 13.15(c)
First Aid Facilities 1
SUPPLEMENT
TABLE 13.15(d)
FIRST AID FACILITIES 2
(a) Finger 12 24 50
(b) Medium sized 6 12 25
Safety pins 6 12 24
plus 1 – 20 – First Aid Kit; 21 – 100 – First Aid Box; 101 – 199 First Aid Post.
Section 8
Civil / Structural / Geo-Technical Design Requirements
Sections
8.1 Building Design Requirements
8.2 Special Building Design Requirements
8.3 Signage
8.4 Repairs, Alterations
8.5 Precautions During
8.6 Materials and Components
8.7 Fire
8.8 Structural Loads/Stability
8.8.1 Scope
8.8.2 Plans and Specifications
8.8.3 Design Safe Load
8.8.4 Design Live Load
8.8.5 Design Dead Load
8.8.6 Existing Buildings
8.8.7 Uniformly Distributed Live Load
8.8.8 Concentrated Loads
8.8.9 Impact Loads
8.8.10 Special Loads
8.8.11 Roof Loads
8.8.12 Wind Load
8.8.13 Earthquake Loads
8.8.14 Combination of Loads
8.8.15 Live Load Reduction
8.9 Foundation Systems and Retaining Walls
8.9.2 Bearing Values of Soils
8.9.3 Foundation Investigations
8.9.4 Soil Test Procedure
8.9.5 Allowable Foundation Loads
8.9.6 Depth of Footings
8.9.7 Footing Design
8.9.8 Timber Footings and Wood Foundations
8.9.9 Steel Grillages
8 9 10 Concrete Footings
p g pp g
[Page 227]
8.3 SIGNAGE
8.8.1 Scope:
The provisions of these sections shall control the structural designs of all buildings and structures or
portions thereof.
8.8.2.1 General: Design plans drawn to minimum scale of 1:100 shall show the size, section and relative
locations of all structural members with floor levels, column centres and all offsets fully dimensioned.
The design loads shall be clearly indicated for all parts of the building of structure.
8.8.3.1 Safe Support required: Building or other structures, and all parts thereof, shall be designed and
constructed to support safely all loads, without exceeding the allowable stresses (or specified strengths
when appropriate load factors are applied) for the materials of construction in the structural members and
connections.
8.8.3.2 Progressive collapse: Buildings and structural systems shall provide such structural integrity that
the hazards associated with progressive collapse are reduced to a level consistent with standard practice.
Structures shall be able to sustain local damage or failure with the structure as a whole remaining stable.
Compliance with the applicable provisions as listed in Schedule 24.1 shall be deemed to meet the
requirements of this section.
[Page 228]
8.8.3.3 Load tests: The code enforcement officer is authorised to require a load test or certified report of
such tests, conducted in an approved manner by approved testing agencies, of any construction whenever
there is reason to question its safety for the intended occupancy or use.
8.8.4.1 Required live load: The live loads to be assumed in the design of buildings and structures shall
be the greatest load produced by the intended use and occupancy, but not less than the minimum
uniformly distributed unit loads required in Section 24.6.0 for specific uses.
8.8.4.2 Load not specified: The code official shall approve the required live load for any use not
specifically provided for in Table 8.6.1.
8.8.5.1 Weights of materials and construction: In estimating dead load for the purposes of structural
design, the actual weights of materials and constructions shall be used, but not less than the unit dead
loads prescribed in N.C.P.I Part 3 (loading) as listed in Schedule 24.2. In the absence of definite
information, any values assumed by the designers shall be subject to the approval of the code enforcement
officer.
8.8.5.2 Weight of fixed service equipment: In estimating dead loads for purposes of design, the weight
of fixed service equipment such as plumbing stacks and risers, electrical feeders, heating, ventilating,
air-conditioning and sprinkler systems shall be included.
8.8.5.3 Partition load: In offices and other buildings, in which subdividing partitions are subsequently
erected, re-arranged or relocated, provision shall be made to support the actual weight of such partitions
where they occur, or for an equivalent uniform load, which shall be assumed not less than 1 KN/m2 of
floor area in addition to the specified uniformly distributed live load. Provision for partition weight shall
be made whether or not partitions are shown on the plans, unless the specified live load exceed 4 KN/m2.
8.8.6.1 General: In the reconstruction, repair, extension or alteration of existing buildings, the allowable
working stresses used in design shall be as indicated in Section 8.8.6.2 through 8.8.6.5.
8.8.6.2 Building extended: When an existing building is altered by an extension in height or area, all
existing structural parts affected by the addition shall be strengthened where necessary, and all new
structural parts shall be designed to meet the requirements for buildings hereafter erected.
8.8.6.3 Building repaired: When repairs are made to the structural portion of an existing building, and
the uncovered structural portions are found to be unsound, such parts shall be made to conform to the
requirements for buildings hereafter erected.
8.8.6.4 Existing live load: When an existing building heretofore approved is altered or repaired the
minimum design loads and stresses for the structure shall be the loads and stresses applicable at the time
of erection, provided the public safety is not endangered thereby.
[Page 229]
8.8.6.5 Posted live load: Any existing building heretofore approved, in which there is not a change in
use to a new use group requiring greater floor loads, is permitted to be posted for the originally-approved
live loads, provided the building is structurally safe in all its parts and adequate for its existing use, and
the public safety is not endangered thereby.
8.8.7.1 Uniform live load: The minimum uniformly distributed live load in KN per square meter shall be
as provided in Table 8.6.1, and all concentrated loads wherever they occur shall be provided in Section
8.6.0. The live loads in Table 8.6.1 are the minimum loads to be used for the occupancies listed. Where
the buildings will be subjected to greater live loads, such loads shall be used for design.
8.8.7.1.1 Trucks and buses: Minimum live loads for garages having trucks or buses shall be in
accordance with live loads of Federal Ministry of Works recommendations as listed in Schedule 8.3, but
shall not be less than 2.45 KN/m2.
8.8.7.1.2 Residential attics: A live load shall be applied to joists or to bottom chords of trusses or
trussed rafters only in those portions of attic space having a clear height of over 1m between joist and
rafter in conventional rafter construction; and between bottom chord and any other member in trusses or
trussed rafter construction. However, joists or the bottom chords of trusses or trussed rafters shall be
designed to sustain the imposed dead load or 0.5KN/m2, whichever is greater, uniformly distributed over
the entire span. A further ceiling dead load reduction to a minimum of 0.25KN/m2 or the actual dead load,
whichever is greater, applied to joists in conventional rafter construction or to the bottom chords of
trusses or trussed rafters is permitted under either or both of the following conditions where the clear
height:
Is not over 7.5m between joist and rafter in conventional construction and between the bottom chord
and any other member for trusses or trussed rafter construction.
Of greater than 7.5m, as defined in Clause 8.8.7.1.2 directly above, does not exist for a horizontal
distance of more than 3.5m along the member.
8.8.7.2 Posting of live loads: In every building or other structure or part thereof the design loads shall be
marked on plates of approved design which shall be supplied and securely affixed by the owner of the
building, or the owner’s authorised agent, in a conspicuous place in each space to which they relate. Any
plates lost, removed or defaced shall be replaced by the owner or the owner’s agent.
TABLE 8.6.1
MINIMUM UNIFORMLY DISTRIBUTED LIVE LOADS
OCCUPANCY OR USE Live Load KN/m2
Apartments (Flats) see Residential –
Armories and drill rooms 7.5
ASSEMBLY AREAS:
Fixed seats 4.0
Movable seats 5.0
Platforms (Assembly) 5.0
[Page 230]
[Page 231]
TABLE 8.7.1
MINIMUM CONCENTRATED LOADS
LOCATION KN
Elevator machine room grating (on area of 2600 sq.mm) 1.5
Finish light floor plate construction (on area 6500 sq.mm) 0.9
Garages See section 8.8.8.2
Greenhouse roof bars, purlins and rafters 0.45
Hospitals and ward rooms 4.5
Libraries 4.5
Manufacturing and storage buildings 9.0
Mercantile area 9.0
Office 9.0
Schools 4.5
Scuttles (Trap door) skylight ribs and accessible ceilings 0.9
Sidewalks or vehicular driveway subject to trucking 35.6
Stair treads (on area of 2600 sq.mm at centre of tread) 1.5
[Page 232]
8.8.8.1 General: Floors of buildings in the locations specified in Table 1107 shall be designed to support
the uniformly distributed live loads prescribed in Section 8.6.0 or the following minimum concentrated
loads in pounds, whichever produces the greater stresses. If the anticipated actual loads are higher, the
actual loads shall be used. Unless otherwise specified, the indicated concentration shall be assumed to
occupy an area of 0.00075m2 and shall be so located as to produce the maximum stress conditions in the
structural members.
8.8.8.2. Garages: Minimum concentrated loads for garages or portions of buildings used for parking
motor vehicles shall be:
For passenger cars accommodating not more than nine passengers, 9.0KN acting on an area of 13000.0
square mm (0.013m2), mechanical parking structures without slab, passenger car only, 6.7KN per wheel;
and for trucks or buses, on slabs, maximum axle load on an area of 13 x 103mm2.
8.8.9.1 General: The live loads specified in Section 8.8.7 shall be assumed to include adequate
allowance for ordinary impact conditions. Provisions shall be made in the structural design for special
uses and loads which involve vibration and impact forces.
8.8.9.2 Elevator (Lift): All moving elevator loads shall be increased to 100 percent for impact, and the
structural supports shall be designed within the limits of deflection prescribed by ASME A17.1 listed in
Section 8.8.5.
8.8.9.3 Machinery: For the purpose of design, the weight of machinery and moving loads shall be
increased as follows to allow for impact:
Elevator machinery ........................................................................................100 percent
Light machinery, shaft- or motor-driven ..........................................................20 percent
Reciprocating machinery or power-driven units ..............................................50 percent
Hangers for floors or balconies ........................................................................33 percent
These percentages shall be increased when so recommended by the manufacturer.
8.8.9.4 Craneways: The design loads and appropriate impact factors for the design of buildings with
bridge, monorail, jib, and single-leg gantry cranes Section 8.8.6.
8.8.9.5 Assembly structures: Grandstands, stadia and similar assembly structures shall be designed to
resist the loads specified in Table 8.6.1. Loads of 1.8 KN/m on footboards and seatboards shall be used.
Lateral sway bracing loads of 0.4KN/m parallel to and 0.2KN/m per DS.
8.8.10.1 General: Provisions shall be made for all special loads herein prescribed and all other special
loads to which the building or structure is subjected.
8.8.10.2 Retaining walls: Retaining walls shall be designed to resist the lateral pressure of retained
material. Walls retaining drained earth shall be designed for a minimum pressure equivalent to that
exerted by fluid weighing not less than 0.21 KN/m3 and having a depth equal to that of the retained earth.
Any surcharge shall be in addition to the equivalent fluid pressure.
[Page 233]
8.8.10.3 Hydrostatic uplift: All foundation slabs and other footings subjected to water pressure shall be
designed to resist a uniformly distributed uplift equal to the full hydrostatic pressure.
8.8.10.4 Construction loads and erection stresses: Provision shall be made for temporary construction
and wind loads which occur during the erection of the building; and all structural members and
connections shall be designed and erected so as to prevent overstressing during construction.
8.8.10.5 Partial loading: The full intensity of the appropriately reduced live load applied only to a
portion of the length of a structure or member shall be considered if it produces a more unfavourable
effect than the same intensity applied over the full length of the structure or member.
8.8.10.6 Interior finish: Finishing materials used on interior walls and partitions shall have adequate
strength to resist a horizontal load of not less than 0.25 KN/m2.
8.8.10.7 Guardrails and handrails: All required guardrails and handrails shall be designed and
constructed to the structural loading conditions set forth in Sections 8.9.7.1 and 8.9.7.2 without exceeding
the allowable design working stress of the materials, anchorage and connecting devices utilised. The
allowable working stresses shall be as defined by the appropriate design standard. Each load shall be
applied so as to produce the maximum stress in each of the respective components.
8.8.10.7.1 Handrail design and construction: Handrails shall be designed and constructed for a
concentrated load of 1KN applied at any point and in any direction. Handrails located in (other than
dwelling units) buildings shall also be designed and constructed for a uniform load of 1.2KN/m applied in
any direction. The concentrated and uniform loading conditions shall not be applied simultaneously.
8.8.10.7.2 Guardrail system design and construction: Guardrails shall be designed and constructed for
a concentrated load of 1.4KN applied at any point and in any direction along the top railing member.
Guardrail systems located in other than dwelling units in buildings shall also be designed and constructed
for a uniform load of 1.5KN/m applied in any direction at the required guardrail height. The concentrated
and uniform loading conditions shall not be applied simultaneously.
The infill area of a guardrail system shall be designed and constructed for a horizontal concentrated load
of 1KN applied on a 0.1m2 at any point in the system, including intermediate rails or other elements
serving this purpose.
8.8.11.1 General: The structural supports of roofs and marquees shall be designed to resist wind (Section
8.12.0) and earthquake loads (Section 8.13.0). In addition to the dead load of construction and the
appropriate live loads as prescribed in this section or in Figure 24.6.1.
8.8.11.2 Minimum roof loads: Ordinary roofs, flat, pitched or curved, shall be designed for the live
loads as specified in Table 8.10.
8.8.11.3 Overhanging eaves: Except where the overhang framing is a continuation of the roof framing,
overhanging eaves, and other roof projections shall be designed for a minimum uniformly distributed live
load of 3KN/m2.
[Page 234]
8.8.11.4 Ponding: Roofs shall be designed for the maximum possible depth of water that would pond
thereon as determined by the relative levels of roofs deck and overflow weirs, edges or serviceable drains
in combination with the deflected structural elements. In determining the maximum possible depth of
water, all primary roof drainage means shall be assumed to be blocked.
8.8.11.5 Special purpose roofs: When used for incidental promenade purposes, roofs shall be designed
for a minimum live load of 23KN/m2. When used for roof gardens or assembly or educational uses, the
minimum designed load shall be 5.0KN/m2.
8.8.11.5.1 Landscape roofs: When roofs are to be landscaped, the uniform design live load in the
landscape area shall be 1KN/m2. The weight of the landscaping materials shall be considered as dead load
and shall be computed on the basis of saturation of the soil.
Roofs to be used for other for other special purposes shall be designed for appropriate loads, or as
otherwise approved.
TABLE 8.10
TABLE 8.11
[Page 235]
8.8.11.6 Roof slope factor for curved roofs: The point at which the slope exceeds 70 degrees (1.22 rad)
shall be considered the “eave” for such roofs. For curved roofs, the slope factor shall be determined by
basing the slope on the vertical angle from the “eave” to the crown.
8.8.11.7 Roof slope factor for multiple roofs: For multiple folded-plate, sawtooth and barrel vault roofs
with parallel ridge lines, the roof slope factor shall be considered to be equal to 1.0 (Cs = 1.0) regardless
of the slope of the roof.
8.8.12.1 General: All exposed structures or structural components, cladding and roof coverings shall be
designed to resist the pressures due to wind in any direction as provided herein.
8.8.12.1.1 Wind loads during erection and construction phases: Adequate temporary bracing shall be
provided to resist wind loading on structural components and structural assemblages during the erection
and construction phases.
8.8.12.1.2 Overturning and sliding: The overturning moment due to wind load shall not exceed
two-thirds of the dead load stabilising moment unless the building or structure is anchored to resist the
excess moment. When the total resisting force due to friction is insufficient to prevent sliding, anchorage
shall be provided to resist the excess sliding force.
8.8.12.1.3 Symbols, notations and definitions: The following symbols and notations apply to the
provisions of this section.
Pd = Pz + Ph = design pressure to be used in determination of wind loads for the main wind
force-resisting system
Pz = windward design pressure evaluated at height z above grade, in KN per cubic metre
Ph = leeward or sidewall pressure evaluated at height z = h, in KN per cubic metre
z = height above grade, in metres
h = the mean roof height of a building, the height of other structures, or the eave height
for buildings with roof slope of less than 10 degrees (0.17 rad), in metres
Pe = effective velocity pressure, including gust effect as tabulated in Table 8.12.1 (1) for
exposure B and Table 8.12.2 for exposure C
I = importance factor of the building or other structure as indicated in Tables 8.12.3
and 8.12.4
Cp = external pressure coefficient to be used in determination of wind loads for
buildings or for any other structures (see Figure 8.12.1 and Tables 8.12.5 through
8.12.10)
8.8.12.1.4 Components and cladding: Structural elements that are either directly loaded by the wind or
receive wind loads originating at relatively close locations and that transfer those loads to the main wind
force-resisting system.
8.8.12.1.5 Main wind force-resisting system: An assemblage of major structural elements designed to
provide support for secondary members and cladding. The system primarily receives wind loading from
relatively remote locations.
8.8.12.1.6 Design: The design and wind pressure for the main wind force-resisting system shall be
determined as follows:
Pd = Pe x I2 x Cp
[Page 236]
8.8.12.1.7 Components and cladding: The design wind pressure for structural components and cladding
supporting tributary areas greater than 100m2 shall be designed using the provisions for main wind
force-resisting systems. Structural components and cladding supporting tributary areas, 100m2 and less
shall be designed in accordance with relevant BS COP listed in Schedule 24.1.
TABLE 8.12.5
Note a: Values listed are for the determination of average loads on main wind force-resisting system.
Note b: Plus and minus signs signify pressures acting toward and away from the surfaces respectively.
Note c: When the rise-to-span is 0.2<r<0.3 alternate coefficients given by 5r-2.1 shall also be used for the
windward quarter.
TABLE 8.12.6
Note a. The design wind force shall be calculated based on the area of the structure protected on a plane
normal to the wind direction. The force shall be assumed to act parallel to the wind direction.
Note b. Linear interpolation is permitted for h/D values other than shown
Note c. Notation
D - Diameter or least horizontal dimension in M
h - Height of structure M
[Page 237]
TABLE 8.12.7
Note a. Signs with openings comprising less than 30 percent of the gross area shall be considered as solid
signs.
Note b. Signs for which the distance from the ground to the bottom edge is less than 0.25 times the
vertical dimension shall be considered to be at ground level.
Note c. To allow for both normal and oblique wind directions, two cases shall be considered:
1. Resultant force acts normal to sign at geometric center, and
2. Resultant force acts normal to sign at level of geometric center and at a distance from windward
Note d. Notation:
V: Ratio of height to width
M: Larger dimension of sign in M
N: Smaller dimension of sign in M
TABLE 8.12.8
e Cp
Square towers d Triangular towers d
<0.025 4.0 3.6
0.025 to 0.44 4.1 - 5.2e 3.7 - 4.5e
0.45 to 0.69 1.8 1.7
0.7 to 1.0 1.3 - 0.7e 1.0+e
Note a. Force coefficients are given for towers with structural angles or similar that sided members
[Page 238]
Note b. For towers with rounded members the design wind force shall be determined using the values in
the above table multiplied by the following factors:
e<0.29 factor = 0.67
0.3<e<0.79 factor = 0.67 e+0.47
0.8<e<1.0 factor = 1.0
Note c. For triangular section towers, the design wind forces shall be assumed to act normal to a tower
face.
Note d. For square section towers, the design wind forces shall be assumed to act normal to a tower face.
To allow for the maximum horizontal wind load, which occurs when the wind is oblique to the faces the
wind load acting normal to a tower wind face shall be multiplied by the factor 1.0+0.7 e<0.5 and shall be
assumed to act along a diagonal.
Note e. Wind forces on tower appurtenances such as ladders, conduits, lights, conductors, elevators and
the like shall be calculated using appropriate force coefficient for these elements.
Note f. For guyed towers the cantilever portion of the tower shall be designated for 125 percent of the
design force.
Note g. A reduction of 25 percent of the design force in any span between guys shall be made for e Ratio
of solid area to gross area of tower.
TABLE 8.12.9
TABLE 8.12.9
Note a: wind force acts normal to the surface and shall be directed inward or outward.
[Page 239]
Note b: Notation.
B – dimension of roof measured normal to wind direction m
L – dimension of roof measured parallel to wind direction m
X – distance to center of pressure from windward edge of roof m
0 – Angle plane of roof from horizontal in degree m.
TABLE 8.12.10
FORCE COEFFICIENTS FOR OPEN SIGNS AND LATTICE FRAMEWORKS Cp. b.c
Cp
e Flat-sided members Rounded members
D/Pe<2.5 D/Pe>2.5
<0.1 2.0 1.2 0.8
0.1 to 0.29 1.8 1.3 0.9
0.3 to 0.7 1.6 1.5 1.1
Note a. Signs with openings comprising 30 percent of the gross area are classified as open signs.
Note b. The calculation of the design wind forces shall be based on the area of all exposed members and
elements protected on a plane normal to the wind direction. Forces shall be assumed to act parallel to the
wind direction.
Note c. Notation.
Note e. Ratio of solid area to gross area.
Note d. Diameter of a typical round member in m.
8.8.12.1.8 Basic wind speed: The basic wind speed, in m/sec to be used for the location of the building
or other structure shall be determined by Table 8.12.1.
8.8.12.1.9 Exposure classification: The effective velocity pressure, Pe, shall be as specified in Table
8.12.1 for exposure B and Table 8.12.2 exposure C where exposures B and C are defined as follows:
8.8.12.1.9.1 Exposure B: Urban and suburban areas, wooded areas, other terrain with numerous closely
spaced obstructions having the size of single-family dwelling or larger. Use of this exposure category
shall be limited to those areas for which terrain representative of Exposure B prevails in the upwind
direction for a distance of at least (500m or 10 times the height of the building or structure, whichever is
greater.
8.8.12.1.9.2 Exposure C: Open terrain with scattered obstructions having heights generally less than 30
feet (9.0m). This category includes flat, open country and grasslands.
TABLE 8.12.1
[Page 240]
TABLE 8.12.2
8.8.12.1.9 Special wind conditions: Special wind conditions shall be provided for in accordance with
Section 8.12.2.4.1 and 8.12.2.4.2.
8.8.12.1.9.1 Increased loads: For structures located on flat, unobstructed coastal areas directly exposed
to wind flowing over large bodies of water, within 500m of the shoreline; the increased wind loads of
exposure D shall be used in accordance with relevant B.S.COP listed in the Schedule 8.
8.8.12.1.9.2 Decreased loads: For structures located in centres of large cities with at least 50 percent of
the building having a height in excess of 21m, the decreased wind loads of exposure A shall be used in
accordance with B.S.COP listed in the Schedule 8.
[Page 241]
8.8.12.1.10 Slender buildings and structures: Buildings and other structures having a height exceeding
5 times the least horizontal dimension or having a fundamental natural frequency less than 1 cycle per
second shall be designed for wind loads which include a gust response factor which has been determined
by a rational analysis that incorporates the dynamic properties of the main wind force-resisting system.
8.8.12.1.11 Wall openings: The main wind force-resisting system for buildings with all openings where
the percentage of total wall area occupied by openings in one wall exceeds that of all other walls by 10
percent or more, and openings in all other walls do not exceed 20 percent of respective wall area, shall be
designed for internal pressure in accordance with relevant B.S.COP in Schedule 8.
TABLE 8.12.3
Note a For building and structure classification categories, see Table 8.12.2.
Note b For regions between the hurricane oceanline and 161 km inland the importance factor 1 shall be
determined by linear interpolation.
Note c Hurricane oceanlines are the Atlantic and Gulf of Mexico coastal areas.
TABLE 8.12.3A
[Page 242]
TABLE 8.12.3B
Normal to < 0.3 -0.7 0.2e 0.2 0.3 0.4 0.5 0.01.0 -0.7
ridge
-0.9e for all values
of h/L and 0
0.5 -0.7 -0.9 -0.75 -0.2 0.3 0.5 0.01.0
TABLE 8.12.4
CLASSIFICATION OF BUILDINGS AND OTHER STRUCTURES FOR WIND LOADS
[Page 243]
Buildings and structures that represent a low hazard to human life in the IV
event of failure, such as agricultural buildings, certain temporary facilities,
and minor storage facilities.
8.8.13.1 General: Every building and structure and portion thereof shall be designed and constructed to
resist the earthquake effects determined in accordance with the requirements of this section. Seismic
zones shall be determined by location. Where wind load requirements as in Section 8.12.0, would produce
higher stresses, such stresses shall be used in lieu of the stresses resulting from earthquake forces. Except
for unreinforced masonry, the determination of forces in this section depends on the ability of a structure
to remain stable when members are strained into the inelastic range during a major earthquake. Structural
concepts other than those set forth in this section shall be permitted when evidence is submitted showing
that equivalent ductility and energy dissipation are provided. While the requirements in this section refer
primarily to an equivalent static force method, other procedures used to establish the seismic forces and
their distribution shall be permitted if the correspondent internal forces and deformation in the members
are determined using a model consistent with the procedure adopted. Principles governing the use of
dynamic analysis are given in Section 8.8.13.8.
8.8.13.1.1 Additions: Where applicable, every addition to an existing building or structure shall be
designed and constructed to resist the forces provided for herein.
8.8.13.1.2 Alterations: Where applicable, an existing building or structure shall not be altered or
reconstructed in such a manner that the seismic forces resisting system is not capable of resisting the
forces provided for herein.
8.8.13.1.3 Plans and design data: Where earthquake loads are applicable a brief statement of the items
indicated in Section 8.13.1.3.1 shall be included with each set of plans filed.
8.8.13.1.3.1 Dead and live loads: A summation of the dead and, where applicable, live loads of the
building; floor by floor, which was used in determining the shear for which the building is designed shall
be included with the set of drawings submitted.
[Page 244]
8.8.13.1.3.2 Bracing: A brief description of the bracing system used, the manner in which the designer
expects such system to act and a clear statement of any assumption used. Assumptions as to location of all
points of contra-flexure in members shall be stated.
8.8.13.1.3.3 Sample calculations: Sample calculations of a typical bend or equivalent shall be included.
8.8.13.1.4 Stress increases: The requirements of this section presume that allowable stresses are
increased by one-third for earthquake loadings. However, this increase shall not be permitted in
conjunction with any decrease in total load effect taken in accordance with Section 8.14.0
8.8.13.1.5 Combined vertical and horizontal forces: In computing the effect of seismic forces in
combination with vertical loads, gravity load stresses induced in members by dead load plus design live
load, except roof live load, shall be considered. Consideration shall also be given to minimum gravity
loads acting in combination with lateral forces.
TABLE 8.13.1
Nature of Occupancy/Factor
8.8.13.2 Definitions: The definitions listed below apply only to the provisions of this section.
Base: The level at which the earthquake motions are considered to be imparted to the structure or the
level at which the structure as a dynamic vibrator is supported.
Braced frame: A truss system or its equivalent which is provided to resist lateral forces in the frame
system and in which the members are subjected primarily to axial stresses.
Diaphram: A horizontal or nearly horizontal system designed to transmit seismic forces to the vertical
elements of the lateral force-resisting system.
Essential facilities: As listed in Table 8.13.1.
Lateral force-resisting system: That part of the structural system to which the lateral forces prescribed in
Section 8.13.4.
Shear wall: A wall designed to resist lateral forces parallel to the wall.
Space frame: A three-dimensional structural system without bearing walls, composed of interconnected
members, laterally supported so as to function as a complete self contained unit with or without the aid of
horizontal diaphragms or floor bracing systems.
[Page 245]
Moment-resisting space frame: A vertical load-carrying space frame in which the members and joints
are capable of resisting forces primarily by flexure.
Special moment-resisting space frame: A moment-resisting frame complying with the requirements for
a ductile moment-resisting space frame as given in Section 8.13.9.3.3.
Semi-ductile moment-resisting space frame: A moment-resisting frame complying with the
requirements for a semi-ductile moment-resisting space frame as given in Section 8.13.9.3.4
Vertical load-carrying space frame: A space frame designed to carry all vertical loads.
8.8.13.3 Symbols and notation: The following symbols and notations apply only to the provisions of the
section.
C = Numerical coefficient as defined in Section 8.13.4.4.
Cp = Numerical coefficient as defined in Section 8.13.10 and set forth in Table 8.13.10.
D = The dimension of the structure, in meters, in a direction parallel to the applied forces. (see also
Section 8.13.5.1)
Ds = The longest dimension of a shear wall or braced frame in the direction parallel to the applied forces,
in metre.
Fi, Fn, Fx = Lateral forces applied to level i, n, or x respectively.
Fp = Lateral force on a part of the structure, and in the direction under consideration.
Fpx = Force on floor diaphragms and collectors.
Ft = That portion of V considered concentrated at the top of the structure in addition to Fn.
fi = Distributed portion of a total lateral force at level i for use in the equation in Section 8.13.4.5.1.
g = Acceleration due to gravity.
hi, hn, hx = The height in metre above the base to level i, n, or x respectively.
I = Occupancy importance factor (see Table 8.13.1).
K = Numerical coefficient as set forth in Table 8.13.4.3.
k = Numerical coefficient for reduction of the overturning moment in tall buildings.
Level i = Level of the structure referred to by the subscript.
i, = 1 designates the first level above the base.
Level n = That level which is uppermost in the main portion of the structure.
Level x = That level which is under design consideration; x = 1 designates the first level above the base.
S = Soil factor (see Table 8.13.4.6).
T = Fundamental elastic period of vibration of the building or structure in the direction under
consideration, in seconds.
V = The total lateral force or shear at the base.
W = The total dead load as defined in Section 8.4.0, including partition loading, plus 25 percent of the
floor live load.
wi wx = That portion of W which is located at or is assigned to level i or x, respectively.
[Page 246]
wpx = The weight of the floor or roof diaphragms and collectors and elements tributary thereto at level x
plus 25 percent of the floor live load.
Wp = The weight of a portion of a structure or nonstructural component.
Z = Numerical coefficient (see Table 8.13.4.1) dependent upon the zone as determined by the maps in
Figure 8.13.1.
Qi = Deflection at level i relative to the base, due to applied lateral forces, <fi, for use in the equation in
Section 8.13.4.5.1.
8.8.13.4 Minimum earthquake forces for structures: Except as provided in Sections13.8 and 8.13.10,
every structure shall be designed and constructed to resist minimum total 24 lateral seismic forces
assumed to act non-concurrently in the direction of each of the main axes of the structure in accordance
with the following formula:
V = ZIKCSW
8.8.13.4.1 Factor: The factor Z shall be as shown in Table 8.13.4.1.
TABLE 8.13.4.1
Seismic Z
Severe earthquakes 4 1
3
Mild earthquakes 3 /4
3
Movement due to tremor 2 /8
3
Earth tremors 1 /16
1
Sign of natural opening (in soils) 0 /8
8.8.13.4.1.1 I Factor: The factor I shall be as shown in Table 8.13.1.
8.8.13.4.2 K Factor: The value of K shall not be less than set forth in Table 8.13.4.3.
TABLE 8.13.4.3
[Page 247]
Note a. The minimum value of Kc shall be 0.12 and the maximum value KCs need not exceed 0.29 or
0.23 for Soil Profile 3 in Seismic Zones 3 and 4. The tower shall be designated for an accidental torsion
of 5 percent as specified in Section 8.8.13.5.5. Elevated tanks that are supported by buildings or do not
conform to the type or arrangement of supporting elements as described above shall be designed in
accordance with Section 24.13.10 using Cp = 0.3.
8.8.13.4.3 Factor: The value of C shall be as indicated in the equation in this subsection. The product
CS (see Section 8.8.13.4.6 for S values) need not exceed 0.14, or, for Soil Profile 3 in Seismic Zones 3
and 4, the product need not exceed 0.11.
The value of C shall be determined in accordance with the following formula:
1
C=
15T
The value of C need not exceed 0.12.
8.8.13.4.4 T- Factor: The value of T shall be determined using the methods described in Sections
8.8.13.4.5.1 and 8.8.13.4.5.2.
8.8.13.4.4.1 T Formula: T is the fundamental period which shall be established using the structural
properties and deformational characteristics of the resisting elements using the following formula or the
appropriate in Section 8.8.13.4.5.2. where the values of fi represent any lateral force distributed
approximately in accordance with the principles of the equations in Section 8.8.13.5.1 other rational
distribution. The elastic deflections Qi shall be calculated using the applied lateral forces fi. The value of
C when calculated using the period T as determined by the equation in this section shall not be less than
80 percent of the value of C based on the period T estimated using the appropriate equation in Section
8.8.13.4.5.2.
8.8.13.4.4.2 Alternative T Formulas: In the absence of a determination of the value of T in accordance
with Section 8.8.13.4.5.1, the value of T for buildings shall be determined by the following appropriate
formula:
8.8.13.4.4.2.1 For shear walls or exterior concrete frames utilizing deep beams or wide piers, or both:
0.05 hn
T=
Ds
[Page 248]
8.8.13.4.4.2.2 For isolated shear walls not interconnected by frames or for braced frames:
0.05 hn
T=
Ds
8.8.13.4.4.2.3 In buildings in which the lateral force-resisting system consists of moment-resisting space
frames capable of resisting 100 percent of the required lateral forces and such system is not enclosed by
or adjoined by more rigid elements tending to prevent the frame from resisting lateral forces.
T = Crhn ¾
Where Cr = 0.035 for steel frames and 0.030 for concrete frames.
8.8.13.4.5 S Factor: The value of S shall be determined from Table 24.13.4.6, the soil profile types are
defined as follows:
8.8.13.4.6 . . .
1. Soil profile type S1 is a profile with:
a. Rock of any characteristic, which is either scale like or crystalline in nature. Such
material is characterised by a shear wave velocity greater than 750m/s; or
b. Stiff soil conditions where the soil depth is less than 61m and the soil types overlying
rock are stable deposits of sands, gravels, or stiff clays.
8.8.13.4.7 . . .
2. Soil profile type S2 is a profile with deep cohesionless deposits or stiff clay conditions,
including sites where soil depth exceeds 61m and the soil types overlying rock are stable
deposits of sands, gavels, or stiff clays.
8.8.13.4.8 . . .
3. Soil profile type S3 is a profile with soft-to medium-stiff clays and sand, characterized by 10m
or more of soft to medium-stiff clays without intervening layers of sand or other cohesionless
soils.
In locations where the soil properties are not known in sufficient detail to determine the soil profile type
or the profile does not fit any of the three types, soil profile S2 or soil profile S3 shall be used, whichever
gives the larger value of CS.
TABLE 24.13.4.6
8.8.13.5 Distribution of lateral forces: The imposed lateral forces shall be applied in accordance with
Section 8.8.13.5.1 through to 8.8.13.5.6.
8.8.13.5.1 Structures having regular shapes or framing systems: The total lateral force V shall be
distributed over the height of the structure in accordance with the following formula=Ft+n/i-IFt Where
the concentrated force at the top Ft shall be determined according to the formula:
Ft=0.07TV
[Page 249]
The maximum required value of Ft shall be 0.25V. When T is 0.7 second or less, the minimum required
value of Ft shall be zero. The remaining portion of the total base shear V shall be distributed over the
height of the structure, including level n, according to the formula: Fx =(V-Ft)Wxhx/n/i=I Wihi
At each level designation as x, the forces Fx shall be applied over the area of the building in accordance
with the mass distribution on the level.
8.8.13.5.2 Setbacks: Buildings having setbacks wherein the plan dimension of the tower in each
direction is at least 75 percent of the corresponding plan dimension of the lower part shall be considered
as uniform buildings without setbacks, provided that other irregularities as defined in this section do not
exist.
8.8.13.5.3 Structures having irregular shapes or framing systems: The distribution of the lateral
forces in structures that have highly irregular shapes, large differences in lateral resistance or stiffness
between adjacent stories, or other unusual structural features shall be determined considering the dynamic
characteristics of the structure.
8.8.13.5.4 Distribution of horizontal shear: Total shear in any horizontal plane shall be distributed to
the various elements of the lateral force-resisting system in proportion to their rigidities, considering the
rigidity of the horizontal bracing system or diaphragm. Rigid elements incorporated into the building that
are not assumed to be part of the lateral force-resisting system shall be permitted if their effect on the
action of the system is considered and provided for in the design.
8.8.13.5.5 Horizontal torsional moments: The design shall provide for the torsional moment resulting
from the location of the building masses plus the torsional moments caused by assumed displacement of
the mass each way from its actual location by a distance equal to 5 percent of the dimension of the
building perpendicular to the direction of the applied forces.
8.8.13.5.6 Diaphragms: Floor and roof diaphragms and collectors shall be designed to resist the forces
determined in accordance with the formula:
Fpx = (n/i = x Fi/n/i = Wi) Wpx
The force Fpx need not exceed 0.30ZIwpx
When the diaphragm is required to transfer lateral forces from the vertical resisting elements above the
diaphragm to other vertical resisting elements below the diaphragm, due to either offsets in the placement
of the elements or to changes in stiffness in the vertical elements, these forces shall be added to the value
determined for Fpx. However, the lateral force on the diaphragm shall not be less than 0.14ZIwpx.
Diaphragms providing lateral support to concrete or masonry walls shall have continuous ties between
diaphragm chords to distribute into the diaphragm the anchorage forces specified in this section. Chords
added to form subdiaphragms to transmit the anchorage forces to the main crossties shall be
permitted. Diaphragm deformations shall be considered in the design of the supported walls.
8.8.13.6 Overturning: Every building or structure shall be designed to resist the overturning effects
caused by the earthquake forces specified in this Section. The overturning moment at each storey x shall
be calculated as follows:
Mx = Ft (hn – hx) + n/i = x Fi (hi-hx)
[Page 250]
The increment of overturning moment at each storey shall be distributed to the resisting elements in the
same proportion as the distribution of the horizontal shears. In tall buildings, the maximum overturning
moment in any element shall be determined by multiplying Mx by a factor K depending on the location
of the element, as follows:
K = 1.0 for the top 10 storyes.
K = 0.8 for the 20th storey from the top and those below.
K = A value between 1.0 and 0.8 determined by straight line interpolation for storeys between the 10th
and 20th storeys below the top.
8.8.13.6.1 Overturning moment distribution: Where other vertical members are provided which are
capable of partially resisting the overturning moments, redistribution to these members shall be permitted
if framing members of sufficient strength and stiffness to transmit the required loads are provided. Where
a vertical resisting element is discontinuous, the overturning moment carried by the lowest storey of that
element shall be carried down as a load to the foundation.
8.8.13.7 Drift and building separation: Lateral deflections or drift of a storey relative to adjacent
storeys, including any portions thereof caused by deflection of horizontal resisting elements, shall not
exceed 0.005 times the storey height (0.0025 in buildings with unreinforced masonry), unless it can be
demonstrated that greater deformation can be tolerated. The horizontal displacement calculated from the
application of the lateral forces shall be multiplied by 1/K to obtain the drift. The ratio 1/K shall be not
less than 1.0. All portions of structures shall be designed and constructed to act as an integral unit in
resisting horizontal forces unless separated structurally by a distance sufficient to avoid contact under
deflection from seismic action.
8.8.13.8 Alternative determination and distribution of seismic forces: Nothing in Section 8.8.13.0
shall be deemed to prohibit the submission of properly substantiated technical data for establishing the
lateral forces and their distribution by elastic or inelastic dynamic analysis. In such analyses, the dynamic
characteristics of the structure shall be considered, and the following principles shall be observed:
1. The base shear shall be not less than 90 percent of that computed in Section 8.8.13.8.
2. Values of base shear consistent with K = 0.67 to 2.5 are applicable only if the structure is
designed and detailed to be consistent with the requirements in Section 8.8.13.9. Otherwise, the
structure shall be designed for a base shear consistent with its ability to dissipate energy by
inelastic cyclic straining, which will generally mean a value of K from 2.5 to 4.0 or greater.
3. The requirements of Section 8.8.13.7 shall be satisfied using the forces prescribed in Section
8.8.13.4.
4. The input to the dynamic analysis shall be either a smoothed response spectrum or a suit of
ground-motion-time histories that reflect the characteristics of the structure and site and are
approved by the code enforcement officer. In either case, the input shall be scaled in accordance
with the above three principles.
8.8.13.9 Structural systems: The design of structural systems shall comply with the applicable
provisions of Section 8.8.13.9.1 through 8.8.13.9.6. Reinforced concrete members shall comply with the
applicable provisions of relevant B.S.COP.
[Page 251]
8.8.13.9.1 Bearing wall systems: Bearing wall systems shall use walls or braced frames as vertical
elements for resistance to lateral seismic force. Horizontal elements of the seismic force-resisting system
shall be diaphragms or trusses. The factor K depends on the type of wall, as shown in Table 8.13.4.3.
Where the framing systems along two orthogonal axes are different, the factor K for both directions shall
be taken as 1.0, 1.33 or 4.0 as appropriate.
8.8.13.9.2 Building-frame systems: Building-frame systems designed using a factor K = 1.0 shall have
an essentially complete frame conforming to the requirements of the relevant B.S.COP. for the design,
fabrication and erection of structural steel for buildings supporting all gravity loads, and shall have shear
walls or vertical bracing trusses to resist the earthquake lateral force.
8.8.13.9.3 Moment-resisting frame systems: Moment-resisting frame systems shall be designed in
accordance with the applicable provisions of Section 8.8.13.9.3.1 through 8.8.13.9.3.4.
8.8.13.9.3.1 Connections in steel frames: Beam-to-column connections in steel moment-resisting
frames shall develop the joint capacity determined by the strength of members framing into the joint
unless it can be shown that adequate rotation can be obtained by deformations of the connection materials
that the added drift is taken into account.
8.8.13.9.3.2 Ordinary steel frames: Moment-resisting steel frame systems designed using a factor K =
1.0 shall have a frame conforming to the requirements of the relevant B.S.COP. for the design, fabrication
and erection of structural steel for buildings.
8.8.13.9.3.3 Special frames: Systems designed using a factor K = 0.67 shall have special
moment-resisting space frames conforming to the requirements of relevant B.S.COP. for the design,
fabrication and erection of structural steel for buildings. Steel members in special moment-resisting frame
systems shall be composed of (Grades 42 through 55) structural steel.
8.8.13.9.4 Semi-ductile concrete frames: Buildings in Seismic Zone 2, and buildings in Seismic Zone 1
with an importance factor I = 1.5, using a semi-ductile concrete moment-resisting space frame
conforming to the relevant B.S COP. requirements shall use a K of not less than 1.0.
8.8.13.9.4.1 Dual systems: Dual systems shall be designed in accordance with the applicable frames
using a factor K = 0.8 shall have special moment-resisting space frames conforming to Section
8.8.13.9.3.4 that are capable of supporting seismic forces. The total seismic force shall be distributed to
the various resisting systems and elements in proportion to their relative rigidities.
8.8.13.9.4.2 Dual systems with semi-ductile concrete frames: In Seismic Zone 2, and for buildings
having an importance factor I of 1.5 in Seismic Zone 1, dual systems designed using a factor K = 1.0 shall
have semi-ductile moment-resisting concrete space frames conforming to the requirements of Section
8.8.13.9.3.4 that are capable of supporting seismic forces. The total seismic force shall be distributed to
the various resisting systems and elements in proportion to their relative rigidities.
8.8.13.9.5 Braced frames: In Seismic Zones 2 and 4, and for buildings having an importance factor I
greater than 1.0 and located in Seismic Zone 2, all members in braced frames shall be designed for 1.25
times the force determined in accordance with [Page 252] Section 8.8.13.4. Steel members in braced
frames shall be limited to those grades listed in Section 8.8.13.9.3.3. Reinforced concrete members in
braced frames shall be provided with the transverse confinement reinforcement required in Section
8.8.13.9.3.3.
8.8.13.9.6 Substructures: In structures where K = 0.67 or 0.80, the special ductility requirements for
structural steel or reinforced concrete specified in Section 8.8.13.9.3.3. shall apply to all structural
elements at the base level and in the first story below the base which are required to transmit to the
foundation the forces resulting from lateral loads.
In structures containing semi-ductile concrete frames where K = 1.0, the ductility requirements specified
in Section 8.8.13.9.3.4 shall apply to all frame elements at the base level and in the first storey below the
base which are required to transmit to the foundation the forces resulting from lateral loads.
8.8.13.10 Lateral forces on elements of structures and nonstructural components: Parts or portions
of buildings or structures, nonstructural components, and their anchorage to the main structural system
shall be designed for lateral forces in accordance with the following formula:
Fp = ZICpWp
The values of Cp are in Table 8.13.10. The value of I shall be as given in Table 8.13.1. The value of I for
anchorage of machinery and equipment required for life safety systems shall be 1.5 for all buildings.
The distribution of these forces shall be according to the gravity loads pertaining thereto.
TABLE 24.13.10
[Page 253]
Note a: Cp required for elements laterally self-supported only at the ground level shall be two-thirds of
value shown.
Note b: Wp for storage racks shall be the weight of the racks plus contents. The value of Cp for racks
over two storage support levels in height shall be 0.24 for the levels below the top two levels.
Where a number storage rack units are interconnected so that there are a minimum of four vertical
elements in each direction on each column line designated to resist horizontal forces, the minimum design
coefficients shall be the same as for a building with K values from Table 8.13.4.3; CS = 0.2 for use in the
formula, V = ZIKCSW; and W equal to the total dead load plus 50 percent of the rack-rated capacity.
Note c: For flexible and flexibly-mounted equipment and machinery, the appropriate values of Cp shall
be determined with consideration given to both the dynamic properties of the equipment and machinery
and to the building or structure in which it is placed but shall be not less than the listed values. The design
of the anchorage of the equipment and machinery is an integral part of the design and specification of
such equipment and machinery.
For essential facilities described in Table 8.13.1 and life safety systems, the design and detailing of
equipment that must remain in place and be functional following a major earthquake shall consider drifts
in accordance with Section 8.8.13.14.
Note d: Ceiling weight shall include all light fixtures and other equipment that is laterally supported by
the ceiling. For purposes of determining the lateral force, a ceiling weight of not less than 0.2NK/m2 shall
be used.
Note e: The force shall be resisted by positive anchorage and not by friction.
Note f: Seismic restraints shall not be required for the following installations:
1. Gas piping less than 25mm inside diameter.
2. Piping in boiler and mechanical rooms less than 32mm inside diameter.
3. All other piping less than 62mm inside diameter.
4. All other electrical conduit less than 62mm inside diameter.
5. All rectangular air-handling ducts less than 0.6m2 in cross-sectional area.
6. All round air-handling ducts less than 700mm in diameter.
7. All piping suspended by individual hangers 300mm or less in length from the top of the pipe to
the bottom of the support for the hanger.
8. All ducts suspended by hangers 300mm or less in length from the top of the duct to the bottom
of the support for the hanger.
[Page 254]
8.8.13.11 Connections: Connections shall comply with the requirements of Section 8.8.13.11.1 through
to 8.8.13.11.5.
8.8.13.11.1 Anchorage of concrete or masonry walls: Concrete or masonry walls shall be anchored to
all floors and roofs that provide lateral support for the wall. Such anchorage shall provide a positive direct
connection capable of resisting the horizontal forces specified in Section 8.8.13.10.
8.8.13.11.2 Load paths: All parts of the building or structure that transmit seismic force shall be
connected through a continuous path to the resisting element. At a minimum, the connection and the
elements along the path to the resisting element shall be capable of resisting force equal to 0.51ZI or 0.05,
whichever is greater, times the weight of the portion being connected.
8.8.13.11.3 Exterior panels: Precast or prefabricated nonbearing, nonshear wall panels or similar
elements that are attached to or enclose the exterior shall be designed to resist the forces determined in
Section 8.8.13.10, and shall accommodate movements of the structure resulting from lateral forces or
temperature changes. The concrete panels or other similar elements shall be supported by means of
cast-in-place concrete or mechanical connections and fasteners in accordance with the following
provisions:
8.8.13.11.3.1 Connections and panel joints shall allow for a relative movement between storeys of not
less than 3.0/K times the calculated elastic storey displacement caused by required seismic forces or
13mm, whichever is greater. Connections that permit movement by using slotted or oversized holes or
connections that permit movement by bending of steel or other connections providing equivalent sliding
or ductility capacity, or both.
8.8.13.11.3.2 Bodies of connectors shall have sufficient ductility and rotation capacity so as to preclude
fracture of the concrete or brittle failures at or near welds.
8.8.13.11.3.3 The body of the connector shall be designed for one and one-third times the force
determined in Section 8.8.13.10. Fasteners attaching the connector to the panel or the structure, such as
bolts, inserts, welds, dowels, and similar fasteners, shall be designed to ensure ductile behaviour of the
connector or shall be designed for four times the load determined in Section 8.8.13.10.
8.8.13.11.3.4. Fasteners embedded in concrete shall be attached to or hooked around reinforcing steel or
otherwise terminated so as to effectively transfer forces to the reinforcing steel.
8.8.13.11.3.5. The value of the factor I for the entire connector assembly shall be 1.0 when applying the
requirements of Section 8.8.13.10.
8.8.13.11.4 Foundation ties: Individual pile caps and caissons of every building or structure in Seismic
Zones 2, 3, and 4 shall be interconnected by ties at approximately right angles, unless it can be
demonstrated that equivalent restraint can be provided by frictional and passive soil resistance or other
approved methods. The design of the piles or ties shall carry the induced lateral forces, with a minimum
horizontal force equal to 0.10ZI times the vertical loading on the pile cap or caisson.
8.8.13.11.5 Braced frames: In braced frames, connections shall be designed to develop the full capacity
of the members or shall be based on the forces specified in Section 8.8.13.9.5 without the one-third
increase usually permitted for stresses resulting from earthquake forces.
[Page 255]
8.8.13.12 Nonseismic-resisting structural members: In Seismic Zones 3 and 4, and for buildings with
an importance factor I greater than 1.0 located in Seismic Zone 2, all framing elements not required by
design to be part of the lateral force-resisting system shall be investigated and shown to be adequate for
vertical load-carrying capacity and induced moment due to 3/K times the distortions resulting from the
code-required lateral forces. The rigidity of other elements shall be considered in accordance with Section
8.8.13.5.4.
8.8.13.13 Moment-resisting frames: Where ordinary and special moment-resisting space frames are
enclosed by, or adjoining by, more rigid elements that would tend to prevent the space frame from
resisting lateral forces, substantiating information shall be submitted to show that the action or failure of
the more rigid elements will not impair the vertical and lateral load-resisting ability of the space frame.
8.8.13.14 Essential facilities: The design and detailing of equipment that must remain in place and be
functional following a major earthquake shall be based on the requirements of Section 8.8.13.10 and
Table 24.13.10. In addition, their design and detailing shall consider effects induced by structure drifts of
not less than 2.0/K times the storey drift caused by required seismic forces. Special consideration shall
also be given to relative movements at separation joints.
8.8.15.1 Permissible reduction: Except as otherwise indicated in Section 8.8.15.2, the minimum
required design live load for members having an influence area of 37.20m2 or more shall be reduced in
accordance with the following equations:
L = Lo (0.25 +15) where:
/--Ai
L = reduced design live load in KN/m2.
Lo = unreduced design live load in KN/m2 from Table 8.6.1.
Ai = influence area in square metres, taken as four times the tributary area for a column, two times the
tributary area for a beam, and the panel area for a two-way slab.
[Page 256]
8.8.15.2 Limitations: The provisions of Section 8.8.15.2.1 through to 8.8.15.2.3 shall limit the
applications of live load reductions permitted by this section.
8.8.15.2.1 Maximum reduction: The reduced design live load permitted by Section 8.8.15.0 shall not be
less than 50 percent of the unreduced live load for members supporting one floor and not less than 40
percent of the unreduced live load for members supporting more than one floor.
8.8.15.2.2 Live loads 5 KN/m2 or less: For live loads of 5 KN/m2 or less, reduction shall not be made
for buildings or portions thereof of Use Groups A and E, for public garages or open parking structures
(except as indicated in Section 8.8.15.2.3), for one-way slabs or for roofs (except as indicated in Section
8.8.10).
8.8.15.2.3 Live loads greater than 5 KN/m2: For live loads which exceed 5 KN/m2 and for Group 2
public garages and open parking structures, minimum design live loads on members supporting more than
one floor shall be reduced by 20 percent.
8.9.1 Scope
The provisions of this article shall control the foundation design and construction of all buildings and
construction of all buildings and structures hereafter erected to ensure adequate strength of all parts
thereof for the safe support of all superimposed live and special loads, in addition to their own dead load,
without exceeding the allowable stresses or design capabilities.
8.9.2.1 Soil analysis: All applications for permits for the construction of new buildings or structures and
for the alteration of permanent structures which require changes in foundation loads and distribution shall
be accompanied by a statement describing the soil in the ultimate bearing strata, including sufficient
records and data to establish its character, nature and load bearing capacity. Such records shall be certified
by a registered structural engineer.
8.9.2.2 Satisfactory foundation materials: Satisfactory bearing materials for spread footings shall
include ledge rock on its natural bed; natural deposits of sand, gravel or firm clay, or a combination of
such materials, provided they do not provide an appreciable amount of peat, organic silt, soft clay or other
objectional materials.
8.9.2.3 Presumptive bearing values: The maximum allowable pressure on supporting soils under spread
footings at or near the surface shall not exceed the values specified in Table 25.1 or the maximum
allowable pressure shall be determined by field loading tests or as otherwise provided herein. Presumptive
bearing values shall apply to all materials of similar physical characteristics and deposition. Surface
values shall be adjusted for deep footings, and for the bearing strata under piles, as provided in this code.
Where foundation piles are driven to penetrate into sound rock, the maximum allowable bearing values in
Table 25.1 shall be increased as prescribed in Section 25.21.0.
8.9.2.4 Lightweight structures: Mud, organic silt, or unprepared fill shall be assumed not to have
presumptive bearing capacity unless approved by test, except where the bearing capacity is deemed
adequate by the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit for the support of lightweight and temporary
structures.
[Page 257]
TABLE 25.1
8.9.3.1 When required: In the absence of satisfactory data from immediate adjacent areas, the owner or
applicant shall make borings, test pits, or other soil investigations at such locations and to sufficient
depths of the bearing materials to the satisfaction of the Code official. For all buildings which are more
than one storey or 6m in height, and whenever it is proposed to use raft or any type of deep foundation,
there shall be at least one exploratory boring to rock or to an adequate depth below the load bearing strata
for every 200m2 of built-over area. If or any such additional test as the code enforcement officer requires
sustaining power of the soil is in doubt, or superior bearing value than specified in this code is claimed,
the code official shall direct that the necessary borings or tests be made.
8.9.3.2 Soil samples: Samples of the strata penetrated in tests boring or test pits, representing the natural
disposition and conditions at the site, shall be available for examination by the code official. Wash or
bucket samples shall not be approved.
8.9.3.3 Varying soil values: When test borings indicate non-uniformity of bearing materials, a sufficient
number of additional borings shall be made to establish strata levels of equal bearing capacity.
[Page 258]
8.9.3.4 Cost of tests: Costs of soil investigations shall be at the expense of the owner.
8.9.4.1 Soil test method: The test procedure and testing apparatus shall be approved by the Code official
before they are used; and a complete record of tests, together with a record of the soil profile, shall be
filed by a registered structural engineer.
8.9.4.2 Loaded areas: For spread footings, the soil shall be loaded at one or more places and at the
required levels. The loaded area shall be approximately 0.37m2 for all bearing materials; except that when
the footing overlies wet clay or other soft materials, the test load shall be applied to an area of not less
than 0.93m2.
8.9.4.3 Recorded settlements: Loads shall be applied in continuous increments of not more than
one-fourth of when the proposed safe loads has been reached, it shall remain undisturbed and readings
shall be recorded to determine the rate of settlement until the settlement in eight consecutive hours is less
than 0.25mm. A 50 percent excess load shall then be applied and allowed to remain in place until the rate
of settlement is less than 0.25mm in 24 hours.
8.9.4.4 Accuracy of loading: Test loads applied by mechanical devices shall be automatically controlled
so as to ensure not more than 5 percent variation in applied load. Such devices shall be calibrated prior to
the test.
8.9.4.5 Test acceptance: The load settlement shall be represented diagrammatically, and a test shall not
be deemed satisfactory if the net settlement after removal of the test load exceeds 0.00028mm/kg of gross
load applied.
8.9.5.1 General: The maximum allowable loads under all types of foundations shall be provided herein.
8.9.5.2 Rock foundations: Where sub-surface explorations at the project site indicate variations of
doubtful characteristics in the structure of the rock upon which it is proposed to construct foundations, a
sufficient number of borings shall be made to a depth of not less than below the level of the footings to
provide assurance of the soundness of the foundation bed and its bearing capacity.
8.9.5.3 Increased rock capacity: The maximum presumptive bearing capacity of Class 1 or 2 rock shall
be increased when the surface is leveled or benched; provided such increased safe capacity is determined
by load tests on an area of not less than 0.093m2 in accordance with the provisions of Section 12.3 but
such loads shall not be increased to exceed the unit compressive stress permitted on reinforced concrete
footings under the provisions of this Code.
8.9.6.1 Frost protection: Exception when erected upon solid rock or otherwise protected from frost,
foundation walls piers and other permanent supports of all buildings and structures larger than 9.30m2 in
area or 3048mm in height shall extend below the frost line of the locality, and spread footings of adequate
size shall be provided when necessary to properly distribute the load within the allowable bearing value
of the soil. Or such structures shall be supported on piles or ranging timbers when solid earth to rock is
not available. Footings shall not be founded on frozen soils unless such frozen condition is of a permanent
character.
[Page 259]
8.9.6.2 Isolated footings: Footings on granular soil of Classes 5 to 10 inclusive in Table 25.1 shall be so
located that the line drawn between the lower edges of adjoining footings shall not have a steeper slope
than 30 degrees (0.52rad.) with the horizontal, unless the material supporting the higher footing is braced
or retained or otherwise laterally supporting the higher footing is braced or retained or otherwise laterally
supported in an approved manner or a greater slope has been properly established by engineering
analysis.
8.9.6.3 Raft foundation: Raft Foundation shall be located on undisturbed soil of inadequate bearing
capacity. The Building Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit shall approve a continuous foundation
of raft which is located directly on the ground when adequate subsoil drainage and a rat proof apron are
provided where subject to freezing, the footings shall be designed to resist frost action.
8.9.7.1 Design loads: The full dead load including the weight of foundations, footings, and overlying
fill, and a rat proof apron as specified in the relevant engineering code of practice shall be used in
designing footings.
8.9.7.2 Pressure due to lateral loads: If the increased pressure on any footings due to wind, earthquake
or other lateral loads does not exceed one-third of the dead and live load pressures alone, such loads are
not required to be considered in the design. When such increased pressure is more than one-third, the
lateral loads shall be considered in the design with a one-third increase in allowable soil pressure under
the combined load.
8.9.7.3 Earthquake loads: In localities subject to seismic disturbances, special provision shall be made
in the foundation design to comply with the provisions of Section 8.8.13.
8.9.7.4 Vibration loads: Where machinery operation or other vibrations are transmitted through the
foundation, consideration shall be given in the footing design to prevent detrimental disturbances of the
soil.
8.9.7.5 Varying unit pressure: Footings shall be so designed that the unit soil pressure under the dead
load shall be as uniform as possible under all parts of the building or structure. When necessary for
stability in the structure due to settlement or varying soil conditions, approved variations are permitted in
the unit pressure under different footings.
8.9.8.1 Timber footings: Timber footings are permitted for buildings of Type 5 construction and as
otherwise approved. Such footings shall be treated in accordance with AWPA C2 or C3 listed in Schedule
A. Treated timbers are not required when placed entirely below permanent water level, or when used as
capping for wood piles which project above the water level over submerged or marsh lands. The
compressive stresses perpendicular to grain in untreated timber footings supported upon piles shall not
exceed 70 percent of the allowable stresses for the species and grade of timber as specified in the NFoPA
National Design Specification for Wood Construction listed in Schedule A.
8.9.8.2 Pole building: Pole-type buildings shall be designed and erected in accordance with AWPI Pole
Building Design listed in Schedule A. The poles shall be treated in accordance with AWPA C2 or C4
listed in Schedule A.
[Page 260]
8.9.8.3 Wood foundations: Wood foundation systems shall be designed and installed in accordance with
NFoPA TR7 listed in Schedule A. All lumber and plywood shall be treated in accordance with
AWPB-FDN listed in Schedule A and shall be identified as to conformance with such standards by an
approved agency.
8.9.9.1 General: All steel grillage beams shall be separated with approved steel spacers and shall be
entirely encased in at least 75mm of concrete and the spaces between the beams shall be completely filled
with concrete or cement grout. When used on yielding soils, steel grillages shall rest on approved
concrete beds not less than 150mm thick.
8.9.10.1 Concrete strength: Concrete in footings shall have a specified compressive strength of not less
than 1.76 kg/mm2 at 28 days.
8.9.10.2 Design: Concrete footings shall comply with BS8110 (1985) listed in Schedule A.
8.9.10.3 Thickness: The thickness of concrete footings shall comply with Section 8.9.9.3.1 and 8.9.9.3.2.
8.9.10.3.1 Plain concrete: In plain concrete footings, the edge thickness shall be not less than 200mm
for footings on soil; except that for buildings of Use Group H-3 and buildings less than two stories in
height of Type 5 construction, the required edge thickness shall be reduced to 150mm provided the
footing does not extend beyond 100mm on either side of the supported wall.
8.9.10.3.2 Reinforced concrete: In reinforced concrete footings, the thickness above the bottom
reinforcement shall not be less than 150mm for footings on soil, nor less than 300mm for footings on
piles. The clear cover on reinforcement where the concrete is cast against the earth shall not be less than
75mm. Where concrete is exposed to soil after it has been cast, the clear cover shall not be less than
38mm for reinforcement of No.5 bars or 16mm diameter wire or smaller, nor less than 50mm for larger
reinforcement.
8.9.10.4 Deposition: Concrete footings shall not be poured through water unless otherwise approved.
When poured under or in the presence of water, the concrete shall be deposited by approved means which
ensure minimum segregation of the mix and negligible turbulence of the water.
8.9.10.5 Protection of concrete: Concrete footings shall be protected from freezing during depositing
and for a period of not less than 5 days thereafter. Water shall not be allowed to flow through the
deposited concrete.
8.9.10.6 Forming of concrete: Concrete footings shall not be cast against the earth where, in the opinion
of the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit, soil conditions warrant forming. When form work is
required, it shall be in accordance with BS 8110 318 listed in Schedule A.
8.9.11.1 Dimensions: Masonry unit footings shall be laid in accordance with BS 5628, and the depth
shall be not less than twice the projection beyond the wall, pier or column. The width shall be not less
than 200mm wider than the wall supported thereon.
[Page 261]
8.9.11.2 Offsets: The maximum offset of each course in brick foundations walls stepped up from the
footings shall be 38mm if laid in single courses, and 75mm if laid in double courses.
8.9.12.1 General: Mat, raft and float foundations shall be used only when the applied loads of the
building or structure are so arranged as to result in practically uniformly balanced loading, and the soil
immediately below the mat is of uniform bearing capacity. The characteristics of the soil under the mat or
raft shall be considered in the analysis of loading on mats and other continuous footings, and due
allowance shall be made for possible concentrated soil pressures under heavily loaded columns.
8.9.13.1 Lateral dimensions and height: Except for buildings of Use Group H-3 and other light
structures, the minimum dimension of isolated piers used as foundations shall be 600mm, and the height
shall not exceed 12 times the least horizontal dimension, unless constructed of reinforced concrete or
structural steel, or when entirely encased in steel shell at least 6mm thick. Approved heights greater than
herein specified are permitted when surrounding foundation materials furnish adequate lateral support.
8.9.13.2 Belled bottoms: Where pier foundations are belled at the bottom, the edge thickness of the bell
shall be not less than that required for the edge of footings. If the sides of the bells slope at an angle less
than 60 degrees (1.05 Rad.) from the horizontal, the effects of vertical shear shall be considered.
8.9.13.3 Plain concrete: Where the unsupported height of foundations piers exceeds six times the least
dimension, the allowable working stress on piers of unit masonry or plain concrete shall be reduced in
accordance with BS 8110 listed in Schedule A.
8.9.13.4 Reinforced concrete: Where constructed of reinforced concrete, spiral or vertical reinforcement
in foundation piers shall conform to BS 8110 listed in Schedule A. When adequate lateral supports is
furnished by the surrounding materials as defined in Section 8.9.14 requirements for long columns shall
be waived.
8.9.13.5 Steel shell: Where concrete piers are entirely encased with a circular steel shell, and the area of
the shell steel is considered as reinforcing steel, the steel shall be protected under the conditions specified
in Section 8.9.14. All horizontal joints in the shell shall be spliced to comply with Section 8.9.14.
8.9.13.6 Dewatering: Where piers are carried to depths below water level, the piers shall be constructed
by a method which will insure accurate preparation and inspection of the bottom, and the depositing or
construction of sound concrete or other masonry in the dry.
8.9.14.1 Investigations: Pile foundations shall be designed and installed on the basis of a foundation
investigation and report which shall include borings, test pits or other sub-surface exploration at locations
and depths sufficient to determine the position and adequacy of the bearing soils, except where sufficient
data upon which to base the design and installation is available. The investigation and report shall
include, but not be limited to, the following:
1. Recommended pile types and installed capacities.
[Page 262]
2. Driving criteria.
3. Installation and field inspection procedures.
4. Pile load test requirements.
5. Durability of pile materials.
6. Designation of bearing stratum or strata.
8.9.14.2 Special types of piles: The use of types of piles not specifically mentioned herein is permitted,
subject to approval, upon the submission of acceptable test data, calculations and other information
relating to the structural properties and load capacity of such piles. The allowable stresses shall not in any
case exceed the limitations specified herein.
8.9.14.3 Protection of pile materials: Where boring records or site conditions indicate possible
deleterious action on pile materials because of soil constituents, changing water levels or other factors, the
pile materials shall be adequately protected by approved materials, methods or processes. Protective
materials shall be applied to the piles so as not to be rendered ineffective by driving.
8.9.14.4 Lateral support: Any soil other than fluid soil shall be deemed to afford sufficient lateral
support to the pile to prevent buckling and to permit the design of the pile in accordance with the
applicable provisions of this code. All piles standing unbraced in air, water or soils not capable of
providing lateral support shall be designed as columns in accordance with the provisions of this code.
8.9.14.5 Group action: In cohesive soils, the compressive load capacity of a group of friction piles shall
be analyzed by an approved, relational method and, where such analysis indicates, the individual
allowable pile loading shall be reduced accordingly.
8.9.14.6 Stability: All piles shall be braced to provide lateral stability in all directions. Three or more
piles connected by a rigid cap shall be considered as being braced, provided that the piles are located in a
radial direction from the centroid of the group, not less than 60 degrees (1.5 Rad.) apart. A two-pile group
in a rigid cap shall be considered to be braced along the axis connecting the two piles. Methods used to
brace piles shall be subject to approval of a registered structural engineer.
Piles supporting walls shall be driven alternately in lines at least 30mm apart and located symmetrically
under the center of gravity of the wall load carried, unless effective measures are taken to provide for
eccentricity and lateral forces, or the wall piles are adequately braced to provide for lateral stability.
Where a single row of piles without lateral bracing is used for buildings of Use Group H-3 or for
lightweight construction not exceeding two storeys or 105mm in height, the centers of the piles shall be
located within the width of the foundation wall.
8.9.14.7 Structural integrity: Piles shall be installed in such a manner and sequences as to prevent
distortion or damage to piles being installed or already in place, to extent that such distortion or damage
affects the structural integrity of the piles.
8.9.14.8 Spacing: The minimum center-to-center spacing of piles shall be not less than twice the average
diameter of a round pile, nor less than one and three-quarters times the diagonal dimension of a
rectangular pile. When driven to or penetrating in to rock, the spacing shall be not less than 600mm.
When receiving principal support from end bearing on materials other than rock, through friction
resistance, the spacing shall [Page 263] be not less than 750mm except that for piles having enlarged
bases formed either by compacting concrete or driving a precast base the minimum center-to-center
spacing shall be 1372mm. The spacing of piles shall be such that the average load on the supporting strata
will not exceed the safe bearing value of those strata as determined by test borings or other approved
methods.
8.9.14.9 Splices: Splices shall be constructed so as to provide and maintain true alignment and position
of the component parts of the pile during installation and subsequent thereto and shall be of adequate
strength to transmit the vertical and lateral loads and moments occurring at the location of the splice
during driving and under service loading. Splices shall develop not less than 50 percent of the least value
of the pile in bending. In addition, all pile splices occurring in the upper 3000mm of the embedded
portion of the pile shall be capable of resisting at allowable working stresses the moment and shear that
would result from an assumed eccentricity of the pile load of 75mm or the pile shall be braced in
accordance with Section 8.9.14.6 to other piles that do not have splices in the upper 3000mm of
embedment.
8.9.14.10 Pile caps: Pile caps shall be of reinforced concrete. The soil immediately below the pile cap
shall not be considered as carrying any vertical load. The tops of all piles shall be embedded not less than
75mm into pile caps and the caps shall extend at least 100mm beyond the edges of all piles. The tops of
all piles shall be cut back to sound materials and allowance for reinforcement anchorage made before
capping.
8.9.14.11 Pre-excavation: The use of jetting, auguring or other methods of pre-excavation shall be
subject to approval by a registered structural engineer. Where approved, pre-excavation shall be carried
out in the same manner as used or for piles subject to load tests and in such a manner that will not impair
the carrying capacity of the piles already in place or damage adjacent structures. Pile tips shall be driven
below the pre-excavated depth until the required resistance or penetration is obtained.
8.9.14.12 Inspection: An approved, qualified inspector shall be present when pile foundations are being
installed or during a test. The inspector shall make and submit to the code official detailed records of the
installation of each pile and the results of load tests. Records shall include the cut off and tip elevation of
each pile relative to a permanent reference.
8.9.14.13 Identification: All pile materials shall be identified for conformity to the specified grade with
this identification maintained continuously from the point of manufacture to the point of installation or
shall be tested by an approved agency to determine conformity to the specified grade and the approved
agency shall furnish an affidavit of compliance to the code enforcement officer.
8.9.14.14 Pile location plan: A plan showing the location and designation of all piles by an
identification system shall be filed with the code official prior to installation of such piles. All detailed
records for individual piles shall bear an identification corresponding to that shown on the plan.
8.9.14.15 Use of existing piles: Piles left in place where a structure has been demolished shall not be
used for the support of new construction unless satisfactory evidence is submitted to the code official
indicating that the piles are sound and meet all the requirements of this code. Such piles shall be loaded
and tested or redriven to verify their capacities. The design load applied to such piles shall be the lowest
allowable load as determined by tests or redriving data.
[Page 264]
8.9.14.16 Pile driveability: Pile cross sections shall be of sufficient size and strength to withstand
driving stresses without damage to the pile, and to provide sufficient stiffness to transmit the required
driving forces.
8.9.14.17 Heaved piles: All piles that have heaved during the driving of adjacent piles shall be redriven
as necessary to develop the required capacity and penetration, or the capacity of the pile shall be verified
by load tests in accordance with Section 8.9.15.4.
8.9.14.18 Settlement analysis: The settlement of individual piles or groups of piles shall be estimated
based upon approved methods of analysis. The predicted settlement shall not cause harmful distortion of,
or instability in, the structure, nor shall it lead to any stresses exceeding allowable values.
8.9.14.19 Use of vibratory drivers: Vibratory drivers shall only be used to install piles where the pile
load capacity is verified by load tests in accordance with Section 8.9.15.4. The installation of production
piles shall be controlled according to power consumption and rate of penetration, or other approved
means that assure pile capacities equal or exceeding that of test piles.
8.9.14.20 Installation sequence: Piles shall be installed in such a sequence to avoid compacting the
surroundings soil to the extent that other piles cannot be installed properly, and to prevent ground
movements that could damage adjacent structures.
8.9.15.1 Determination of allowable loads: The allowable axial and lateral loads on piles shall be
determined by an approved formula, test or method of analysis.
8.9.15.2 Piles in subsiding areas: Where piles are driven through subsiding fills or other subsiding strata
and drive support from underlying firmer materials, the downward friction forces which are imposed on
the piles by the subsiding upper strata shall be included in the design.
8.9.15.3 Driving formula: The allowable compressive load on any pile when determined by the
application of an approved driving formula shall not exceed 36287kg. The formula load shall be
determined for gravity drop or power-actuated hammer energy used shall be the maximum consistent with
the size, strength and weight of the driven piles. The use of a follower shall be permitted only when
approved. The introduction of fresh hammer cushion or pile cushion material just prior to final
penetration shall not be permitted.
8.9.15.4 Load tests: When greater compressive loads per pile than permitted by Section 8.9.15.3 are
desired or when the design load for any pile foundation is in doubt, control test piles shall be tested in
accordance with ASTMD1143 listed in Schedule A. At least one pile shall be test loaded in each area of
uniform subsoil conditions. When required by the code official, additional piles shall be load tested if
necessary to establish the safe design capacity. The resulting allowable loads shall be not more than
one-half of that test load which produces a permanent net settlement of not more than 0.000028mm/kg of
test load, and not more than 19mm. In subsequent driving of the balance of foundation piles, all piles shall
be deemed to have a supporting capacity equal to the control pile when such piles are of same or
comparable methods and equipment as the test pile, are installed in similar subsoil conditions as the test
pile, and when the rate of penetration of such piles is equal to or less than that of the test pile through a
comparable driving distance.
[Page 265]
8.9.15.5 Use of higher allowable stresses: Allowable stresses greater than those specified for each pile
type in this article shall be permitted when supporting data justifying such higher stresses are filed with
the code official. Such substantiating data shall include a foundation investigation in accordance with
Section 8.9.14.1 and pile load tests in accordance with Section 8.9.15.4, regardless of the load supported
by the pile. The design and installation of the pile foundation shall be under the direct supervision of a
registered professional engineer knowledgeable in the field of soil mechanics and pile foundations, who
shall certify to the code official that the piles as installed satisfy the design criteria.
8.9.15.6 Allowable lateral load: When required by the design, the lateral load capacity of a single pile
or a pile group shall be determined by an approved method of analysis or by lateral load tests to at least
twice the proposed design working load. The resulting allowable load shall be not more than one-half of
that test load which produces a gross lateral movement of 25mm at the ground surface.
8.9.15.7 Uplift capacity: When required by the design, the uplift capacity of a single pile shall be
determined in accordance with relevant BS COP listed in Schedule B or an approved method of analysis
based upon a minimum safety factor of three. The maximum allowable uplift load shall be one-half that
load which produces an upward movement of the pile but equal to the gross elastic extension of the pile
plus 3mm. For pile groups subjected to uplift, the allowable working uplift load for the group shall be the
lesser of the proposed individual pile uplift working load times the number of piles in the group, or
two-thirds of the effective weight of the pile group and the soil contained within a block defined by the
perimeter of the group and the length of the pile.
8.9.15.8 Bearing capacity: Individual piles and groups of piles shall develop ultimate load capacities of
at least twice the design working loads in the designated bearing layers. Analysis shall show that the soil
layer underlying the designated bearing layers does not cause the bearing capacity safety factor to be less
than two.
8.9.15.9 Bent piles: The load carrying capacity of piles discovered to have a shaft or sweeping bend shall
be determined by an approved method of analysis or by load testing a representative pile.
8.9.15.10 Overloads on piles: The maximum compressive load on any pile due to mislocation shall not
exceed 110 percent of the allowable design load
8.9.16.1 Materials: Structural steel piles, steel pipe and fully-welded steel piles fabricated from plates
shall conform to ASTM A36, A252, A283, A572 or A588 listed in Schedule A.
8.9.16.2 Allowable stresses: The allowable design compressive stresses shall not exceed 0.33 of the
minimum specified yield strength of the steel, except that maximum allowable design stresses shall be
0.50 of the minimum specified yield strength of steel where substantiated by Section 8.9.15.5.
8.9.16.3 Dimensions of H-piles: Sections of H-piles shall comply with the criteria of Section 25.15.3.3.
8.9.16.3.1 Flanges: The flange projections shall not exceed 14 times the minimum thickness of metal in
either the flange or the web, and the flange widths shall be not less than 80 percent of the depth of the
section.
[Page 266]
8.9.16.3.2 Depth: The nominal depth of the direction of the web shall be not less than 100mm.
8.9.16.3.3 Thickness: Flanges and web shall have a minimum nominal thickness of 10mm.
8.9.16.3.4 Dimensions of steel pipe piles: Steel pipe piles driven open-ended shall have a nominal
outside diameter of not less than 250mm and a minimum wall thickness of not less than 6mm for
diameters less than 356mm, and not less than 10mm for diameters 356mm and over. Where pipe of less
wall thickness is driven open-ended, a suitable cutting shoe shall be provided.
8.9.17.1 Materials: Steel pipe and tube piles shall conform to ASTM A252 or A282 listed in Schedule
A. Concrete shall conform to Section 8.9.17.1.1 maximum size coarse aggregate shall be 19mm.
8.9.17.2 Allowable stresses: The allowable design compressive stresses in the concrete shall not exceed
0.33 of the 28-day specified compressive strength (fcu). The allowable design compressive stress in the
steel shall not exceed 0.35 of the minimum specified yield strength of the steel, except that the maximum
allowable design compressive stress shall be 0.50 of the minimum specified yield strength of the steel
where substantiated by Section 8.9.14.5.
8.9.17.3 Minimum dimensions: Piles shall have a nominal outside diameter of not less than 100mm and
a minimum wall thickness in accordance with Section 8.9.15.4. For mandrel-driven pipe piles, the
minimum wall thickness shall be 3mm.
8.9.17.4 Reinforcement: Reinforcement steel shall conform to Section 8.9.17.1.2 Reinforcement shall
not be placed within 25mm of the steel casing.
8.9.17.5 Placing concrete: Placing of concrete shall conform to Section 8.9.17.1.3.
8.9.18.1 General: The materials, The materials, reinforcement and installation of cash-in-place concrete
piles shall conform to Sections 8.9.17.1.1 through to 8.9.17.1.3.
8.9.18.1.1 Material: All concrete shall have a 28-day specified compressive strength (fcu) of not less
than 21NKmm2. When concrete is placed through a funnel hopper at the top of the pile, the concrete mix
shall be designed and proportioned so as to produce a cohesive workable mix having a slump of not less
than 102mm and not more than 150mm. If concrete is to be pumped, the mix design including slump shall
be adjusted to produce a pumpable concrete.
8.9.18.1.2 Reinforcement: Except for steel dowels embedded 1500mm or less in the pile and as
provided in Section 8.9.18.2 reinforcement when required shall assembled and tied together and shall be
placed in the pile as a unit before the reinforced portion of the pile is filled with concrete.
8.9.18.1.3 Installation: Concrete shall be placed in such a manner as to insure the exclusion of any
foreign matter and to secure a full-sized shaft. Concrete shall not be placed through water except when
tremie methods are approved. When depositing concrete from the top of the pile, the concrete shall not be
chuted directly into the pile but shall be poured in a rapid and continuous operation through a funnel
hopper centered at the top of the pile.
[Page 267]
8.9.18.2 Drilled or augured uncased piles: Drilling or augured uncased piles shall conform to Section
8.9.17.2.1 through to 8.9.17.2.4.
8.9.18.2.1 Allowable stresses: The allowable design stress in the concrete of drilled uncased piles shall
not exceed 33 percent of the 28-day specified compressive strength (cu). The allowable design stress in
the concrete of augured cast in place piles shall not exceed 25 percent of the 28-day specified
compressive strength (fcu).
8.9.18.2.2 Dimensions: The pile length shall not exceed 30 times the average diameter. The minimum
diameter shall be 300mm.
8.9.18.2.3 Installation: If pile shafts are formed through unstable soils and concrete is placed in an open
drilled hole, a steel liner, shall be inserted in the hole prior to placing concrete. If the steel liner is
withdrawn during concreting, the level of concrete shall be maintained above the bottom of the liner at a
sufficient height of any hydrostatic or lateral soil pressure.
If concrete is placed by pumping through a hollow-stem auger, the auger shall not be permitted to rotate
during withdrawal and shall be withdrawn in a steady continuous motion. Concreting pumping pressures
shall be measured and shall be maintained high enough at all times to offset hydrostatic and lateral earth
pressures. Concrete volumes shall be measured to ensure that the volume of concrete placed in each pile
is equal to or greater than the theoretical volume of the hole created by the auger. If the installation
process of any pile is interrupted or a loss of concreting pressure occurs, the pile shall be redrilled to
original depth and reformed. Augured cast-in-place piles shall not be installed within six pile diameters
center-to-center of a pile filled with concrete less than 24 hours old unless approved. If the concrete level
in any completed pile drops, the pile shall be rejected and replaced.
8.9.18.2.4 Reinforcement: For piles installed with a hollow-stemauger, where longitudinal steel
reinforcement is placed without lateral ties, the reinforcement shall be placed through ducts in the auger
prior to filling the pile with concrete.
All pile reinforcement shall have a concrete cover of not less than 64mm.
8.9.18.3 Driven uncased piles: Driven uncased piles shall conform to Section 8.9.17.3.1 through to
8.9.17.3.4.
8.9.18.3.1 Allowable stress: The allowable design stress in the concrete shall not exceed 25 percent of
the 28-day specified compressive strength (fcu) applied to a cross-sectional area not greater than the
inside area of the drive casing or mandrel.
8.9.18.3.2 Dimensions: The pile length shall not exceed 30 times the average diameter. The minimum
diameter shall be 300mm.
8.9.18.3.3 Installation: Piles shall not be driven within six pile diameters center-to-center in granular
soils or within one-half the pile length in cohesive soils of a pile filled within concrete less than 48 hours
old, unless approved. If the concrete surface in any complete pile ties or drops, the pile shall be rejected
and replaced. Piles shall not he installed in soils which could cause pile heave.
8.9.18.3.4 Concrete cover: All pile reinforcement shall have a concrete cover of not less than 64mm,
measured from the inside face of the drive casing of mandrel.
8.9.18.3.5 Enlarged base piles: Enlarged base piles shall conform to Section 8.9.17.4.1 through
8.9.17.4.5.
[Page 268]
8.9.18.3.6 Materials: The maximum size for coarse aggregate for all concrete shall be 19mm compacted
concrete shall have a zero slump.
8.9.18.3.7 Allowable stress: The maximum allowable design compressive stress for concrete not placed
in permanent steel casing shall be 25 percent of the 28-day specified compressive strength (fcu) where the
concrete is placed in a permanent steel casing all the maximum allowable concrete stress shall be 33
percent of the 28-day specified compressive strength (fcu).
8.9.18.3.8 Installation: Enlarged bases formed either by compacting concrete or driving a precast base
shall be formed in a driven into granular soils. All piles shall be constructed in the same manner as
successful prototype test piles driven for the project. Pile shafts extending through peat or other organic
soil shall be encased in a permanent steel casing. If a cased shaft is used, it shall be adequately reinforced
to resist column action or the annular space around the pile shaft shall be filled sufficiently to restable the
lateral support of the soil. If pile heave occurs, the pile shall be rejected unless it can be demonstrated that
the pile is undamaged and capable of carrying twice its design load.
8.9.18.3.9 Bearing capacity: Pile bearing capacity shall be verified by load tests in accordance with
Section 8.9.14.4.
8.9.18.3.10 Concrete cover: The minimum concrete cover shall be 64mm for uncased shafts and 25mm
for case shafts.
8.9.18.4 Steel cased piles: Steel cased piles shall comply with Section 8.9.18.4.1 through 8.9.17.5.4.
8.9.18.4.1 Material: Pile shells or casings shall be made of steel and shall be sufficiently strong to resist
collapse and sufficiently water-tight to exclude any foreign materials during the placing of concrete. Steel
shells shall have a sealed tip with a diameter of not less that 203mm.
8.9.18.4.2 Allowable stress: The allowable design compressive stress in the concrete shall not exceed 33
percent of the 28-day specified compressive strength (fcu). The allowable concrete compressive stress
shall be 0.40 (fcu) for that portion of the pile meeting the conditions specified in Section 8.9.17.5.2.1
through 8.9.17.5.2.4.
8.9.18.4.2.1 Thickness: The thickness of the steel shell is not less than No. 14 gauge 0.17mm minimum.
8.9.18.4.2.2 Shell type: The shell is seamless or is provided with seams of strength equal to the basic
material and is of a configuration which will provide confinement to the cast in place concrete.
8.9.18.4.2.3 Strength: The ratio of steel yield strength (fcu) to design shall be not less than 6.
8.9.18.4.2.4 Diameter: The nominal pile diameter is not greater than 16 inches.
8.9.18.4.3 Installation: Piles shall have steel shells, mandrel-driven their full length in contact with the
surrounding soil, left permanently in place and filled with concrete. A pile shall not be driven within four
and one-half average pile diameters of a pile filled with concrete less than 24 hours old unless approved.
Concrete shall not be placed in steel shells within heave range of driving.
[Page 269]
8.9.18.4.4 Reinforcement: Reinforcement shall not be placed within 25mm of the steel shell.
Reinforcing shall be considered necessary only for unsupported pile lengths or when the pile is designed
to resist uplift or unbalanced lateral loads.
8.9.19.1 Design and manufacture: All piles shall be designed and manufactured in accordance with
accepted practice, and to resist all stresses induced by handling, driving and service loads. The minimum
lateral dimension shall be 250mm. All corners of square piles shall be chamfered. Longitudinal steel shall
be arranged in a symmetrical pattern and shall be laterally tied with steel ties or wire spiral spaced not
more than 75mm apart, center-to-center, for a distance of 600mm from the ends of the pile; and not more
than 150mm elsewhere except that at the ends of each pile the first five ties or spirals shall be spaced
25mm center-to-center.
8.9.19.1.1 Installation: All piles shall be handled and driven so as not to cause injury or overstressing
which will affect their durability or strength.
8.9.19.2 Reinforced piles: Reinforced precast concrete piles shall conform to Section 8.9.18.2.1 through
to 8.9.18.2.5.
8.9.19.2.1 Design: The minimum amount of longitudinal reinforcement shall be 2 percent of the concrete
section and shall consist of at least four bars.
8.9.19.2.2 Material: All concrete shall have a 28-day specified compressive strength (fcu) of not less
than 2.81kg/mm2.
8.9.19.2.3 Allowable stress: The allowable compressive stress in the concrete shall not exceed 33
percent of the 28-day specified compressive strength (fcu) applied to the gross cross-sectional area of the
pile.
8.9.19.2.4 Concrete cover: All pile reinforcement shall have a concrete cover of not less than 50mm
except that piles exposed to sea water shall have a minimum protective concrete cover of 75mm.
8.9.19.2.5 Installation: A precast concrete pile shall not be driven before the concrete has attained a
compressive strength of at least 2.11kg/mm2, but not less than such strength sufficient to withstand
handling and driving forces.
8.9.19.3 Pre-stressed piles: Pre-stressed concrete piles shall conform to Section 8.9.18.3.1 through
8.9.18.3.4.
8.9.19.3.1 Design: The effective pre-stress in the pile shall be not less than 5N/mm2.
8.9.19.3.2 Material: Pre-stressing steel shall conform to ASTM A416 listed in Schedule A. All-concrete
shall have a 28-day specified compressive strength (fcu) of not less than 40N/mm2.
8.9.19.3.3 Allowable stress: The maximum allowable design compressive stress (fcu) in concrete shall
be determined as follows: 0.33fcu-0.27fpc where fpc is the effective prestress on the gross area of pile
section.
8.9.19.3.4 Installation: A prestressed pile shall not be driven before the concrete has attained a
compressive strength of at least 2.81kg/mm2 but not less than such strength sufficient to withstand
handling and driving forces.
[Page 270]
8.9.20.1 Materials: Timber piles shall conform to ASTM D25 listed in Schedule A.
8.9.20.2 Preservative treatment: Timber piles used to support permanent structures shall be treated in
accordance with this section unless it is established that the tops of untreated timber piles will be below
lowest ground water level assumed to exist during the life of the structure. Preservative and minimum
final retention shall be in accordance with AWPA C3 listed in Schedule A. When timber piles are used in
salt water, the treatment shall conform to AWPB MP1, MP2 or MP4 listed in Schedule A. Pile cutoffs
shall be treated in accordance with AWPA M4 listed in Schedule A.
8.9.20.3 Allowable stresses: The allowable stresses for treated round timber piles shall not exceed those
set forth in Section 8.9.19.3 and as approved for in Sections 8.9.18.3.1 and 8.9.18.3.2.
8.9.20.3.1 Stress increase: The allowable unit stresses in compression parallel to grain shall be increased
by 0.2 percent for each 300mm of length from the tip of the pile to the critical section. The increase shall
not exceed 10 percent for any pile. The stress increase is cumulative with increase in section properties
due to pile taper.
8.9.20.3.2 Dried or untreated piles: The working stresses in Section 8.9.20.3 have been adjusted to
compensate for strength reductions due to conditioning prior to treatment. Where piles are air-dried or
kiln-dried prior to pressure treatment, or where untreated piles are to be used, the compression, bending
and shear stresses shall be increased by multiplying the tabulated values by a factor of 1.5:
TABLE 25.2
TABLE 25.19.3
ALLOWABLE UNIT STRESSES FOR TREATED ROUND TIMBER PILES, NORMAL LOAD
DURATION – VALUES AT TIP OF PILE
(see Section 25.19.3.2)
Species Compression Shear horiz. Comp. Modulus
Bending
parallel to psi perp. to of
psi
grain psi grain psi elasticity
Pacific coast
Douglas fir
(see Section 1,250 2,450 115 230 1,500,000
25.19.3.1)
Red oak – northan 1,250,000
and southern 1,100 2,450 135 350
Red pine (grown in 1,280,000
the United States) 900 1,900 85 155
Southern pine
longleave, slash,
loblolly and short
leave (see Section 1,500,000
25.19.3.1 1,200 2,400 110 250
8.9.21.1 Design: Composite piles consisting of two or more approved pile types shall be designed to
meet the conditions of installation.
8.9.21.2 Limitation of load: The maximum allowable load shall be limited by the capacity of the
weakest section incorporated in the pile.
8.9.21.3 Splices: Splices between concrete and steel or wood sections shall be designed to prevent
separation both before and after the concrete portion has set, and to ensure the alignment and transmission
of the total pile load. Splices shall be designed to resist uplift due to upheaval during driving of adjacent
piles, and shall develop the full compressive strength and not less than 50 percent of the tension and
bending strength of the weaker section.
8.9.22.1 Construction: Caisson piles shall consist of a shaft section of concrete-filled pipe extending to
bedrock with an uncased socket drilled into the bedrock and filled with concrete. The caisson pile shall
have a full-length structural steel core or a stub core installed in the rock socket and extending into the
pipe portion a distance equal to the socket depth.
8.9.22.2 Design: The depth of the rock socket shall be sufficient to develop the full load bearing capacity
of the caisson pile with a minimum safety factor of two, but the depth shall be not less than the outside
diameter of the pipe. The design of the rock [Page 272] socket is permitted to be predicated on the sum of
the allowable bearing pressure on the bottom of the socket plus bond along the sides of the socket. The
minimum outside diameter of the caisson pile shall be 45mm, and the diameter of the rock socket shall be
approximately equal to the inside diameter of the pile.
8.9.22.3 Material: Pipe and steel cores shall conform to the material requirements in Section 8.9.15.0.
Pipe shall have a minimum wall thickness of 10mm and shall be fitted with a suitable steel driving shoe
welded to the bottom of the pipe. All concrete shall have a 28-day specified compressive strength (pc) of
not less than 30N/mm2. The concrete mix shall be designed and proportioned so as to produce a cohesive
workable mix with a slump of from 100mm to 150mm.
8.9.22.4 Structural core: The gross cross-sectional area of the structural steel core shall not exceed 25
percent of the gross caisson section. The minimum clearance between the structural core and the pipe
shall be 50mm. If cores are to be spliced, the ends shall be milled or ground to provide full contact and
shall be full-depth welded.
8.9.22.5 Allowable stresses: The allowable design compressive stresses shall not exceed the following:
concrete, 0.33f’c, steel pipe, 0.35fy; structural steel core, 0.50fy.
8.9.22.6 Installation: The rock socket and pile shall be thoroughly cleaned of all foreign materials before
filling with concrete. Steel cores shall be bedded in cement grout at the base of the rock socket. Concrete
shall not be placed through water except when tremie methods are approved.
8.9.23.1 Design: Foundation walls shall be designed to resist forecast action and to support safely all
vertical and lateral loads as provided in Section 11. The maximum stresses due to combined loads shall be
within the values specified for the materials used in the construction. Unless properly reinforced, tensile
stresses shall not exceed those permitted in plain masonry.
8.9.23.2 Minimum thickness: The thickness of foundation walls shall be not less than the wall
supported, and the minimum thickness shall be limited for the various materials of construction as herein
specified. 200mm foundation walls shall be permitted under brick veneered frame and under 250mm
cavity walls when the total height of the wall supported, including gables, is not more than 6000 mm.
8.9.23.2.1 Reinforced concrete: When reinforced concrete is required to resist all stresses, foundation
walls shall be not less than 200mm thick.
8.9.23.2.2 Hollow and solid non-reinforced masonry and plain concrete: The thickness of
non-reinforced masonry foundation walls shall not be less than shown in Table 8.9.22.2.2 for the type of
foundation and superstructure construction used. The maximum depth below grade shall be increased up
to that indicated in parenthesis in Section 8.9.23.2.2 where such increase is warranted by soil conditions
and local experience, and is approved. Where height of unbalanced fill (height of finish grade above
basement floor or inside grade) exceeds 2134mm, foundation wall thickness shall be determined by
structural analysis as required in Section.8.9.24.2.
[Page 273]
TABLE 25.22.2.2
THICKNESS OF FOUNDATION WALLS
8.9.24.1 General: Walls built to retain or support the lateral pressure of earth or water or other
superimposed loads shall be designed and constructed of approved masonry, reinforced concrete, steel
sheet piling or other approved materials within the allowable stresses specified in this Code.
8.9.24.2 Design: Retaining walls shall be designed to resist the pressure of the retained material,
including both dead and live load surcharges to which they are subjected, and to ensure stability against
overturning, sliding, excessive foundation pressure and water uplift.
[Page 274]
8.9.24.3 Hydrostatic pressure: Unless drainage is provided, the hydrostatic head of water pressure shall
be assumed equal to the height of the wall.
8.9.24.4 Coping: All masonry retaining walls other than reinforced concrete walls shall be protected
with an approved coping.
8.9.24.5 Guardrails: Where retaining walls with a difference in grade level on either side of the wall in
excess of 1200mm are located closer than 600mm to a walk, path, parking lot or driveway on the high
side, such retaining walls shall be provided with a guardrail constructed in accordance with Section
10.27.17 or other approved protective measures.
8.9.25.1 Where required: Walls or portions thereof, retaining earth and enclosing interior spaces and
floors below grade shall be waterproofed and damp-proofed according to this section except those spaces
containing uses other than residential and institutional where such omission is not detrimental to the
building or occupancy.
8.9.25.1.1 Storey above ground level: Where a basement is considered a storey above ground level and
the ground level adjacent to the basement wall is below the floor elevation for not less than 25 percent of
the perimeter, the floor and walls shall be damproofed in accordance with Section 8.9.25.3 and a
foundation drain shall be installed in accordance with Section 8.9.25.3 The foundation drain shall be
installed around the portion of the perimeter where the basement floor is below ground level. The
provisions of Section 8.9.25.2, 8.9.25.4 and 8.9.25.1 shall not apply in this case.
8.9.25.1.2 Underfloor space: The finished ground level of an underfloor space such as a crawl space
shall not be located below the bottom of the footings. Where there is evidence that the ground water table
can rise to within 150mm of the ground level at the outside building perimeter or where there is evidence
that the surface water does not readily drain from the building site, the ground level of the underfloor
space shall be as high as the outside finished ground level, unless an approved drainage system is
provided. The provisions of Section 8.9.24.2, 8.9.24.3, 8.9.24.4, 8.9.24.5, and 8.9.24.6. shall not apply in
this case.
8.9.25.2 Ground water table investigation: The owner or applicant shall perform a sub-surface soil
investigation to determine the possibility of the ground water table rising above the proposed elevation of
the floor or floors below grade.
Exception: A subsurface soil investigation shall not be required when:
1. Waterproofing is to be provided.
2. Satisfactory data from adjacent areas is available which demonstrates that ground water has not
been a problem.
3. Floodproofing is to be provided in accordance with Section.
8.9.25.2.1 Ground water control: Where the ground water table is lowered and maintained at an
elevation not less than 150mm below the bottom of the lowest floor, the floor and walls shall be
damp-proofed in accordance with Section 8.9.25.3. The design of the system to lower the ground water
table shall be based upon accepted principles of engineering which shall consider, but not necessarily be
limited to: permeability of the soil, rate at which water enters the drainage system, rated capacity of
pumps, head against which pumps are to pump and the rated capacity of the disposal area of the system.
8.9.25.3 Damp-proofing required: Where hydrostatic pressure will not occur as determined by Section
8.9.25.2, floors and walls for other than wood foundation systems [Page 275] shall be damp-proofed in
accordance with this section. Wood foundation systems shall be constructed in accordance with NFoPA
TR7 listed in the Schedule.
8.9.25.3.1 Floor applications: The required damp-proofing materials shall be installed between the floor
and the base as provided by Section 8.9.14.5.1 except where floor is provided above a concrete slab.
8.9.25.3.2 Floor damp-proofing materials: Where installed beneath the slab, damp-proofing shall
consist of not less than 6-mil(.006 inch; 152mm) polyethylene with joints lapped not less than 150mm, or
other approved methods or materials. Where permitted to be installed on top of the slab, damp-proofing
shall consist of mopped-on bitumen, not less than 4-mil (.004 inch; 102mm) polyethylene, or other
approved methods or materials. Joints in the membrane shall be lapped and sealed in accordance with the
manufacturer’s recommendations.
8.9.25.3.2.1 Walls: Damp-proofing materials shall be installed on the exterior surface of walls, and shall
extend from the top of the footing to above ground level.
8.9.25.3.2.2 Surface preparation of walls: Prior to application of damproofing materials on concrete
walls, all holes and recesses resulting from the removal of form ties shall be sealed with a bituminous
material or other approved methods or materials. Unit masonry walls shall be parged on the exterior
surface below ground level with not less than 10mm of Portland cement mortar. The parging shall be
coved at the footing.
Exception: Parging of unit masonry walls is not required where a material is approved for direct
application to the masonry.
8.9.25.3.2.3 Wall damp-proofing materials: Damp-proofing shall consist of a bituminous material, any
of the materials permitted for waterproofing by Section 8.9.25.4.2.2, or other approved methods or
materials.
8.9.25.4 Waterproofing required: Where the ground water investigation required by Section 8.9.24.2
indicates that a hydrostatic pressure condition exits walls and floors shall be waterproofed in accordance
with the pressure to which they will be subjected.
8.9.25.4.1 Floors: Floors required to be waterproofed shall be of concrete, designed and constructed to
withstand the hydrostatic pressure of which they will be subjected.
8.9.25.4.1.1 Floor waterproofing materials: Waterproofing shall be accomplished by placing a
membrane of rubberised asphalt, butyl rubber, neoprene, or not less than 6-mil (0.006 inch; 152mm)
polyvinyl chloride or polyethylene with joints lapped not less than 150mm, or other approved materials
under the slab. Joints in the membrane shall be lapped and sealed in accordance with the manufacturer’s
recommendations.
8.9.25.4.2 Walls: Walls required to be waterproofed shall be of concrete or masonry designed and
constructed to withstand the hydrostatic pressure and other lateral loads to which they will be subjected.
8.9.25.4.2.1 Surface preparation of walls: Prior to the application of waterp-proofing materials on
concrete or masonry walls, the walls shall be prepared in accordance with Section 8.9.24.3.2.1.
8.9.25.4.2.2 Wall waterproofing materials: Waterproofing shall be applied from the bottom of the wall
to not less than 300mm above the maximum elevation of the ground water table. The remainder of the
wall shall be damp-proofed in accordance with Section 8.9.24.3.2.2. Waterproofing shall consist of
two-ply hot mopped felts, not less than [Page 276] 6-mil (006 inch; 152mm) polyvinyl chloride or other
approved methods or materials capable of bridging nonstructural cracks. Joints in the membrane shall be
lapped and sealed in accordance with the manufacturer’s recommendations.
8.9.25.4.3 Joints and penetrations: Joints in walls and floors, and between the wall and floor, and
penetrations of the wall and floor, shall be made water-tight utilising approved methods and materials.
8.9.25.5 Subsoil drainage system: Where a hydrostatic pressure condition does not exist,
damp-proofing shall be provided and a base shall be installed under the floor and a drain installed around
the foundation perimeter. A subsoil drainage system designed and constructed in accordance with Section
8.9.24.2.1 shall be deemed adequate for lowering the ground water table.
8.9.25.5.1 Floor base: Floors of basements except as provided in Section 8.9.24.4.1.1 shall be placed
over a base course not less than 100mm in thickness consisting of gravel or crushed stone containing not
more than 10 percent of material that passes a No. 4 sieve.
8.9.25.5.2 Foundation drain: A drain shall be placed around the perimeter of a foundation consisting of
gravel or crushed stone containing not more than 10 percent material that passes a No. 4 sieve. The drain
shall extend a minimum of 102mm beyond the outside edge of the footing. The thickness shall be such
that the invert level of the drain is not higher than the invert level of the base under the floor, and the top
of the drain is not less than 150mm above the top of the footing. The top of the drain shall be covered
with an approved filter membrane material. Where a drain tile or perforated pipe is used, the invert of the
pipe or tile shall be not higher than the floor elevation. The top of joints or the top of perforations shall be
protected with an approved filter membrane material. The pipe or tile shall be placed on not less than
50mm of gravel or crushed stone complying with Section 8.9.24.5.1 and covered with not less than
150mm of the same material.
8.9.25.5.3 Drainage disposal: The floor base and foundation perimeter drain shall discharge by gravity
or mechanical means into an approved drainage system complying with the plumbing code listed in the
Schedule.
Exception: Where a site is located in well-drained gravely or sand-gravel mixture soils, a dedicated
drainage system is not required.
8.9.25.6 Placement of backfill: The excavation outside the foundation shall be backfilled with soil
which is free of organic material, construction debris, and large rocks. The backfill shall be placed in lifts
and compacted in a manner which does not damage the waterproofing or damp-proofing material.
8.9.25.7 Site grading: The ground immediately adjacent to the foundation shall be sloped away from the
building at a slope of not less than one unit vertical in twelve units horizontal (1:12) for a minimum
distance of 2400mm measured perpendicular to the face of the wall or an approved alternate method of
diverting water away from the foundation shall be used. Consideration shall be given to possible
additional settlement of the backfill when establishing the final ground level adjacent to the foundation.
8.9.25.8 Erosion protection: Where water impacts the ground from the edge of the roof, downspout,
scupper, or other rain water collection or diversion device, provisions shall be made to prevent soil
erosion and direct the water away from the foundation.
Section 9
Service Engineering Design Requirements
Sections
9.1 Mechanical Engineering Design Requirements
9.1.1 Building Design Requirements
9.1.2 Special Building Design Requirements
9.1.3 Signage
9.1.4 Repairs, Alterations
9.1.5 Precautions During
9.1.6 Materials and Components
9.1.7 Fire
9.1.8 Mechanical Systems, Elevators, Conveyor Equipment and Dumbwaiters
9.1.8.1 General
9.1.8.2 Plans and Specifications
9.1.8.3 Inspections and Tests
9.1.8.4 Existing Buildings
9.1.8.5 Fees
9.1.8.6 Drying Rooms
9.1.8.7 Waste and Linen Handling Systems
9.1.8.8 Refuse Vaults
9.1.8.9 Duct, Stock and Refuse Conveyor Systems
9.1.8.10 Elevator, Dumbwaiter and Conveyor Equipment, Installation and
Maintenance
9.1.8.11 Plans, Specifications and Permits
9.1.8.12 Tests and Inspections
9.1.8.14 Certificate of Compliance
9.1.8.15 Maintenance and Accidents
9.1.8.16 Existing Installations
9.1.8.17 Power Elevator Operation
9.1.8.18 Hoistway Enclosures and Venting
9.1.8.19 Elevator and Dumbwaiter Machinery and Equipment
9.1.8.20 Machine Rooms and Related Construction for Passenger and Freight
Elevators and Dumbwaiter
9.1.8.21 Elevator Opening Protection
9.1.8.22 Elevator Car Emergency Signals Signs
9.1.8.23 Manlifts
y y
[Page 279]
9.1.3 Signage
The provisions of Sections 7.1, 7.2, 7.4, 7.5 and 7.6 of this Code shall apply to these sub-sections.
The provisions of Section 10.1 of this Code shall apply to this sub-section.
9.1.7 Fire
The provisions of Section 12.1 of this Code shall apply to this sub-section.
9.1.8.1 General
9.1.8.1.1 Scope: The provisions of this Section shall control the design installation, construction,
inspection and maintenance of all mechanical equipment and systems in respect to structural strength, fire
safety and operation.
9.1.8.1.2 Mechanical Code: All mechanical equipment and systems shall be con structed, installed and
maintained in accordance with the mechanical code.
9.1.8.2 Plans and Specifications
9.1.8.2.1 General: Plans and specifications for the installation repair, extension or removal of any
mechanical equipment or system shall be submitted in accordance with the mechanical code listed in the
Schedule, and a permit shall be secured prior to the commencement of any work.
9.1.8.2.2 Matter covered: The plans and specifications shall show in sufficient detail all pertinent
features and clearances of the appliances and systems, including: size and type of apparatus; construction
of flue, stack or chimney; stack connections; type of fuel; method of operation; and the method of
compliance with all regulations for the class and type of equipment installed.
9.1.8.2.3 Details: An application for permit shall be accompanied by specifications and diagrammatic
mechanical drawings in sufficient detail, and complying with the provisions of the mechanical code listed
in the Schedule, before a permit shall be issued for the mechanical equipment or system. The plans shall
be drawn to a scale of not less [Page 280] than 1:100, and shall show the location and arrangement of all
equipment and distribution elements including safety and pressure-controlling devices.
9.1.8.3 Inspections and Tests
9.1.8.3.1 Inspection: All mechanical equipment and systems requiring a permit shall be inspected in
accordance with the mechanical code and shall not be placed in operation until having been tested and
approved.
9.1.8.3.2 Concealment: It shall be unlawful for owners, contractors or workers to any way to conceal
any piping, outlet boxes or other parts of the mechanical equipment or system requiring a permit until an
inspection has been made thereof and due notice given that the work has been approved.
9.1.8.3.3 Defects and repairs: Upon inspection or reinspection of a mechanical system, any defects or
deficiencies which require repair to ensure safe operation shall be rectified before the system is placed in
use.
9.1.8.3.4 Power to deem unsafe: When a system or any part thereof is found unsafe to life or property, it
is shall be deemed unsafe and such system shall not be restored to use until it has been made safe and
approved.
9.1.8.4 Existing Buildings
9.1.8.4.1 Unsafe orders: All existing mechanical equipment and systems shall be maintained and
operated in accordance with the requirements of this Code. Any such equipment which does not comply
with the requirements, and the operation of which is deemed unsafe to the building occupants, shall be
altered as ordered by the code enforcement officer to secure safety.
9.1.8.5 Fees
9.1.8.5.1 General: A permit to begin work for new construction or alteration shall not be issued until the
prescribed application and permit fees have been paid, nor shall an amendment to a permit necessitating
an additional fee because of the additional work involved be issued until the additional fee has been paid.
9.1.8.6 Drying Rooms
9.1.8.6.1 General: A dry room or dry kiln installed within a building shall be constructed entirely of
approved non-combustible materials or assemblies of such materials with the required fire-resistance
rating based on the fire hazard of the contents and the process, as regulated by the approved rules or as
required in Section 7.2 for special uses.
9.1.8.6.2 Piping clearance: All overhead heating pipes shall have a clearance of not less than 50mm
from combustible contents of the dryer.
9.1.8.6.3 Insulation: When the operating temperature of the dryer is 79 degrees C or more, metal
enclosures shall be insulated from adjacent combustible materials by not less than 300mm of air space, or
the metal walls shall be lined with 6mm asbestos mill board or other approved equal insulation.
9.1.8.6.4 Fire protection: Drying rooms designed for high hazard materials and processes, including
special uses provided for in Section 8, shall be protected by an approved automatic fire suppression
system conforming to the provisions of Section 12.1.
[Page 281]
9.1.8.7 Waste And Linen Handling Systems
9.1.8.7.1 General: Waste and linen handling systems shall be installed in accordance with the relevant
standards as listed in the Schedule.
9.1.8.8 Refuse Vaults
9.1.8.8.1 Refuse vault enclosures: A vault for receiving combustible refuse from an exhaust system
shall be constructed of not less than 3-hour fire-resistance rated assemblies.
9.1.8.8.2 Openings to boiler rooms: The opening between a vault and a boiler room shall not exceed
0.84m2 in area and shall be located at least 2.4m from the firing door of the boiler, and the bottom of the
opening shall be not less than 150mm above the boiler room floor. All openings shall be equipped with
fire doors of not less than 11/2-hour fire-resistance rating complying with Section 12.3.18.
9.1.8.8.3 Location: When located within a building, a refuse vault shall extend above the roof or shall be
directly vented to the outer air with ducts complying with the mechanical code listed in the Schedule.
9.1.8.8.4 Fire protection: A vault for combustible refuse which exceeds 125m3 in volume shall be
protected by an approved automatic fire suppression system conforming to Section 12.1.
9.1.8.9 Duct, Stock and Refuse Conveyor Systems
9.1.8.9.1 Power transmission: Power for fans located in rooms from which flammable dust is being
removed shall be transmitted by means of a shaft passing through a bushed hole, or by a belt, chain or
similar driving mechanism which is encased in a metal or other noncombustible dust-tight enclosure, both
within and without the room.
9.1.8.9.2 Collectors and separators: Cyclone collectors and separators and their supports shall be
constructed of noncombustible materials and shall be located whenever possible on the exterior of the
building or structure. A collector or separator shall not be located nearer than 3m to combustible
construction or to an unprotected wall or floor opening, unless the collector is provided with a metal vent
pipe which extends above the highest part or any roof within a distance of 9m.
9.1.8.9.3 Discharge pipes: Discharge pipes shall conform to all the requirements for ducts, including
clearances required for high appliances, as contained in the mechanical code listed in the Schedule. A
delivery pipe from a cyclone collector shall not convey refuse directly into the firebox of a boiler,
furnace, dutch oven, refuse burner, incinerator or other appliance.
9.1.8.9.4 Vents for exhaust conveyor systems: An exhaust system shall be vented to the outside of the
building either directly by flue, or indirectly through the separator, bin, or vault into which it discharges.
9.1.8.9.5 Spark protection: The outlet of an open air vent shall be protected with an approved metal or
other non-combustible screen or by other equally efficient means to prevent the entry of sparks.
9.1.8.9.6 Explosion relief vents: A safety or explosion relief vent shall be provided on all systems which
convey combustible refuse or stock of an explosive nature, in accordance with the requirements of
Section 8.20.
[Page 282]
9.1.8.9.7 Screens: When a screen is used in a safety relief vent, it shall be so attached as to permit ready
release under emergency pressure.
9.1.8.9.8 Hoods: The relief vent shall be provided with an approved non-combustible cowl or hood, or
with a counterbalanced relief valve or cover arranged to prevent the escape of hazardous materials, gases
or liquids.
9.1.8.10 Elevator, Dumbwaiter and Conveyor Equipment, Installation and Maintenance
9.1.8.10.1 Scope: Except as otherwise provided by statute, the provisions of this Chapter shall control
the design, construction, installation, maintenance and operation of all elevator, dumbwaiters, escalators,
moving walks and special hoisting and conveying equipment hereafter operated, installed, relocated or
altered in all buildings and structures. The design, construction, installation, maintenance and operation of
all miscellaneous hoisting and elevating equipment and amusement devices shall be subject to such
special requirements as are deemed necessary by the code enforcement officer to secure their safe
operation. The provisions of the chapter shall not apply to portable elevating within one storey. The
construction, alteration, maintenance, operation, inspection and tests of manlifts shall comply with the
relevant standards (see ASME A 90).
9.1.8.10.2 Referenced standard: Except as otherwise provided in this Code, and except where more
restrictive provisions govern, the construction, alteration, maintenance, operation, inspections and tests of
elevators, dumbwaiters, moving walks and escalators shall conform to ASME A17.1 listed in the
Schedule.
9.1.8.10.3 Purpose and exceptions: The purpose of this code is to provide safety for life and property. In
case of practical difficulty or unnecessary hardship, the code enforcement officer shall grant exceptions
from the literal requirements or permit the use of other methods, but only when it is clearly evident that
reasonable safety is thereby secured.
9.1.8.11 Plans, Specifications and Permits
9.1.8.11.1 Application: The person responsible for the installation, relocation, or alteration covered by
this Chapter shall file an application for permit with the code enforcement officer, accompanied by
governing specifications and scaled or fully-dimensioned drawings with sufficient clarity and detail
showing: the location of the installation in relation to the plans and elevation of the building; the location
of the machinery room and equipment to be installed, relocated or altered, and all structural supporting
members thereof, including foundations. Such plans and specifications shall specify all materials to be
employed and all loads to be supported or conveyed and shall be sufficiently complete to illustrate all
details of construction and design.
9.1.8.11.2 Permits: Equipment or devices subject to the provisions of this code shall not be constructed,
installed, relocated or altered unless a permit has been received from the code enforcement officer before
the work is commenced. A copy of such permit shall be kept at the constructions site at all times while the
work is in progress.
9.1.8.11.3 Identification of equipment: In buildings containing more than one elevator or device and
where such devices are subject to periodic inspections, each such elevator or device shall be identified by
a serial number, in figures not less than 25mm high, attached to, painted, stenciled or otherwise registered
on the crosshead of the elevators, on the motor or machine. After such devices have been so designated,
their numbers shall not be changed, except by permission of the code enforcement officer, and all
correspondence in regard to such device shall refer to said number.
[Page 283]
9.1.8.12 Tests and Inspections
9.1.8.12.1 General: All equipment and devices covered by the provisions of this code shall be subjected
to acceptance and maintenance tests and periodic inspections as required herein.
9.1.8.12.2 Acceptance tests: Acceptance tests and inspections shall be required on all new, relocated and
altered equipment subject to the provisions of this Chapter. Tests and inspections shall be of such nature
as to determine whether the entire installation is designed, constructed and installed in compliance with
this Code, and shall include all parts of the equipment and machinery. All such tests shall be made in
conformance with the requirements of the relevant Mechanical Code and in the presence of the Code
Enforcement Officer, by the person installing such equipment.
9.1.8.12.3 Periodic tests and periodic inspections: Periodic tests shall be required on all new and
existing power elevators, and periodic inspections shall be made of all new and existing equipment
subject to the provisions of this Chapter.
9.1.8.12.4 Periodic tests and Inspections: Periodic tests and inspections shall be made by the code
enforcement officer, or by an approved agency, and shall be made at the expense and responsibility of the
owner. Where such test and inspections are not made by the code enforcement officer, the approved
agency shall submit a detailed report of the tests and inspections to the Code Enforcement Officer, the
approved agency shall submit a detailed report of the test and inspections to the code enforcement officer
on approved forms not more than 30 days following the completion of the tests.
9.1.8.12.5 Frequency of tests and inspections: Tests and inspections shall be conducted at frequencies
specified in Section 9.1.8.14.6 and 9.1.8.14.7
9.1.8.12.6 Periodic inspection intervals: Periodic inspections shall hereafter be made at intervals of not
more than six months for all manlifts, and at intervals not exceeding that set forth in relevant Mechanical
Codes’ for elevators, escalators, dumbwaiters and moving walks miscellaneous hoisting, and elevating
equipment, conveyors and amusement devices shall be inspected at such intervals as are deemed
necessary by the code enforcement officer to ensure safety of operation.
9.1.8.12.7 Periodic test intervals: Periodic tests shall be done at intervals not exceeding those set forth
in the relevant Mechanical Code.
9.1.8.12.8 Elevators, dumbwaiters and escalators: The equipment and machinery of elevators,
dumbwaiters and escalators shall be inspected and tested to the requirements of ASME A17, listed in the
Schedule.
9.1.8.13 Freight lifts conveyors and amusement devices: Freight lifts, conveyors and amusement
devices shall be inspected and subjected to tests to ensure the load capacity and safety of operation. The
tests shall cover all operating protective and safety devices, structural adequacy of the supports, and
anchorage to floors, walls ceiling and foundations.
9.1.8.13.1 Manlifts: All equipments and machinery of manlifts shall be inspected and tested to ensure
reasonable safety of operation and shall include tests of the brake, terminal and emergency stopping
devices and belt tension. Acceptance tests shall also include a load capacity test as provided in the
relevant in the Mechanical Code.
[Page 284]
9.1.8.13.2 Miscellaneous hoisting and elevating equipment: All miscellaneous hoisting and elevating
equipment shall be subjected to such test and inspection as required by the code enforcement officer to
ensure safe operation.
9.1.8.14 Certificate of Compliance
9.1.8.14.1 General: The operation of all equipment governed by the provisions of this Section and
hereafter installed, relocated or altered shall be unlawful by persons other than the installer thereof until
such equipment has been inspected and tested as herein required and a final or limited certificate of
compliance has been issued thereof by the code enforcement officer.
9.1.8.14.2 Final certificate of compliance: The Code Enforcement Officer shall issue a final certificate
of compliance for each unit of equipment which has satisfactorily met all the inspections and tests
required by this Section. Such final certificate shall bear the signature of the person who made the
inspection and tests, and shall designate the rated load and speed, the date of acceptance tests and
inspections, and the name of the code enforcement officer who made or witnessed such tests and
inspections.
The final certificate shall also include the necessary space for inserting the name of the periodic
inspection and the maintenance test.
9.1.8.14.3 Limited certificate of compliance: The Code Enforcement Officer is authorised to issue a
limited certificate of compliance for any equipment covered by this Chapter, which is hereafter being
installed, relocated or altered, to permit its limited use by the person designated therein during the period
of such installation, relocation or alteration. Such certificate shall be signed by the code enforcement
officers, shall bear the dates of issue, renewal and expiration, and shall designate the class of service
allowed.
9.1.8.14.4 Test and minimum safeguard required: A limited certificate shall not be issued for an
elevator until such elevator has satisfactorily passed tests for rated, load, car and counterweight safety,
and terminal stopping devices. Permanent or temporary guards and enclosures shall be installed on the
car, around the hoistway and at the landing entrances. Equipment other than elevators shall be tested and
protective safeguards provided as deemed necessary by the code enforcement officer to ensure safe
operation for the limited service specified.
9.1.8.14.5 Special conditions: Automatic and continuous-pressure operation elevators shall not be
placed in temporary operation from the landing push-buttons unless the door locking device and
interlocks required by the relevant Mechanical Code are installed and operative. When the car can be
operated only from the inside, landing entrance guards shall be provided with locks that can be released
from the hoistway side only.
9.1.8.14.6 Time limitation: Limited certificate of operation shall be issued for periods of not more than
30 days. The Code Enforcement Officer is authorised to renew the limited certificates of operation for
additional periods of not more than 30 days each.
9.1.8.14.7 Posting certificates of compliance: The owner or lessee shall post the last-issued certificate
of compliance in a conspicuous place available to the code enforcement officer.
9.1.8.15 Maintenance and Accidents
9.1.8.15.1 Owner responsibility: The owner or the owner’s legal agent for the building in which the
equipment is located shall be responsible for the care, maintenance and safe operation of all equipment
covered by this Chapter after the installation thereof and [Page 285] its acceptance by such owner or
agent. The owner or legal agent shall make or cause to be made all periodic tests and inspections, and
shall maintain all equipment in a safe operating condition, as required by this Chapter.
9.1.8.15.2 Contractor responsibility: The person installing any device covered by this Section shall
make all acceptance tests and be responsible for the care and safe operation of such equipment during its
construction and until temporarily or finally accepted by the building owner or the owner’s legal agent.
9.1.8.15.3 Maintenance items: All operating and electrical parts and accessory equipment or devices
subject to this Section shall be maintained in a safe operating condition. The maintenance of elevators,
dumbwaiter and escalators shall conform to the relevant Mechanical Code.
9.1.8.15.4 Unsafe conditions: If upon inspection any equipment covered in this Section is found in an
unsafe condition, or not in accordance with the provisions of this code, the Code Enforcement Officer
shall thereupon serve a written notice of such finding upon the building owner or lessee, stating the time
when recommended repairs or changes shall be completed. After the service of such notice, it shall be the
duty of the owner to proceed within the time allowed to make such repairs or changes as necessary to
place the equipment in a safe condition. It shall be unlawful to operate such equipment after the date
stated in the notice unless such recommended repairs or changes have been made and the equipment has
been approved, or unless an extension of time has been secured from the code enforcement officer in
writing.
9.1.8.15.5 Power to seal equipment: The Code Enforcement Officer, in addition to any other penalties
herein provided, shall have the power to seal out of service any device or equipment covered by this
Section when in case of emergency in the opinion of the code enforcement officer, such device is in a
condition to render it unsafe for operation; or for wilful failure to comply with recommendations and
orders.
9.1.8.15.6 Notice of sealing out of service: Before sealing any device out of service, the code
enforcement officer, except in case of emergency shall serve written notice upon the building owner or
lessee stating intention to seal the equipment out of service and the reasons thereof.
9.1.8.15.7 Unlawful removal of seal: Any device sealed out of service by the Code Enforcement
Division/Section/Unit shall be plainly marked with a sign or tag indicating the reason for such sealing.
Any tampering with, defacing or removal of the sign, tag or seal without approval shall constitute a
violation of this Code.
9.1.8.15.8 Accidents reported and recorded: The owner of the building shall immediately notify the
Code Enforcement Officer of every accident involving personal injury or damage to apparatus on, about,
or in connection with any equipment covered by this Chapter, and shall afford the code enforcement
officer all facilities for investigating such accident. When an accident involve the failure, breakage,
damage or destruction of any part of the apparatus or mechanism, it shall be unlawful to use such device
until after an examination by the code enforcement officer is made and approval of equipment for
continued use is granted. It shall be the duty of the code enforcement officer to conduct a prompt
examination into the cause of the accident and to enter a full and complete report thereof in the records of
the building department, within 21 days of the reported accident. Such reports shall be open for public
inspection at all reasonable hours.
[Page 286]
9.1.8.15.9 Removal of damaged parts: It shall be unlawful to remove from the premises any part of the
damage construction or operating mechanism of elevators, or other equipment subject to the provisions of
this Chapter until permission to do so has been granted by the code enforcement officer.
9.1.8.16 Existing Installations
9.1.8.16.1 Retroactive provisions: The provisions of this Section are not retroactive except as
specifically provided hereunder, and except further that if, upon inspection of any device covered by this
code, the equipment is found in a dangerous condition, or there is an immediate hazard to those riding on
or using such equipment, or if the design or the method of operation in combination with devices used, is
considered inherently dangerous in the opinion of the Code Enforcement Officer, the code enforcement
officer shall notify the owner or lessee in writing of the existing condition and shall recommend such
alterations or additions as are deemed necessary to eliminate the dangerous situation.
9.1.8.16.2 Projections into hoistway: All ledges, floor beams, saddles, timbers and other projections
that project more than 50mm from the inside of the general surface of the hoistway enclosure shall be
fitted with smooth bevelled guards set directly over the entire length of the projection, except door
interlocks and contacts, door closers, door tracks and hangers, and door operating or signal devices in
front of car openings, landing sills and separator beams between adjacent elevators. The angle of the
bevels or guard plates shall not be less than 60 degrees (1.50rad) from the horizontal.
9.1.8.16.3 Emergency interlock release switch: Emergency interlock release switches are prohibited.
9.1.8.16.4 Lighting: The cars and entrances of all elevators shall be properly lighted at all times when in
service. Minimum illumination shall not be less than 53.82lux at the landing edge of the platform.
9.1.8.16.5 Belt and chain-driven machines: Single-belt and chain-driven machines are permitted only
on freight elevators, and only when equipped with electrical-released spring-applied brakes and with
terminal stopping and electrical safety devices required for new electric elevators. The brakes shall be
applied directly to the hoisting machine and shall be arranged to belted elevator machines and permitted
only on freight elevators and when driven by a line shafting which is used to apply power for other
purposes.
9.1.8.16.6 Replacement or relocation of gate switches on interlocks: The code enforcement officer
shall require the replacement or relocation of car gate electric contacts, safety cut-out switches or
interlocks where such devices are found to be tied or blocked so as to render them inoperative.
9.1.8.16.7 Removal of pipes from hoistway: The code enforcement officer shall order the removal from
existing elevator hoistways of any pipe conveying gases, vapours on liquids which would endanger life if
discharged into the hoistway or ignited.
9.1.8.16.8 Existing passenger elevators: In addition to other provisions of this section, existing
passenger elevators shall comply with Section 9.1.8.18.9 through to 9.1.8.18.12
9.1.8.16.9 Hoistway enclosure: All existing passenger hoistways shall be fully enclosed from floor to
ceiling on all floors to comply with Section 9.1.8.20.
[Page 287]
9.1.8.16.10 Hoistway doors and interlocks: All existing electric and electrically controlled and operated
hydraulic passenger elevators equipped with mechanical locks and electrical contacts in good operating
condition are not required to be removed or altered. If not so equipped, such passenger elevators shall be
provided with hoistway landing doors equipped with approved interlocks conforming to the requirements
for new elevators; except that where approved interlock switches are installed in connection with existing
hoistway door closers, the combination door closer and interlocks shall require tests. The use of service
and emergency keys for opening hoistway doors from the landing shall conform to the requirements of
the relevant Mechanical Code.
9.1.8.16.11 Hydraulic passenger elevators: Hydraulic passenger elevators, except those equipped with
electric control and operating devices, shall be provided with self-closing hoistway doors arranged to lock
automatically when closed in lieu of interlocks. Car doors or gates on electric or electricity controlled and
operated hydraulic elevators shall be equipped with car door or gate electric contacts conforming to the
requirements for new elevators.
9.1.8.16.12 Emergency signal or telephone: Existing power passenger and freight elevators shall be
provided with emergency signal devices conforming to the requirements of ASME A17.1 listed in the
Schedule.
9.1.8.16.13 Existing freight elevators: In addition to other provisions, existing freight elevators shall
comply with Section 9.1.8.18.14 through to 9.1.8.18.18.
9.1.8.16.14 Hoistway enclosure: If not now enclosed, enclosures shall be required on existing freight
elevators as required for existing passenger elevators in Section 27.18.8, except as provided in Section
9.1.8.18.16.
9.1.8.16.15 Hoistway doors: All landing openings in existing electric or electricity controlled and
operated hydraulic freight elevator hoistways which are enclosed in fire-resistance rated partitions shall
be provided with fire doors equipped either with approved hoistway door interlocks, or approved
hoistway door electric contacts and mechanical locks conforming to ASME A17.1 listed in the Schedule,
or with fusible mechanical locks conforming to ASME A17.1 listed in the Schedule, or with fusible links
and automatic self-closing devices.
9.1.8.16.16 Landing gates: Where automatic self-closing landing doors with fusible links are used, or
where fire-resistance rated hoistway enclosures are not required, the landing openings of electric or
electricity controlled and operated hydraulic elevators shall be equipped with landing gates not less than
1650mm high and provided with either hoistway gate interlocks or hoistway gate electric contacts and
mechanical locks conforming to ASME A17.1 listed in the Schedule.
9.1.8.16.17 Hydraulic freight elevators: Interlocks or electric contacts shall not be used on hydraulic
elevator landing doors or gates, except where such elevators are provided with electric control and
operating devices, and provided further that the landing openings of such elevators shall be equipped with
self-closing gates at least 1650mm high with approved mechanical locks. Fully automatic gates shall be
prohibited. Semi-automatic shall be prohibited, except on hydraulic elevators with mechanical control and
operating devices.
[Page 288]
9.1.8.16.18 Gates on cars: All openings on existing electric or electro-hydraulic freight elevator cars,
except the opening immediately adjacent to the operating device, shall be provided by the side of the
landing door adjacent contacts when the distance between the hoistway side of the landing door adjacent
to such opening and the hoistway edge of the landing threshold is more than 100mm. All such elevators
using lever, wheel or cable operating devices shall have gate contacts installed at all car openings. All
openings on existing continuous-pressure or automatic operation freight elevator cars shall be operated
from the landings and shall be provided with car gates and car gate electric contacts. Existing sidewalk
elevators shall not be subject to the provisions of this section. Car gate electric contacts shall be of an
approved type conforming to ASME A17.1 listed in the Schedule.
9.1.8.17 Power Elevator Operation
9.1.8.17.1 Designated operator: Every power elevator, except automatic and continuous-pressure
operation types and sidewalk elevators, shall be in the change of a competent designated operator.
9.1.8.17.2 Emergency operation of elevators: In all structures where elevators are to be installed,
elevator emergency operation shall be provided in accordance with the requirements of the Mechanical
Code and Section 9.1.8.20.1 through 9.1.8.25.
9.1.8.17.3 Buildings with elevator service: In all buildings and structures serviced by an elevator, at
least one elevator shall be provided with a minimum clear distance between walls, or between wall and
door excluding return panels, not less than 1727mm by 1372mm, and a minimum distance from wall to
return panel not less than 1295mm. The minimum clear width of the door shall be 813mm.
9.1.8.17.4 Elevators for fire department use: In all structures where elevator service required for fire
department use (see Section 7.2.3.5), at least one elevator shall be provided with a minimum distance
between walls, or between wall and door excluding return panel, not less than 1772mm by 1372mm and a
minimum distance from wall to return panel not less than 1295mm, with a 1067mm side-slide door to
allow for turning a wheelchair or accommodating an ambulance stretcher in its horizontal position.
9.1.8.17.5 Elevator operator: In every structure over 45 meters in height, a competent elevator operator
shall be available at all times to assist the fire department in obtaining access to any floor in the building
or structure served by elevators except where an automatic or continuous pressure operation elevator is
available.
9.1.8.17.6 Passenger restriction: Freight elevators shall be in accordance with the passenger restrictions
as specified in the manufacturer’s manual.
9.1.8.17.7 Freight operators: Except as provided in Section 9.1.8.17.8 it shall be unlawful for any
person other than the operator or those individuals necessary to handle freight to ride on any elevator
other than a passenger elevator. It shall be unlawful for the owner or other responsible person to permit
any individual other than above specified to ride on any elevator other than a passenger elevator.
9.1.8.17.8 Other employees: Employees of the owner shall not ride on a freight elevator, unless
approved and in conformance with the requirements of the relevant standards (See ANSI A17).
[Page 289]
9.1.8.17.9 Use by handicapped persons: If interior access in multi-storey buildings are provided by
elevator(s), they shall conform to the special requirement for use by handicapped persons as provided in
the relevant Mechanical Code listed in the Schedule.
9.1.8.18 Hoistway Enclosures and Venting
9.1.8.18.1 Hoistway enclosures: Hoistway enclosures shall be constructed in accordance with Section
9.1.8.21.2 through 9.1.8.21.4.
9.1.8.18.2 Elevator enclosures: All elevator and other hoistway enclosures other than dumbwaiter shafts
shall be constructed to afford at least the fire-resistance rating specified in Table 6.1 with approved
opening protective conforming to Section 9.1.8.24, Section 12.3.
9.1.8.18.3 Dumbwaiter enclosures: Shaft enclosures and dumbwaiters having a car area of more than
0.28m2 which travel through more than one storey and serve more than two adjacent floors shall be of
1-hour fire-resistance rated construction with approved ¾-hour opening protective or the approved
labeled equivalent complying with Section 12.3 except that when the load capacity exceeds 488.2kg/m2,
the enclosure and opening protective shall comply with the requirements of Section 9.1.8.21.1 for
fire-resistance rating.
9.1.8.18.4 Special dumbwaiter enclosures: The enclosure of dumbwaiters not more than 0.28m2 in area
with a load capacity of not more than 11.35kg, and all dumbwaiters serving not more than two adjacent
levels, shall be enclosed with approved non-combustible materials.
9.1.8.18.5 Number of elevators permitted in hoistway: Where four or more elevators serve all or the
same portion of a building, they shall be located in not less than two hoistways, and more than four
elevators shall not be located in any one hoistway.
9.1.8.18.6 Vents required: Hoistway of elevators and dumbwaiters serving more than three storeys shall
be equipped with means for venting smoke and hot gases to the outer air in case of fire, except as listed in
Section 9.1.8.18.8 and 9.1.8.18.9.
9.1.8.18.7 Exception: Venting of hoistway is not required in a building equipped with a smoke control
system conforming to Section 12.2.20.11.
9.1.8.18.8 Fire suppression alternative: In buildings other than Use Groups H-1, H-2, F-1 and F-2 and
similar buildings with overnight sleeping quarters, hoistways not extending into the top storey shall be
vented as herein required or shall be equipped with an approved automatic fire suppression system
connected to the building water supply system or conforming to Section 12.2.5.
9.1.8.18.9 Sidewalk elevator hoistways: Sidewalk elevator hoistways are not required to be vented.
9.1.8.18.10 Location of vents: Vents shall be located on the side of the hoistway enclosure directly
below the floor or floors at the top of the hoistway, and shall open either directly to the outer air or
through non-combustible ducts to the outer air. Cable slots entering the machine room shall be sleeved
beneath the machine room floor and extended to not less than 300mm below the shaft vent to inhibit the
passage of smoke into the machine room.
[Page 290]
9.1.8.18.11 Area of vents: Except as herein provided, the area of the vents shall be not less than 3½
percent of the area of the hoistway nor less than 0.28m2 for each elevator car, and shall be of the
permanently open type. Where mechanical ventilation conforming to the current Engineering Code of
Practice provides equivalent venting, the required vent area shall be reduced provided the conditions of
Section 9.2.4 and 9.2.7.3 are met.
9.1.8.18.12 Restricted use: The building is not of Use Group H-1, H-2, F-1 or F-2 or a similar building
with overnight sleeping quarters.
9.1.8.18.13 Vent location: The required vents in Section 9.1.8.18.10 are so located that they do not have
outside exposure.
9.1.8.18.14 Closed vents: Closed portions of the required vent area shall consist of windows or duct
openings glazed with plain glass not more than 3mm thick.
9.1.8.18.15 Windows: Windows used as required vents shall conform to Section 12.2.19 and they shall
be glazed with 3mm plain glass.
9.1.8.18.16 Plumbing and mechanical systems: Plumbing and mechanical systems, other than floor
drains, sumps and sump pumps at the base of the of the shaft, shall not be located in an elevator shaft.
9.1.8.19 Elevator and Dumbwaiter Machinery and Equipment
9.1.8.19.1 General: The construction of machine rooms and related construction for passenger and
freight elevators and dumbwaiters shall conform to ASME A17.1 listed in the Schedule.
9.1.8.20 Machine Rooms and Related Construction for Passenger and Freight Elevators and
Dumbwaiter
9.1.8.20.1 General: The construction of machine rooms and related construction for passenger and
freight elevators and dumbwaiters shall conform to ASME A17.1 listed in the Schedule.
9.1.8.21 Elevator Opening Protection
9.1.8.21.1 General: All hoistway enclosure doors for elevators, dumbwaiters and other hoisting
equipment shall be constructed with materials of adequate fire-resistance in accordance with the
provisions of Section 12.3 and as herein required.
9.1.8.21.2 Hoistway doors: Door openings of elevator hoistway enclosures shall be equipped with
protective assemblies having a fire-resistance rating of not less than ½-hours or their approved labeled
equivalent. However, when the shaft opens into a vestibule enclosed with not less than 2-hour
fire-resistance rated construction in which all vestibule openings are protected with assemblies having a
fire-resistance rating of not less than 1 hour, the required fire-resistance rating of the hoistway doors shall
be ¾-hour.
9.1.8.21.3 Hardware: All hardware on opening protective shall be of an approved type installed as
tested, except that interlocks, mechanical elevator door locks and electric contacts and door operating
mechanism of approved types shall be exempt from the fire test requirements.
[Page 291]
9.1.8.21.4 Emergency door operation: In every structure where elevator emergency operation is
provided in accordance with Section 9.1.8.18.10, each elevator lobby and associated elevator machine
rooms shall be provided with a smoke detector installed in accordance with the relevant standards (See
NFiPA 72E). A designated level, which shall be the main floor level that best serves the needs of
emergency personnel for fire fighting or rescue purposes, shall be approved by the Code Enforcement
Division/Section/Unit and the fire safety Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit. The activation of a
smoke detector in any elevator machine room to return non-stop to the designated level. If a smoke
detector at the designated level is activated, the cars shall return to an approved level. Manual control to
override the smoke detectors shall be provided at the designated level in accordance with the current
Engineering Code of Practice. The smoke detectors shall operate before the optical density exceeds 0.098
per m. The detector is permitted to serve to close the lobby doors.
9.1.8.21.5 Exception: Freight elevators located in or at openings into industrial areas.
9.1.8.22 Elevator Car Emergency Signals Signs
9.1.8.22.1 Emergency signs: Elevator car shall be provided with car emergency signals conforming to
the requirements of ASME A17.1 listed in the Schedule.
9.1.8.22.2 Emergency signs: A pictograph sign, of an approved standardized type, shall be posted over
each elevator call station on all floors, indicating that in case of fire, occupants shall not use elevators and
that stairways are the approved method of exit.
9.1.8.23 Manlifts
9.1.8.23.1 Restricted use: Manlifts shall be accessible and their use shall be restricted to employees
only. They shall comply with the applicable requirements of this Chapter and shall be installed only when
permitted by the Code Enforcement Officer in feed, flour and cereal mills, gain elevators and in similar
buildings of other use groups.
9.1.8.23.2 Enclosures: When the clear vertical distance between mounting platform and ceiling guard is
less than 2286mm, the manlift shall be completely enclosed without access openings.
9.1.8.23.3 Accessibility: Entrances to manlifts shall not be provided from any floor or level with a clear
ceiling height of less than 2783mm and the minimum clearance between the head pulley and the roof or
other overhead obstruction shall be not less than 1500mm.
9.1.8.23.4 Speed: The speed of manlifts shall not exceed 0.046m/s except by special approval.
9.1.8.23.5 Manlift safeties: Manlift safeties shall conform to Section 27.26.6 through to 9.1.8.26.6.
9.1.8.23.6 Manlift manual stops: An approved manually-operated stopping device shall be provided to
permit passengers riding on a manlift to control the operation of the lift at all floors and at any level in the
travel of the device.
9.1.8.23.7 Manlift automatic stops: An approved safety device shall be provided which will
automatically stop the lift in the event that a rider fails to alight at the top landing but such automatic
device shall not be capable of restoring the operating circuit of adequate strength to support a load of
90.8kg on each step of one run without loss of traction.
[Page 292]
9.1.8.23.8 Handholds: Manlift handholds shall be located not less than 1200mm nor more than 1422mm
above each step tread on both runs of the manlift with a 50mm clearance from the belt. Such handholds
shall be not less than 225mm in length in the clear.
9.1.8.23.9 Final acceptance: All manlifts shall be subject to approval and periodic tests and inspections
as provided in Section 9.1.8.14.2.
9.1.8.23.10 Manlift instruction signs: Manlifts shall be subject to approval and periodic tests and
inspections as provided in Section 9.1.8.14.2.
9.1.8.23.11 Landing signs: Approved signs shall be provided on each landing and stenciled on the belt
at approximately eye level above each step giving the following instructions:
For Employees Only. Face the Belt. Use the Handhold. To Stop, Pull Rope.
9.1.8.23.12 Terminal sign: The top landing shall be provided with an illuminated warning sign in block
letters not less than 50mm high which shall be located within easy view of ascending passengers at a level
of not more than 60cm above the top landing reading: Top Floor, Get Off.
9.1.8.24 Industrial Lifts and Loading Ramps
9.1.8.24.1 General: Except as exempted by Section 9.1.8.12 or as otherwise by statute, the provisions of
this section shall control the design, construction, installation, maintenance and operation of all
automotive lifts, industrial lifts and loading dock ramps hereafter installed, relocated or altered in all
buildings or structures. The purpose of this code is to provide safety for life and property. In case of
practical difficulty or unnecessary hardships, the code enforcement officer shall grant exceptions from the
literal requirements or permit the use of other methods, but only when it is evident that safety is hereby
secured.
9.1.8.24.2 General requirements: Industrial lifts and loading ramps shall be marked with the name of
manufacturer, model number, serial number, and rated capacity. Such markings shall be legibly stamped
or etched on a metal plate which shall be permanently secured in a convenient place for inspection. Such
data plates shall not be obscured, obliterated or changed.
9.1.8.24.3 Controls: The controls shall be so located that the operator has a full and unobstructed view
of the lift area at all times. All control devices shall be accessible to the operator without exposing him to
danger. Alterations or changes shall not be made in the control device, or its manner of use, which will
render its normal functioning inoperative.
9.1.8.24.4 Lift control: When the device used for controlling the travel of the lift in either direction is
not continuous-pressure or deadpan type, an emergency stop button shall be provided and so located as to
be readily accessible to the operator at all times.
9.1.8.24.5 Maintenance: Maintenance of industrial lifts and loading ramps shall be provided in
accordance with manufacturer’s maintenance manual and design specifications.
9.1.8.24.6 Owner responsibility: The owner or the owner’s agent shall be responsible for the care,
maintenance, and safe operation of all equipment covered by this chapter after the installation thereof and
its acceptance by such owner or agent or its approval.
The owner or agent shall not permit the equipment to be used unless it is, to the best of such owner’s or
agent’s knowledge, in safe operating condition.
[Page 293]
9.1.8.24.7 Housekeeping: The spaces around or beneath the equipment shall be kept clean. Rubbish or
oil shall not be allowed to accumulate therein, nor shall any part of this space be used for storage of
materials or equipment. All parts, except those requiring freedom of movement, shall be kept tight at all
times. All mechanical working parts shall be kept free of rust, and properly lubricated and adjusted. The
owner, or the owners’ agent, shall be responsible for inspecting the oil level in all hydraulic systems to
ensure that it is at or above the manufacturer’s prescribed minimum level.
9.1.8.24.8 Lighting: The entire operating area shall be illuminated to provide a distributed intensity of
not less than 32.29lux over the area of operating floor and platform.
9.1.8.24.9 Pressure tanks: All separate tanks for liquids storage under pressure, not an integral part of
the cylinder assembly, shall conform to the provisions of the standards (See ASME Code for Unfired
Pressure Vessels and shall be marked with a securely attached metal label to indicate the approved
operating pressure. For hydroneumatic systems, the storage capacity shall be such that with the lift in
fully elevated position there shall remain not less than 75mm of usable oil in the storage tank. Adequate
means shall be provided to determine that the oil level in reservoir, with lift in the lowest position, is at or
above the safe minimum operating level as prescribed by the manufacturer.
9.1.8.24.10 Design and construction: The construction and installation of all power industrial lifts and
loading ramps shall comply with the provisions of this section and other relevant standards (see ANSI
A10.5)
9.1.8.24.11 Rated load: The lifting capacity shall be not less than 244kg/m2 for gross platform area.
9.1.8.24.12 Platform construction: The platform and its supports shall be designed for the loads to be
transmitted within strength and deflection limitations such that when one-half the capacity loading is
applied to an edge, the lift platform shall not deflect more than 13mm at any edge point.
9.1.8.24.13 Platform and hoist protection: Platform and hoist protection shall be provided in
accordance with Section 9.1.8.24.14 through to 9.1.8.24.24.
9.1.8.24.14 Unprotected space not more than 1.5m: When the lift rise is such that the unprotected
vertical distance from the landing to the botton edge of the vertical side of the platform is not more than
1500mm, protection shall be provided as described in Section 9.1.8.24.1 through to 9.1.8.24.6.
9.1.8.24.15 Toe guards: A toe guard plate not less than 200mm in height shall be provided on all
unprotected sides. It shall be made of steel, nor less than 3mm nominal thickness, attached to flush with
the vertical edge or the platform, and slanted inwardly at an angle or approximately 30 degrees (0.52rad)
from the vertical. Toe guards are not required where skirts are used.
9.1.8.24.16 Skirts: For automatic operation, the unprotected sides of the platform shall be provided with
metal or wood sheathing or skirts attached to the platform to protect the exposed vertical openings.
9.1.8.24.17 Enclosures: When toe guard or skirt protection is not provided, the unprotected sides shall
be provided with solid or mesh enclosures to the full height of the lift rise. Mesh enclosure shall, by test,
reject a 50m ball.
[Page 294]
9.1.8.24.18 Unprotected space more than 1.5m: When the unprotected space exceeds that set forth in
Section 9.1.8.24.14 protection shall be provided as described in Section 9.1.8.24.3.
9.1.8.24.19 Loading or unloading side: Sides used for loading or unloading at the lower level shall be
protected with skirts as described in Section 9.1.8.24.14, or by a landing gate with electrical contact, or an
automatic landing gate.
9.1.8.24.20 Other sides: Sides not used for loading or unloading shall be protected with skirts or
enclosures as described in Section 9.1.8.24.14.
9.1.8.24.21 Lift rise more than 1.65m: When the lift rise exceeds 1650mm above the lowest level,
additional protection shall be provided as described in Sections 9.1.8.24.22 and 9.1.8.24.23.
9.1.8.24.22 Landing gate: The upper landing shall be provided a landing gate equipped with mechanical
lock and electrical contact.
9.1.8.24.23 Enclosure: The sides of the platform not used for loading or unloading shall be provided
with railing, mesh, or solid enclosures not less than 105mm.
9.1.8.24.24 Surface installations: When the lift is surface mounted, toe clearance space shall be
provided on all unprotected sides. Such toe clearance shall be not less than 75mm vertical and 100mm
horizontal clearance when the platform is at its lowest position.
9.1.8.24.25 Platform protection, loading ramps: The sides or edges of loading ramps which rise above
the surrounding platform shall be provided with skirts or toe guards protecting the opening under the
sides of the ramp.
9.1.8.24.26 Overload protection: Overload protection shall be provided in accordance with Sections
9.1.8.26.8.
9.1.8.24.27 Hydraulic operation: Hydraulic overload protection shall be provided by means of a relief
valve that will prevent raising of the elevating device when it is loaded to 125 percent of rated capacity.
The relief valve shall be so designed that its operation will not cause the platform, to lower.
9.1.8.24.28 Electric operation: Electric overload protection shall be provided by means of a thermal cut
out or other suitable device.
9.1.8.25 Automotive Lifts
9.1.8.25.1 General: All electric, hydraulic and hydropneumatic automotive lifts shall comply with the
requirements of Section 9.1.8.19 and other relevant standards (see ANSI B153).
9.1.8.25.2 Types: Lifts shall be classifed as semi-hydraulic, full hydraulic or Mechanical lifts according
to their operation as described in Section 9.1.8.25.3 through to 9.1.8.25.5.
9.1.8.25.3 Semi-hydraulic/hydropneumatic: A semi-hydraulic lift is an automotive lift of the plunger
type which employs compressed air as primary lifting and load-sustaining effort, such compressed air acts
continuously against a column of liquid to provide the lifting and load-sustaining effort.
9.1.8.25.4 Full hydraulic: A full hydraulic lift is an automotive lift of the plunger type that employs a
liquid under pressure as the direct lifting and load-sustaining agent. Such a lift is so designed and
constructed that the full weight of the load and lifting [Page 295] assembly rests on a continuous column
of liquid which extends from the cylinder to the liquid control valve.
9.1.8.25.5 Mechanical lifts: A mechanical lift is an automotive lift so designed that the motive power is
transmitted to the lifting frame by mechanical means. There are three principal types: cable and drum;
rack and pinion; and screw type.
9.1.8.25.6 Safeties: All mechanical automotive lifts shall be equipped with approved safeties as specified
in Section 9.1.8.25.7 through to 9.1.8.25.9.
9.1.8.25.7 Limit stop: Every mechanical automotive lift shall be equipped with an automatic overtravel
device to stop the motor or drive machine before the lifting frame reaches safe limits of travel.
9.1.8.25.8 Holding brake: When the friction of the gear train of the driving mechanism is insufficient to
hold the load, the mechanical automatic lift shall be equipped with a brake or other locking device to
automatically hold the lift at any level immediately on failure of the lifting power for any cause.
9.1.8.25.9 Stopping brake: When the structural members of the lifting frame are so designed that they
interfere with open doors or other projections from the vehicle, the automotive lift shall be provided with
a quick-acting automatic brake to stop the ascent of the lift in case of emergency.
9.1.8.25.10 Control: Controls shall be provided in accordance with Sections 9.1.8.25.11 and 9.1.8.25.12.
9.1.8.25.11 Automatic release: The direct control device shall be of a type that will automatically return
itself to the neutral or off position upon release by the operator.
9.1.8.25.12 Speed control: A speed control device shall be provided to control the descent of the lift at a
speed of not more than 0.10m/s under rated load.
9.1.8.26 Conveyors
9.1.8.26.1 Enclosures: All package elevators, boosters or lifts connecting successive floors or levels
shall be enclosed in fire-resistance rated construction in conformance with the requirements of Sections
12.3.
9.1.8.26.2 Opening protective: Opening protective shall be provided in accordance with Section
9.1.8.26.3 through to 9.1.8.26.5.
9.1.8.26.3 Plans and specifications: Whenever conveyor or other material handling devices are designed
to pass through floors, ceilings, partitions or walls, the plans and specifications shall give the necessary
details of the opening protective in respect to location, structural strength and fire-resistance rating.
9.1.8.26.4 Fire curtains: Openings in partitions and walls through which conveyors pass shall have
automatic fire dampers or curtains to prevent the spread of fire when, in the opinion of the code
enforcement officer, such protection is necessary due to the hazard of operation of the conveyors.
9.1.8.26.5 Fire doors: All opening protective shall meet the fire-resistance rating requirements of
Section 12.3 for the location, type of construction and use of the building or structure.
9.1.8.26.6 Machinery guards: All conveying devices shall be manufactured, installed, and guarded in
accordance with the relevant standards (see ASME B20).
[Page 296]
9.1.8.26.7 Chute enclosures: All slides and chutes shall be enclosed with fire-resistance rated
construction, or protected with approved automatic shutters of non-combustible construction, to ensure a
full firestop between floors of the building or structure.
9.1.8.26.8 Conveyor safeties: All power-operated conveyors, belts and other material moving devices
shall be equipped with automatic limit switches which will shut off the power in an emergency and
automatically stop all operation of the device.
9.1.8.27 Escalators
9.1.8.27.1 General: All escalators and their enclosures shall comply with the provisions of this Section
and other current Engineering Code and manufacturers’ manuals.
9.1.8.27.2 Construction materials: Escalator construction materials shall comply with the provisions of
current Engineering Code.
9.1.8.27.3 Machine room enclosure: The stairwell is not required to be enclosed when protected with an
exhaust system or ventilation and water curtains as provided in Section 8.7.3, or with a power-operated
shutter conforming to Section 9.12.5 except that the machine room shall be enclosed with 1-hour
fire-resistance rated construction and shall be properly lighted and ventilated.
9.1.8.27.4 Non-combustible materials: The escalator shall be constructed entirely of non-combustible
and fire-retardant materials except electrical equipment, wiring, wheel, handrails and the use of 1mm
wood veneers on balustrades backed up with non-combustible materials.
9.1.8.27.5 Automatic fire shutter: Unenclosed escalators, which are not protected as specified in
Section 8.7.3, shall be equipped with a power-operated automatic shutter at every floor pierced thereby,
constructed of non-combustible materials with a fire-resistance rating of not less than 2 hours.
9.1.8.27.6 Construction: The shutter shall close immediately upon the automatic detection of fire or
smoke by an approved device and shall completely shut off the well opening. The shutter shall operate at
a speed of not more than 0.15m/s and shall be equipped with a sensitive leading edge to arrest its progress
when in contact with any obstacle, and to continue its progress on release there-from.
9.1.8.28 Plumbing Systems
9.1.8.28.1 General
9.1.8.28.1.1 Scope: The design and installation of plumbing systems, including sanitary and storm
drainage, sanitary facilities, water supply, and storm water and sewage disposal in buildings shall comply
with the requirements of this part and the Plumbing Code listed in the Schedule.
9.1.8.28.2 Plans and specifications
9.1.8.28.2.1 When required: Prior to the issuance of any permit, plumbing plans and specifications for
the installation, alteration or addition to the plumbing system of any building, structure or premises shall
be submitted to the code enforcement officer for approval. The plans and specifications shall show in
sufficient detail the layout and spacing of fixtures; the size, material and location of all building and storm
sewers and drains; and the soil, waste, vent, and water supply piping.
[Page 297]
9.1.8.28.2.2 Plans: Legible plans drawn to a scale of not less than 1:100 of each floor and of a typical
floor shall be filed in quadruplicate and show the complete plumbing system, all plumbing fixtures and all
water supply piping, together with building sections showing vertical and diagrammatic elevations of the
soil, waste, vent and water supply lines with traps and valves, and the location and size of the public
sewer or other disposal system.
9.1.8.28.2.3 Exceptions: The filing of plans and specifications shall not be required for minor repairs as
defined in the Plumbing Code listed in the Schedule, or for the installation or alteration of plumbing and
drainage systems in buildings or structures herein specifically exempted, such as open sheds for storage
purposes, isolated private garages without sanitary fixtures, temporary sanitary installations required
under the provisions of Part 18 for construction operations, and temporary installations for exhibition
purposes when not designed for sanitary use and not directly connected to a sewage system.
9.1.8.29 Sewer and Water Supply Data
9.1.8.29.1 Public sewer: Plans for new plumbing systems or alterations to existing plumbing systems
shall be accompanied by a diagram showing the relative elevation of the lowest fixture and the top of the
public sewer referred to in the established datum of the jurisdiction when such public sewer is available.
The plans shall show the size, number and location of all new sewer connections.
9.1.8.29.2 Public water mains: When the installation of a water distribution system or the replacement
or alteration of an existing water supply system is contemplated, the plumbing plans shall show the
location and size of all the water lines and branches involved, the fixtures, or other devices to be supplied,
and the minimum water pressure in the main in front of the building or structure.
9.1.8.29.3 Identical structures: Where the same set of plumbing or water supply piping plans and
specifications is used for two or more buildings or structures which are similar and are located on
adjoining plots under the same ownership, the applications for permission to construct or alter shall be
filed simultaneously.
9.1.8.30 Permits and Certifications of Approval
9.1.8.30.1 Plans for approval: Before any work is commenced on plumbing installations which required
the submission of plans, a permit shall be secured from the code enforcement officer and such permit with
a stamped and approved copy of the plans shall be available at the constructions sites at all times.
9.1.8.30.2 Amended plans: All plumbing installations shall be installed in accordance with the plans as
approved, and any changes made during construction which are not in conformance with the approved
plans shall be resubmitted for approval on amended plans.
9.1.8.30.3 Certificate of approval: After the prescribed tests and final inspection indicate the work
complies in all respects with the provisions of the plumbing code listed in the Schedule, a certificate of
approval and acceptance shall be issued by the code enforcement officer.
9.1.8.30.4 Notice of commencement and completion: The Code Enforcement Officer shall be notified
of the commencement of any plumbing work and when such work is completed or ready for inspection,
all such notices shall be confirmed in writing and shall be part of the official record of the application and
permit.
[Page 298]
9.1.8.30.5 Violation: If work is installed contrary to the approved plans in any essential details, the
owner, general contractor, supervising engineer or architect and the master plumber shall jointly and
separately be deemed to be in violation of this code and subject to the penalties provided in Section 3.8.2
until amended plans are filed and approved.
9.1.8.30.6 Owner performance: The provisions herein contained shall not prohibit the owner of a
building or structure from personally installing the plumbing system in his own residence under the
conditions specified in the following Section 9.15.7 through to 9.15.11
9.1.8.30.7 Approval of plans: Approval of plans and final approval shall be obtained.
9.1.8.30.8 Permit: A permit shall be secured as herein provided before the work is performed.
9.1.8.30.9 Statutory fees: All statutory fees shall be paid to the appropriate agencies.
9.1.8.30.10 Work: All work shall actually be performed by the owner in accordance with the provisions
of this Code.
9.1.8.30.11 Tests: The owner shall make application for all required inspections and tests.
9.1.8.31 Water Supply Systems
9.1.8.31.1 General: Every building in which people live, work or congregate shall be provided with a
supply of clean, cool and portable water in sufficient quantity to maintain all water supply and plumbing
fixtures in a safe and sanitary manner, and such other water supplies as are required for fire protection, air
conditioning and all other service equipment of the building or structure required by this Code.
9.1.8.31.2 Required capacity: Where the required capacity of portable water supply is available from
public water mains at the site, every building or structure shall be supplied from such mains to provide for
all service equipment.
9.1.8.31.3 Private water supply: When public water mains are not available and a private source of
water supply is used, samples shall be submitted periodically to the health official for analysis and
approval and the use of such source of supply shall be approved by the health official and the Code
Enforcement Officer.
9.1.8.31.4 Cross-connected supplies: Cross-connected water supplies shall be avoided in accordance
with Sections 9.16.1 and 9.16.2.
9.1.8.31.5 Building service supply: It shall be unlawful to connect water piping supplied directly from
city water mains or other approved sources with or to piping from underground storage tanks or other
unapproved sources. Cross connection shall not be made between the portable water distribution system
and any portion of waste or soil systems, or fixtures or devices that will contaminate, pollute or otherwise
render the water unsafe.
9.1.8.31.6 Process water: Water from unapproved sources for industrial processing or for fire protection
shall be identified at each outlet with an approved sign stating that the water is unfit and that its use is
prohibited for drinking purposes. Piping carrying portable water shall be identified and distinguished
from water piping from unapproved sources by distinctive painting and appropriate signs.
[Page 299]
9.1.8.32 Existing Buildings and Installations
9.1.8.32.1 Compliance with Code: When alterations are made in an existing building or structure
requiring the addition of any two or more plumbing fixtures, or one or more Waterflush closets, or when a
new bathroom is added, or a building is remodeled for an extension in size or change in use in which
plumbing work is involved, the new work shall be made to conform to the current Engineering Code of
Practice.
9.1.8.32.2 Unsafe installations: Any existing installation of plumbing systems deemed unsafe and
dangerous to the public health, in whole or in part, shall comply with all the provisions of this Section of
this Code.
9.1.8.32.3 Existing drainage nuisances: Any surface or roof drainage which creates a structural or
health hazard, or any other nuisance to the owners or occupants of adjacent premises, or to the public by
reason of discharge into, onto or across any adjacent building, premises or public thoroughfare, shall be
abated by the owner of the improperly drained area. The code enforcement officer shall require the
drainage to be disposed of in accordance with the provisions of the plumbing code listed in the Schedule.
9.1.8.32.4 Soil and vent stacks: Soil and vent stacks in existing buildings shall comply with Section
9.1.8.32.5 through to 9.1.8.32.7.
9.1.8.32.5 Extension above new building: When a new building is erected higher than an existing
building, windows or other wall openings shall not be located nearer than 3m to an existing soil or vent
stack on the lower building unless the owner of the new building makes the necessary provision to extend
such soil or vent stacks to a height of not less then 60cm above the topmost opening at his own expense
with the approval of the adjoining owner.
9.1.8.32.6 Extension above existing buildings: When the existing adjoining building is of greater height
than the new building, the owner of the structure of greater height shall not extend any new soil, waste or
vent stacks which are located within 6m of the common lot line to a level above the higher existing roof
without the consent of the owner of the new structure.
9.1.8.32.7 Exception: Approved fixed window assemblies of the required fire-resistance rated
construction which comply with the provisions of Section 12.3, when permitted in lot line walls, shall not
be deemed wall openings within the meaning of this section.
9.1.8.33 Plumbing fixture surrounds
9.1.8.33.1 Surrounding material for urinals: Wall and floor space to a point of 30cm in front of a
urinal lip and 1.2m above the floor, and at least 30cm to each side of the urinal, shall be finished with a
smooth, waterproof, non-absorbent, cleanable material.
9.1.8.33.2 Surrounding materials for water closets: Floors within 30cm in any direction from the rim
of a water closet shall be finished with a smooth, waterproof, non-absorbent, readily-cleanable material.
9.1.8.33.3 Showers: The wall area above built-in tubs having installed shower heads and in shower
compartments shall be constructed of smooth, non-corrosive and non-absorbent waterproof materials to a
height of not less than 1.8m above the room floor level. Such walls shall form a water-tight joint with
each other and with the tub, receptor, or shower floor.
[Page 300]
9.1.8.33.3.1 Shower floors or receptors: Floor surfaces shall be constructed of smooth, non-corrosive,
non-absorbent and waterproof materials.
9.1.8.34 Private Sewage Disposal
9.1.8.34.1 General: Private sewage disposal systems shall conform to the private sewage disposal
requirements listed in the Schedules.
9.2.8 Fire
9.2.9.1 General
9.2.9.1.1 Scope: The provisions of this Part shall control the design and construction of all new
installations of electrical conductors, equipment and systems in buildings or structures; and all alterations
to existing wiring systems therein to ensure safety. All such installations shall conform to the provisions
of the Electrical Code.
9.2.9.1.2 Electrical Code:
The Electrical Code shall mean the latest Edition of Wiring Regulations in Nigeria (CAP. 106 LFN)
PARTS 1 and 2, together with the Earthing Code by the Standards Organisations of Nigeria, and the latest
Edition of Approved Specifications for Telephone Wiring in Public Buildings.
Special emphasis should be placed on the following areas:
a. Use of conductors and cables of correct sizes
b. Use of protective devices of appropriate capacity
c. Use of cables and conductors with sufficient insulation resistance
d. Use of earthing system with correct earthing resistance
e. Protection against electrical shock
f. Protection against thermal effect
g. Protection against overcurrent
h. Protection against short circuit current
i. Protection against lightning
j. Protection against malfunction of the entire electrical systems in a building.
Exceptions
Electrical wiring shall not be installed in a building or structure, nor shall an alteration of an existing
electric wiring system be made, until a permit has been issued therefore as required in Section 9.2.9.5,
except as provided in Section 9.2.9.1.3, 9.2.9.1.4, 9.2.9.1.5.
[Page 301]
9.2.9.1.3 Public service agencies: The provisions of this Code shall not apply to installations for electric
supply or communication agencies in the generation, transmission or distribution of electricity, or the
operation of signals, or the transmission of intelligence, or to installations located within or on building or
premises used exclusively by such agency, or on public thoroughfares.
9.2.9.1.4 Railway utilities: The provisions of this Code shall not apply to the installations or equipment
employed by the Railway Corporation in the exercise of its functions as a public carrier, and located
outdoors or in buildings used exclusively for that purpose.
9.2.9.1.5 Radio and television transmitting stations: The provisions of this Code shall not apply to
electrical equipment used for radio and television transmission, except the equipment and wiring for
power supply and the installations of towers and antennae, whether erected on buildings or on the ground.
9.2.9.1.6 Electric installation standards: Conformity with the installation of electric conductors and
equipment to the provisions of the Electrical Code, shall be the prima facie evidence that such
installations are reasonably safe for use in the service intended and in compliance with the provisions of
this Code.
9.2.9.1.7 Electric equipment standards: The materials, appliances, and other equipment listed in
published reports of inspected electrical equipment by the Standards Organisation of Nigeria, and other
approved agencies and testing organisations, and installed in accordance with any instructions included as
part of such listing, shall be approved as meeting the requirements of this Code.
Design Stage / Section 9 Service Engineering Design Requirements / 9.2
Electrical Engineering Design Requirements / 9.2.9.2 Plans and Specifications
9.2.9.2.1 General: Plans, specifications and schedules in sufficient detail shall be filed with the Code
Enforcement Division/Section/Unit showing the location and capacity of all lighting facilities, electrically
operated equipment and electrical circuits required for all service equipment of the building or structure.
9.2.9.2.2 Items covered: All electrically controlled devices, including signal, communicating and
lighting systems and their wiring, whenever required under the provisions of this code shall be shown on
the plans and elevations of the building or structure with respect to those uses covered by Section
9.2.9.2.3 through to 9.2.9.2.9.
9.2.9.2.3 Emergency/hazard use lighting: Places of public assembly and education and control of
emergency lighting systems in accordance with Section 7.24 and hazardous uses in Section 7.2.
9.2.9.2.4 Exit and elevator lighting: Stairway and exit illumination in accordance with Sections 7.3 and
10.25; “Exit” sign lighting circuits, Section 10.24, elevator car illumination, Section (refer to mechanical
installations)
9.2.9.2.5 Service equipment: Electrical equipment and control of heating, refrigerating and ventilating
machinery and devices, in accordance with the mechanical code.
9.2.9.2.6 Fire alarm and signal systems: Fire alarm signal systems, fire department communication and
supervisory service in accordance with Sections 12.2.18, 12.2.19 and 12.2.21.
9.2.9.2.7 Construction operations: Temporary construction lighting requirements equivalent to 50 lux
in accordance with Section 13.13.
[Page 302]
9.2.9.2.8 Signs and towers: Wiring of display signs radio and television antennae, in accordance with
the Electrical Code.
9.2.9.2.9 Toilets and bathrooms: Illumination of toilets and bathrooms equivalent to 50 lux in
accordance with Section 9.2.1.1 (a).
9.2.9.3.1 During installation: During the installation of electrical systems and equipment, the code
enforcement officer shall make inspections to ensure compliance with the provisions of this Part, except
as provided in Section 9.2.9.5.
9.2.9.3.2 Final inspection and test: On completion of the work, the code enforcement officer shall
inspect the work and cause tests to be made of the operation of the entire system to ensure compliance
with all requirements.
9.2.9.4.1 Permission: Permission for temporary electricity supply shall be obtained in accordance with
the Electrical Code.
9.2.9.5.1 General: Electrical wiring or equipment shall not be installed within or on any building,
structure or premises, nor shall any alteration be made in any such existing installations, without first
securing approval and a permit as specified in the Electrical Code. It shall be unlawful to use or allow the
use of, or to supply current for an electrical system in a building or structure, unless the required
certificate of inspection and permit have been issued as specified in the Electrical Code.
9.2.9.5.2 Exception: A permit shall not be required for the execution and use of the classes of work
specified in Section 9.2.9.5.3 through to 9.2.9.5.6.
9.2.9.5.3 Repairs and maintenance: Minor repair work, including the replacement of lamps or the
connection of approved portable electrical equipment to approved permanently installed receptacles.
9.2.9.5.4 Public service agencies: The installation, alteration or repair of electrical equipment for the
operation of communications and signals or the transmission of intelligence by wire by a public service
company for its use in the generation, transmission, distribution or metering of electricity.
9.2.9.5.5 Power companies: The installation, alteration or repair of electrical equipment of a power or
public service company for its use in the generation, transmission, distribution or metering of electricity.
9.2.9.5.6 Temporary testing systems: The installation of any temporary system required for the testing
or servicing of electrical equipment or apparatus.
9.2.9.6.1 General: Alterations shall not be made to any existing installations of electric wiring or
equipment for which a permit is required within or on any building, structure or premises, except as
provided in Section 9.2.9.5, without first securing the approval and a permit from the code enforcement
officer.
9.2.9.6.2 Defective wiring: If, upon inspection, an electric wiring system is found defective and unsafe,
the code enforcement officer shall cause such defective wiring to be rectified.
[Page 303]
9.2.9.6.3 Additional loads: When additional electrical loads are to be connected to existing service in
buildings or structures the existing load shall be established. New loads shall be computed in accordance
with the requirements of the provisions of the Electrical Code.
9.2.9.7.1 General: Emergency electrical systems are those systems required to automatically supply
power for illumination and equipment in the event of failure of the normal power supply. The emergency
electrical system shall conform to the provisions of the Electrical Code. The systems shall pick up their
connected loads within 10 seconds after failure of the normal power supply and shall operate under all
weather conditions.
9.2.9.7.2 Capacity: The emergency systems shall have the capacity to operate equipment such as egress
lighting, exit signs, door locks, and any other emergency equipment as required by other sections of this
Code.
9.2.9.7.3 Power source: The emergency electrical system shall not be connected to a standby power
system and shall come on as priority load.
9.2.9.8.1 General: Standby power systems are those intended to automatically supply power to selected
loads required by this Code, other than those classified as emergency systems, in the event of failure of
the normal power source. Standby power systems shall conform to the provisions of the Electrical Code.
The systems shall pick up their connected loads within 60 seconds of failure of the normal power supply
and shall operate under all weather conditions.
9.2.9.8.2 Capacity: Standby power systems shall have the capacity and rating to operate equipment such
as mechanical systems, fire pumps, signal, lighting, communication, elevators, and other standby
equipment as required by other sections of this Code. The capacity and rating shall include the ability to
start all rotating equipment from a standing start. The system capacity need not be sized to operate all the
connected equipment simultaneously where loads can be manually controlled.
9.2.9.8.3 Connection of emergency systems: Where an emergency electrical system is connected to the
standby power system as provided for in Section 9.2.9.7.3, the load pickup time for emergency equipment
shall comply with Section 9.2.9.7.1 and the standby system shall be sized for the additional load.
Construction Stage
Construction Stage
Section 10
Building Materials and Components Requirements
Sections
10.1 General
10.1.1 Hazardous materials
10.1.2 Components
10.2 Stones
10.2.4 Marble
10.2.5 Aggregate for reinforced concrete
10.2.6 Aggregate for concrete
10.2.7 Sand for mortar, plaster, rendering or floor screeds
10.3 Concrete
10.3.1 General
10.3.2 Definitions
10.3.3 Materials used For Concrete
10.3.4 Concrete Quality
10.3.5 Designed Concrete Mixes
10.3.6 Durability
10.3.7 Evaluation for Acceptance of Concrete
10.3.8 Frequency of Testing
10.3.9 Quality Control Requirements
10.3.9.3 Mixing and placing of concrete
10.3.10 Shot-crete
10.3.11 Pre-stressed concretes
10.3.12 Precast concretes
10.3.13 Sand-crete Blocks
10.3.14 Pre-Cast Concrete Blocks
10.3.15 Workmanship
10.4 Glass
10.5 Iron and Steel
10.5.3 Reinforcement
10.6 Deformation Requirements
10.7 Sampling and Preparation of Test Pieces
10.8 Non-Ferrous Metals and their Alloys
10.9 Aluminium and its Alloys
10 10 Copper Zinc Lead and their Alloys
g
[Page 307]
10.1 GENERAL
The application of all materials and components used in the construction of buildings must be such that
will achieve aesthetics, durability, functionality, character and affordability.
Locally available building materials should be integrated for their additional advantages of availability,
identity, job creation and affordability.
Any material adjudged as hazardous by the appropriate authority shall not be used in the building. The
use of asbestos and other hazardous materials have been found to be hazardous to health. The use of,
therefore their application in building construction, should be restricted and handled with great care.
10.1.2 Components
All building components shall comply with the provisions of this Code.
10.2 STONES
10.2.1 Scope:
This article specifies rock minerals and rock structures for use in buildings. It also specifies the strength,
fire-resistances, and accepted processes for the use of natural and cast stones as well as the practice for
cleaning and surface repair of stone construction.
Construction Stage / Section 10 Building Materials and Components
Requirements / 10.2 STONES / 10.2.2 Glossary of terms:
The definition of terms for rocks, minerals and rock structures, and terms for masonry tools, handling
equipment, stone work construction, and operation in this Chapter shall be as stipulated and in accordance
with BS 6100.5.2: 1984.
Stones fall into one of three classes: Igneous, sedimentary, or metamorphic rocks; each with recognisable
characteristics.
10.2.3.1 Igneous stones: Include granites, dolerites, basalts and pumice granites are extremely dense,
hard and resistant to knock and abrasion and to attack by ordinary chemicals. Igneous stones can be used
in masonry, facing, flooring, curbing, paving, cladding and damp-proofing.
10.2.3.2 Sedimentary stone: Include sand-stones and lime-stones. They are characterised by grains and
bedding planes which make them potentially weaker than other stones. Sedimentary stones can be used as
masonry, wall cladding, paving, flooring and in making stones.
[Page 308]
10.2.3.3 Metamorphic stones: These include marbles, slates and quartzite. These are either sedimentary
or igneous stones that have been subjected to immense heat and pressure resulting in structural changes.
Metamorphic stones are used in masonry, coping, window-sills, flooring, external paving, wall cladding,
as aggregates, tiling of walls.
10.2.3.4 Use of natural stone for masonry: Natural stone for masonry shall be sound and free from
loose or friable inclusions. It should be hard and durable and without flaws and faults for the intended
use. Stone shall be thoroughly wetted before laying and all masonry kept damp for at least 7 days. Stone
shall pass a resistance to crushing of at least 10.5N/mm2.
10.2.3.5 Clearing and surface repair of stone buildings: The provisions of BS 6270.1: 1982 shall
govern the material, procedure and practice for cleaning and repairs.
10.2.3.6 Other use of stone: Stone can be used as:
Cut stone, rubble, ashlars facing, in addition to their common uses as masonry.
i Cut stone: Stone that is cut or machined to a given size, dimension shape, and produced in
accordance to specifications.
ii Rubble: A natural cleft stone which may be limestone, sandstone or quartzite, used as veneer.
Rubble may have a variety of colours and textures.
iii Ashlar facing: Exposed stone made from broken or cut stone. Ashlar facing can be provided in a
variety of finishes such as: smooth finish, cabo-finish, rubbed finish, sawed finishes, tooled finishes
and hard finishes.
10.2.4 Marble
Marble is fully metamorphosed lime-stones which are very hard, dense and resistant to abrasion. Marble
requires good polish. White and coloured varieties are common.
Marble can be attacked by acids and polluted atmosphere.
Marble can be classified into four groups: A, B, C and D.
A – Sound marble and stones with uniform and favourable working qualities.
B – Marble with some less favourable working qualities which may have occasional
natural faults. These require limited sticking and waxing for use as finishes.
C – Marble with geological flaws, voids, veins, and lines of separation. These will need
waxing, sticking and filling to improve their quality.
D – Highly coloured marble, prized for their decorative qualities.
10.2.4.1 Cast stone: Cast stone is defined as any product manufactured of aggregate and cement and
intended, to resemble the appearance and be used in a similarly way as natural stone. The provisions of
BS 1217: 1975 shall govern the requirements for construction, materials, colours, texture, tolerance,
slenderness ratio, compressive strength and internal surface absorption and the methods for testing for
compressive strength, drying shrinkage and initial surface.
10.2.4.2 The provisions of BS 4357: 1968 shall govern the requirements for pre-cast terrazzo granite
units when used as floor slabs, paving staircase treads, risers and landing, partition and components,
walling panels, skirting and window sills external cladding panels, shower trays and working top.
[Page 309]
Aggregate for reinforced concrete shall consist of sand, gravel, crushed or uncrushed natural stone in
conformity with the appropriate provisions of NCP-1: 1973 provided with: at least 95% of the coarse
aggregate will pass a mesh of size at lest 7mm less than the minimum lateral distance between the
reinforcing bars or 7mm less than the minimum cover, whichever is the smaller or in the case of solid
slabs will pass a 20mm mesh.
Shall be reasonably clean and free from clay or organic or other deleterious matter;
Shall be of such size as to pass a 5mm mesh;
Shall be well graded;
Sand for mortar, plain and reinforced brick-work, block walling and masonry, shall comply with BS
1200: 1976.
Sand for external rendering; internal plastering using mixes of cement and sand (with or without addition
of lime) and for floor screeds shall comply with NCP-1: 1973.
TABLE 10.1
COARSE AGGREGATE
2.36 - - - - - - 0-5
TABLE 10.2
FINE AGGREGATE
*Increased to 20% for crushed rock fines, except when they are used for heavy-duty floors.
Note: Fine aggregate not complying with table 5 may also be used provided that the supplier can satisfy
the purchaser that such materials can produce concrete of the required quality.
(Table 10.2: BS 882: 1983)
TABLE 10.3
ALL-IN AGGREGATE
*Increased to 10% for crushed rock fines. (Table 10.3: BS 882: 1983) recommended limits on the degree
of polished-stone value of the aggregate when used for road surfacing.
BS 2451: 1963 chilled iron shot and grit
This standard specifies the sizes of particles of chilled iron shot and grit, and the method of testing for
size. It also specifies material, form, designation and grading, and describes a hardness test.
[Page 311]
10.3 CONCRETE
10.3.1 General
Structural members of concrete (reinforced, prestressed and plain concrete expressly certified to act as
structural member) shall be designed and constructed in accordance with the provisions of NCP-1: 1973.
The constituent materials of concrete shall conform with the provisions of NCP-1: 1973.
10.3.2 Definitions
TABLE 10.4
PROPORTION AND STRENGTH REQUIREMENTS
FOR NOMINAL CONCRETE MIXES WITH CEMENT
AND AGGREGATES
Designed concrete mixes shall be in accordance with the requirements of Section 2.9 of NCP-1: 1973.
For guidance on the design of standard mixes, refer to Table 16B.
TABLE 10.5
STANDARD MIXES
Workability slump 10mm maximum size 13mm maximum size 19mm maximum size 38m
(mm) compacting
factor
Low Medium High Low Medium High Low Medium High Low
0-5 5-25 25-50 5-20 20-40 40-100 12-25 25-50 50-125 25-50
80-86 81-93 81-87 81-87 87-93 93-97 82-88 88-94 94-97 82-88
N/mm2 kg kg kg kg kg kg kg kg kg kg kg
10.3.6 Durability
Concrete should be dense, impermeable and of a quality suitable for the conditions of exposure involved.
The greater the severity of the exposure, the higher the quality of concrete required, and thus although a
weaker concrete may be adequate from structural considerations this weaker mix may not be suitable
from the durability view-point.
Nominal concrete mixes should not be used for structures exposed to sea water.
[Page 314]
10.3.6.1 Protection from chemical attack: Concrete shall be protected from chemical attack by
complying with the provisions of Section 4.8 of NCP-1: 1973.
10.3.7.1 General: For evaluation and acceptance of concrete the procedures established in Section 2.8.3
(1)-(3) of NCP-1: 1973 shall be adopted.
Samples for strength tests of each mix of concrete placed each day shall be taken not less than once a day.
10.3.9.1 General: In order to maintain a high standard of quality, the following should be observed.
10.3.9.2 Supervision: A competent professional should be employed whose first duty it will be to
supervise all stages in the preparation and placing of the concrete. All tests on materials, the making and
testing of cubes and the maintenance and calibration of all mixing and measuring tools should be carried
out under his direct supervision.
The requirements of Section 2.9.4 of NCP-1: 1973 should be fully complied with.
10.3.9.3 Mixing and placing of concrete
10.3.9.4 General: The preparation, handling and curing of concrete shall be performed in accordance
with the requirement of this section.
10.3.9.5 Preparation of equipment and place of deposit: Preparation before concrete placement shall
include the following:
a. All equipment for mixing and transporting concrete shall be clean.
b. All debris shall be removed from spaces to be occupied by concrete.
c. Forms shall be properly coated.
d. Masonry filler units that will be in contact with concrete shall be well drenched.
e. Reinforcement shall be thoroughly clean of all types of deleterious coating.
f. Water shall be removed from place of deposit before concrete is placed unless otherwise
permitted by the supervising officer.
g. All laitance and other unsound materials shall be removed before additional concrete is placed
against hardened concrete.
i Mixing: All concrete shall be mixed until there is a uniform distribution of materials, and
shall be discharged completely before the mixer is recharged. Concrete shall be mixed for
four minutes immediately after water is added and should not stay for more than 45
minutes before placement.
ii Conveying: Concrete shall be conveyed from mixer to place of final deposit by methods
that will prevent separation or loss of materials. Conveying equipment shall be capable of
providing a supply of concrete at site of placement without separation of ingredients and
without interruptions sufficient to permit loss of plasticity between successive increments.
iii Depositing: Concrete shall be deposited as nearly as practicable in its final position to
avoid segregation due to re-handling or flowing. Concrete [Page 315] shall be deposited
as soon as possible after mixing and without segregation of the material.
iv Placement timing: Concrete shall be carried on at such a rate that concrete is at all times
plastic and flows readily into spaces between reinforcement.
v Unacceptable concrete: Concrete that has partially hardened or been contaminated by
foreign materials shall not be deposited in the structure.
vi Retempering: Retempering concrete or concrete that has been remixed after initial set
shall not be used unless approved by the supervising officer.
vii Continuous concreting: After concreting is started, it shall be carried on as a continuous
operation until placing of a panel or section, as defined by its boundaries or
predetermined joints, is completed except as permitted or prohibited by the supervising
officer.
viii Placement in walls: Top surfaces of vertically formed lifts shall be generally level.
ix Construction joints: When construction joints are required, joints shall be made in
accordance with the recommendations of the structural engineer.
x Consolidation: All concrete shall be thoroughly consolidated by tampering or by any
other suitable means, including vibration, during placement and shall be thoroughly
worked around reinforcement and embedded fixtures and into corners of forms.
xi Curing: Concrete (other than high-early-strength concrete) shall be maintained above
50°F (10°C) and in a moist condition for at least the first seven days after placement.
xii Hot weather requirements: During hot weather, attention shall be given to ingredients,
production methods, handling, placing, protection, and curing to prevent excessive
concrete temperatures or water evaporation that would impair required strength or
serviceability of the member or structure.
10.3.10.1 General: Except as specified in the following sections, shot-crete shall conform to the
requirements for plain concrete or reinforced concrete.
10.3.10.2 Definition: Shot-crete is mortar or concrete pneumatically projected at high velocity unto a
surface.
i Proportioning: Shot-crete proportions shall be selected that allow suitable placement procedures
using the delivery equipment selected, and that results in in-place hardened shot-crete meeting the
strength requirement of this Code.
ii Aggregates: Coarse aggregates if used, shall not exceed 19mm in size.
iii Rebound: Any rebound or accumulated loose aggregate shall be removed from the surfaces to be
covered prior to placing the initial or any succeeding layers of shot-crete. Rebound shall not be
reused as aggregates.
[Page 316]
iv Joints: Except where permitted herein, unfinished work shall not be allowed to stand for more than
30 minutes unless all edges are sloped to a thin edge. For structural elements which will be under
compression and for construction joints shown on the approved plans, square joints shown on the
approved plans, square joints are permitted. Before placing additional material adjacent to
previously applied work, sloping and square edges shall be cleaned and wetted.
v Damage: Any-in-place shot-crete which exhibits sags or sloughs, segregations, honey-combing,
sand pockets or other obvious defects shall be removed and replaced.
vi Curing: During the curing periods specified herein, shot-crete shall be maintained in a moist
condition. In highland areas, shot-crete shall be maintained at 40ºC.
vii Initial curing: Shot-crete shall be kept continuously moist for 24 hours after shot-creting is
completed or shall be sealed with an approved curing compound.
viii Final curing: Final curing shall continue seven days after shot-creting, or for three days if
high-early-strength cement is used, or until the specified strength is obtained. Final curing shall
consist of either the initial curing process or the shot-crete shall be covered with an approved
moisture retaining cover.
ix Natural curing: Natural curing shall not be used in lieu of that specified above unless the relative
humidity remains at or above 85 percent, and is authorised by the design architect/engineer, and
approved by the supervising officer.
These concretes shall be dense, impermeable and of a quality suitable for the conditions of pre-stress
involved. Concretes of high quality and durability are normally required and should conform with the
recommendations of the registered structural engineer.
Construction Stage / Section 10 Building Materials and Components
Requirements / 10.3 CONCRETE / 10.3.12 Pre-cast Concretes
Pre-cast concretes shall meet the durability requirements of their applications and shall satisfy the
recommendations of a registered structural engineer.
10.3.13.1 Sand-crete blocks:–shall mean a composite material made up of cement, sharp sand and
water.
i Blocks shall be moulded for sand-crete using metal (wood) moulds of:
450mm x 225mm x 150mm
450mm x 225mm x 225mm
450mm x 225mm x 100mm
ii They are usually jointed by mortar which is a rich mix of sand-crete.
[Page 317]
10.3.14.1 NCP 1:1973 Aggregate: Included both coarse and fine, from natural sources, blast furnace
slag, crushed clay and furnace clinker.
10.3.14.2 NCP 1:1973 Sand: shall be of approved clean, sharp, fresh water or pit sand. Free from clay,
loam, dirt, organic or saline water of any description and shall mainly pass 4.70mm (3/16") Test sieve. If
lagoon sand is used this must be properly washed to the approval of the Supervisor.
10.3.14.3 Mix proportions: Mix used for blocks shall not be richer than 1 part by volume of cement to 6
parts of fine aggregate (sand) except that the proportion of cement to mixed-aggregate may be reduced to
1:41/2 (Where the thickness of the web of the block is one 25mm or less).
10.3.14.4 Strength requirements: Sandcrete blocks shall posses resistance to crushing as stated below
and the 28 day compressive strength for a load bearing wall of two or three storey building shall not be
less than:–
10.3.14.5 Moulding: The twenty eight day compressive strength of a sandcrete block for load bearing
wall of two or three storey buildings shall not be less than the values given above and shall comply with
the existing NIS specification for sandcrete blocks.
10.3.14.6 Compaction: Two methods to be applied depending on the availability of materials (tools)
1. By approved (standard) machine compaction.
2. By metal mould (hand) compaction.
10.3.14.7 Production/processing: The sandcrete block shall be cast using an appropriate machine with
cement/sand ratio of 1:6 measured by volume. Where hand mixing is carried out, the materials shall be
mixed until an even colour and consistency throughout is attained. The measure shall be further mixed
and water added through a fire hose in such sufficient quantity as to secure adhesion. It shall then be well
rammed into moulds and smoothed off with a steel face tool.
10.3.14.8 Curing: After removal from the machine, the blocks shall be left on pallets under cover in
separate rows, one block high, with a space between each block for at least 24 hours and kept wet by
weathering through a fire watering hose. The blocks [Page 318] may then be removed from the pallets
and stacked during which time the blocks shall be kept wet. The blocks may be stacked not more than five
blocks high under cover at least seven (7) days before use after the previous period.
10.3.14.9 Physical requirements: Special sizes and shapes of blocks and blocks 11.25mm (i.e. 4½”)
thick or less shall be solid with groove and tongued joints. Blocks of greater thickness, than 11.25mm
(4½”) thick shall be hollow of used above damp proof course. Hollow blocks shall be more than 50mm
thick. Hollow blocks shall be used only where vertical steel reinforcement is to be fixed.
10.3.15 Workmanship
All block walling shall be built in cement and sand of 1:6 mortar. The mortar shall be used in within 1
hour of mixing. The mortar is also subject to variation in compressive strength. The strength of adhesion
to the units, its jointing, and the manner with which it is placed. Mortar shall not be used or mixed with
any other mortar after it has began to set, nor shall any mortar of any kind of a previous day’s mixing be
used.
A proper stage shall be provided to receive the mortar when made. The joints in the block-work shall not
exceed 9.39mm (?) in thickness. Greater care should be taken during the laying of blocks to ensure proper
adhesion of mortar to the blocks. The perpends in alternative course must be directly above one another
and every joint both vertical and horizontal shall be properly flushed with mortar. Simple lipping at the
edges of the joints shall not be permitted.
Joints on wall faces to be plastered shall be raked out 9.39mm (?”).
All corners, cross-wall junctions and reveals shall be properly bonded. No blocks shall be well wetted
before being laid or built on.
All block-work is to be laid in stretcher bond properly bedded and jointed with (at) course level, perpends
true and all quoins, jambs and angles, plumbed as the work proceeds. It must be borne in mind that failure
of the block columns at the joint should be avoided at all possible cost.
Note: The bending moment carrying capacity of the columns increase as the sand/cement ratio decreases.
It also increases with water/cement ratio in the range of water/cement ratio considered.
10.4 GLASS
10.4.1 Definition:
Glass herein is defined as a hard, brittle substance that is usually transparent, made by melting sand with
soda, potash, lime, or other substances applicable to buildings and structures.
10.4.2 General:
The provisions of this Section shall govern the materials, design, construction, quality and requirement of
glass and glazing in vertical and sloped applications. All glass for the purposes of buildings shall have a
flame – Spread rating as predetermined test exposure of 45-minute duration.
For building purposes, annealed flat glass, processed flat glass, and miscellaneous glass in accordance to
terms, definitions, together with details of nominal thickness, weight and tolerance shall conform to BS
952.
[Page 319]
Terms used in the glass industry, covering types and properties of glass, raw materials, melting, forming
and finishing, forms of glass shall be in accordance to BS 3447: 1962.
Regular plate, sheet or patterned glass in louvered windows shall not be thinner than nominal 5.6mm and
not longer than 1219mm. When other glass types are used, design shall be submitted to the supervising
officer, for approval. Exposed glass edges shall be smooth (dulled).
Where one or more sides of any sheet of glass is not firmly supported, or is subjected to unusual load
conditions, detailed shop drawings, specification and analysis or data assuring safe performance for the
specific installation shall be prepared by engineers experienced in this work and approved by the
supervising officials.
Where individual panels are more than 13mm2 in an area, a supplementary stiffener shall be provided
behind the panels, anchored thereto and to the structural supports.
Essential requirement for lead barium silicate (Type LBSD) and lead Silicate (Type LS) glasses or
protection against X-ray radiation and a method of measuring the lead equivalent shall conform as
stipulated in BS 4031: 1966 (as given in Table 17 below)
TYPICAL EXAMPLES OF MINIMUM LEAD EQUIVALENTS
(Table BS:17)
10.4.9 Impact performance requirement for flat safety glass and safety plastics for use in building: This
section shall comply with BS 6206: 1981. Classification of safety glass and safety plastics according to
behaviour on impact shall conform to Table 17.2 below.
TABLE 10.6
[Page 320]
Glass in windows, curtains and window walls, skylights, doors, and other exterior applications shall be
chosen to resist the wind load in accordance with structural design requirements.
Any installation of glass or other transparent, translucent, or opaque glazing material installed at a slope
of 15 degrees or more from the vertical plane including skylights, roofs and sloped walls shall comply
with section 17.11.10.
10.4.12 Framing:
All sloped glazing and skylight frames shall be constructed of non-combustible materials.
10.4.13 Limitations:
Heat-strengthened glass and fully-tempered glass when used in monolithic glazing material, to protect
building occupants from falling glass should breakage occur.
Each skylight unit shall have a maximum area within the curb of 9.3m2 except that the area of skylight
units shall not be limited in building equipped throughout with an approved automatic fire suppression
system.
The aggregate area of skylight shall not exceed 33 percent of the floor area of the room or space sheltered
by the roof in which they are installed.
This section shall be in conformity with section 1420.0 – 1420.4 of the BOCA National Building Code
1987.
Every room or space intended for human occupancy shall have an exterior glazing area of not less than 8
percent of the floor area.
Where natural light for room or spaces without exterior glazing area is provided through an adjoining
room, the unobstructed opening to the adjoining room shall be at least 8 percent of the floor area.
10.4.20 Stairways:
Interior stairways shall be provided with an exterior glazing area of not less than 0.93m2 on every floor
through which the stairway passes.
Natural light shall be capable of providing a minimum illumination as specified for natural light.
[Page 321]
Maximum size (6.35mm) wired glass which has been labelled for use in approved labelled opening
protectives, shall conform to the size limitations set below:
Limiting size of wired glass panels: See Table below:
The working strength of glass for any location in which it is required to withstand wind or impact shall
comply with Section 12.1.8 as stipulated above.
The following shall be considered specific hazardous locations for purpose of glazing.
1. Glazing in ingress and egress doors.
2. Glazing in fixed, sliding or swinging panels of sliding or swinging – type doors.
3. Glazing in storm doors.
4. Glazing in all unframed swinging doors.
5. All glazing in railings regardless of area or height above a walking surface.
All packages and containers of glass shall bear the label of an approved agency showing the flame –
spread rating and fire-resistance rating of the product at the thickness tested or the use for which the
product has been listed.
10.5.1 General:
The provisions of this Chapter shall govern the materials and quality of steel structural members.
Structural steel construction used in all building and structures shall be fabricated from materials of
uniform quality, free from defects that would vitiate the strength or stability of the structure.
All the provisions of NIS 117: 1988 shall be complied with in the selection and use of reinforcing steel
bars for concrete.
10.5.2.1 The structural use of steel
10.5.2.2 General: The purpose of this section is to ensure that structural steel work is adequately
protected against corrosion and has adequate strength, stiffness and stability.
10.5.2.3 Cleaning and protection against corrosion
i Structural steel shall be cleaned of loose scale and rust and, except where it is to be solidly encased
with brick-work, concrete or other similar non-combustible material, shall be either thoroughly
coated with at least two coats of paint or boiled oil, one coat of which, subject to sub-paragraph
(with such other protection against corrosion as shall to the satisfaction of the supervising o with
such other protection against corrosion as shall to the satisfaction of the supervising officer.
[Page 322]
ii The coating with paint or boiled oil or the provision of other protection against corrosion, of all
surfaces inaccessible after erection, except surfaces held in direct contact by riveting or intermittent
welding, shall be carried out before erection.
10.5.3 Reinforcement
10.5.3.1 General: The purpose of this Section is to ensure that reinforced concrete has adequate strength,
stiffness and stability.
10.5.3.2 Reinforcement shall be free from loose mill scale, loose rust, oil or other matter which might
affect adversely the proper function of reinforcement with concrete.
10.5.3.3 Grades: Bars shall be grade 230 or 420 in accordance with Clause 2.1.1 or 2.1.2 of NIS 117:
1988 as applicable.
Table 18A shown below gives some properties of these grades of steel.
TABLE 10.7
TENSILE PROPERTIES
1 2 3 4 5
GRADE REH RP 0.2 RM A
(Minimum (Minimum (Minimum) (Minimum)
MPA) (OR MPA) %
N/MM2
230 HD 230 - 1.15 REH 22
230 HP 230 - 1.15 REH 22
420 HD 420 - 1.15 REH 12
420 CD - 420 1.08 RPO.2 12
TABLE 10.8
DIMENSIONAL AND MASS REQUIREMENTS FOR DEFORMED STEEL REINFORCING
BARS
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Deformation requirements
Bar size Calculated Calculated Nominal Maximum Minimum Maximum
(mm) mass per 2 2 average average gap (mm)
area (mm ) area (mm )
meter spacing height
(kg/m) (mm) (mm)
6 0.222 28.2 30 4.2 0.2 2.3
8 0.395 50.3 47.8 5.6 0.3 3.1
10 0.617 78.5 73.8 7.0 0.4 3.9
12 0.888 110 110 8.4 0.5 4.7
16 1.579 201.1 200 11.2 0.7 6.3
20 2.466 314.2 310 14.0 1.0 7.9
25 3.853 490.9 479.2 16.8 1.25 9.9
28 4.834 615.8 620 19.6 1.40 11.0
32 9.313 804 800 22.4 1.60 12.6
36 7.991 1017.9 1020 25.2 1.80 14.1
40 9.864 1256.6 1260 28.0 2.00 15.7
50 1963.5 1963.5 1960 35.0 2.50 19.6
[Page 324]
10.5.3.7:
TABLE 10.9
FREQUENCY OF TENSILE AND BEND TEST
10.5.3.8 Other tests which may be considered necessary for the works to be done should comply with the
provisions of Sections 9.3, 9.4 and 9.5 of NIS 117: 1988.
10.6.1 General:
Deformations in concrete reinforcement bars shall conform to the requirement of this Section and Table
18B.
All the requirements of deformation stated in Section 6.3 of NIS 117: 1988 shall be complied with.
10.7.2 For bars of grade 230HD, 230HP and 420HD, samples shall be taken from steel on each ladle for
tensile and bend test pieces. They shall not be annealed or otherwise subjected to heat treatment after
selection.
10.7.3 Tensile and bend test pieces shall be the full section of the bar as rolled and the tensile properties
shall be determined on the nominal area of the bar.
10.7.4 For bar having a diameter of 32mm or more, proportional tensile test pieces may be prepared from
the test samples by machining, and the tensile properties shall be determined from the actual
cross-sectional area of the piece.
10.7.6 For bars of grade 420CD, test samples of sufficient length for the specified tensile and bend tests
shall be cut from the finished bar after cold-working at a frequency not less than that given in Table 18C.
10.8.2 Scope:
This article governs the materials, profiles, properties and dimensions of hot-galvanised corrugated steel
sheets for building and general purpose. The Nigerian Industrial Standards governing the manufacture
and use of galvanised corrugated steel products as stipulated in NIS 180: 1988.
The standard definitions of the following terms and concepts: hot-dipping; galvanising, coating, dross,
fluxing, prickling, standard dimensions, pitch and depth of corrugation: shall be in conformity with those
provided by NIS 180: 1989 under the appropriate sub-headings.
[Page 325]
The quality of steel sheets and the process to be used in the production of galvanised steel products shall
be those specified in NIS 180: 1989.
The quality of zinc to be used in the galvanisation process should be of minimum purity of 98.5% for the
bath.
10.8.5 Continuously hot-dip zinc coated and iron alloy coated steel:
Wide strips, sheets, plates and slits: The standard required for Iron-zinc alloy-coated steel flat rolled
products in forming and structural grades by a continuous process is governed by this article. The
composition, mechanical strength, coating mass, test methods, dimensional tolerance, and geometrical
deviations are as stipulated hereunder and in conformity with BS 2989: 1982.
This standard stipulates 4 types of galvanised steel corrugated steel sheets as specified in Table 6.1 below
and as stipulated in NIS 180: 1989.
KG/m2 KG/m2
A 0.381 0.455
B 0.458 0.455
C 0.550 0.608
D 0.610 0.762
The mass of zinc coating on galvanised steel shall be determined by one of the two methods specified in
NIS 180: 1989.
The galvanised corrugated steel shall be free from twist and buckle. Galvanised flat sheet shall be clean,
and its surface free from contamination and other defects. It should conform to the standards stipulated in
NIS 7: 1982.
10.8.9. General properties and standard specifications for galvanised corrugated steel with respect
to:
coating adherence of sheets, standard dimensions, thickness of base sheet, standard width and length,
thickness and mass, marking and methods of calculation of mass of sheets shall be in accordance with
NIS 180.8.12: 1983.
10.9.1 Scope:
The provisions of this article shall govern the materials, design, construction and quality of aluminium
and its alloys for use in building construction.
The definition of terms used in wrought aluminium industry in connection with the manufacture of
products shall be as defined hereunder and in conformity with BS 3660: 1976.
The standard, quality and characteristics required of sheet, plate and strip made from various grades of
aluminium and aluminium alloys under various conditions for use in building and general engineering
purposes shall be in conformity with BS 1470: 1972.
[Page 326]
10.9.4 Bars, extended tubes and sections of aluminium and its alloys:
The requirement for solid bars, sections, extruded round tubes, and hollow sections made from various
grades of aluminium and aluminium alloys under various conditions shall be in accordance with BS 1474:
1972.
Rivets, bolts and screw stock of one grade of aluminium and 4 aluminium alloys made under various
conditions shall be in accordance with BS 1473: 1972.
This article specifies the requirements and methods for testing for organic coating used for finishing
aluminium sections, and also for the finish of the section themselves. The products and process shall be in
accordance with BS 4842: 1972.
10.10.1 Scope:
The provisions of these articles shall govern the material, design, construction and quality of copper, zinc,
lead and their alloys with particular reference to their use in building industry.
Definition of the terms for wrought product of these metals to include the following: Cast forms, wrought
forms, processing, thermal treatment, finishes, dimensional surface and structural characteristics,
packaging and temper-designation shall be in conformity with those stipulated in the current Engineering
Code of Practice.
Three grades of copper are used in building (A) Deoxidized copper; (B) Rise-refined tough pitch copper,
and (C) Electrolytic tough pitch high conductivity copper.
Grade A: Copper is used in domestic plumbing tubes where welding is to be carried out.
Grade B: Copper is a stronger grade and more resistant to atmospheric corrosion than grade A. It is used
as sheets for fully supported roof covering.
Grade C: is similar to Grade B, but of higher purity. It is used for electricity conductors.
The most common alloys of copper are those of copper and zinc in different proportions resulting in
various types of brasses; and those of copper and tin for various types of bronzes. These two alloys are
used in building industry for their enhanced characteristics.
Name plates, door furniture, extrusions and sheets for various uses.
10.10.5 Rolled copper and copper alloy sheet, strip and foils:
This section governs the standard, quality and characteristic requirements for rolled copper and copper
alloy sheet, strip and foil for general purposes in thickness not exceeding 10mm covering several grades
of copper and copper alloys which should be in conformity with stipulations of BS 2870: 1980.
The standard specification for wrought copper and copper alloys plates of over 10mm thickness shall be
as stipulated in BS 2875: 1969.
[Page 327]
The standard specification governing the materials, freedom from defect, stamping, dimensions, guages,
bending tests, and other requirements relating to Construction method of laying zinc on different roofing
forms shall be as stipulated in BS 849: 1979.
This article governs the requirement for composition, manufacture, dimensions and use of 2 types of zinc
alloys: a crip-resistant zinc/lead alloy for flashings; The typical sizes and physical and mechanical
properties shall be in accordance with BS 6569: 1985.
The standard specification for soft milled load sheet for roofing, flashings, wallings, damp-proofing
courses and similar building work shall be as specified in BS 1178: 1982.
10.11.1.1 General requirements and quality: Bricks shall be hand or machine moulded. They shall be
made of clay, properly prepared, rightly burnt and shall be free from deep or extensive cracks, warpage
and other flaws to affect adversely their strength and quality. Moreover, the bricks shall be free from
salts, pebbles, lime particles and any material likely to cause efflorescence or stains in the rendering of
plaster. They shall also, when a cut surface is examined, show a reasonable uniform texture. They shall
have smooth rectangular faces with 2 sharp edges and emit clear ringing sound when struck.
Terminology:– A walling unit not exceeding 337.55mm in length, 225mm in width, or 112.5mm in
height.
10.11.2.1 Clay block: A walling unit exceeding in length, width, or height, the dimensions specified for
bricks.
Note: Bricks and blocks for walling are units designed to be
i laid in a bed of mortar;
ii when the term “brick” is used in this Code, it shall be deemed to refer to units of all sizes and
blocks.
10.11.2.2 Common bricks: Suitable for general building works, to give an attractive appearance.
Specially made or selected to give an attractive appearance when used without rendering or plaster or
other surface treatment of the wall.
Engineering bricks: Having a dense and strong semi-vitreous body conforming to defined limits for
absorption and strength.
Brick suitable for internal use only. (may need protection on site during inclement weather).
10.12 VARIATIONS
In which small holes passing through, or nearly through it, do not exceed 25% of its volume, or in which
frogs (depression in the beds faces of a brick) do not exceed 20% of its volume.
Note: For the purpose of this definitions, a small hole is a hole less than 20mm wide or less than 500mm2
which may be incorporated as aids to handling within the total 25%.
In which holes passing through it exceed 25% of its volume (the holes are not small as defined in solid
bricks alone up to three layer holes not exceeding 3250mm2 each may be incorporated as aids to
handling).
In which holes passing through it exceeds 25% of its volume and the holes are not small, as defined
above.
Normally made by pressing, perforated and hollow bricks and blocks by extrusion perforations and
hollows may be either perpendicular to the bed faces (V-type) or parallel to the bed face (H-type).
10.12.5 Compliance:
for dimension of bricks is based on a sample of twenty four (24) and of blocks on a sample of ten (10) of
which no more than two (2) may exceed permissive deviations.
10.13 FORMATS
The formats of bricks shall be designated in term of their co-ordinating size, which includes the thickness
of a mortar joint. This mortar joint is taken for the purpose of this Code as equal to 10mm. (See Table) –
standard format bricks and blocks.
TABLE 10.10
STANDARD FORMAT (Bricks and blocks)
BRICKS MM MM MM
225 X 112.5 X 75
10.13.1 Dimensional tolerances (bulk supply): The bulk supply of load of bricks shall be deemed to
comply with the formats (Clause above) if the overall measurement of a sample of 24, taken in
accordance with (Clause 5.2 NIS 74: 2003 – Methods of [Page 329] Sampling): and tested in accordance
with (Clause 3.3) NIS 74: 2003, do not fall outside the tolerance given in Table 2; NIS 74: 2003. If the
measurement of the sample falls outside these tolerances the bulk supply or load shall be deemed not to
comply. No testing of a second sample shall be permitted.
10.13.2 Determination of dimensions: Twenty four (24) whole bricks shall be selected in accordance
with methods of sampling (Clause 5.2 NIS 74: 2003). All blisters, loose particles of clay and small
projections shall be removed. They shall then be arranged upon a level surface successively as in Fig. 1a,
1b and 1c in contact with each other and in a straight line. The overall length of the assembled bricks shall
be measured with a steel tape or other suitable inextensible measuring device sufficiently long to measure
the whole row at one stretch. Measurement by repeated application of a short rule or measuring device
shall not be permitted. If for any reason it is found impracticable to measure 24 bricks in a row, the
samples may be divided into two rows of 12 or three rows of 8 which shall be measured separately to the
nearest millimetre and their measurements added. The measurement of one row of 12 or 8 units and
multiplication by 2 or 3 shall not be considered satisfactory, because of the probability that the mean
dimensions of so small a sample would differ appreciably from the mean dimension of the bulk supply.
10.13.3 Physical properties (NIS 17: 1974): Compressive strength: When tested, the compressive
strength of the bricks of ordinary quality shall not be less than 3.0N/mm2. This minimum strength is
acceptable provided the bricks are satisfactory in other respects.
10.13.4 Calculated compressive strength by the formula: Compressive strength (kgf/cm2) =
Maximum load at failure (kgf)
Cross sectional Area of bricks (cm2).
The average of the results shall be taken as the compressive strength of the specimen.
Water absorption: When tested in accordance with the procedure laid down in Schedule B, the average
water absorption of common building bricks shall not be more than 25% by weight after immersion in
water for 24 hours.
Efflorescence: When common bricks are tested in accordance with the procedure laid down in Schedule
C, the rating of efflorescence shall not be worse than moderate.
Warpage: When tested in accordance with the procedure laid down in Schedule D, the warpage shall not
exceed 1% of the dimension measured.
10.14 BINDERS
10.14.1 Cement: shall be;
10.14.1.1(a) Ordinary Portland Cement shall comply with the appropriate provisions of NIS 11: 1974.
Ordinary Portland Cement should be ground to a very fine powder with an average specific surface of not
less than 2500cm/g.
Shall have initial setting time of not less than 45 minutes and final setting time of 10 hours.
O.P.C shall be very sound with an expansion of not more than 5mm.
O.P.C shall be stored immediately in an air-tight container such as a bag made from thick water-proof
sheets. The volume of air remaining in the filled container shall be the minimum practicable.
[Page 330]
Cement shall be stored in the order in which it will be used, and in such a manner as to permit easy access
for proper inspection and identification of each consignment and in a suitable weather-tight building to
protect the cement from dampness and to minimize ware-house deterioration (FIRST IN, FIRST OUT). In
addition, cement of different brand, shall not be used together in the mix.
O.P.C. shall have the average compressive strength of 3 mortar cubes prepared and stored and tested after
3 days and 7 days, the 3 days strength shall not be less than 15mn/m2. The 7 day strength shall show an
increase on the compressive strength at 3 days and shall not be less than 24MN/m2.
TABLE 10.11
TESTS AND SPECIFICATIONS FOR GYPSUM BUILDING PLASTERS
A B C D
Plaster of Retarded Anhydrous Keene’s
Paris hemihydrate gypsum plaster
Chemical composition (%
by weight of plaster) 35% 35% 40% 47%
Minimum SO 2 2 2 2
/3 SO3 /3 SO3 /3 SO3 /3 SO3
Minimum CaO3 0.2% 0.2% 0.2% 0.2%
TABLE 10.12
TESTS AND SPECIFICATIONS FOR PREMIXED LIGHTWEIGHT PLASTERS
1Browning 2 3
plaster Metal Bonding
lathing plaster
plaster
Maximum 1040
3 1.0
Dry set density (kg/m )
Maximum
Compressive strength
(N/mm2)
Minimum mechanical
resistance (dropping ball test)
Diameter of indentation
10.14.2 Gypsum
10.14.3 Lime
10.14.3.1 Lime for mortar or plasters: Lime used for building works shall comply with the appropriate
provisions of BS 890: 1972.
a. shall be properly slaked or run to putty before use, and all proportioning shall be in respect of
one of these forms;
b. shall to the satisfaction of the supervising officer, be in other respects suitable, having regard to
the particular circumstances of the case;
c. shall be used in such manner as the Code Enforcement Officer may approve as being suitable.
Cement – Lime – mortar shall be composed of ordinary Portland cement or rapid hardening cement and
lime mixed with sand in proportions specified by supervising officer and are capable of setting and
hardening when cured under water.
[Page 332]
10.14.4 Pozzolonas: Shall comply with BS 6588: and BS 6610: 1985.
The main criterion is that the Portland – pozzolona cement should be comparable in strength and other
related properties to Ordinary Portland Cement.
This standard specifies the methods of sampling and testing bone, skin and fish glues.
Table 10.13 lists the tests and summarises the mass of glue and the volume of water required for each test.
TABLE 10.13
GLUE CONCENTRATIONS
[Page 333]
TABLE 10.14
BS 647: 1981
Strengths Test
of adhesive
Boiling water resistance Hot water resistance Cold water resistance Micro-org
Condition Time Failing Condition Time Failing Condition Time Failing Conditio
Force force force
(min.) (min.) (min.)
h kN h kN h kN
[Page 334]
This standard specifies dry glue (supplied in cakes, pieces, granules, pearls cubes or powder) and jelly or
liquid glue.
Requirements for dry glue are specified as follows:
i Overlap joint strength in longitudinal shear: minimum 2.65KN. Moisture content: maximum 18%.
Chlorides: Maximum 2% (calculated as sodium chloride).
PH: Minimum 4.0 maximum 8.2.
Odour: Not objectionable.
Keeping quality: Minimum 6 days without evidence of liquefaction, putrefaction or mould growth.
ii Requirements for jelly or liquid glue are specified as follows:
Overlap joint strength in longitudinal shear: minimum 2.65KN
PH: Minimum 4.0, maximum 8.2.
10.15.4 Synthetic resin adhesives (phenolic and aminoplastic) for wood shall comply with BS 1204
Part 1: 1979 Gap-filling adhesives.
Part 2: 1979 Close-contact adhesive.
This standard specifies requirements for four types of adhesives-three for external use depending on
performance and one for internal use.
10.15.5 Cold-setting casein adhesive powers for wood shall comply with BS 1444: 1970
Casein is a protein precipitated from skimmed milk which, when compounded with other reactants, is
used as an adhesive for wood. Casein adhesive have a limited degree of water resistance and should be
used only for interior applications.
Requirements are specified in this standard for storage properties and adhesive strengths. Sampling and
method of test are appended.
10.15.6 Adhesive for hanging flexible wall-covering; shall comply with BS 3040: 1981
This standard specifies requirements for five types of adhesives suitable for hanging flexible
wall-coverings and ceiling coverings supplied in roll form.
Type 1: For use as a low solids adhesive with easy slip showing very low marking and every low
tarnishing. Especially suitable for light grammage wall-coverings.
[Page 336]
Type 2: Normally used as a medium solids adhesive, showing low marking and low tanishing, suitable
for wall-coverings for all grammages and also for previous, washable wall-coverings.
Type 3: Adhesive with good wet adhesive, particularly suitable for wall-coverings of heavy grammage
and also for previous washable coverings.
Type 4: Adhesive containing fungicide to inhibit mould growth (mould resistant) suitable for
impervious wall-coverings of all grammages.
Type 5: High wet adhesion, high dry strength adhesive, containing fungicide to inhibit mould growth.
Suitable for most impervious wall-coverings or special applications, often ready-mixed.
10.15.8 Polyvinyl acetate (PVA) emulsion adhesive for wood, shall comply with BS 4071: 1986
This standard specifies requirements for resistance to freezing and thawing freedom from staining,
strength, resistance to sustained loading and storage. It refers to the methods of test described in BS 3544.
10.15.9 Polyvinyl acetate (PVAC) emulsion bonding agents for internal use with gypsum building
plaster, shall comply with BS 5270: 1976
This standard specifies requirements for PVA emulsion bonding agents for internal use with gypsum
building plasters, to improve adhesive to difficult back-grounds or to control high section as follows:
Soil content: not less than the minimum value state by manufacturer.
Saponification value: 575-652 (for non-volatile component).
Acid value: minimum 10 (for non-volatile component).
Ash: maximum 2 percent by mass.
Flexibility: a dry film of the bonding agent 0.05mm thick shall not show any cracking when bent over a
1.5mm mandrel at 23 plus 2oC.
Bond strength: minimum 200N.
[Page 337]
10.15.11 Adhesives for use with ceramic tiles and mosaics shall comply with BS 5980: 1980
This standard classifies adhesives into five types depending on their chemical composition and physical
form and into three classes based on their resistance to water.
The five types and classes are as follows:
Type 1: Hydraulically – hardening mortar.
Type 2: Dispersion adhesive.
Type 3: Dispersion/cement adhesive.
Type 4: Dissolved resin adhesive.
Type 5: Reaction resin adhesive.
Class AA. materials with a faster development of water resistance.
10.16.1 Definition:
Shall be those comprising either bitumen, natural or derivative, coal tar or pitch. Natural bitumen is a
non-crystalline solid or viscous material comprising complex hydrocarbons which is soluble in carbon
disulphide.
It softens when it is heated, is waterproof and has good powers of adhesion.
Derivative bitumens are distilled from mineral oils. Bituminous materials shall be those formed by
applying soluble bitumen on ground limestone, coarse aggregate, natural rock aggregate, hessian cloth or
felt fiber. Bituminous materials namely those comprising bitumen coal tar or pitch shall not be intermixed
or appted over one another. Bituminous materials shall conform to the following standards:
i Sampling and testing – BS 598 Parts 1 and 2: 1974.
ii Design and Physical Testing – BS 598 Part 3: 1985.
iii Test for petroleum and its products BS 2000: 1983.
iv Determination of softening point of bitumen and tar in ethylene glycol (ring and ball) – BS 5094:
1974.
v Sampling and testing mastic asphalt and pitch mastic used in building BS 5284: 1976.
[Page 338]
Shall consist of a core of sheet laid between two layers of bituminised felt fibre coated with bitumen and
surfaced with talc or other suitable material and shall be such as the Supervising Officer may approve as
being durable, impervious to moisture and in all other respects suitable for their purpose having regard to
the particular circumstances of the works.
It shall comply with BS 747 class 5: 1968 in all respects and be laid in 3 layers and bonded together with
thin layers of bitumen which is poured on while hot. The first and second layers should weigh not less
than 1.35kg/m2 and top layer is to be finished with white mineral surface and to weigh not less than
3.2kg/m2 and each layer shall be fully lapped 50mm at all points and inter-sections and laid to prime
surfaces with 144 bituminous primer and continuously bedded in hot tropical grade.
10.16.3 Types:
10.16.7 Mastic asphalt containing natural rock aggregate for damp-proof courses:
Asphalt as an ordinary horizontal damp-proof course above ground level or for example through a parapet
wall may be applied in one 13mm coat.
Below ground level: Except in work which comes under the category of tanking both horizontal and
vertical work should be in two layers, the former 20mm thick and the latter not less than 13mm. All
internal angles shall have asphalt fillet. In horizontal damp-proof courses, the asphalt shall have sufficient
stability to prevent material being displaced under load.
It shall comply with BS 6577: 1985 and the soluble bitumen content shall lie between 17% and 20%.
Grading of mineral aggregate shall be in accordance with BS 410 test sieves as detailed in Table 10.16
below:
TABLE 10.16
COMPOSITION BY ANALYSIS OF MASTIC ASPHALT FOR TANKING
PROPERTY Percentage by mass of mastic asphalt
All other
Swiss Natural Natural Asphalt
rock Asphalt rock
Using Maximum Minimum Maximum
min.
Grading of mineral aggregate BS …………… ………… ………… …………
410 test sieves:
retained on 3.35mm mesh
Passing 3.35mm mesh 0 10 0 10
retained on 600um mesh
[Page 340]
Tanking shall be continuous mastic lining to a basement, reservoir, water tower, or swimming pool, for
the purpose of water-proofing, as distinct from damp-proof coursing. The asphalt shall be applied in three
coats, with 150mm laps, on horizontal work and 75mm on vertical with a two-coat asphalt fillet at all
internal angles. Horizontal work shall be laid to a total thickness of 30mm and vertical shall not be less
than 20mm. The asphalt covering shall be carried out under stanchions, by lining the pits to ensure the
covering is continuous. It shall comply with BS 6577: 1985 and shall be soluble bitumen content in the
same range as for damp-proof courses. Grading of material aggregate shall also be as specified for
damp-proof course above and in the table below:
TABLE 10.17
COMPOSITION BY ANALYSIS OF MASTIC ASPHALT FOR TANKING AND DAMP-PROOF
COURSES
PROPERTY Percentage by mass of mastic asphalt
Grading of mineral aggregate BS All other
410 test sieves:
Swiss Natural Natural Asphalt
rock asphalt rock
Using Maximum Minimum Maximum
min.
Retained on 3.35mm mesh ………… ………… ………… …………
Shall comply with BS 6577: 1985. It shall be applied as flooring and paving material for industrial, office,
hospital or domestic purposes and shall be jointless, comparatively noiseless, dustless, hard wearing,
hygienic, easily cleaned and impervious to moisture in liquid or vapour form.
It can be laid on most forms of solid construction including concrete, sound timber boarding, bricks,
quarry tiles or stone flags.
10.16.11 Thickness:
It shall be laid from 15 to 40mm thick in one layer except when it serves as underlay for another floor
finish such as tile, linoleum, rubber sheeting where it shall not be less than 15mm.
It shall have soluble bitumen content in the range of 16% and 20% and conform to grading of mineral
aggregate using BS 410 test sieves as applicable to Table 7: BS 6577: 1985 as detailed below:
TABLE 10.18
COMPOSITION BY ANALYSIS OF UNGIFTED MASTIC ASPHALT FOR FLOORING
Shall conform to Schedule A: BS 988: 1973 with regards to recommended thickness for different types of
flooring.
Grades of mastic asphalt flooring.
Aggregate shall conform to BS 802: 1967.
i Tarmacadam and tar carpets (gravel aggregate) shall conform to BS 1241: 1959.
ii Tarmacadam “Tarpaving” for footpaths, playgrounds and similar works shall conform to BS 1242:
1960.
[Page 342]
10.16.16 Pitch: Pitch is the residue after distilling tar from coal fluxed back with some of the
by-products. Like coal tar it softens at lower temperature and less plastic less able to resist temperature
variations and is cheaper than bitumen.
It shall not be used only for temporary work.
Coat tar pitches for building purposes shall conform shall conform to BS 1310: 1965. It can be used in
paints, fluxes e.g. for damp-proof membrane, as saturated for felts and as an impregnant in pitch-fibre
drain pipes.
10.17.1 Definition:
Paints and paints materials shall consist of pigment suspended in either oil or water mixed together into
uniform paste for application as decorative and/or protective film on walls, floors, timber and metals.
They shall conform to BS 2015: 1965.
The different types of paints shall be in accordance with the following standards.
10.17.2 Paints:
Paints and paints materials shall be an oil-based or water-based decorative and or protective material and
shall be in accordance with the following Nigerian Industrial Standards:
[Page 343]
Oil paint shall be ready-mixed oil paint in accordance with NISD (BS 929) of the type approved and
having a high gloss or enamel finish. The quality used shall be in either exterior or interior quality
according to the position in the works. Where more than one coat is specified the manufacturer's
recommended undercoating shall be used; the gloss or enamel coat being applied only as a finishing coat
and not as an undercoat. Where different grades are manufactured for use either particularly on wood
surfaces or on metal only the correct grade shall be applied.
Shall be an oil based wall paint having a flat egg shell finish and not a high gloss or enamel finish as
specified for oil paint and should conform to NIS of BS 929.
Emulsion paint shall be composed of coloured pigment suspended in water and applicable on wood as
primer and on concrete and blockwalls as undercoat and finishing coat. It shall not be diluted with water
except in strict compliance with the manufacturer’s instructions.
It shall be composed of white linseed oil primer with 10% red lead added.
Metal primer for iron and steel shall be red lead primer confirming to BS 1011 Type 1.
10.17.8 Metal primer for zinc, aluminium and similar non ferrous metals: It shall be etching zinc
chiromate priming paint.
10.19.5 Water:
10.19.6 Pigment:
This is colouring materials and shall comply with all relevant BS standards.
10.19.7 Putty:
Asahard stopping materials and shall conform to BS 544: 1934 and shall be applied and finished with a
knife. Water-soluble stopping should not be used out of doors.
10.20 STORAGE
Paints shall be stored in cool places and arranged/stocked in order of delivery, paints not in use shall be
properly covered.
10.21 PLASTICS
For the purpose of this Chapter, certain terms are defined as follows:
10.21.1.1 Plastics: shall be defined as moulding or giving shape to materials (synthetics and
nonsynthetics) applicable to buildings and structures.
10.21.1.2 Materials: Chemistry, industrial application, moulding process and after manufacturing
processes shall be in accordance with BS 1755: 1951.
10.21.1.3 Plastics colours for building purposes: Plastics colours for building purposes shall be in
accordance with BS 4901: 1976 as being summarised in Table under section (GS) “Colour”.
10.21.1.4 Butyl rubbers compounds: Requirement for four rubber compounds based on either
isobutene (isoptene (butyl) rubber or halogenated isobuten) or isopreme (halobutyle) rubbers, classified
by their vulcanized hardness shall be in accordance with BS 3227: 1980. These compounds, are intended
for the manufacture of items in the form of extrusions, mouldings, moulded or calendered sheet, or for
items cut or purched from sheet.
10.21.1.5 Schedule of common names and abbreviations for plastics and rubbers shall conform to
the table below
[Page 345]
10.21.1.6 Rigid expanded polyvinyl chloride for thermal insulation purposes and building
applications: The rigid expanded PVC in the form of blocks, boards, and sheets of minimum thickness
12.5mm for thermal insulation and building applications at temperatures up to 50oC shall be in
accordance with BS 3869: 1965. This standard is applicable to materials of apparent density 24-48kg/m3
and over 48kg/m3. Requirements are specified for cross-breaking strength, compressive strength, water
vapour transmission and dimensional stability.
Method for preparation of test specimens, measurement of compressive strength, [Page 346] flexural
strength, bond strength, density, modulus of elasticity, tensile strength and resistance to liquids shall be in
accordance with BS 6319.
10.21.3 Installation:
Approved light-transmitting plastics deffusers shall be in accordance to U.B.C. Standard 4201: 1985.
10.21.3.1 Connections and supports: All fastenings, connections and supports shall be proportioned to
safety transmit two and one half times the design live load. Adequate allowance shall be made in the
fastenings and supports for differential expansion and contraction of the connected materials.
10.21.3.2 Partitions: Approved light-transmitting plastics used in or as partitions shall comply with the
requirement of U.B.C. Standard 4201: 1985.
10.21.3.3 Bathroom accessories: Approved plastics shall be permitted as glazing in shower stails,
shower doors, bathtub enclosures and similar accessory units.
10.21.3.4 Size limitations: Individual panels or units shall not exceed 3048mm in length nor 3m2 in area.
10.21.3.5 Other applicable requirements: Light-transmitting plastics used in glazing applications and
skylight assemblies; exterior wall, and roof panels shall be in accordance with U.B.C. Standard Section
5207.
10.21.3.6 Fire suppression system: In buildings having an approved automatic fire suppression system
throughout, plastics light-diffusing system shall be protected both above and below. Unless the system
has been specifically approved for installation only above the system.
10.21.3.7 Approval for use: The building official shall require that sufficient technical data be submitted
to substantiate the proposed use or any light-transmitting materials and if it is determined that the
evidence submitted is satisfactory for the use intended, he may approve its use subject to the requirement
of this Chapter.
10.22 TIMBER
10.22.1 Timber is defined as wood in a form suitable for construction or carpentry, joinery or for
reconversion for manufacturing purposes.
Standing trees or felled trees capable of being converted for the above uses shall also fall within this
definition.
There are many types of timbers available for commercial use. The standard botanical name for timbers
and their trade names as marketed in Nigeria are shown in Table 1 of NCP2: 1973.
All timbers for construction shall conform with information relating to Nigerian timbers as given in Table
2, NCP2: 1973. These relate to density, strength, natural durability, resistance to impregnation, movement
and shrinkage.
10.22.3.1. Density: The density is given at a moisture content of 18 percent; it thus provides an
indication of the weight of the timber species at moisture content reasonably close at which it is likely to
be used for construction.
10.22.3.2 Strength: The strength group is one of seven groups designated N1 to N7, into which it has
been found convenient to divide Nigerian timbers. The strongest timbers fall into N1, group and the
weakest into N7, group.
[Page 347]
10.22.3.3 Each species is classified according to the ability of the heartwood to resist attack by fungi and
insects; five durability classes are used as follows:
— Very durable
— Durable
— Moderately durable,
— Non-durable
— Perishable.
10.22.3.4 Preservation: The ease with which the timber can be impregnated with preservatives is of
importance when it is used under condition which favours decay or attack by insects or marine borers.
Five classes indicating the resistance of the heartwood to impregnation are used as follows:
— Permeable
— Moderately resistant
— Resistant
— Very resistant
— Extremely resistant
10.22.3.5 Shrinkage: Allowable shrinkage in timber with those of the “movement” or dimensional
changes in service is associated with changes in moisture content.
10.22.3.6 Moisture content of timber: Before timber is put to use, it must be properly seasoned and as
near as practicable to the mean value of the moisture content it is expected to attain in service.
All Building timber for various purposes should conform to Table 3: NCP2: 1973.
Timber shall be preserved and protected from insects, inclement weather, not exposed to excessive rain or
cold, timber treatment will conform to Table 4: NCP2: 1973.
The cross-sectional sizes for sawn wood to be adopted by timber manufacturers and users in the country
are as shown in Table 5 NCP2: 1973, special order may be allowed after a written permission from the
supervising officer.
All structural members, assemblies or framework in a building in combination with floors walls and other
parts, must be capable of sustaining all types of loading as shown in Table 6.0 NCP2: 1973.
In sustaining these loads, the structure must maintain stability, stiffness and stress limit as specified in the
table above.
10.22.7 Loadings:
The loadings shall be in accordance with the NCP1: 1973 Part III (Refer to structural section)
Species with similar basic stress and stiffness value are grouped together (Table 7: of NCP2: designated
seven strength groups that will apply to seasoned timber.
10.22.8.1 Species have been assigned appropriate strength groups in Table 8 of NCP2: 1973.
The allocation of species is based on calculated values of basic stresses and experience of the use of
timber in Nigeria.
[Page 348]
Timber piles are commonly designated at a critical section governed by tip size.
10.22.9.1 Quality requirement of pile: All piles shall be of sound wood, free of decay and insect attack.
Piles shall be cut above the ground swell and have a taper from butt to tip.
Piles shall have at least 6 rings per 25mm of average rate growth measured in the outer 50% of the radius
of wood.
10.22.9.2 All knots and limbs shall be cut flush with the surface of pile, except that knots may be hand
trimmed flush with the surface of the swell surrounding the knot.
10.22.9.3 Piles splits shall not be longer than the butt diameter.
Split is defined as lengthwise separation of the wood across the rings of nominal growth, extending from
one surface through the piece to the opposite surface.
10.22.9.4 Piles with checks – length wise separation of wood across the rings of normal growth,
extending from surface towards the pitch, extending through the piece is not acceptable.
Effective Length. For different conditions of end restraint, the effective length L, shall be taken from
Table 16: NCP2-1973 in calculating slenderness ratio.
This shall be done on a suitable level surface in such a manner that the finished structural units conform
fully to specification. Twisted or damaged members shall be replaced before erection on site. Periodic
checks shall also be made on all template and gauges.
10.22.11.1 Handling and erection of assemblies: Over stressing of members during handling shall be
avoided. During transport, hoisting and erection, all materials and assemblies shall be protected from the
weather.
10.22.11.2 Connections: See section 7.17 to 7.18.5 of NCP2: 1973
Timber shall be treated with fire retarders and samples should be tested for 3 types of failure i.e. structural
collapse, passage of flame and passage of heat (insulation value).
Other tests to be done are combustibility and the surface spread of flame test.
The tests should conform with 29.5.1 of this code and should conform with ASTME 84.
Timber structure during/after erection shall be inspected periodically in order to ensure satisfactory
performance in service.
Remedial action shall be taken as necessary including in-situ treatment of any timber signs of decay.
10.22.13.1 Testing and method of testing of structures shall conform with Section 9.2.5 of NCP2: 1973.
10.23.1.1 Sun dried bricks and blocks made in the traditional manner shall be made from a suitable soil
in a mould made of wood or steel. Most lateritic soil with clay content less than 20% are generally
suitable.
10.23.1.2 Any water free from high quality of soluble salts shall be used for mixing the soil. Brakish and
sea water shall not be used. Soluble salts can recrystalise upon drying and cause damage to the
brick/block.
10.23.1.3 Drying time for brick/blocks will depend on the quality of mixing water, air temperature,
humidity and wind. Drying shall be under a shade to minimise cracking. All bricks/blocks must, however,
be dry before use.
10.23.1.4 i Random bricks/blocks shall be taken for testing at the ratio of 5 samples for every 1000
bricks/blocks produced.
ii The compressive strength can be between 1.70 – 2.75N/mm2 Brick/block of compressive
strength of 1.60 N/mm2 is suitable for use for the construction of one storey building
(bungalow)
10.23.1.5 A simple field compressive strength test can be done as follows: A test sample is placed on two
simple supports provided by two round steel rods placed on a plain timber placed on a level surface. A
level timber is placed over the test sample. Known weights of blocks are placed in small increments until
failure occurs.
10.23.1.6 i Earth plaster of the same material as the brick/block should be used for laying of the
bricks/blocks.
ii Where cement stucco (plaster) is to be used for rendering, weak cement sand mortar
should be used for laying the bricks/blocks.
This is to ensure adhesion of the cement stucco to the adobe wall.
iii The mortar shall not exceed 10mm in thickness.
10.23.1.7 i A higher quality adobe can be produced by using an appropriate mechanical press such
as the Cinva Rem, NBRRI block making machine etc. Where a mechanical press is used,
water shall be mixed with the soil at the optimum water content of the soil. The optimum
water content can be determined in the field as described in 23.1.7 (ii) below.
ii A simple field test to determine the optimum water content is to progressively wet the
soil. At each stage, a handful of the soil is compressed firmly within the palm. On
releasing the fingers, if the grains of the palm and fingers appear distinctly on the ball of
the soil, the water content is suitable for block production.
10.23.1.8 The adobe shall not be used in any building more than one storey in height).
10.23.1.8.1 Wall height/thickness ratio: For load bearing wall, the height/thickness ratio shall not be
less than 10/1, that is, the thickness of the wall shall not be less than h/10 where h is the height of the
wall.
10.23.1.8.2 Wall thickness: Provided that the recommended height/ thickness is satisfied, wall thickness
is of relative less importance. However, recommended wall thickness, based on practical considerations,
are as follows:
i Load bearing wall 225mm.
[Page 350]
ii Internal non-bearing wall 113mm.
10.23.1.8.3 Maximum length of wall without crosswall support shall not exceed 3.65m Wider spans of
wall not exceeding 7.00m may be used if intermediate supports are provided in the form of columns,
beams etc.
10.23.1.8.4 Brick/Block bonding: Minimum bonding of brick/block shall be half the length of the
brick/block or 100mm whichever is greater.
10.23.1.8.5 Tie beam of timber or concrete shall be used as the wall plate and shall be designed and
installed in the established manner.
10.23.1.8.6 Attachment of roof truss: The roof truss or roof shall be attached to the wall plate by toe
nailing or bolting as applicable.
10.23.1.8.7 Lintels: Lintel strength can be determined by normal design calculations. Lintel less than
1m, can consist of timber, plain trunk, clay reinforced with traditional organic reinforcements. Lintels
wider than 1m shall be determined by design calculation. Lintel bearing on adobe wall shall be a
minimum of 200mm at each end.
10.23.1.8.8 Foundation walls: For permanent structures, low bearing walls below ground floor shall
consist of more durable material such as burnt bricks, sandcrete etc.
10.23.1.8.9 Foundation footings: The foundation footing should be strong enough to support the wall
above it with the allowance made for the bearing capacity of the soil.
Gravels, crushed rock or stone adequately compacted or bonded with cement mortar are allowed.
10.23.1.8.10 Rendering
i Earth (mud) plaster shall be of the same basic material as the material of the adobe wall.
ii Cement stucco (plaster) shall be used provided the bonding mortar used for the adobe wall was a
weak cement sand mortar.
iii Cement stucco with wire mesh employed irrespective of bonding mortar. The metal wire mesh of
minimum 20 gauge by 2.50mm opening shall be securely attached to the exterior adobe wall
surface by nails or staples with minimum penetration of 380mm.
The mesh fasteners shall have a maximum spacing of 3.80m. The cement stucco shall have a minimum
thickness of 20mm.
iv Other protective coating may be used provided it is approved by the supervising officer.
Soils suitable for producing adobe, sun-dried blocks are also suitable for rammed earth wall construction
as indicated in Section 1.1.
However, soils with small aggregate are also suitable.
[Page 351]
The mixing water content should be such that the soil is damp but wet. A simple field test is to squeeze a
handful of soil in the palm of the hand. If the water content is too wet, the soil will feel sticky. If the soil
is too dry, the soil will not compact and bind together. If the water content is right, the grains of the palm
and fingers will appear distinctly on the soil. When this ball is dropped onto a firm surface from a length
of 1.0m, the soil ball will shorten into 4 or 5 lumps.
10.24.4 Formwork:
Any systems of formwork which allows full compaction of the enclosed earth is allowed. Suitable forms
range from single forms to complex patented systems.
The uncompacted demy soil shall be compacted in layers not exceeding 150mm until maximum
compaction is achieved. Maximum compaction can be determined by a change of sound (ringing) when
full compaction has been reached.
Wall thickness shall be as for the adobe as considered in Sections 1.7.1 and 1.7.2
10.24.7 Opening:
All openings in rammed earth wall must be provided with a lintel strong enough to span the opening
width, time should be allowed before such a bed is placed on the wall.
10.24.8 Drying:
The compressive strength of most wet rammed earth is in the range 0.2 – 0.6 N/mm2. Construction may
therefore be continuous unless a structural load in this range is to be imposed in the wet state; in that case
sufficient drying time should be allowed before such a load is placed on the wall.
10.24.9 Foundations:
i Earth plaster shall be for the same basic material as the material of the earth rammed wall;
ii Cement Stucco (plaster) shall be applied with and of wire mesh. The metal wire mesh of minimum
20 gauge by 2.50mm opening shall be securely attached to the exterior of the rammed earth wall
surface by nails or staples with minimum penetration of 380mm. The mesh fasteners shall have a
maximum spacing of 3.80m. The cement stucco shall have a minimum thickness of 20mm;
iii Cement stucco (plaster) can be applied without wire mesh for rammed earth walls consisting of
cement stabilised earth, after drying.
iv Other protective coating may be provided, it is approved by the Code Enforcement
Division/Section/Unit.
i Where a sieve analysis is available, the percentage of clay passing through should not be higher
than 20%.
ii Where a simple sedimentation test is performed in the field, the thickness
a. of the clay fraction shall not be more than 25 times the combined thicknesses of the sand
and silt fractions.
b. A sedimentation test is performed with a transparent glass jar at not more than one third
the height of the jar. The jar is filled with water. The soil and water are rigorously shaken
together until the soil is suspended in the water.
The mixture is now allowed to settle down for about half an hour. Three distinct zones can now be
observed and identified. Starting from the bottom upwards are sand, silt and clay zones.
iii Most lateritic soils are usually suitable for producing cement stabilised blocks.
The wet stablilised blocks should first be allowed to air dry under a shade for twenty four hours.
Thereafter curing is continued by sprinkling water morning and evening and covering the blocks with
polythene sheet for one week.
10.25.7 Rendering:
Cement stabilised block wall can be rendered with normal cement-sand mortar (1:6). Rendering is
recommended for external wall to increase its durability. It is also recommended where the durability of
the cement stabiliser block is marginally below acceptable limit.
A soft packing material such as soft plywood 10mm thick is placed over the block, top and bottom. The
compressive strength test is then carried out in the conventional manner. Cement-sand [Page 353] mortar
should not be used as this leads to an under estimate of the compressive strength of the block.
10.25.9 Other stabilising agents including lime pozzolona cement, asphalt, plyash be used with the
approval of the Code Enforcement Officer.
Ordinary Portland cement; a suitable fibre and well-graded sand, the mix proportions of cement, sand and
fibre in the range of 4:4:0.01 to 4:3:0.1 by weight are provided as a guide. The usual dimensions are 750
x 1000mm or 1000 x 1000mm and 10mm thickness. The normal weight for 750 x 1000mm is 32kg/m2.
Construction Stage / Section 10 Building Materials and Components
Requirements / 10.26 FIBRE CONCRETE ROOFING SHEET / 10.26.2 Suitable
fibres:
Unlike FCR tiles, fibres provide reinforcement for FCR sheets and should be tested for suitability.
Coconut fibre and raffia have been found to be suitable. There are indications that palm kernel fibres may
be suitable.
10.26.2.1 The preparation of fibres, types of sand, cement and water required are as described in 1.2, 1.3,
1.4 and 1.5 above.
a. The raw materials – sand, cement and fibre-are batched in the recommended proportions. The
fibre is soaked in water for one hour before use. The batched materials are mixed thoroughly
with water. The slurry is transferred to the working bench previously covered with a polythene
sheet. The material is spread over the table and may be vibrated where provision is made for
vibration. The screeded material is next drawn over a corrugated mould with the aid of the
polythene sheet on which the screeded material was placed.
The wet roofing sheets on the moulds are air dried for about twenty four hours on stacks. The
sheets are then demoulded and transferred to a water tank for curing.
b. Production method can be improved by the use of an appropriate hydraulic press.
10.26.4 Breaking load and water tightness tests are as described in Sections 1.7 and 1.8 above.
The roof design is done in the conventional manner. The minimum pitch should be 30oC.
10.26.5.1 Installation: The installation of the sheets should be in accordance with BS 8000 Part 5, 1990.
Section 11
Building Construction Requirements
Sections
11.1 Special Building Design Requirements
11.2 Prohibited Use
11.3 Existing Buildings
11.4 Building Materials and Components Requirements
11.5 Post-Construction Requirements
11.6 Precautions During Building Operations
[Page 357]
11.6.1 General
11.6.1.1 Scope: The provisions of this Chapter shall apply to all construction operations in connection
with the erection, alteration, repair, rehabilitation, demolition or removal of buildings and structures.
11.6.1.2 Other laws: Nothing herein contained shall be construed to nullify any rules, regulations or
statutes of State agencies governing the protection of the public or workers from health or other hazards
involved in manufacturing, mining and other processes and operations which generate noise toxic gases,
dust or other elements dangerous to the respiratory system, eye-sight or general well-being.
11.6.1.3 Combustible and explosive hazards: The provisions of this Code which apply to the storage,
use or transportation of explosives, highly flammable and combustible substances, gases and chemicals
shall be construed as supplemental to the requirements of the federal laws, and the rules and regulations
of the states and local governments.
11.6.1.4 Plans, Specifications and Special Permits
11.6.1.4.1 Temporary construction: Before any construction operation is started, plans and
specifications shall be filed with the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit showing the design and
construction of all temporary construction interfacing the public highways access and services. Approval
shall be secured before the commencement of any such work.
11.6.1.4.2 Special permits: All special licenses and permits for the storage of materials on sidewalks and
highways, for the use of water or other public facilities and for the storage and handling of explosives
shall be secured from the administrative authorities having jurisdiction.
[Page 358]
11.6.1.4.3 Temporary encroachments: Subject to approval, sidewalk sheds, under-pinning and other
temporary protective guards and devices shall project beyond the interior and street plot lines where
required to ensure the safety of the adjoining property and the public. When necessary, the consent of the
adjoining property owner shall be obtained.
11.6.1.5 Test
11.6.1.5.1 Loading: It shall be unlawful to load any structure, temporary support, scaffolding, sidewalk
bridge or sidewalk shed or any other device or construction equipment during the construction or
demolition of any building or structure in excess of its safe working capacity as provided in Section 8.8
and 8.9 for allowable loads and working stresses.
11.6.1.5.2 Unsafe equipment: Whenever any doubt arises as to the structural quality or strength of
scaffolding plank or other construction equipment, such material shall be replaced, or the Code
Enforcement Officer shall require a strength test to four times the super-imposed live load to which the
material or structural member is to be subjected.
The member shall sustain the test load without failure.
11.6.1.6 Inspection
11.6.1.6.1 Unsafe condition: When inspection of any construction operation reveals that any unsafe or
irregular conditions exist, the Code Enforcement Officer shall notify the owner and direct the owner to
take the necessary remedial measures to remove the hazard or violation.
11.6.1.6.2 Failure to comply with orders: Unless the owner so notified proceeds to comply with the
orders of the Code Enforcement Officer within 7 days, the Code Enforcement Officer shall have full
power to correct the usage conditions as provided in Section 2.3.6.2 and 2.6. All expenses incurred in the
correction of such unsafe conditions shall become a lien on the property.
11.6.1.6.3 Unsafe construction equipment: When the strength and adequacy of any scaffolding or other
device or construction equipment is in doubt, or when any complaint is made, the Code Enforcement
Officer shall inspect such equipment and shall prohibit its use until tested as required in Section 13.1.6.2,
or until all danger is removed.
Post-Construction Stage
Post-Construction Stage
Section 12
Post-Construction Requirements
Sections
12.1 Maintenance
12.2 Fire Protection Systems
12.3 Fire Resistive Construction
[Page 361]
12.1 MAINTENANCE
12.1.1 General:
All construction equipment and safeguards shall be constructed, installed and properly maintained and
shall be so operated as to ensure protection to the workers engaged thereon and to the general public. It
shall be unlawful to remove or render inoperative any structural, fire protection or sanitary safeguard or
device herein required except when necessary for the actual installation and prosecution of the work.
12.1.2.1 Protection: All existing and adjoining public and private property shall be protected from
damage incidental to construction operations.
12.1.2.2 Chimney, soil and vent stacks: Whenever a new building or structure is erected to greater or
less heights than an adjoining building, the construction and extension of new or existing chimneys shall
conform to the provisions of the mechanical code listed in the Schedule, and the construction and
extension of soil and vent stacks and the location of window openings shall comply with the provision of
Section 9.1.8.32.4.
12.1.2.3 Adjoining walls: The owner of the new or altered structure shall preserve all adjoining
independent and party walls from damage as provided herein. The owner shall underpin where necessary
and support the adjoining building or structure by proper foundations to comply with Section 13.6.
12.1.2.4 Maintenance: In case an existing party wall is intended to be used by the person who causes an
excavation to be made, and such party wall is in good condition and sufficient for the use of both the
existing and proposed building, such person shall preserve the party wall from damage and support it by
proper foundations at his own expense, so that it shall be and remain as safe and useful as it was before
the excavation was commenced. During the demolition, the party wall shall be maintained weatherproof
and structurally safe by adequate bracing until such time as the permanent structural supports shall have
been provided.
12.1.2.5 Beam holes: When a structure involving a party wall is being demolished the owner of the
demolished structure shall, at his own expense, bend over all wall anchors at the beam ends of the
standing wall and shall brick up all open beam holes and otherwise maintain the safety and usefulness of
the wall.
12.1.2.6 Party wall exits: A party wall balcony or horizontal exit shall not be destroyed unless and until
a substitute means of egress has been provided and approved by the Code Enforcement Officer.
12.1.2.7 Adjoining roofs: When a new building or demolition of an existing building is being
undertaken at a greater height, the roof, roof outlets and roof structures of adjoining buildings shall be
protected against damage with adequate safeguards by the person doing the work.
[Page 362]
12.1.3.1 General: Whenever a building or structure is erected, altered, repaired, removed or demolished,
the operation shall be conducted in a safe manner and suitable protection for the general public and
workers employed thereon shall be provided.
12.1.3.2 Fences: Every construction operation located 1.5m or less from the street plot line shall be
enclosed with a fence not less than 2.4m high to prevent entry of unauthorised persons. When located
more than 1.5m from the street plot line, a fence or other barrier shall be erected when required by the
Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit. All fences shall be of adequate strength to resist wind pressure.
12.1.3.3 Sidewalk bridge: Whenever the ground is excavated under the sidewalk, a sidewalk bridge
shall be constructed at least 1.2m wide, or a protected walkway of equal width shall be erected on the
street, provided the required permit for such walkway is obtained from the administrative authority as
provided for in 13.1.4.1.
12.1.3.4 Sidewalk shed: Sidewalk sheds shall be provided in accordance with Section 13.4.5 through to
13.4.8. as follows:
12.1.3.5 Within 3m of street plot line: When any building demolished or erected is located within 3m
of the street plot line is to be erected or raised more than 12m in height, or whenever a building more than
12m in height within 3m of the street plot line is to be demolished, a sidewalk shed shall be erected and
maintained for the full length of the building on all street fronts, for the entire time that work is performed
on the exterior of the building.
12.1.3.6 Within 6m of street plot line: When the building being demolished or erected is located within
6m of the street plot line and is more than 12m in height, exterior flare fans or catch platforms shall be
erected at vertical intervals of not more than two floors.
12.1.3.7 Buildings higher than six floors: When the building being demolished or erected is more than
six floors or 22m (22860mm) in height, unless set back from the street plot line a distance more than
one-half its height, a sidewalk shed shall be provided.
12.1.3.8 Walkway: An adequately lighted walkway at least 1.2m wide and 2.4m high in clearance shall
be maintained under all sidewalk sheds for pedestrians. When ramps are required, they shall conform to
the relevant provisions of this Code.
12.1.3.9 Thrust-out platforms: Thrust-out platforms or other substitute protection in lieu of sidewalk
sheds shall not be used unless approved and deemed adequate to ensure the public safety. Thrust-out
platforms shall not be used for the storage of materials.
12.1.3.10 Watchman: Whenever a building is being demolished, erected or altered, a watchman shall be
employed to warn the general public when intermittent hazardous operations are conducted across the
sidewalk or walkways.
12.1.4.1 Notice of intent: The person intending to cause a demolition or an excavation shall deliver
written notice of such intent to the owner of each potentially affected adjoining plot, building or structure
at least 30 days prior to the commencement of work. The notice shall request a licence to enter the
potentially affected plot, building or structure prior to the commencement of the work and at reasonable
intervals during its execution to inspect and preserve it from any damage which might result from the
intended [Page 363] work. The potentially affected adjoining owner shall have the right to inspect the
drawings of the proposed works.
12.1.4.2 Protection of adjoining property: If afforded the necessary licence to enter the adjoining plot,
building or structure, the person causing the demolition or excavation to be made shall at all times and at
his own expense preserve and protect it from damage or injury. If the necessary licence is not afforded, it
shall be the duty of the owner of the adjoining plot, building or structure to make safe his own property,
for the prosecution of which he shall be granted the necessary licence to enter the premises of the
demolition or excavation.
12.1.4.3 Removal of debris: All waste materials shall be removed in a manner which prevents injury or
damage to persons, adjoining properties and public rights of way and keep such premises in safe and
sanitary condition.
12.1.4.4 Notice to the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit: If the person causing a demolition or
excavation to be made is not afforded a licence to enter an adjoining structure, plot or building, he shall
immediately notify both the Code Enforcement Officer and the owner of the adjoining property in writing
that the responsibility of providing support to the adjoining plot, building or structure has become his (the
person causing the demolition or excavation) exclusive responsibility.
12.1.5.1 General: When a building has been demolished and building operations have not been projected
or approved, the following shall apply:
12.1.5.1.1 Grading of plot: The vacant plot shall be filled, graded and maintained in conformity to the
established street grades at curb level. The plot shall be maintained free from the accumulation of rubbish
and all other unsafe or hazardous conditions which endanger the life or health of the public. Provision
shall be made to prevent the accumulation of water or damage to any foundations on the premises or the
adjoining property.
12.1.5.1.2 Utility connections: All service utility connections shall be discontinued and capped in
accordance with the approved rules and the requirements of the authority having jurisdiction.
12.1.6.1 General: When the adjoining grade is not higher than the permissible level, the person causing
an excavation to be made shall erect, when necessary, a retaining wall at his own expense and on his own
land. Such wall shall be built to a height sufficient to retain the adjoining earth, shall be properly coped
and shall be provided with a guardrail or fence not less than 1 meter in height.
12.1.6.2 Design capacity: Materials or equipment stored within the building, or on sidewalk, sheds or
scaffolds shall be placed so as not to overload any part of the construction beyond its design capacity, nor
interfere with the safe prosecution of the work.
12.1.6.3 Special loading: Unless the construction is designed for special loading, materials stored on
sidewalk sheds and scaffolds shall not exceed a one-day supply. All materials shall be piled in an orderly
manner and height, to permit removal of individual pieces without endangering the stability of the pile.
12.1.6.4 Pedestrian walkways: Materials or equipment shall not be stored on the street without a permit
issued by the administrative official having jurisdiction. When so [Page 364] stored, they shall not unduly
interfere with vehicular traffic or the orderly movement of pedestrians on the highway or street. The piles
shall be arranged to maintain a safe walkway not less than 1.2m wide, unobstructed for its full length, and
adequately lighted at night and at all necessary times for the use of the public.
12.1.6.5 Obstruction: Material and equipment shall not be placed or stored so as to obstruct access to
fire hydrant, standpipes, fire or police alarm boxes, utility boxes, catch basins or manholes, nor shall they
be located within 6m of a street intersection, or so placed as to obstruct normal observations of traffic
signals or to hinder the use of public transit loading platforms.
12.1.7.1 General: Material shall not be dropped by gravity or thrown outside the exterior walls of a
building during demolition or erection. Wood or metal chutes shall be provided for this purpose and any
material which in its removal will cause an excessive amount of dust shall be wet down to prevent the
creation of a nuisance.
12.1.7.2 Protection of adjoining property
12.1.7.3 General: Adjoining property shall be completely protected from any damage incidental to the
building operation when the owner of the adjoining property permits free access to the building at all
reasonable times to provide the necessary safeguards in accordance with Section 13.6.
12.1.7.4 Guardrails: All floor and wall openings shall be protected with adequate guardrails and toe
board.
12.1.8 Scaffolds
12.1.8.1 Load capacity: Scaffolds and their components shall be capable of supporting without failure at
least four times the maximum intended load. All platform and supporting elements of scaffolds shall be
designed and constructed to support uniform minimum live loads in kilograms per meter square of the
platform area in accordance with the classifications described in Table 13.10.
12.1.8.2 Erection: Built-up, swinging and suspended scaffolds shall be erected by competent workers
only.
12.1.8.3 Scaffolding: All scaffolding shall be constructed in accordance with Section 13.10.4 and
13.10.5 as follows:–
12.1.8.4 All buildings: All scaffolding exceeding 26m or seven floors in height used in construction
operations involving the erection, alteration or maintenance of buildings, shall be constructed of
non-combustible or fire-retardant materials complying with the provision of Section12.3.4.
TABLE 12.1
SCAFFOLD LOAD CAPACITY
[Page 365]
12.1.8.5 Use Group F: All scaffolding used in construction operations involving the repair or partial
demolition during occupancy of buildings of Use Group F-2 and F-3 shall be constructed of
non-combustible or fire-retardant materials complying with the provisions of Section 12.3.4.
12.1.9.1 Hoist protection: All material hoists shall be adequately protected. When erected on the outside
of a building over 26m or seven floors in height, the hoist structure shall be built of non-combustible or
approved fire-retardant materials with the exception of the loading platform.
12.1.9.2 Passengers prohibited: Persons shall not be permitted to ride a material hoist. Temporary
elevators shall be installed when necessary to transport workers as provided in Section 9.
12.1.9.3 Guarding of cables: All hoisting cables and signal cords shall be guarded whenever they pass
through working spaces to prevent injury to persons.
12.1.9.4 Rigger’s licence: All persons engaged in the erection of derricks and other hoisting apparatus
shall secure a licence or certificate of fitness for the performance of such work from the authorised
administrative official.
12.1.10.1 Temporary stairways: When a building has been constructed to a greater height than 15m or
four floors, or when an existing building exceeding 15m in height is altered, at least one temporary
lighted stairway shall be provided unless one or more of the permanent stairways are erected as the
construction progresses.
12.1.10.2 Ladders: Temporary ladders, when permitted for access to floors before stairways are
installed, or which are designed for other working purposes, shall extend at least 1.0m above the floor
level which they serve.
12.1.11 Lighting
12.1.11.1 General: All stairways and parts of buildings under demolition, erection or repair shall be
adequately lighted while persons are engaged at work, to comply with the provisions of Sections 10.25
and 9.2.9.2.7.
12.1.12.1 General: The provisions of this Code and of the fire prevention code listed in the Schedule,
shall be strictly observed to safeguard worker against hazards attendant upon construction operations.
[Page 366]
12.1.12.2 Storage of flammables: Storage of gasoline for hoist, oils, paints and other highly flammable
materials shall be permitted only as specified in Section 5 and when stored in approved safety containers.
The storage of larger quantities shall not be approved unless stored in separate compartments or
enclosures of approved non-combustible construction.
12.1.12.3 Flame cutting and welding: The use of oxyacetylene torches for cutting or welding shall be
permitted only in accordance with ANSI Z49.1 listed in the Schedule.
12.1.12.4 Concrete forms: Combustible materials shall not be stored on any floor of a building under
construction until all combustible concrete forms are removed from the tier immediately above.
12.1.12.5 Fire extinguishers: Fire extinguishers shall be provided as required by Section 30.22.
12.1.12.6 Standpipes and fire lines: Where standpipes are provided as a permanent part of the building,
they shall be installed and made ready for instant use by the fire service as the structure progresses in
accordance with the provisions of Section 30.14. Free access from the street to such standpipes shall be
maintained at all times. Materials shall not be stored within 1.5m of any fire hydrant or in the roadway
between such hydrant and the center line of the street.
12.1.12.7 Housekeeping: Rubbish and trash shall not be allowed to accumulate on the site and shall be
removed as fast as conditions warrant. Combustible rubbish shall be removed daily, and shall not be
disposed of by burning on the premises or in the immediate vicinity. The entire premises and area
adjoining and around the operation shall be kept in a safe and sanitary condition and free of accumulation
of trash, rubbish, nuts, bolts, small tools and other equipment.
12.1.13.1 General: Every construction or maintenance operation which results in the diffusion of noise,
dust, stone and other small particles, toxic gases or other harmful substances in quantities hazardous to
health shall be safeguarded by means of local ventilation or other protective devices to ensure the safety
of the workers and the public as required by this Code and contained in Tables 12.2, 12.3, 12.4, and 12.5.
12.1.13.2 Removal of dust: Dust, sand blasts or other harmful agents, when employed or occurring in
construction operations shall be disposed of at or near the point of origin to prevent their diffusion over
adjoining premises or streets as contained in Section 12.3.
12.1.13.3 Protective equipment: Facilities shall be provided in approved closed containers for housing
the necessary vision, respiratory and protective equipment required in welding operations, and in
accordance with the regulations of the administrative official.
12.1.13.4 Welding enclosures: All welding and flame-cutting operations shall be performed in protected
areas with full consideration of safety and fire hazards. Such closed spaces shall be properly ventilated
while welding or cutting is being done. Suitable protection against the rays of the electric arc shall be
maintained by the contractor where welding operations might be viewed within harmful range by persons
other than the welding operations and inspectors.
[Page 367]
12.1.13.5 Flammable materials: Proper precautions shall be taken to avoid all risk of fire or explosion,
and flammable or explosive materials shall not be stored in the vicinity of welding or cutting operations.
Post-Construction Stage / Section 12 Post-Construction Requirements / 12.1
MAINTENANCE / 12.1.14 Sanitation
12.1.14 Sanitation
12.1.14.1 General: Every building in the course of demolition, erection or repair shall be provided with
toilet and drinking water facilities which shall be constructed and installed in accordance with the
plumbing code listed in the Schedule.
12.1.15 Disputes
12.1.15.1 General: The Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit when requested by any person,
aggrieved or otherwise, shall serve a written notice on any owner, tenant and their agents who fail to
conform to the requirements of this Chapter, directing such person to take the necessary remedial action.
If the person whose duty it is to protect his own or adjoining property under those provisions fails to
proceed to fully comply with such notice within seven days of receipt thereof, or within a reasonable time
thereafter as determined by the Code Enforcement Officer, such officer is authorised to cause the
necessary work to be done when the health, safety and general welfare of the public are involved. The
cost of such work shall become a lien against the property of the offending owner, and the legal authority
of the jurisdiction shall institute appropriate action for its recovery.
TABLE 12.2
ACCEPTABLE NOISE LEVEL
The table below shows recommended maximum daily exposure
[Page 368]
TABLE 12.3
DUST
THRESHOLD LIMIT VALUES in mg/m3
(Total and respirable mass) FOR SOME DUSTS
TABLE 12.4
FIRST AID FACILITIES 1
SUPPLEMENT
TABLE 12.5
FIRST AID FACILITIES 2
plus 1 – 20 – First Aid Kit; 21 – 100 – First Aid Box; 101 – 199 First Aid Post.
12.2.1 General
12.2.1.1 Scope: The provisions of this Part shall specify where fire protection systems are required in all
buildings or structures or portions thereof.
12.2.1.2 Installation requirements: The installation methods, repair, operation and maintenance of fire
protection systems shall be in accordance with this Code and the fire safety code listed in the Schedule.
12.2.1.3 Maintenance: The owner, tenant or lessee of building or structure shall be responsible for the
care and maintenance of all fire protection systems, including equipment and devices, to ensure the safety
and welfare of the occupants. Fire protection systems shall not be disconnected or otherwise rendered
unserviceable without first notifying the fire department. When installations of required fire protection
systems are interrupted for repairs or other necessary reasons, the owner, tenant or lessee shall
immediately advise the fire department and shall diligently prosecute the restoration of the protection.
[Page 370]
12.2.1.4 Threads: All threads provided for fire department connections to sprinkler systems, standpipe
systems, yard hydrants or any other fire hose connections shall be uniform to those used by the local fire
department.
12.2.1.5 Signs: Where fire suppression control valves are located in a separate room or building, a sign
shall be provided on the entrance door. The lettering for such sign shall be of a conspicuous colour and
shall be at least 100mm in height, and shall read Sprinkler Control Valves or Standpipe Control Valves or
indicate other types of systems (see Section 12.1.14. for additional signs).
12.2.1.6 Tests: Where required by this Part and the standards referenced herein, all flow test connections
and points of fluid discharge shall be reasonably accessible and acceptable to the administrative authority.
12.2.2.1 Required: Plans shall be submitted to indicate conformance with this Code and shall be
reviewed by the department prior to issuance of the permit.
12.2.2.2 Note: Since the fire department is responsible for inspection for the proper maintenance of fire
protection systems in buildings, the administrative authority shall cooperate with the fire department in
the discharging of responsibility to enforce this Part.
12.2.2.3 Plans: The plans and specifications submitted to the department shall contain sufficient detail to
evaluate the hazard and the effectiveness of the system. The details on the hazards shall include materials
involved, the location and arrangement, and the exposure to the hazard.
12.2.2.4 Calculations: The details on the fire protection system shall include the design considerations,
calculations and other information as required by this Code.
12.2.3.1 Where required: Fire suppression systems shall be installed and maintained in full operating
condition, as specified in this Code, in the locations in Section 12.1.1.2 through to 12.1.3.27
12.2.3.2 Exception: Buildings of Use Group H-3:
Use Group A-1: In all buildings or structures or portions thereof of Use Group A-1.
Exception: Auditoria, foyers, lobbies, and toilet rooms.
12.2.3.3 Use Group A-2: In all buildings or structures or portions thereof of Use Group A-2.
1. When more than 465m2 in area; or
2. When more than one storey in height.
12.2.3.4. Use Group A-3: In all buildings or structures or portions thereof of use Group A-3 when more
than 1116m2 in area.
12.2.3.5 Stages and enclosed platforms: Stages under the roof and gridiron, in the tie and fly galleries,
and in all places behind the proscenium wall of the stage; over and within enclosed platforms in excess of
46.5m2 in area: and in dressing rooms, lounges, workshops and store rooms accessory to such stages or
enclosed platforms.
[Page 371]
12.2.3.6 Exceptions
1. Stages or enclosed platforms open to the auditorium room on three or more sides.
2. Altars, pulpits or similar platforms and their accessory rooms.
3. Stage gridirons when side wall sprinklers with 57 degrees C (135 degrees F.) rated heads with
heat-baffle plates are installed around the perimeter of the stage except for the proscenium
opening at points not more than 75cm below the gridiron nor more than 15cm below the baffle
plate.
4. Under stage or under enclosed platform areas less than 1.2m in clear height used exclusively for
chair or table storage and lined on the inside with materials approved for 1 hour fire-resistance
rated construction.
12.2.3.7 Use Groups B, H-1 and H-2: In all buildings or structures of Use Groups B, H-1 and H-2 when
more than 12 storeys or 45m in height.
12.2.3.8 Exception: In buildings of use group H, sprinklers are not required in bathrooms not greater
than 5.12m2 in area
12.2.3.9 Use Group E: In all buildings or structures or portions thereof of Use Group E.
12.2.3.10 Use Group F: In all buildings or structures or portions thereof of Use Group F.
12.2.3.11 Exceptions
1. Use Group F-2 hospitals of Type 1 construction not over five storeys and 22.5m, hospitals of
Type 2A construction not over three storeys and 13.5m, and hospitals of Type 2B construction
not over one story in height.
2. Use Group F-2 nursing homes of Types 1, 2A or 2B construction, not over one story in height.
3. Use Group F-2 child care facilities not over one story in height which accommodate 100
children or less with each room having an exit directly to the outside.
4. Buildings of Use Group F-3 two storeys of less in height and having an occupant load of less
than 20.
5. Buildings of Use Group F-3 having an occupant load of less than six.
12.2.3.12 Use Groups G I-1 and D-1: In all buildings or portions thereof of Use Groups G, I-1 and D-1
1. When more than 1116m2 in area; or
2. When more than 2232m2 in total area on all floors; or
3. When more than three storeys in height.
12.2.3.13 Public garages (Group 1): In all Group 1 public garages
1. When more than 930m2 in area.
2. When more than 697.5m2 in area and more than one story in height.
3. When more than 465m2 in area and more than two storeys in height.
4. When more than three storeys in height.
5. When located in buildings where the upper storeys are designed for other uses.
6. When located in any story that is more than 50 percent below grade.
[Page 372]
7. In fuel dispensing areas.
12.2.3.14 Public garages (Group 2): In all Group 2 public garages
1. When more than 930m2 in area and more than one storey in height.
2. When more than two storeys in height.
3. When located in buildings where the upper storeys are designed for other uses.
12.2.3.15 Exception: Open parking structures or portions of buildings classified as open parking
structures according to the definition in Section 8.8.1.
12.2.3.16 Bus garages: In all bus garages
1. When required by Section 8.10.
2. When used as passenger terminals for four or more buses.
3. When used for storage or loading of four or more buses.
12.2.3.17 Unlimited area buildings: In unlimited area buildings as required.
12.2.3.18 Exception
12.2.3.19 Storage and workshop areas: In all portions of Use Group A, B, C, F, H-1 and H-2 occupied
for storage, workshop or similar purposes and as provided in Sections 8.11.2 and 8.12.7 for Use F-2 and
F-3 respectively.
12.2.3.20 Exceptions
1. Individual storage or workshop area located entirely within unsprinklered dwelling units.
2. Storage and workshop rooms less than 2.23m2 in area.
12.2.3.21 Windowless storey: In every storey or basement of all buildings where there is not provided at
least 1.86m2 of opening entirely above the adjoining ground level at each 15m or a fraction thereof of
exterior wall in the storey or basement, on at least one side of the building. Openings shall have minimum
dimensions of not less than 55 cm. Such openings shall be accessible to the fire department from the
exterior and shall be unobstructed to allow firefighting and rescue operations from the exterior. When
openings in a storey are provided on only one side and the opposite wall of such story is more than 22.5m
from such openings, the storey shall be provided with an approved automatic fire suppression system, or
openings as specified above shall be provided on at least two sides of the exterior walls of the storey. If
any portion of a basement is located more than 22.5m from openings required in this section, the
basement shall be provided with an approved automatic fire suppression system.
12.2.3.22 Painting rooms: In spray painting rooms or shops where painting, brushing, dipping or mixing
is regularly conducted using flammable materials.
12.2.3.23 Trash rooms and chutes: In rooms or areas used for incineration, trash and laundry collection
or similar uses; and at alternate floor levels and at the top of all chutes used in conjunction with these
rooms or areas.
12.2.3.24 Furnace rooms: In furnace rooms, boiler rooms and rooms for similar uses and as provided in
Section 8.11.2 and 8.12.7 for Use Groups F-2 and F-3 respectively.
12.2.3.25 Exception: Such a room located entirely within and serving a single dwelling unit. Unenclosed
vertical openings: In unenclosed vertical openings between floors as required by Section 8.7.3.
[Page 373]
12.2.3.26 Kitchen exhaust systems: In commercial kitchen exhaust systems when such systems are
required by the mechanical code listed in the Schedule.
12.2.3.27 Hazardous exhaust systems: In duct systems exhausting hazardous material in accordance
with the mechanical code listed in the Schedule.
12.2.3.28 Alternative protection: In special use areas of buildings or structures, an automatic fire alarm
system shall be installed in lieu of a fire suppression system where such fire suppression system
installation would be detrimental or dangerous to the specific use or occupancy, as approved by the code
enforcement officer and the fire safety Code Enforcement Officer.
12.2.3.29 Telephone central office equipment buildings: Within telephone central office equipment
buildings, the automatic fire suppression system is not required in the following rooms or areas when
such rooms or areas are protected with an approved automatic fire alarm system.
1. Generator and transformer rooms.
2. Communication equipment areas when such areas when such areas are separated from the
remainder of the building by 1-hour fire-resistance rated wall and 2-hour fire-resistance rated
floor/ceiling assemblies and are used exclusively for such equipment.
12.2.4.1 General: To guide the administrative authority with the selection of the proper type of fixed fire
suppression system, the extinguishing agents for each type of hazard or fire are classified as follows.
12.2.4.2 Class A. Fires involving ordinary combustible materials (such as wood, cloth, paper, rubber and
many plastics) requiring the heat-absorbing (cooling) effects or water, water solutions or the coating
effects of certain dry chemicals which retard combustion.
12.2.4.3 Class B. Fires involving flammable or combustible liquids, flammable gases, grease and similar
materials where extinguishment is most readily secured by excluding air (oxygen), inhibiting the release
of combustible vapours, or interrupting the combustion chain reaction.
12.2.4.4 Class C. Fires involving energised electrical equipment where safety to the operator requires the
use of electrically nonconductive extinguishing agents.
12.2.4.5 Note: Portable Class A or B extinguishers and hand-held solid stream nozzles are inappropriate
for fighting electrical fires. However, fixed water spray systems are appropriate for fighting fires in
energised electrical systems.
12.2.4.6 Special hazards: In rooms or buildings containing combustibles such as aluminium powder,
calcium carbide, calcium phosphide, metallic sodium and potassium, quick-lime, magnesium powder or
sodium peroxide, which are incompatible with the use of water as an extinguishing agent, other
extinguishing agents shall be used.
12.2.4.7 Types: Where a fire suppression system is required in this Code, Table 12.1.4 provides the code
enforcement officer with information to assist in the determination of the type of suppression system
suitable for the hazard involved, if not otherwise specified in this Code.
[Page 374]
Installation: Fixed fire suppression systems shall be of an approved type designed and installed in
accordance with the requirements of this Code.
Tests: All tests required by this code and the standards listed in this Code shall be conducted at the
expense of the owner or the owner’s representative.
TABLE 12.6
GUIDE FOR SUPPRESSION SYSTEM SELECTION
[Page 375]
12.2.5.1 General: Water Sprinkler extinguishing systems shall be of an approved type and installed in
accordance with the provisions of this Code and NFiPA 13 listed in the Schedule.
12.2.5.2 Occupancy sprinkler system: Within a building of mixed occupancies and where an
occupancy is required by this Code to be sprinklered with more than 20 sprinklers, the Use Group
requiring sprinklers shall be separated from other uses by fire separation walls and floor/ceiling
assemblies having a fire-resistance rating corresponding to the highest fire grading prescribed at Table
29.3 for the separate uses and equipped throughout with a complete automatic sprinkler system.
12.2.5.3 Design: The details of the system supplied with the plans and specifications shall include
information and the calculations of the sprinkler spacing and arrangement with water supply and
discharge requirements, size and equivalent lengths of pipe and fittings and water supply source.
Sufficient information shall be included to identify the apparatus and devices used. The design of the
sprinkler system for a HPM use facility shall be in accordance with NFiPA 13 listed in the Schedule, and
not less than that required for the special fire hazard areas shown in Table 30.4.
12.2.5.4 Actuation: Water sprinkler extinguishing systems shall be automatically actuated unless
otherwise specifically provided in this Code.
12.2.5.5 Sprinkler alarms: Approved audible or visual alarm devices shall be connected to every water
sprinkler system. Such alarm devices shall be activated by water flow and shall be located in approved
location.
12.2.5.6 Exception: Alarms and alarm attachments shall not be required for limited area sprinkler
systems (see Section 12.1.6).
12.2.5.7 Additional alarms: At least one additional audible or visual alarm device shall be installed
within the building.
12.2.5.8 Water control valve tags: Identification tags shall be provided in accordance with NFiPA 26
listed in the Schedule.
12.2.5.9 Sprinkler riser: A sprinkler system riser which also serves as the wet stand pipe riser in
buildings required to have or having both systems shall conform to Section 12.1.13.
12.2.6.1 General: A limited area sprinkler system shall be of an approved type and installed in
accordance with the provisions of this Section.
12.2.6.2 Installation: Where the provisions of this Code require a limited number of sprinklers, a limited
area sprinkler system is permitted to be installed to comply with these requirements.
12.2.6.3 Design: The details of the system supplied with the plans and specifications shall include
information and the calculations of the sprinkler spacing and arrangement with water supply and
discharge requirements, size and equivalent lengths of pipe and fittings and water supply source.
Sufficient information shall be included to identify the apparatus and devices used.
12.2.6.4 Actuation: A limited area sprinkler system shall be automatically actuated.
[Page 377]
12.2.6.5 Sprinkler alarms: Alarms and alarm attachments shall not be required.
12.2.6.6 Standpipe connection: The water supply for the limited area sprinkler system shall be from the
building standpipe system when the building is equipped with a standpipe system that is sized for
0.032m3/s (500 gallons per minute) minimum flow and has an automatic water supply (see Section
12.1.13).
12.2.6.7 Domestic supply: Where limited area sprinklers are supplied from the domestic water system,
the domestic water system shall be designed to adequately support the design flow of the largest number
of sprinklers in any one of the enclosed areas. When supplied by the domestic water system, the
maximum number of sprinklers in any one enclosed room or area shall not exceed 20, and the sprinklers
shall be capable of totally protecting the room or area.
12.2.6.8 Fire department connections: A fire department connection is not required for limited area
sprinkler systems supplied from the domestic water system.
12.2.6.9 Cross connection: There shall not be a cross connection between the domestic water system
and the standpipe system.
12.2.6.10 Domestic connection: A check valve shall be provided at the point where the suppression
system piping is connected to the domestic water piping to prevent contamination of the domestic water
supply. Shut-off valves shall not be permitted in the suppression system piping. Water supply shall be
controlled by the riser control valve to the domestic water piping.
Use: Limited area sprinklers shall be used only in rooms or areas enclosed with construction assemblies
as required by this Code.
12.2.7.1 General: Water-spray extinguishing systems shall be of an approved type and installed in
accordance with the provisions of this code and NFiPA 15 listed in the Schedule.
12.2.7.2 Design: The details of the system supplied with the plans and specifications shall include
information and the calculations of the sprinkler spacing and arrangement with water supply and
discharge requirements, size and equivalent lengths of pipe and fittings and water supply source.
Sufficient information shall be included to identify the apparatus and devices used.
12.2.7.3 Actuation: Water-spray extinguishing systems shall be automatically actuated with
supplementary manual tripping capability.
12.2.7.4 Tests: All new system piping shall be hydrostatically tested in accordance with the provisions of
NFiPA 15 listed in the Schedule.
12.1.8.1 General: Foam extinguishing systems shall be of an approved type and installed in accordance
with the provisions of this Code and NFiPA 11, 11A and 16 listed in the Schedule.
12.1.8.2 Design: The details of the system supplied with the plans and specifications shall include
complete computations showing pressure drop in all system piping, friction loss calculations of liquid
lines and a detailed layout of the entire hazard area to be protected. Hydraulic characteristics of foam
proportioners and foam makers as determined [Page 378] by tests shall be supplied by the manufacturer to
the department (including the range of operating conditions required for the proposed installation) to
permit determination of the adequacy of the hydraulics of the proposed protection.
12.1.8.3 Actuation: A foam extinguishing system shall be automatically actuated with supplementary
manual tripping capability.
12.1.8.4 Tests: All piping, except that piping which handles expanded foam, shall be subjected to a
2-hour hydrostatic pressure test of 1375kpa (200 psi) or 345 kpa (50psi) in excess of the maximum
pressure anticipated, whichever is greater, without leakage. The systems shall be subjected to a flow test
to ensure that the hazard area is fully protected in conformance with the design specifications, and to
determine the flow pressures, actual discharge capacity, foam quality, consumption rate of
foam-producing materials, manpower requirements and other operating characteristics.
12.2.9.1 General: Carbon dioxide extinguishing systems shall be of an approved type installed in
accordance with the provisions of this code and NFiPA 12 listed in the Schedule.
12.2.9.2 Design: The details of the system supplied with the plans and specifications shall include
information and calculations of the amount of carbon dioxide, the location and flow rate of each nozzle
including equivalent office area and the location, size and the carbon dioxide storage facility. Information
shall be submitted pertaining to the location and function of the detection devices, operating devices,
auxiliary equipment and electrical circuitry, if such used. Sufficient information shall be indicated to
identify properly the apparatus and devices used. Any special features shall be adequately explained.
12.2.9.3 Actuation: Carbon dioxide extinguishing systems shall be automatically actuated with
supplementary manual tripping capability.
12.2.9.4 Safety requirements: In any proposed use of a carbon dioxide system where there is a
possibility that persons will enter or be trapped in atmospheres made hazardous by a carbon dioxide
discharge, warning signs, discharge alarms and breathing apparatus shall be provided to ensure prompt
evacuation of and to prevent entry into such atmospheres, and also to provide means for prompt rescue of
any trapped personnel.
12.2.9.5 Tests: A completed system shall be tested for tightness up to the selector valve, and for
continuity of piping with free unobstructed flow beyond the selector valve. The labelling of devices with
proper designations and instructions shall be checked. Operational tests shall be conducted on all devices
except cylinder valves in multi-cylinder high pressure systems. Where conditions prevail that make it
difficult to determine adequately the system requirements or design, a suitable discharge test and
concentration analysis test shall be made. All tests to be conducted as indicated in NFiPA 12 listed in the
Schedule.
12.2.9.6 Range hoods: In addition to the requirements of this section, Section 1002.20 and the
mechanical code listed in the Schedule, range hood CO2 systems shall bear the label of an approved
agency. The system shall be installed in accordance with the manufacturer’s installation instructions.
[Page 379]
12.2.10.1 General: FM 200 fire extinguishing systems shall be of an approved type and installed in
accordance with the provisions of this code and NFiPA 12A and 12B listed in the Schedule.
12.2.10.2 Design: The details of the system supplied with the plans and specifications shall include
information and calculations of the amount of extinguishing agent, container storage pressure; the
location and flow rate of each nozzle including equivalent orifice area; the location, size and equivalent
length of pipe, fittings and hose; and the locations and size of the storage facility. Information shall be
submitted pertaining to the location and function of the detection devices, auxiliary equipment and
electrical circuitry, if used. Sufficient information shall be indicated to identify property the apparatus and
devices used. Any special features shall be adequately explained.
12.2.10.3 Actuation: FM 200 fire extinguishing systems shall be automatically actuated with
supplementary manual tripping capacity.
12.2.10.4 Safety requirements: In any proposed use of a FM 200 fire extinguishing system where there
is a possibility that persons will enter or be trapped in atmospheres made hazardous by a discharge,
warning signs, discharge alarms and breathing apparatus shall be provided to ensure prompt rescue of any
trapped personnel.
12.2.10.5 Tests: A completed system shall be tested for tightness up to the selector valve, and for
continuity of piping with free unobstructed flow beyond the selector valve. The labelling of devices with
proper designations and instructions shall be checked. Operational test shall be conducted on all devices
except cylinder valves in multi-cylinder systems. Where conditions prevail that make it difficult to
determine adequately analysis shall be made. All tests are to be conducted as indicated in NFiPA 12A and
12B listed in the Schedule.
12.2.11.1 General: Dry chemical extinguishing systems shall be of an approved type and installed in
accordance with the provisions of this code and NFiPA 17 listed in the Schedule.
12.2.11.2 Design: The details of the system supplied with the plans and specifications shall include
sufficient information and calculations on the amount of dry chemical; the size, length, and arrangement
of connected piping, or piping and hose; description and location of nozzles so that the adequacy of the
system can be determined. Information shall be submitted pertaining to the location and function of
detection devices, operating devices, auxiliary equipment and electrical circuitry, if used. Sufficient
information shall be indicated to identify properly the apparatus and devices used. Any special features
shall be adequately explained.
12.2.11.3 Actuation: Dry chemical extinguishing systems shall be automatically actuated with
supplementary manual tripping capability.
12.2.11.4 Safety requirements: Where there is a possibility that personnel will be exposed to a dry
chemical discharge, warning signs, alarms and breathing apparatus shall be provided to ensure prompt
evacuation of such locations, and also to provide means for prompt rescue for any trapped personnel.
[Page 380]
12.2.11.5 Tests: A completed system shall be tested by a discharge or expellant gas through the piping
and nozzles. Observations for gas leakage and for continuity of piping with free unobstructed flow shall
be made. Observations shall be made of the flow or expellant gas through all nozzles. The labelling of
devices with proper designations and instructions shall be checked. After testing, all piping and nozzles
are to be blown clean using compressed air or nitrogen and the system properly charged and placed in the
normal “set” condition. All tests are to be conducted as indicated in NFiPA 17 listed in the Schedule.
12.2.11.6 Range hoods: In addition to the requirements of this section, Section 1002.20 and the
mechanical code listed in the Schedule, range hood dry chemical systems shall bear the label of an
approved agency. The system shall be installed in accordance with the manufacture’s installation
instructions. The dry chemical agent of the system shall be non-toxic.
12.2.12.1 General: Wet chemical extinguishing systems shall be installed in accordance with the
provisions of this section, and the mechanical code and NFiPA 17A listed in the Schedule. The system
shall bear the label of an approved agency and be installed in accordance with manufacturer’s installation
instructions. Wet chemical is defined as a solution of water and potassium-carbonate-based chemical,
potassium-acetate-based chemical or a combination thereof which forms the extinguishing agent.
12.2.12.2 Tests: A completed system shall be tested by a discharge or wet chemical in sufficient amounts
to verify that the system is properly installed and functional. Tests shall include a check of the detection
systems, alarms, and releasing devices, including manual stations, fuel and power shutoff devices and
other associated equipment. All tests are to be conducted as indicated in NFiPA 17A listed in the
Schedule.
12.2.13.1 General: Standpipe systems shall be of an approved type and installed and maintained in
accordance with the provisions of this code, the fire prevention code and NFiPA 14 listed in the Schedule.
12.2.13.2 Where required: Standpipe systems shall be installed in the locations prescribed in Section
12.1.13.1 through to 12.1.13.14.
12.2.13.3 Use Group A: In all buildings or structures or portions thereof of Use Group A when:
1. Two or more storeys in height of Use Group A-1, A-2, or A-3, and having an occupant load of
more than 300; or
2. three or more storeys in height regardless of the area per floor; or
3. having an auditorium seating over 500. Standpipes shall be located one on each side of the
auditorium in each tier, one in each mezzanine, one in each tier or dressing rooms, and
protecting each property, store and work room;
4. having a stage. Standpipes shall be located on each side of the stage. Such standpipes shall be
not less than 62.5mm diameter, equipped with 37.5cm hose and 10mm nozzles.
[Page 381]
12.2.13.4 Use Group B: In all buildings or structures or portions thereof of Use Group B when:
1. Three or more stories in height, and more than 279m2 in area per floor; or
2. four or more stories in height regardless of the area per floor.
12.2.13.5 Use Group C: In all buildings or structures or portions thereof of Use Group C when three or
more stories in height regardless of the area per floor or when having a stage or auditorium in accordance
with Section 12.1.13.2 and 12.1.13.4.
12.2.13.6 Use Group D: In all buildings or structures or portions thereof of Use Group D when:
1. Three or more stories in height, and more than 279m2 in area per floor; or
2. four or more stories in height regardless of the area per floor.
12.2.13.7 Use Group E: In all buildings or structures or portions thereof of Use Group E when:
1. Three or more storeys in height, and more than 930m2 in area per floor; or
2. four or more storeys in height regardless of the area per floor.
12.2.13.8 Use Group F: In all buildings or structures or portions thereof of Use Group F three or more
storeys in height regardless of the area per floor.
12.2.13.9 Exception: Use Group F-I when three storeys in height and less than 930m2 in area per floor.
12.2.13.10 Use Group G: In all buildings or structures or portions thereof of Use Group G when:
1. Three storeys or more in height, and more than 279m2 in area per floor; or
2. four or more storeys in height regardless of the area per floor; or
3. classified as a covered mall building within the mall portions (see Section 8.2.11).
12.2.13.11 Use Group H: In all buildings or structures or portions thereof of Use Group H when:
1. Three or more storeys in height and of Use Group H-1 regardless of the area per floor; or
2. three or more storeys in height and more than 930m2 in area per floor; or
3. four or more storeys in height regardless of the area per floor.
12.2.13.12 Use Group I: In all buildings or structures or portions thereof of Use Group S, other public
garages which shall conform to Section 2.1.13.14, when:
1. Three more storeys in height, of Use Group I-1 and more than 279m2 in area per floor; or
2. three or more storeys in height, of Use Group I-2 and more than 930m2 in area per floor; or
3. four or more storeys in height of Use Group I-1 or I-2 regardless of the area per floor.
12.2.13.13 Use Group Y: In all buildings or structures or portions thereof Use Group Y when:
1. Three or more storeys in height and more than 930m2 in area per floor; or
[Page 382]
2. four or more storeys in height regardless of the area per floor.
12.2.13.14 Public garages: In all Group I and II public garages when:
1. More than 930m2 in area per floor; or
2. more than 698m2 in area per floor and more than one story in height; or
3. more than 465m2 in area per floor, and more than two storeys in height; or
4. more than three storeys in height; or
5. located in buildings where the upper storeys are designed for other uses; or
6. when located in any storey that is more than 50 percent below grade.
12.2.13.15 Note that open parking structures are not public garages (see Section 8.8).
12.2.13.16 Standpipe system piping sizes: The riser piping, supply piping, and the water service piping
shall be sized to maintain a residual pressure of at least 65 psi (448kPa) at the topmost outlet of each riser
while flowing the minimum quantities, of water specified in Sections 12.1.13.20 of this Code.
12.2.13.17 Exception: The 448kPa (65 psi) residual pressure is not required to be maintained in
buildings less than 22.5m in height which are equipped throughout with an approved automatic fire
suppression system.
12.2.13.18 Riser sizing: The vertical water pipe(s) within a building to which fire hose outlets and
valves are attached shall be sized for a minimum flow of 0.032m3/s (500 gpm).
12.2.13.19 Exceptions
1. Where only 37.5mm valves are required or are provided, the riser(s) shall be sized to provide a
minimum flow of 0.0063m3/s (100gpm). The minimum size shall be 62.5mm.
2. In buildings where limited area sprinkler systems are supplied water from a common standpipe
riser, the riser shall be sized to satisfy total demand.
3. In buildings equipped throughout with an approved automatic fire suppression system where
both the suppression system and standpipe fire hose outlets are supplied water from a common
riser, the minimum riser diameter shall be adequate for the sprinkler system or the standpipe
system, whichever is greater. The minimum riser diameter shall be not less than that based on
hydraulic calculations.
4. In buildings which are not equipped throughout with an approved automatic fire suppression
system wherein the minimum diameter of the common riser is based on hydraulic calculations,
all risers shall have a minimum diameter as described in Table 30.13.
5. In buildings of Use Groups B, H-1, H-2, and F equipped throughout with an approved automatic
fire suppression system, each vertical standpipe riser shall be sized for a minimum flow of
0.016m3/s. (250gpm).
6. Standpipe systems in covered mall buildings as provided in Section 8.2.11.
[Page 383]
TABLE 12.7
BUILDING HEIGHT AND STANDPIPE RISER SIZE
12.2.13.20 Supply pipe sizing: The supply piping, including the horizontal or common feeder lines
within a building and the water service line outside of the building, shall be sized for a minimum flow of
0.032h3/s (500 gpm). When more than one standpipe riser is required or provided, all common supply
piping shall be sized for a minimum flow of 0.032m3/s (500gpm) for the first riser plus 0.016m3/s
(250gpm) for each additional riser, and the total need not exceed 0.16m3/s (2,500gpm).
12.2.13.21 Exceptions
1. Where only 37.5mm valves are required or are provided, the supply piping shall be sized for a
minimum flow of 0.0063m3/s (100gpm) for each riser, and the total need not exceed 0.032m3/s
(500gpm). The minimum size shall be 62.5mm.
2. In buildings where limited area sprinkler systems are supplied water from a common standpipe
riser, the supply piping shall be sized for a minimum flow of 0.032m3/s (500gpm) plus the
sprinkler demand for the first riser, plus 0.016m3/s 250gpm for each additional riser and the
total need not exceed 0.16m3/s (2,500 gpm).
12.2.13.22 In buildings of Use Group B, F, H-1 and H-2 equipped throughout with an approved
automatic fire suppression system, all common supply piping shall be sized for a minimum flow of
0.016m3/s (250 gpm) for the first riser plus 0.016m3/s (250 gpm) for each additional riser, and the total
need not exceed 0.095m3/s (1,500gpm).
12.2.13.23 Number of risers: The number of standpipe risers shall be such that all parts of every floor
area can be reached by a 9m hose stream from a nozzle attached to not more than 30m of hose connected
to a riser outlet. In those buildings equipped with an interior smoke proof enclosure vestibule, at least one
standpipe hose connection shall be located in the vestibule. In covered mall buildings, outlets shall be
located in accordance with Section 8.2.11.
12.2.13.24 Combination: Where a standpipe system riser also serves as the water sprinkler system riser
in buildings required to have both systems or in buildings having both systems, control valves shall be
installed where sprinklers are connected to the riser so that sprinklers are under the control of a separate
floor control valve(s) to allow standpipes to remain operational while the sprinkler system is in a closed
position. If control valves are located in a separate room or building, a sign shall be provided on the
entrance door. The lettering of such sign shall be of a conspicuous colour and shall be at least 100mm in
height and shall read Standpipe Control Valve or indicate other types of systems.
[Page 384]
12.2.13.25 Outlets: Standpipe system outlets shall comply with the provisions of Section 12.1.13.26
through to 12.1.13.30.
12.2.13.26 Hose connections: At each floor level, and not more than 1.5m above the floor, there shall be
connected to each standpipe a 62.5mm hose connection with valves and threads conforming to the local
fire department standards, if deemed necessary by the local fire department, 37.5mm hose connection
shall be provided and equipped with not more than 30m of 37.5mm approved lined fire hose with an
approved variable fog nozzle and couplings and hung in an approved rack or cabinet. Hose provided for
rack and cabinet use shall be of ozone-resistant materials and designed to be folded in a pin rack unit.
12.2.13.27 Exception: In buildings equipped throughout with an approved automatic fire suppression
system, the 37.5mm hose connection, hose and cabinet are not required.
12.2.13.28 Roof hydrants: Where standpipes are installed in buildings more than six storeys or 22.5m in
height, at least one riser shall extend through the roof and terminate in a two-way, 62.5mm hose
connection. The main control valve on a roof hydrant or manifolded hose connection shall be located in
an area not subject to freezing, as close to the roof access as practical and plainly marked (see Section
12.1.15.9).
12.2.13.29 Pressure reducers: When the residual pressure at any standpipe fire hose outlet exceeds 690
kPa (100 psi) approved pressure reducing devices or discs shall be installed at the outlets to reduce the
pressure to 690 kPa (100 psi) while the required quantity of water per minute is flowing. Any standpipe
riser over 75m in height shall be equipped with an approved pressure regulating device on each hose
outlet, which controls discharge pressures under both flow (residual) and no-flow (static) conditions.
12.2.13.30 Test gauges: An approved water pressure gauges shall be attached to the top of each
standpipe riser for inspection and test purposes. Shut-off valves, with provisions for bleeding pressure
from the gauge, shall be installed between the gauge and the top of the riser. Gauges shall be accessible
and located in spaces not subject to freezing.
12.2.13.31 Materials: All standpipes shall be constructed of approved materials. All pipes, fittings and
valves shall be of extra heavy pattern when the normal working pressure will exceed 1207 kPa (175 psi).
12.2.13.32 Tests: All standpipe systems shall be flow tested and hydrostatical tested in accordance with
the fire prevention code listed in the Schedule.
12.2.14.1 General: Standpipes required by this section are to be either temporary or permanent in nature,
with or without a water supply, provided, however, that such standpipes conform to the requirements of
Section 12.1.13 as to number of risers, capacity, outlets and materials.
12.2.14.2 Where required: Temporary or permanent standpipes shall be installed, as the work of the
building progresses, beginning at the 5th storey or at 19.5m in height.
12.2.14.3 Height: The standpipe systems shall be carried up with each floor and shall be installed and
ready for use as each floor progresses. Standpipes shall be extended as construction progresses to within
one floor of the highest point of construction having secured decking or flooring.
[Page 385]
12.2.14.4 Outlets: Hose outlets shall be provided with caps and attachment chains. The 37.5mm hose
and nozzle shall not be required during construction.
12.2.14.5 Fire department connections: At the street level there shall be provided for each temporary or
permanent standpipe installation one or more two-way fire department inlet connections. Fire department
inlet connections shall be prominently marked and readily and easily accessible at all times (see Section
12.1.15.9).
12.2.14.6 Buildings under demolition: Where a building is being demolished and a standpipe is existing
within such a building. Such standpipe shall be maintained in an operable condition so as to be available
for use by the fire department. Such standpipe shall be demolished with the building but shall not be more
than one floor below the floor above being demolished.
12.2.16.1 Required: All fire suppression and standpipe systems shall be provided with at least one
automatic supply of extinguishing material of adequate pressure, capacity and reliability to perform the
function intended, except as provided in Section 12.1.14.
12.2.16.2 Combination sprinkler/standpipe water supply: Where both sprinklers and standpipes are
installed and have a common fire water service as their combined source of supply, the water supply line
shall be adequately sized to meet the flow and pressure demands of the water supplies for the sprinkler
system or the standpipe system, whichever is greater.
12.2.16.3 Combination sprinkler/domestic water supply: Where a sprinkler system is connected to the
domestic water supply system, it shall be of adequate pressure, capacity and size for the simultaneous
operation of the water sprinkler system and domestic water needs. Taps for domestic water from water
sprinkler systems are prohibited.
12.2.16.4 Size: The extinguishing material supply for fire suppression systems shall be sized in an
approved manner in accordance with this Code.
12.2.16.5 Standpipe water service: All standpipe systems shall be connected to a street water main.
Water mains shall be adequately sized and have enough pressure and discharge capacity to supply the
total water demand for the building. Taps into the main and water service lines from the main to the
building shall be at least equal in size to the largest supply line inside the building. Common supply lines
from the main, from which standpipes, domestic or sprinkler systems are supplied, shall be sized to
satisfy total demand.
12.2.16.6 Standpipe interconnection: The required water supply shall be connected to the base of each
standpipe riser. Where more than one standpipe riser is required, all risers shall be interconnected at their
base with a common supply line and an approved indicating valve shall be installed at the base of each
riser so as to permit individual risers to be taken out or service if damaged or broken without interrupting
the water supply to other risers.
12.2.16.7 Standpipes in unheated areas: Standpipes installed so that all or any portion of the system is
installed through unheated areas subject to freezing shall be so arranged through the use of approved
devices as to admit water to the system automatically by opening a hose valve or through the use of
approved remote control devices located at each hose station.
Post-Construction Stage / Section 12 Post-Construction Requirements / 12.2 FIRE
PROTECTION SYSTEMS / 12.2.17 Yard Hydrants
12.2.17.1 Fire hydrants: Fire hydrants installed on private property shall be located and installed as
directed by the fire department. Hydrants shall conform to the standards of the administrative authority of
the jurisdiction and the fire department. Hydrants shall not be installed on a water main less than 150mm
in diameter.
12.2.18.1 Plans and specifications: Where a fire protective signalling system is required by this Code,
the plans and specifications shall show the location and number of [Page 387] all sending stations and
signals with specifications of the type, construction and operation of the system. Installation of all
equipment shall conform to the requirements of this Code and NFiPA 72A listed in the Schedule.
12.2.18.2 Approval: The fire protective signalling systems shall be approved for the particular
application and shall be used for the fire protective signalling purpose only. Alarm boxes shall be painted
a distinctive red colour.
12.2.18.3 Where required: A fire protective signalling system shall be installed and maintained in full
operating condition in the locations described in Section 12.1.18.4 through to 12.1.18.11.
12.2.18.4 Use Groups A-4 and C: In all new and existing buildings of Use Groups A-4 and C.
12.2.18.5 Exception: Sanctuary and nave areas of churches and similar religious buildings.
12.2.18.6 Use Group B: In all buildings of Use Group B when three or more storeys in height.
12.2.18.7 Exception: Buildings equipped through with an approved automatic fire suppression system
and less than seven storeys in height.
12.2.18.8 Use Group F: In all buildings of Use Group F.
12.2.18.9 Use Group F-3: In all buildings of Use Group F-3. The manual pull boxes shall be permitted
to be locked, provided that staff is present within the subject area when occupied.
12.2.18.10 Use Group H-1: In all buildings of Use Group H-1.
12.2.18.11 Use Group H-2: In all buildings of Use Group H-2 when four or more storeys in height.
12.2.18.12 Location: Manual pull stations shall be located in each storey, including basement, not more
than 1.5m from each exit. In buildings of Use Group A, where a stage is provided, a manual pull station
shall be located adjacent to the lighting control panel.
12.2.18.13 Box height: The height of the manual pull station boxes shall be a minimum of 1 meter and a
maximum of 1.35m measured vertically, from the floor level to the activating handle or lever of the pull
station.
12.2.18.14 Coding: Systems shall be either coded or non-coded. Coded stations shall be coded in
conformance with NFiPA 72A listed in the Schedule.
12.2.18.15 Power supply: The power for the fire alarm system shall be provided from an emergency
electrical system conforming to Section 9.2.9.1.
12.2.18.16 Requirements: Fire protective signaling systems shall be of the closed circuit type and shall
be electrically or mechanically supervised. In addition, such systems shall comply with Section
12.1.18.17 through to 12.1.18.21.
12.2.18.17 Wiring: All wiring or mechanical tubing shall conform to the requirements of NFiPA 72A
listed in the Schedule.
12.2.18.18 Alarms: Audible alarms of the approved type shall be provided. The operation of any fire
alarm device shall cause all audible or visual alarms to operate Visual and audible alarms shall be
provided in occupancies housing the hard of hearing. Alarm [Page 388] sounding devices shall be of
approved type, shall provide a distinctive tone and shall not be used for any purpose other than that of a
fire alarm. They shall be of such character and so located as to be seen or effectively heard above all other
sounds, by all the occupants, in every occupied space within the building.
12.2.18.19 Exception: Smoke detectors in buildings of Use Group F-3 shall be permitted to alarm at a
constantly attended location and are not required to accomplish general alarm indication.
12.2.18.20 Presignal system: Presignal systems shall not be installed unless approved by the Code
Enforcement Officer and by the fire department. Where a presignal system is installed, 24-hour personnel
supervision shall be provided at a location approved by the fire department, in order that the alarm signal
can be actuated in the event of fire or other emergency.
12.2.18.21 Zones: Each floor shall be zoned separately. If the floor area exceeds 1860m2 additional
zoning shall be provided. The length of any zone shall not exceed 90m in any direction. Zoning indicator
panels and controls shall be located as approved by the department. Annunciators shall lock in until the
system is reset.
12.2.18.22 Acceptance tests: Upon completion of the fire protective signaling system, the installations
shall be subjected to a performance test to demonstrate its efficiency of operation. All connections and
wiring, with signal devices disconnected, shall develop an insulation resistance of not less than 1 (one)
megohm.
12.2.19.1 Plans and specifications: Where an automatic fire detection system is required by this Code,
the plans and specifications shall show the location and number of all sending stations and signals with
specifications of the type of construction and operation of the system including all automatic detection
devices. Installation of all equipment shall conform to requirements of this Code and NFiPA 72E listed in
the Schedule. The system shall be installed in accordance with this section and shall be part of and subject
to the requirements of a fire protective signalling system specified in Section 12.1.18.
12.2.19.2 Approval: The automatic fire detection system shall be approved for the particular application
and shall only be used for detection and signalling in the event of fire. The automatic detecting devices
shall be smoke detectors, except an approved alternative type of detector shall be installed in space such
as boiler rooms where during normal operation products of combustion are present in sufficient quantity
to cause alarm.
12.2.19.3 Where required: An automatic fire detection system shall be installed and maintained in full
operating condition in the locations described in Section 12.1.19.4 through to 12.1.19.11.
12.2.19.4 Use Group F-1 and F-2: In all buildings of Use Group F-1. Buildings of Use Group F-2 shall
be equipped with a fire protective signalling system in accordance with this section and Section 7.2.11.7.
12.2.19.5 Use Group F-3: Automatic smoke detectors shall be installed throughout all resident housing
areas.
12.2.19.6 Exceptions
1. Smoke detectors shall not be required in sleeping rooms with four or less occupants in Use
Group II or III (see Section 4.8.5).
[Page 389]
2. Smoke detectors shall not be required in sleeping rooms with four or less occupants in buildings
protected throughout with an approved automatic fire suppression system.
12.2.19.7 Use Group H-1: In all buildings of Use Group H-1.
12.2.19.8 Exception: Motel/hotel units that do not have interior corridors and which have direct access
to the outside from the sleeping unit at grade level.
12.2.19.9 Use Group B or H-2: In all buildings of Use Group B or H-2 when such buildings have floors
used for human occupancy located more than 22.5m above the lowest level of fire department vehicle
access.
12.2.19.10 Exception: In buildings of Use Group H-2, smoke detectors are not required within the
individual dwelling units except as required by Section 12.1.19.11.
12.2.19.11 Sleeping areas and dwelling units: In addition to any automatic fire protective signaling
system required by Section 12.1.19.4, 12.1.19.7 and 12.1.19.9, a minimum of one single-station smoke
detectors shall be installed in each guest room, suite or sleeping area in buildings of Use Group H-1 and
F-1 and in dwelling units in the immediate vicinity of the bedrooms in buildings of Use Group H-2 or
H-3. When actuated, the detector shall provide an alarm suitable to warn the occupants within the
individual unit. In buildings of Use Groups H-1 and H-2 which have basements and additional smoke
detectors shall be installed in the basement. In buildings of Use Group H-3, smoke detectors shall be
required on every storey of the dwelling unit including basements. In dwelling units with levels, a smoke
detector installed on the upper level shall suffice for the adjacent lower level provided the lower level is
less than one full storey below the upper level. If there is an intervening door between the adjacent levels,
a smoke detector shall be installed on both levels. All detectors shall be installed in an approved location.
Where more than one detector is required to be installed within an individual dwelling unit, the detectors
shall be wired in such a manner that the situation of one alarm will actuate all the alarms in the individual
unit.
12.2.19.12 Sprinklered buildings exception: Buildings or portions thereof equipped throughout with an
automatic fire suppression system are not required to be equipped with an automatic fire detection system,
but are required to be equipped with a manual fire protective signaling system conforming to Section
12.1.18. This exception does not apply to buildings of Use Group F-2 to single-station smoke detectors as
required in Section 12.1.19.11.
12.2.19.13 Distances: Smoke detectors shall be installed not to exceed the lineal or square footage
allowances specified, based on the test standards under which they were tested and approved.
12.1.19.14 Zones: The automatic fire detection system shall be connected to the same zones as those
required for the fire protective signalling system in Section 12.1.18. Automatic detectors which have
separate indication on the annunciator panel from the manual pull stations and the fire suppression
systems shall have detection zones which match the pull station zones in size and arrangement.
12.2.20.1 General: Smoke control systems required by this Code shall conform to the provisions of this
section.
[Page 390]
12.2.20.2 Acceptance: Before a certificate of occupancy is issued, the smoke control system shall be
tested in an approved manner to show compliance with the applicable requirements of this section.
12.2.20.3 Standby power: All equipment required to provide smoke control shall be equipped with a
standby source complying with Section 9.2.9.8.
12.2.20.4 Exceptions
1. Mechanical air-handling equipment designed to accomplish smoke control in systems specified
in Sections 12.1.20.6 and 12.1.20.11, when the building is equipped throughout with an
approved automatic fire suppression system.
2. Smoke control systems specified in Section 12.1.20.12.
12.2.20.5 Inspections: All operating parts of the smoke control systems specified in Section 12.1.20.17
and 12.1.20.23 (including dampers) shall be tested by the owner every three months and a log of the tests
shall be kept for examination by the fire department. At six-month intervals, the system shall be inspected
and operated in accordance with the fire prevention code listed in the Schedule.
12.2.20.6 High-rise buildings: Where required by Section 8.3.7, natural or mechanical ventilation for
the removal of products of combustion shall be provided in every story and shall consist of one of the
methods described in Section 12.1.20.7 through 12.1.20.10.
12.2.20.7 Panels or windows: Panels or windows shall be provided in the exterior walls which can be
opened remotely from an approved location other than the fire floor. Such venting facilities shall be
provided at the rate of 1.85m2 per 15m length of exterior wall in each story and shall be distributed
around the perimeter at not more than 15m intervals. Such windows or panels and their controls shall be
clearly identified.
12.2.20.8 Exception: When a complete automatic fire suppression system is installed, remotely operated
operable panels and windows are not required when windows or panels manually operable from within
the fire floor are installed or approved fixed tempered glass is used. Such windows shall be clearly
identified and shall be of the size and spacing indicated above.
12.2.20.9 Mechanical system: Where a complete and approved automatic fire suppression system is
installed and the mechanical air handling equipment is designed to accomplish smoke removal, the return
and exhaust air shall be moved directly to the outside without recirculation to other sections of the
building under fire conditions. The air handling system shall provide a minimum of one exhaust air
change each 10 minutes for the area involved.
12.2.20.10 Other designs: Any other approved design which will adequately remove smoke from each
compartment served in an unsprinkled building is permitted, provided the system is tested and approved
by the code enforcement officer before the building is ratified for occupancy.
12.2.20.11 Elevators: When equipped with a mechanical smoke control system that will restrict smoke
and hot gases from entering the elevator shaft in the fire floor, hoistway venting specified in Section
9.1.8.18.6 is not required. In high-rise buildings equipped with this system and equipped throughout with
an approved automatic fire suppression system, the 1-hour fire-resistance rated elevator lobbies specified
in Section 8.3.8 are not required.
[Page 391]
12.2.20.12 Covered mall buildings: Where required by Section 8.2.12, the mall and adjacent tenant
spaces shall be equipped with an approved smoke control system. Smoke control equipment serving the
mall shall be sized to provide a minimum of six air changes per hour for malls having a volume of
16800m3 or less, and a minimum of four air changes per hour for malls having a volume of more than
16800m3. The volume shall be measured from the entrance to tenant spaces and to a height of 3.6m above
each pedestrian area. Exhaust inlets for the mall shall be located a minimum of 1.8m above the walking
surface. Necessary outside air to accomplish the required air changes per hour shall be provided.
12.2.20.13 Activation: The exhaust system shall be activated by smoke detectors complying with NFiPA
72E listed in the Schedule, by operation of the sprinkler system, and manually. A smoke detector shall be
installed in the return air portion of every heating and cooling system ahead of any fresh air intake. The
activation system shall be installed in an approved manner.
12.2.20.14 Operation: The approved automatic exhaust system shall be a separate system or shall be
integrated with an approved air conditioning system. Where a separate system is provided, operation of
the fire emergency ventilation system shall automatically shut down the air conditioning system or any
other devices which interfere with the effective operation of the fire emergency ventilating system.
12.2.20.15 Tenant space zones: When a fire occurs within a tenant space zone, that zones shall operate
at 100 percent exhaust, and supply air to that zone shall be shut down. Adjoining tenant space zones shall
go to normal operations and the mall system shall operate at 100 percent fresh air supply.
12.2.20.16 Mall system: When a fire occurs within the mall, the mall system shall operate at 100 percent
exhaust, and adjoining tenant spaces shall go to normal operation.
12.2.20.17 Atriums: Where required by Section 8.7.2.1, a smoke control system shall be designed to
control the migration of products of combustion in the atrium spaces. A mechanically operated air
handling system shall be installed that will exhaust smoke either entering or developing within the atrium.
Exhaust openings shall be located in the ceiling or in a smoke trap area immediately adjacent to the
ceiling of the atrium. Supply opening sized to provide 50 percent of the exhaust volume shall be located
at the lowest level of the atrium. For purposes of this section, the volume of the atrium shall include all
spaces not separated from the atrium in accordance with Section 8.7.2.2.
12.2.20.18 Supply air: Where the height of the atrium is 16.5m or less, supply air introduced by gravity
is permitted provided smoke control is accomplished. When the height of the atrium is more than 16.5m,
supply air shall be introduced mechanically from the floor of the atrium and be directed vertically toward
the exhaust outlets. In atriums over six stories in height or having open floors above the second storey,
introduction of supplemental supply air at upper levels is permitted.
12.2.20.19 Exhaust: The atrium smoke control system shall exhaust not less than the following
quantities of air:
1. For atriums having a volume of not more than 16800m3, including the volume of any levels not
physically separated from the atrium, not less than 18.88m3/s nor less than six air changes per
hour.
[Page 392]
2. For atriums having a volume of more than 16800m3, including the volume of any levels not
physically separated from the atrium, not less than four air changes per hour.
12.2.20.20 Smoke detectors: Smoke detectors shall be installed at the perimeter and on the ceiling of the
atrium and on the underside of each floor level that is open to the atrium space. Detectors shall be located
in accordance with their listing.
12.2.20.21 Smoke control activation: The smoke control system required for the atrium spaces, shall be
activated by the fire suppression system, by smoke detectors required by Section 12.1.20.20, and by
manual controls provided for fire department use. The system shall not be activated by a manual fire
protective signalling system required by Section 12.1.18. Manual controls shall be located in the central
control station or other location approved by the fire department. When the smoke control system is
activated, other air handling systems which interfere with its function shall shut off automatically.
12.2.20.22 Other approved methods: Any other approved design which will achieve the same level of
smoke control as described in this section is permitted in lieu of these requirements.
12.2.20.23 Floor openings: The smoke control system required by Section 8.7.2.1 shall be an automatic
exhaust system designed to prevent the passage of smoke to the storey above in accordance with Section
12.1.20.24 through to 12.1.20.26 or any other approved system of smoke control which will accomplish
the same purpose.
12.2.20.24 Control: The system shall be a separate unit or shall be integrated with an approved air
handling system and shall be thermostatically controlled to operate simultaneously with the detection of
fire.
12.2.20.25 Capacity: The system shall be of adequate capacity to create a controlled draft in the floor
opening with sufficient velocity of flow over the entire area of the floor opening under normal conditions
of window and door openings in the building.
12.2.20.26 Operation: The system shall be so arranged as to automatically stop the operation of the
normal mechanical air handling ventilating systems, and close the dampers of the return air duct
connections, in the event of fire.
12.2.21 Supervision
12.2.21.1 Fire suppression systems: Fire suppression systems required for buildings of Use Groups A,
C, F or H shall be supervised by methods 1, 2, 3 or 4 below. All other fire suppression systems shall be
supervised by one of the following methods.
1. Approved central station system in accordance with NFiPA 71 listed in the Schedule.
2. Approved proprietary system in accordance with NFiPA 72D listed in the Schedule.
3. Approved remote station system of the jurisdiction in accordance with NFiPA 72C listed in the
Schedule.
4. Approved local alarm service which will cause the sounding of an audible signal at a constantly
attended location in accordance with NFiPA 72A listed in the Schedule.
5. Locking valves open.
[Page 393]
12.2.21.2 Exceptions
1. Underground gate valves with roadway boxes.
2. Halogenated extinguishing systems.
3. Carbon dioxide extinguishing systems.
4. Dry chemical extinguishing systems.
5. Limited area sprinkler systems.
12.2.21.3 Fire protection systems: All required fire protection systems, other than fire suppression
systems, shall be connected to an approved central station system, proprietary system, or remote station
system of the jurisdiction when approved by the fire department. Fire suppression systems shall conform
to Section 12.1.21.
12.2.21.4 Exceptions
1. Standpipe systems.
2. Fire alarm systems in buildings of Use Group H when less than five storeys in height.
3. Single-station detectors required by Section 12.1.19.11.
4. Smoke detectors in buildings of Use Group F-3.
12.2.22.1 Approval: Portable fire extinguishers shall bear the label of an approved agency and shall be
installed in a location visible and accessible to the occupants.
Where required: A portable fire extinguisher shall be installed in the following locations in accordance
with NFiPA 10 listed in Schedule A.
1. In all buildings of use groups.
2. In all areas containing commercial kitchen exhaust wood system.
3. In all areas where fuel is dispensed.
4. In all areas where a flammable or combustible liquid is used in the operation of spraying,
coating or dipping.
5. In all buildings of Use Group F-3 at staff locations. Access to portable extinguishers shall be
permitted to be locked.
6. On each completed floor of buildings under construction, other than buildings of Use Group
H-3.
12.3.1 General
12.3.1.1 Scope: The provisions of this Part shall govern the use and design of all materials and methods
of construction in respect to required fire resistance rating and flame-resistance, as determined by the
potential fire hazard of the use and occupancy of the building or structure and the location and function of
all integral structural and other fire resistive elements of the building; and the installation of safeguards
against the spread of fire to and from adjoining structures.
12.3.1.2 Performance standards: The requirements of this Part shall constitute the minimum functional
performance standards for fire protection purposes; and shall not be deemed to decrease or waive any
strength provisions or in any other manner decrease the requirements of this code in respect to structural
safety.
[Page 394]
12.3.1.3 Use of combustibles: All materials and forms of construction that develop the fire-resistance
ratings required by this code shall be acceptable for fireproofing and structural purposes; except that the
use of combustible component materials in structural units or structural assemblies shall be limited in
types of construction specified in Section 6.2.2, 6.2.3, 6.2.4 and 6.2.5, and in Section 29.1.4.
12.3.1.4 Combustible components: Combustible aggregates are permitted in concrete mixtures
approved for fire-resistance rated construction as provided in (refer to section on Gypsum) for gypsum
concrete, in (Chapter on Materials, ext. walls) for cinder concrete, and any other approved component
material or admixture is permitted in assemblies that meet the fire-resistive test requirements of this code;
and wood nailing stir or any other materials if similar combustible characteristics are permitted in
concrete and masonry construction for securing trim and finish.
12.3.2.1 General: Plans for all buildings shall designate the type of construction and fire-resistance
rating of all structural elements as required by this Code. The plans and specifications shall include
documentation or supporting data substantiating all required fire resistance ratings.
12.3.2.2 Penetrations: Plans for buildings more than two stories in height shall indicate where
preparations will be made for electrical, mechanical, plumbing and communications conduits, pipes and
systems, and shall also indicate the materials and methods for maintaining the required structural
integrity, fire resistance rating and fire-stopping.
12.3.3.1 General: The degree of fire hazard of buildings for each specific Use Group as defined by the
fire grading in Table 12.2.3 shall determine the requirements for fire walls, and horizontal and vertical
assemblies separating mixed uses as prescribed in Section 5.2.11 and all structural members supporting
such elements unless otherwise provided for in this code.
12.3.3.2 Unclassified uses: The Code Enforcement Officer shall determine the fire hazard classification
of a building or structure designed for a use not specifically provided in Table 12.2.3 in accordance with
the fire characteristics and potential fire hazard of the Use Group which it most nearly resembles; or its
designation shall be fixed by the approved rules.
TABLE 12.8
FIRE GRADING OF USE GROUPS
[Page 395]
12.3.4.1 Structural building assemblies: Built-up masonry units and composite assemblies of structural
materials including walls, partitions, columns, girders, beams slabs and assemblies of slabs and beams or
other combinations of structural units for use in floor and roof construction shall be regulated by the fire
resistance ratings of Table 6.1. Floor assemblies which are required to be fire-resistance rated shall extend
to and be tight against exterior walls, or other provisions shall be made for maintaining the fire-resistance
rating of the assembly at such locations.
12.3.4.2 Fire-resistance ratings: The fire-resistance ratings of building assemblies and structural
elements shall be determined in accordance with the test procedures set forth in ASTM E119 listed in the
Schedule. The fire-resistance rating of concrete assemblies and structural elements shall be established as
heretofore required, or shall be determined in accordance with the procedures of the CRSI book
Reinforced Concrete Fire Resistance or PCI MNL 124-77 listed in the Schedule. The fire-resistance rating
of protected steel shall be established as heretofore required or shall be calculated in accordance with
AISI Designing Fire Protection for Steel Columns, AISI Designing Fire protection for Steel Beams and
AISI Designing Fire Protection for Steel Trusses listed in the Schedule.
12.3.4.3 Tested assemblies: Assemblies of building construction shall be tested according to Section
12.2.4 or be detailed in GA-600 or in the UL Fire-Resistance Directory listed in the Schedule as having
the fire-resistance ratings specified therein for determining compliance with the requirements of this
Code.
12.3.4.4 Alternative protection: Where it can be shown to the Code Enforcement Officer that the
structural integrity of structural framing elements will not be reduced below a safe level by a fire within
the building or in an adjacent building having a severity corresponding to the fire-resistance rating
required for the elements through the use of heat shields, separations or other approved means of
protection, fire-resistive coverings or insulating enclosing materials are not required for such elements.
[Page 396]
12.3.4.5 Opening protectives: Opening protectives shall include the fire door, fire shutter, fire window,
or fire damper and all required hardware, anchorage, frames and sills necessary for the assembly.
12.3.4.6 Combustibility tests: Where the behaviour of materials under exposure to fire is specified in
this Code, the characteristics of materials shall be determined by the tests and criteria set forth in Sections
12.2.4.8.
12.3.4.7 Tests: The tests indicated in Section 12.2.4.8 and 12.2.4.9 shall serve as criteria for acceptance
of building materials as set forth in Section 6.2.2, 6.2.3, 6.2.4 and 6.2.5 governing the combustibility of
building materials for use in Types 1, 2, 3, and 4 construction. The term “noncombustible” does not apply
to the flame spread characteristics of interior finish or trim materials. A material shall not be classed as a
noncombustible building construction material which is subject to an increase in the combustible or flame
spread rating beyond the limits herein established through the effects of age, moisture or other
atmospheric conditions.
12.3.4.8 Elementary materials: Materials which are intended to be classified as non-combustible shall
be tested in accordance with ASTM E136 listed in the Schedule. Such materials shall be acceptable as
non-combustible materials when at least three of the four specimens tested meet all of the following
criteria.
1. The recorded temperature of the surface and interior thermocouple shall not at any time during the test
rise more than 30 degrees C above the furnace temperature at the beginning of the test.
2. There shall not be flaming from the specimen after the first 30 seconds.
3. If the weight loss of the specimen during testing exceeds 50 percent, the recorded temperature of the
surface and interior testing thermocouple shall not at any time during the test rise above the furnace air
temperature at the beginning of the test, and there shall not be flaming of the specimen.
12.3.4.9 Composite materials: Materials having a structural base of non-combustible material as defined
in section 29 with a surfacing not more than 3mm thick which has a flame spread rating not greater than
50 percent when tested in accordance with ASTM E84 listed in the Schedule, shall be acceptable as
noncombustible materials.
12.3.6.1 General: All materials which are required to restrict the spread of flame or to be flame-resistant
under the provisions of this code, including but not limited to interior finish materials, fire-retardant
treated wood, tents and tarpaulins, and interior hangings and decorations, shall meet the requirements for
their respective use and classifications as determined by the applicable test procedures listed in this
section.
12.3.6.2 Interior finish and trim material: All materials used for interior finish and trim shall be
classified in accordance with ASTM E648 listed in the Schedule.
12.3.6.3 Interior floor finish materials: Interior floor finish materials which are judged by the code
enforcement officer to represent an unusual hazard and are to be installed in exits, passageways and
corridors shall be classified in accordance with ASTM E648 listed in the Schedule
12.3.6.4 Interior hangings and decorations: Interior hangings and decorations shall comply with
Section 12.2.6.5 through to 12.2.6.8.
12.3.6.5 Acceptance criteria: Where required to be flame resistant under the provisions of this code, all
materials used for artistic enhancement, decorations, draperies, curtains, scenery and hangings shall
comply with this section. If treated to be flame resistant, these materials shall not generate smoke more
dense than that given off by untreated wood or paper burning under comparable conditions when tested in
the vertical flame test in accordance with NFi PA 701 listed in the Schedule.
12.3.6.6 Limitation of approval: All approvals of organic decorative material shall be limited to one
year. The owner or the owner’s authorised agent shall file an affidavit with the Code Enforcement Officer
certifying that the process and materials used comply with this code and stating the date of treatment and
the warranty period of effectiveness of the process.
12.3.6.7 Field test for decorative materials: The Code Enforcement Officer shall subject decorative
materials, where required to be flame resistant, to a field test in accordance with Section 5 of NFi PA 701
listed in the Schedule .
12.3.6.8 Replacement of defective materials: All treated hangings, draperies, canvas and other
decorative and tent materials that fail to meet the field test requirements shall be retreated or replaced by
an approved installation.
12.3.7.1 General: In buildings or parts thereof of the uses and types of construction herein specified, the
general fire-resistive requirements of Table 6.1 and the height and area limitations of Table 11.2.0 shall
be subject to the exceptions and modifications described in Section 12.2.7.1 and 12.2.7.6.
[Page 398]
12.3.7.2 Use Groups B, G and H: Buildings of Use Group B, G and H shall comply with the special
fire-resistive requirements of Section 12.2.7.3 through to 12.2.7.5.
12.3.7.3 Type 3A construction: The height limitation for buildings of Use Group H-2 of Type 3A
construction shall be increased to six storeys and 22.5m where the first floor construction above the
basement has fire-resistance rating of not less than 3 hours and the floor area is subdivided by 2-hour fire
walls into fire areas of not more than 279m2.
12.3.7.4 Type 2B construction: The height limitation for buildings of Use Group H-2 of Type 2B
construction shall be increased to nine stories and 30m where the building is separated by not less than
15m from any other building on the plot and from interior plot lines, the exits are segregated in a fire area
enclosed in a fire wall of 2-hour fire-resistance rating and the first floor construction has a fire-resistance
rating of not less than 1½-hours.
12.3.7.5 Use Groups B and G: The first floor of buildings of Type 2C, 3B or 5B construction shall not
be occupied for Use Groups B and G, unless the floor/ceiling assembly and enclosure walls are protected
to afford 1-hour fire-resistance rating and the exits from the residential floors are separately enclosed in
accordance with the requirements of Section 12.2.
12.3.7.6 Interior partitions: In buildings or structures of other than Use Groups F and H of Types 1, 2A
and 2B construction, partitions of a single thickness of wood or approved composite panels, and glass or
other approved materials of similar combustible characteristics, are permitted to subdivide rooms or
spaces into offices, entry areas, or other similar compartments, provided they do not establish a corridor
serving an occupant load of more than 30 in areas occupied by a single tenant and do not exceed 465m2;
between fire separation assemblies or fire walls. The maximum allowable compartment size shall be
increased to 697.5m2 where subdivided with fire-retardant treated wood complying with Section 12.2.5.
12.3.8.1 General: All exterior walls shall comply with the applicable provisions of this Code and with
the fire-resistance rating requirements of this section and Section 6.1, except as provided in Section
12.2.8.3 for open parking structures.
12.3.8.2 Exception: The provisions of Section 12.2.8.4 and 12.2.8.9 shall not apply to exterior walls
which face buildings on the same plot when the buildings are such that, if combined into one structure,
the resulting building would otherwise comply with the height and area limits of Section 11.2.0 (Section
11.2.1).
12.3.8.3 Omission of exterior walls: The provisions of this Code shall not be deemed to prohibit the
omission of exterior walls for all or part of a storey where the provisions of Section 12.2.8.4 do not
require a non-load-bearing exterior wall to provide a fire-resistance rating. Except as otherwise
specifically permitted in Section 12.2.14.5, the piers, columns and other structural elements within the
open portion shall be constructed with the fire-resistance rating required for exterior bearing walls in
Table 6.1. Open parking structures erected without exterior walls shall have an enclosure wall having a
fire-resistance rating of not less than 2 hours without openings when located with a fire separation
distance of less than 1.8m from an interior plot line.
[Page 399]
12.3.8.4 Fire resistance ratings: The fire resistance rating of exterior walls shall comply with Table
12.2.8.4. Load-bearing exterior walls with a fire separation distance of greater than 1.5m shall be rated for
exposure to fire from the inside. The fire-resistance rating of exterior walls with a fire separation distance
of 1.5m or less shall be rated for exposure to fire from both sides.
12.3.8.5 Wall height: The wall shall extend the full height of the building and shall be constructed so
that it will remain in place for the duration of time indicated by the required fire-resistance rating.
12.3.8.6 Automatic fire suppression: In buildings protected throughout with an approved automatic fire
suppression system, the required fire-resistance rating of non-load bearing exterior walls shall be reduced
by one hour. This reduction shall not apply to buildings of Use Group E.
12.3.8.7 Non-combustible construction exemptions: One-storey buildings of Type 2C construction
which do not exceed 279m2 in area shall be exempted from all protected exterior wall requirements. This
exemption shall not apply to buildings of Use Group A, C, E and F.
12.3.8.8 Unexposed surface temperature: Where protected openings are not limited by Table 12.2.8.5,
the limitation on the rise of temperature on the unexposed surface or exterior walls as required by ASTM
E119 listed in the Schedule shall not apply. Where protected openings are limited by Table 12.2.8.4, the
limitation on the rise of temperature on the unexposed surface of exterior walls as required by ASTM
E119 listed in the Schedule shall not apply provided correction is made for radiation from the unexposed
exterior wall surface in accordance with the following formula.
Ac = A+ (Af x Feo)
Where
Ae = equivalent area of protected openings.
A = actual area of unprotected and protected openings.
AF = area of exterior wall surface in the storey under consideration exclusive of openings, on
which the temperature limitations of ASTM E119 for walls is exceeded.
Feo = an “equivalent opening factor” derived from Figure 12.2.8.8 Graph of Fig. 12.2.8.8 below.
FIGURE 12.9
EQUIVALENT OPENING FACTOR
12.3.8.9 Openings: The maximum area of unprotected or protected openings permitted in an area of
exterior wall in any storey shall not exceed the values given in Table 12.2.8.4. Where both unprotected
and protected openings are used in the exterior wall in any story, the total area of the openings shall
comply with the following formula.
A + Au < 1.0
a au
Where A = actual area of protected openings, or the equivalent area of protected openings Ae (see
Section 12.2.8.4).
a = allowable area of protected opening.
Au = actual area of unprotected openings.
au = allowable area of unprotected openings.
[Page 400]
TABLE 12.10
MAXIMUM PERCENT AREA OF EXTERIOR WALL OPENINGS b.c
Note a: For buildings of Use Group H-3, the maximum percentage of unprotected exterior wall openings
shall be 5 percent.
Note b: This table assumes that the openings are reasonably uniformly distributed. Where openings are
not reasonably uniformly distributed, the portion of the wall used to calculate compliance with Table
29.8.4 shall be approved.
Note c: NP = not permitted: NL – no limit.
12.3.8.10 Automatic fire suppression: In buildings equipped throughout with an approved automatic
fire suppression system, other than buildings, or portions thereof, of Use Group E, the area of unprotected
openings shall not exceed the tabulated limits for protected openings.
12.3.8.11 First storey: In all buildings, other than buildings, or portions thereof, of Use Group E,
unlimited unprotected openings are permitted in the first storey of exterior walls facing a street and
having a fire separation distance of greater than 4.5m.
12.3.8.12 Vertical separation of openings: Openings in exterior walls in adjacent storeys shall be
separated vertically to protect against fire spread on the exterior of the buildings where the openings are
within 1.5m of each other horizontally and the opening in the lower storey is not a protected opening in
accordance with Section 12.2.9. Such openings shall be separated vertically at least 90cm by spandrel
girders, exterior walls, or other similar assemblies with a fire resistance of at least 1 hour or by flame
barriers which extend horizontally at least 75cm beyond the exterior wall. Flame barriers shall also have a
fire resistance rating of at least 1 hour. The unexposed surface temperature limits specified in ASTM
E119 listed in the Schedule shall not apply to the flame barriers or vertical separation unless otherwise
required by the provisions of this Code.
12.3.8.13 Exceptions
1. This section shall not apply to buildings of three storeys or less in height.
2. This section shall not apply to buildings equipped throughout with an approved automatic fire
suppression system.
12.3.8.14 Vertical exposure: Approved protective shall be provided in every opening which is less than
4.5m vertically above the roof of an adjoining building or adjacent structure that is within a horizontal fire
separation distance of 4.5m of the wall in which the opening is located unless such roof construction
affords a fire resistance rating of not less than 1 hour.
[Page 401]
12.3.8.15 Continuity of exterior walls: Exterior walls required to be fire resistance rated by Section
12.2.8.4 because of fire separation distance, shall be continuous from the foundation to not less than 75cm
above the roof surface.
12.3.8.16 Exceptions
1. Where the roof deck or sheathing is constructed of approved noncombustible materials or of
fire-retardant treated wood for a distance of not less that 1.2m from the wall, and the roof
covering has a minimum of a Class C rating, the exterior wall shall be permitted to stop at the
underside of the roof deck or sheathing.
2. Exterior walls in buildings of Use Group H-3 or buildings not exceeding 93m2 in area.
3. Exterior walls of a building where the roof has an angle of more than 20 degrees (0.35 rad.) with
the horizontal.
12.3.9.1 Where required: Exterior opening protectives shall be provided in all exterior wall openings
required to be protected by Section 12.2.8.
12.3.9.2. Outside sprinklers: Approved outside automatic sprinklers used for the protection of exterior
openings shall be installed in accordance with NFiPA 13 listed in the Schedule, shall have an automatic
source of water supply and shall be provided with a fire department connection.
12.3.9.3 Automatic protection: Approved fire protective assemblies shall be fixed, self-closing or
equipped with approved automatic closing devices meeting the requirements of this section and Section
12.2.4, 12.2.19, 12.2.20 and 12.2.21.
12.3.9.4 Fire resistance rating: An exterior opening in a wall required by Section 12.2.8 to have a fire
resistance rating greater than 1 hour shall be protected with an assembly having a fire-resistance rating of
not less than 1½-hours. An exterior opening in a wall required by Section 12.2.8 to have a fire-resistance
rating of 1 hour shall be protected with an assembly having a fire-resistance rating of not less than
¾-hour.
12.3.9.5 Unprotected openings: Where protected openings are not required by Section 12.2.8, windows
and doors shall be constructed of any approved materials. Glazing shall conform to the requirements of
section 10.
12.3.10.1 General: Walls shall have sufficient structural stability under fire conditions to allow collapse
of construction on either side without collapse of the wall, and shall be constructed of any approved
non-combustible materials providing the required strength and fire-resistance rating specified in Table 6.1
for the type of construction, but not less than the fire grading of the Use Group specified in Table 12.2.3.
Strength stability shall comply with the provisions of (Section 5.3.3 on ext. walls).
12.3.10.2 Cutting walls: A wall 20cm of less in thickness shall not be cut for chases or socketed for
insertion of structural members subsequent to erection.
12.3.10.3 Hollow walls: When combustible members frame into hollow walls or walls of hollow units,
all hollow spaces shall be solidly filed for the full thickness of the wall and for a distance not less than
10cm above, below and between the structural members with noncombustible materials approved for
firestopping in Section 12.2.23. The [Page 402] wall shall be not less than the minimum thickness
specified in NBS 211 for reinforced masonry, NBS H74 for reinforced masonry, BIA Building Code
Requirements for Engineered Brick Masonry, NCMA TR75-B or ACI 1531 listed in the Schedule.
12.3.10.4 Combustible insulation: The Code Enforcement Officer shall permit the application of cork,
fiber board or other combustible insulation where laid up without intervening air spaces and attached
directly to the face of the wall, and protected on the exposed surface as provided in Sections 10.22 and
12.2.30.
12.3.10.5 Continuity of walls: In all buildings or structures, walls shall be continuous from foundation
to 80 centimetres above the roof surface, except as provided in Section 29.10.6 through to 29.10.8. Fire
walls shall be made smoke-tight at their junction with exterior walls. In exterior walls construction
employing studs, the wall shall extend through the stud space to the exterior sheathing.
12.3.10.6 Non-combustible roofs: The wall is permitted to terminate at the underside of the roof deck
where the roof is of noncombustible construction and is properly firestopped at the wall.
12.3.10.7 Combustible roofs: The wall is permitted to terminate at the underside of the roof deck in
Types 3, 4, and 5 construction where all of the following conditions below are met.
1. The wall is properly firestopped at the deck.
2. The roof sheathing or deck is constructed of approved noncombustible materials, or
fire-retardant treated wood, for a distance of 1.2m on either side of the wall.
3. Combustible material does not extend through the wall.
4. The roof covering has a minimum of a Class C rating.
12.3.10.8 Non-combustible frame: The wall shall not be supported on the structural frame in buildings
of noncombustible construction unless such supporting frame has a fire-resistance rating at least equal to
that required for the wall.
12.3.10.9 Offset fire walls: Where fire walls are offset at intermediate floor level in protected
skeleton-frame construction, the offset floor construction and the intermediate wall supports shall be
constructed of noncombustible materials with a fire-resistance rating not less than that required for the
fire wall.
12.3.11.1 General: Openings in fire walls shall not exceed the limits in size and area herein prescribed
and the opening protectives shall conform to the provisions of Section 12.2.4 and 12.2.9.
12.3.11.2 Size of opening: Except in sprinklered buildings, an opening through a fire wall shall not
exceed 11.16m2 in area, and the aggregate width of all openings at any floor level shall not exceed 25
percent of the length of the wall.
12.3.11.3 First storey: Where the entire first storey areas on both sides of a fire wall are provided with
an approved automatic fire suppression system complying with the requirements of Section 7.3 the
maximum size of openings on the first storey of the building designed for the passage of trucks shall be
increased to 22.32m2 in area with a minimum distance of 90cm between adjoining openings. Such
openings shall be protected with approved automatic opening protectives of 3-hour fire-resistance rating,
and provided with an approved water curtain in addition to all other requirements.
[Page 403]
12.3.11.4 Opening protectives: Every opening in a fire wall shall be protected with an approved
automatic opening protectives assembly as herein required or the approved labelled equivalent in
accordance with Section 12.2.18.3, except as provided in Section 7.15.2 for horizontal exit openings.
12.3.11.5 Hold-open devices: Heat actuated hold-open devices shall be installed on both sides of the
wall, interconnected so that the operation of any single device will permit the door to close. Heat
detectors or fusible links shall be installed at the door opening and at the ceiling in conformance with
NFiPA 80 listed in the Schedule for the particular type of door to be installed. Swinging fire doors, where
the ceiling is less than 90cm above each side of the opening, are permitted to be actuated by a single link
incorporated in the hold-open arm of an approved automatic door closer. Doors opening in a means of
egress shall be closed by an approved door closer or shall be closed by actuation of a smoke detector
located in conformance with NFiPA 80 listed in the Schedule.
12.3.12.1 General: Fire separation walls for subdividing purposes shall be constructed of the types of
materials and shall have the minimum fire-resistance rating as prescribed by Table 6.1 for the type of
construction, except as provided in Section 12.2.12.4.
12.3.12.2 Mixed uses: When a building contains more than one occupancy, and each part of the building
is separately classified as to use, the mixed uses shall be completely separated with fire separation walls
as specified in Section 5.2.1.1.
12.3.12.3 Multiple single-family dwellings: Single-family dwelling units (Use Group H-3) located
above or adjacent to other single-family dwelling units (Use Group H-3) shall be considered as one
building classified as Use Group H-3 for the purpose of determining the applicable provisions of this
Code, provided each dwelling unit is completely separated from the adjacent dwelling unit(s) by fire
separation wall(s) and floor/ceiling assemblies of not less than 1-hour fire-resistance rated construction
and each unit has independent means of egress.
12.3.12.4 Exits: Fire separation walls required for the enclosure of exits and areas of refuge shall be
constructed of masonry, reinforced concrete or any other approved non-combustible materials having the
minimum fire-resistance rating prescribed by Table 6.1. Such walls, where permitted to be of combustible
materials by Section 12.2.17, shall comply with Section 12.2.12.4.1.
12.3.12.5 Combustible stair enclosures: Where permitted by Section 7.17.21, combustible stair
enclosures shall be constructed of approved combustible assemblies protected with component materials
to afford the required fire-resistance ratings, shall be continuous through combustible floor construction;
and shall provide an unbroken fire barrier in combination with protected floors, ceiling and fire doors,
separating the exits from the unprotected areas of the building. Such enclosures shall be firestopped to
comply with Section 12.2.23.
12.3.12.6 Openings for lighting: Openings for the purpose of providing light in combustible stair
enclosures are permitted to be protected with wired glass with single panes not more than 0.23m2 in area
and a total area in one storey of not more than 0.46m2. Such light panels shall comply with the provisions
of Section 12.2.21, and shall be contained in stationary sash and frames of steel or other approved
non-combustible material.
[Page 404]
12.3.12.7 Openings: Exit doors located in fire separation walls shall be limited to a maximum aggregate
width of 25 percent of the length of the wall and the maximum area of any single opening shall not
exceed 4.46m2.
12.3.12.8 Protectives: All opening protectives in fire separation walls shall comply with the provisions
of Section 12.2.4 and shall have the minimum fire-resistance rating as set forth in Section 12.2.18.
12.3.12.9 Continuity: All fire separation walls shall extend from the top of the fire-resistance rated
floor/ceiling assembly below to the fire-resistance rated floor/ceiling assembly above, unless otherwise
provided for in this code, and shall be securely attached thereto. Where these walls enclosed required
exits, areas of refuge and shafts, or where these walls separate mixed uses, they shall be continuous
through all concealed spaces such as the space above a suspended ceiling, and they shall be constructed
tight to the underside of the floor slab or roof deck above. The supporting construction shall be protected
to afford the required fire-resistance rating of the wall supported except for exit access corridor walls in
buildings of Types 2C, 3B and 5B construction. All hollow vertical spaces shall be fire-stopped at every
floor level as required in Section 12.2.23.
12.3.12.10 Exterior walls: Where exterior walls serve as a part of a required fire-resistance rated
resistance rated enclosure requirements shall not apply.
12.3.13.1 Where required: Smoke barriers shall be provided as required in Section 8.11.6 for buildings
of Use Group F-2 and Section 8.12.8 for buildings of Use Group F-3.
12.3.13.2 Construction: Smoke barriers shall have a fire-resistance rating of not less than 1 hour. Such
barriers shall form an effective membrane continuous from outside wall to outside wall and from floor
slab to floor or roof deck above, including continuity through all concealed spaces, such as those found
above suspended ceilings, and including interstitial structural and mechanical spaces. Transfer grilles,
whether equipped with fusible link-operated dampers or not, shall not be used in these partitions. The
supporting construction shall be protected to afford the required fire-resistance rating of the wall
supported in buildings of other than Types 2C, 3B and 5B construction.
12.3.13.3 Exceptions
1. Smoke barriers are not required in interstitial spaces when such spaces are designed and
constructed with ceilings that provide resistance to the passage of fire and smoke equivalent to
that provided by smoke barriers.
2. Smoke barriers in buildings of Use Group F-3 are permitted to be constructed of nominal
2.5mm thick steel plate.
12.3.13.4 Doors: Doorways separating corridors in adjoining smoke compartments shall be equipped
with a pair of swinging type doors, each swinging in a direction opposite from the other, and the
minimum clear width of each door shall be 1.1m for corridors used for the movement of beds and 80cm
for other corridors. Other doors in smoke barriers shall be of the swinging type of required width.
12.3.13.5 Exception: Horizontal sliding doors complying with Section 8.12 are permitted to be used in
smoke barriers in buildings of Use Group F-3.
[Page 405]
12.3.13.6 Opening protectives: Doors in smoke barriers shall have a fire-resistance rating of not less
than 20 minutes when tested in accordance with ASTM E152 listed in the Schedule, without the hose
stream and labelled by an approved agency. Double egress corridor doors shall have vision panels of
6mm thick labelled wired glass mounted in approved steel frames. Vision panels provided in other doors
in smoke barriers shall be 6mm thick labelled wired glass mounted in approved steel frames. The glass
area of the vision panels shall be limited to 0.84m2 for each door. The doors shall close the openings with
only the clearance necessary for proper operation under self-closing or automatic closing and shall be
without undercuts, louvres or grilles. Rabbets or astragals are required at the meeting edges of double
egress doors, and stops are required on the head and jambs of all doors in smoke barriers. Positive
latching devices are required on double egress corridor doors.
12.3.13.7 Exceptions
1. Protection at the meeting edges of doors and stops at the head and sides of door frames shall not
be required in buildings equipped throughout with an approved engineered smoke control
system. The engineered smoke control system shall respond automatically, preventing the
transfer of smoke across the barrier.
2. In buildings of Use Group F-2 positive latching devices are not required on double egress doors,
and center mullions are prohibited.
12.3.13.8 Door closers: Doors in smoke barriers shall be self-closing or shall be provided with approved
door hold-open devices of the fail-safe type which shall release the doors, causing them to close upon the
actuation of smoke detectors as well as upon the application of a maximum manual pull of 244N against
the hold-open device.
12.3.13.9 Smoke damper: An approved damper designed to resist the passage of smoke shall be
provided at each point a duct penetrates a smoke barrier. The damper shall close upon detection of smoke
by an approved smoke detector located within the duct.
12.3.13.10 Exceptions
1. In lieu of an approved smoke detector located within the duct, ducts which penetrate smoke
barriers above smoke barrier doors required by Section 12.2.13.6 shall have the approved
damper arranged to close upon detection of smoke by the local device designed to detect smoke
on either side of the smoke barrier opening.
2. Dampers are not required in buildings equipped throughout with an approved engineered smoke
control system.
3. Dampers are not required where the openings in ducts are limited to a single smoke
compartment and the ducts are of steel construction.
12.3.14.1 Requirements: The fire-resistance rating of structural members and assemblies shall comply
with the requirements for the type of construction and not less than the rating required for the
fire-resistance rated assemblies supported, except as provided in Section 12.2.12.9 for support of exit
access corridor walls and in Section 12.2.12.9 for support of smoke barriers.
[Page 406]
12.3.14.2 Protection of structural members: Columns, girders trusses, beams, lintels, or other
structural members that are required to have a fire-resistance rating and that support more than two floors
or one floor and roof, or support a bearing wall or a non-bearing wall more than two storeys high, shall be
individually protected on all sides for their length or height with materials having the required
fire-resistance rating. All other structural members required to have a fire-resistance rating shall be
protected by individual encasement, by a membrane or ceiling protection as specified in Section 12.2.15,
or by a combination of both.
12.3.14.3 Embedments and enclosures: Pipes, wires conduits, ducts or other service facilities shall not
be embedded in the required fire protective covering of a structural member that is required to be
individually encased.
12.3.14.4 Impact protection: Where the fire protective covering of a structural member is subject to
impact damage from moving vehicles, the handling of merchandise, or other activity, the fire protective
covering shall be protected by corner guards or by a substantial jacket of metal or other non-combustible
material to a height adequate to provide full protection, but not less than 1.5m from the finished floor.
12.3.14.5 Exterior structural members: Structural members located in exterior walls or along the outer
lines of a building or structure shall be protected as required by Table 6.1 for exterior bearing walls for
the type of construction involved and shall be protected against corrosion by an approved method
complying with (see section on steel). The interior faces of exterior structural members shall be protected
with covering of not less than the required fire-resistance rating specified for interior structural members
in Table 6.1. Where a fire-resistance rating is required in Table 6.1 for exterior bearing walls in buildings
of Type 2C, 3B and 5B construction, the interior faces of any exterior structural member of such
buildings shall be protected to provide a fire-resistance rating not less than that required for exterior
bearing walls.
12.3.14.6 Bottom flange protection: Fire protection is not required for the bottom flange of lintels, shelf
angles and plates not a part of the structural frame or with a span of 1.8m or less.
12.3.14.7 Stone lintels: The use of stone lintels on spans exceeding 1.2m shall not be permitted, unless
supplemented by fire-resistance rated structural members or masonry arches of the required strength to
support the superimposed loads.
12.3.16.1 General: Roofs shall be constructed of materials or assemblies of materials designed to afford
the fire-resistance rating required by Table 6.1 as herein modified.
12.3.16.2 Stadia: The roof construction, including beams, trusses, framing, arches and roof decks,
enclosing stadia of Type 1 or Type 2 construction shall be of non-combustible materials without a
specified fire-resistance rating or of Type 4 construction.
12.3.16.3 Roofs 6m or higher: Where every part of the structural framework of roofs in buildings of
Type 1 or Type 2 construction is 6m or more above the floor immediately below, omission of all fire
protection of the structural members is permitted, including the protection of trusses, roof framing and
decking.
12.3.16.4 Roofslabs, arches and decking: Where the omission of fire protection from roof trusses, roof
framing and decking is permitted, roofs in buildings of Type 1 and Type 2 construction shall be
constructed of non-combustible materials without a specified fire-resistance rating, or of Type 4
construction in building not over five stories 19.5m in height.
12.3.16.5 Firestopping: Firestopping of ceiling and attic spaces shall be provided as required by Section
12.2.23.
Post-Construction Stage / Section 12 Post-Construction Requirements / 12.3 FIRE
RESISTIVE CONSTRUCTION / 12.3.17 Vertical/Shafts
12.3.17 Vertical/Shafts
12.3.17.1 General: The provisions of this Section shall apply to all vertical shaft enclosures, except as
provided for stairway enclosures in Sections 10.17.21 and 29.12, refuse chutes in (Section 9.1.8.7 –
Waste and Linen), and elevator and dumbwaiter hoist ways in Section 9.1.8.10.
12.3.17.2 Open shaft enclosures: The enclosing walls of shafts that are open to the outer air at the top
shall be constructed of materials specified in (see section on Materials, ext. walls) for exterior walls of
buildings and structures of the required fire-resistance rating specified in Table 6.1.
12.3.17.3 Covered shaft enclosures: The enclosing walls of interior covered shafts shall be constructed
of approved materials with the fire-resistance rating specified in Table 6.1. The tops of covered shafts
shall comply with Section 12.2.17.7.
12.3.17.4 Exception
1. Shafts in buildings of Use Group H-3 and serving a single dwelling unit are not required to be
enclosed.
2. The minimum required fire-resistance rating for shaft enclosures connecting three floor levels or
less shall be 1 hour.
[Page 408]
12.3.17.5 Duct and pipe shafts: In all buildings other than buildings of Use Group H-3, vertical pipes
arranged in groups of two or more which penetrate two or more floors and occupy an area of more than
0.093m2, and vertical ducts which penetrate two or more floors, shall be enclosed by construction having
the fire-resistance rating specified in Table 6.1. All combustible pipes and ducts connecting two or more
stories shall be enclosed as indicated herein.
12.3.17.6 Shaft alternative: Where a shaft is required by Section 12.2.17.5, a shaft shall not be required
where a pipe penetrate protection system tested according to ASTM E814 listed in the Schedule, is
provided and has an F-rating and T-rating of 1 hour but not less than the required fire-resistance rating of
the assembly being penetrated. The test shall be conducted with a minimum positive pressure differential
of 7.5p (0.03 inches of water column).
12.3.17.7 Top enclosure: A shaft that does not extend to the underside of the roof deck of the building
shall be enclosed with top construction of the same strength and fire-resistance rating as the floors of the
building or structure in which it occurs, but not less than that of the fire-resistance rating of the shaft
enclosure.
Bottom enclosure: All shafts that do not extend to the bottom of the building or structure shall be
enclosed at the lowest level with construction of the same strength and fire-resistance rating as the lowest
floor through which it passes, but not with a fire-resistance rating less than that of the shaft enclosure.
12.3.17.8 Shaft openings: Openings other than those necessary for the purpose of the shaftway shall not
be constructed in shaft enclosures. All openings shall be protected with approved fire doors, fire windows
or fire dampers complying with the provisions of Section 12.2.9, 12.2.18, 12.2.19 and 12.2.20.
12.3.17.9 Shaft wall penetrations: Non-combustible pipe, tube and conduit penetrating a shaft wall
shall have approved firestopping installed around the penetrating pipe, tube and conduit. Such
firestopping shall be capable of maintaining the integrity of the shaft wall when subjected to the test
temperatures prescribed in ASTM E119 listed in the Schedule for the duration of time equal to the rating
of the assembly to be penetrated and then subjected to the hose stream test as prescribed in ASTM E119
listed in the Schedule. Each penetration of a shaft wall by a combustible pipe, tube, or concuit shall be
protected according ASTM E119 listed in the Schedule. The through-penetrating firestop system tested
according to ASTM E814 shall have an F-rating and T-rating not less than the required fire-resistance
rating of the shaft wall penetrated. The system tested according to ASTM E119 shall have a
fire-resistance rating not less than the required fire-resistance rating of the shaft wall penetrated. The
ASTM E814 test shall be conducted with a minimum positive pressure differential of 7.5 P (0.03 inches
water column).
12.3.18.1 Fire door assemblies: Approved fire door assemblies as defined in this Code shall be
constructed of any material or any material or an assembly of component materials which meets the test
requirements of ASTM E152 listed in the Schedule and the fire-resistance rating herein required in Table
12.2.18, unless otherwise specifically provided for in this Code.
[Page 409]
12.3.18.2 Twenty-minute doors: One-third hour (20-minute) fire doors shall be tested in accordance
with ASTM E152 listed in the Schedule without the hose stream test.
12.3.18.3 Labelled protective assemblies: All fire door assemblies shall be labelled by an approved
agency. Labelled protective assemblies meeting the requirements of this section or UL 10A, 14B and 14C
for tin-clad fire door assemblies, and NFiPA 80 listed in the Schedule, shall be approved for use as
provided for in this Code.
12.3.18.4 Labelled requirements: Fire doors shall have a label or other identification showing the name
of the manufacturer, the fire-resistance rating and, where required for stairway fire doors by Section
7.17.17, the maximum transmitted temperature end point. Such label shall be approved and shall be
permanently affixed. The label shall be applied at the factory where fabrication and assembly are done.
Inspection shall be made by an approved agency.
12.3.18.5 Oversize doors: Approval of doors which cannot be labelled because of size shall be based on
a certificate of inspection furnished by an approved testing agency for such oversized doors. The
certificate shall state that the door conforms to the requirements of design, materials and construction, but
has not been subjected to the fire test.
12.3.18.6 Multiple doors in fire walls: Two doors, each with a fire-resistance rating of
1½-hours, installed on opposite sides of the same opening in a fire wall, shall be deemed equivalent in
fire-resistance rating to one 3-hour fire door.
12.3.18.7 Glass panels: Wired glass panels shall be permitted in fire doors within the limitations of
Section 12.2.21 and as herein specifically prescribed.
12.3.18.8 Closing devices: Except as otherwise provided for openings in fire wall and fire separation
walls, all fire doors shall be self-closing and shall be closed during occupancy of the building or part
thereof. The use of rate-of-rise heat-actuated devices, fusible links, or smoke detection devices on doors
that are normally required to be open for ventilation or other specified purpose shall be permitted when
the safety of the occupants is not endangered thereby.
12.3.18.9 Smoke-actuated closing devices: Where fire doors open onto an exit access, exit or horizontal
exit and are not self-closing, door closers shall be smoke-actuated.
12.3.18.10 Closing time: Doors which are automatic-closing by smoke detection or by rate-of-rise
detection, or self-closing, shall not have a delay in closing or reclosing of more than 10 seconds.
TABLE 12.11
FIRE DOOR FIRE-RESISTANCE RATINGS
[Page 410]
12.3.19.1 Fire-resistance rating: Approved assemblies of fire windows and fire shutters shall meet the
test requirements of ASTM E163 listed in the Schedule. Fire windows shall be in the fixed closed
position or be automatic-closing.
12.3.19.2 Exception: Steel window frame assemblies of 3mm minimum solid section or of not less than
nominal 1.2mm thick formed shaft steel members fabricated by pressing, miltering, riveting, interlocking
or welding and having provision for glazing with 6mm wired glass as required in Section 12.2.21 when
securely installed in the building construction and glazed with 6mm labeled wired glass, shall be deemed
to meet the requirements for a 3/4-hour fire window assembly.
12.3.19.3 Window mullions: All metal mullions which exceed a nominal height of 3.6m shall be
protected with materials to afford the same fire-resistance rating as required for the wall construction in
which the protective is located.
12.3.19.4 Swinging fire shutters: When fire shutters of the swinging type are used in exterior openings,
not less than one row in every three vertical rows shall be arranged to be readily opened from the outside,
and shall be identified by distinguished marks or letters not less than 15cm high.
12.3.19.5 Rolling fire shutters: When fire shutters of the rolling type are used, they shall be of approved
counterbalanced construction that can be readily opened from the outside.
12.3.20.1 Approval: Fire dampers shall comply with UL 555 listed in the Schedule and shall bear the
label of an approved agency. Fire dampers shall be installed in accordance with the manufacturer's
installation instructions. Fire dampers shall be capable of maintaining the integrity of the required
fire-resistance rating.
12.3.20.2 Where required: Fire dampers shall be provided at locations where air distribution systems
penetrate assemblies required to have a fire-resistance rating.
12.3.20.3 Exceptions: Fire dampers are not required:
1. Where proper fire tests have shown that fire dampers are not necessary to maintain the integrity
of the fire-resistance rated assembly.
2. Where an exhaust duct penetrates a fire-resistance rated shaft wall and the sub duct extends not
less than 55cm vertically upward.
3. At penetrations of tenant separation and corridor walls in buildings equipped throughout with an
approved automatic fire suppression system.
[Page 411]
4. Where the ducts are constructed of steel and are part of an engineered smoke removal system.
5. At penetrations of corridor walls when the ducts are constructed of steel and do not have
openings which communicate the corridor with adjacent spaces or rooms.
6. At penetrations of a roof assembly when ducts are open to the atmosphere.
7. In hazardous exhaust systems as defined in the mechanical code listed in the Schedule.
8. Where ceiling dampers are installed in accordance with Section 12.2.15.1.
12.3.20.4 Accessibility: Fire dampers shall be accessible
TABLE 12.12
LIMITING SIZE OF WIRED GLASS PANELS
3-hour 0 0 0
11/2-hour doors in exterior walls 0 0 0
12.3.21.2 Fire walls: Wired glass in fire doors located in fire walls shall be prohibited except that where
serving as a horizontal exit, a self-closing swinging door shall be permitted to have a vision panel of not
more than 0.065m2 without a dimension exceeding 25cm.
12.3.21.3 Fire separation walls: Wired glass vision panels shall not be used in fire doors of 11/2-hour
fire-resistance rating intended for use in fire separation walls, unless the glass panels are not more than
0.065m2 in area.
12.3.21.4 Exit and elevator protectives: Unless specifically required by Section 7.2 to be solid in such
locations where unusually hazardous conditions prevail, approved wired glass vision panels used in fire
doors in elevator and stairway shaft enclosures shall be so located as to furnish clear vision of the
passageway or approach to the elevator or stairway and shall not exceed the size limitations specified in
Table 12.3.21.
12.3.21.5 Fire separation walls: One-quarter inch wired glass panels shall not be used in fire separation
walls used for subdividing purposes as set forth in Section 12.2.12 when the required fire-resistance rating
of the wall exceeds 1 hour. The maximum size of such panels shall not exceed the limitations for 3/4-hour
door.
[Page 412]
12.3.22.1 Thickness of plaster: The required thickness of fire-resistance rated plaster protection shall be
determined by the prescribed fire tests for the specified use and type of construction and in accordance
with the provision of (refer section on gypsum and plaster) for interior plastering and (refer section on
gypsum and plaster) for exterior plastering. The thickness in all cases shall be measured from the face of
the lath when applied to gypsum lath or metal lath.
12.3.22.2 Plaster equivalents: For fire-resistive purposes, 13mm or unsanded gypsum plaster shall be
deemed equivalent to 19mm or one-to-three sanded gypsum or 25mm portland non-combustible
plastering base and furring.
12.3.22.3 Double reinforcement: Except in solid plaster partitions, or when otherwise determined by the
prescribed fire tests, plaster protection more than 25mm in thickness shall be reinforced with an additional
layer of approved lath embedded at least 19mm from the outer surface and fixed securely in place.
12.3.22.4 Plaster alternates for concrete: In reinforced concrete construction, gypsum or portland
cement plaster is permitted to be substituted for 13mm of the required poured concrete protection, except
that a minimum thickness of 10mm of poured concrete shall be provided in all reinforced concrete floors
and 25mm in reinforced concrete columns in addition to the plaster finish. The concrete base shall be
prepared in accordance with (refer section on gypsum and plaster).
12.3.23.1 General: To prevent the free passage of flame and products of combustion through concealed
spaces or openings in the event of fire, provisions shall be made to provide effective firestops as herein
specified.
12.3.23.2 Firestopping materials: All firestopping shall consist of approved non-combustible materials
or of materials of two thickness of 25mm lumber with broken lap-joint, or one thickness of 18.3mm
plywood with joints backed by 18.3mm plywood, or of 50mm lumber installed with tight joints, shall be
used in open spaces of wood framing.
12.3.23.3 Draftstopping materials: Draftstopping materials shall be not less than 13mm gypsum board,
19mm plywood or other approved materials adequately supported.
12.3.23.4 Integrity: The integrity of all firestopping and draftstopping shall be continuously maintained.
12.3.23.5 Required inspection: Firestopping and draftstopping shall not be concealed from view until
inspected and approved.
12.3.23.6 Fire-stopping required: Fire-stopping shall be provided in the locations specified in Section
12.3.23.7 through to 12.3.23.13.
12.3.23.7 Concealed wall spaces: In concealed spaces of stud walls and partitions, including furred or
studded-off spaces of masonry or concrete walls, at the ceiling and floor or roof levels.
12.3.23.8 Connections between horizontal and vertical spaces: At all interconnections between
vertical and horizontal spaces such occur at soffits over cabinets, drop ceilings, foyer ceiling and similar
locations.
[Page 413]
12.3.23.9 Stairs: In concealed spaces between stair stringers at the top and bottom of the run.
12.3.23.10 Ceiling and floor openings: At openings around vents, pipes, ducts, chimneys and fireplaces
at ceiling and floor levels, with noncombustible materials.
12.3.23.11 Architectural trim: In exterior cornices and other exterior architectural elements here
permitted of combustible construction in Section 12.3.28 or when erected with combustible frames, at
maximum intervals of 6m if non-continuous, they shall have closed ends, with at least 10cm of separation
between sections.
12.3.23.12 Combustible finish and trim: In the space behind combustible trim and finish where
permitted under this code and all other hollow spaces where permitted in fire-resistance rated construction
at 3m intervals; or the space shall be solidly filled with noncombustible materials.
12.3.23.13 Concealed sleeper spaces: In concealed spaces formed by floor sleepers in areas of not more
than 9.30m2; or the space shall be solidly filled with non-combustible materials.
12.3.23.14 Draftstopping required: Draft stopping shall be provided in Types 3, 4 and 5 construction in
the locations specified by Sections 12.3.23.15 and 12.3.23.20.
12.3.23.15 Floors: Where ceilings are suspended below solid wood joists or suspended or attached
directly to the bottom of open web wood floor trusses, the space between the ceiling and the floor above
shall be divided by providing draft stopping as specified in Section 12.3.23.16 through to 12.3.23.18.
12.3.23.16 Use Groups H-1 and H-2: In buildings of Use Groups H-1 and H-2 draftstopping shall be in
line with the tenant separation walls when the walls do not extend to the floor sheathing above.
12.3.23.17 Use Groups H-3: In buildings of Use Group H-3, the space shall be divided into
approximately equal areas not greater than 46.5m2. The draft stopping shall be provided parallel to the
main framing members.
12.3.23.18 Other use groups: In all other use groups, draft stopping shall be provided so that horizontal
areas do not exceed 93m2.
12.3.23.19 Exception: Where the space above a ceiling is of combustible construction and the building is
sprinklered above and below the ceiling, the draft stopping is not required.
12.3.23.20 Attics and concealed spaces: Attics and concealed roof spaces shall be provided with draft
stopping as specified in Sections 12.3.23.21 and 12.3.23.23.
12.3.23.21 Use Group H: In buildings of Use Group H, in the attic, mansard, overhang or other
concealed roof space, above and in line with the tenant separation walls which do not extend to the roof
sheathing above.
12.3.23.22 Exceptions
1. Where corridor walls provide a tenant separation, draftstopping shall only be required above
one of the corridor walls.
2. Where flat roofs with solid joist construction are used, draftstopping over tenant separation
walls is not required.
[Page 414]
3. Where the space above a ceiling is of combustible construction and the building is sprinklered
above and below the ceiling, the draft stopping is not required.
4. Draft stopping is not required in detached one-and two family dwellings.
12.3.23.23 Other use groups: In attics and concealed roof spaces, draft stopping shall be provided so
that any horizontal area does not exceed 279m2.
12.3.23.24 Exceptions
1. Where flat roofs with solid joist construction are used, draft stopping over tenant separation
walls is not required.
2. Where the space above a ceiling is of combustible construction and the building is sprinklered
above and below the ceiling, the draft stopping is not required.
12.3.23.25 Ventilation: Ventilation of concealed roof spaces shall be maintained in accordance with
Section 9.2.7.
12.3.23.26 Access to attics: A readily-accessible access opening not less than 55cm by 75cm shall be
provided to any attic area having a clear height of over 75cm. When doors or other openings are provided
in the draft stopping, they shall be self-closing and of approved materials specified in this section, and the
construction shall be tightly fitted around all pipes, ducts or other assemblies piercing the draftstopping.
12.3.24.1 General: Interior finish and trim of buildings shall conform to the requirements of this Section.
Interior finish shall include all wainscoting and panelling or other finish applied structurally or for
acoustical treatment, insulation, decoration or similar purposes. The use of a surface finish of paper or of
material of not greater fire hazard than paper shall not be prohibited provided such finish does not exceed
1mm in thickness and is applied directly to a non-combustible base or substrate meeting the requirements
of Section 12.3.5.2. Show windows in the first storey of buildings are permitted to be of wood or
unprotected metal framing.
12.3.24.2 Exposed construction: These requirements shall not be considered as requiring the installation
of interior finish, but where construction or fire protection materials are exposed in rooms or spaces used
for the occupancies specified in Section 12.3.24.6, the hazard from rate of flame spread of such exposed
materials shall not be greater than that of the interior finish permitted for such occupancy or use. Exposed
portions of structural members complying with the requirements for Type-4 construction in Section 6.2.5
and Section 10.22 shall not be subject to interior finish regulation.
12.3.24.3 Smoke or gases: Interior finish materials shall not be permitted that have a smoke developed
rating greater than 450 when tested in accordance with ASTM E84 listed in the Schedule. When
restrictions are not otherwise established in this Code, interior finish is not controlled, except that
pyroxylin or similar finishes shall not be applied which, as dry films, produce excessive smoke or toxic
fumes when exposed to fire.
12.3.24.4 Materials: Materials shall only be used for interior finish and trim as specifically provided in
this Code for the occupancy or use of the space in which it is installed. Use of any material for floor
finish, interior finish, and trim in a building of Type 1 or 2 construction within the scope permitted in this
Section or Section 12.2.26 shall not declassify the building with respect to its type of construction.
[Page 415]
12.3.24.5 Foam plastics: Foam plastics shall not be used as interior trim or finish except in compliance
with this section and (refer Section on Materials and Plastics).
12.3.24.6 Interior finish: Interior finish of walls and ceilings shall have a flame spread rating not greater
than that designated by the class prescribed for the various use groups listed in Table 12.3.2, when tested
in accordance with the requirements of Section 12.3.6.2.
12.3.24.7 Basements: In buildings or structures other than Use Group H-3, Class I or II interior finish
shall be used in all basements or other underground spaces from which there is not direct exit to the
outside of the building, if subject to occupancy for any purpose other than storage or service facilities.
12.3.24.8 Maximum flame spread: Interior finish materials with flame spread classifications greater
than 200 shall not be used in any room or space subject to human occupancy, except to such extent as
specifically approved on the basis of a finding that such use does not significantly increase the life hazard.
12.3.24.9 Flame spread classifications: The classifications of interior finishes referred to herein
correspond to flame spread ratings determined by ASTM E84 listed in the Schedule as follows: Class I
flame spread, 0-25; Class II flame spread, 26-75; Class III flame spread, 76-200.
12.3.24.10 Rooms and enclosed spaces: Requirements for rooms or enclosed spaces are based upon
spaces enclosed in partitions of the building or structure, and where fire-resistance rating is required for
the structural elements, the enclosing partitions shall extend from the floor to the ceiling. Partitions which
do not comply with this shall be considered as enclosed spaces and the rooms or spaces on both sides
thereof shall be counted as one. In determining the applicable requirements for rooms or enclosed spaces,
the specific use or occupancy thereof shall be the governing factor, regardless of the use group
classification of the building or structure. Where an approved automatic fire suppression system is
provided, interior finish of Class II or Class III materials is permitted to be used in place of Class I or
Class II materials respectively, where required in Table 12.3.24.6.
12.3.24.11 Interior trim: Baseboards, chair rails, mouldings, trim around openings and other interior
trim, not in excess of 10 percent of the aggregate wall and ceiling areas of any room or space, shall be of
Class I, II or Class III materials, except that trim around fire windows and fire doors shall comply with
the requirements of Section 12.2.28.
12.3.24.12 Interior floor finish: Finished floors or floor covering materials of a traditional type, such as
wood, vinyl, linoleum, terrazzo and other resilient floor covering materials are exempted from the
requirements of this section. Floor coverings judged by the Code Enforcement Officer to represent an
unusual hazard shall meet the classification prescribed for the various use groups listed in Table
12.2.24.12 when tested in accordance with the requirements of Section 12.2.6.2.
12.3.24.13 Suppression system exception: Where an approved automatic fire suppression system is
provided, Class II materials are permitted in any area where Class I materials are required and material
complying with the DOCFF-1 “pill test” listed in the Schedule are permitted in any area where Class II
materials are required.
[Page 416]
TABLE 12.13
INTERIOR FINISH REQUIREMENTS
Note a: For requirements applicable to rooms and enclosed spaces, see Section 12.3.24.15.
Note b: Class III interior finish materials are permitted in places of assembly with a capacity of 300
persons or less.
Note c: Class III interior finish materials are permitted for wainscoting or paneling for not more than
93m2 of applied surface area in the grade lobby when applied directly to non-combustible base
or over furring strips applied to a non-combustible base and firestopped as required by Section
12.3.25.
Note d: Class III interior finish materials are permitted in mercantile occupancies of 279m2 or less gross
area used for sales purposes on the street floor only (balcony permitted).
Note e: Lobby areas shall be not less than Class II.
Note f: Where building height is over two stories, Class II shall be required.
Note g: For the classifications of interior finishes referred to herein, see Section 12.3.24.9. For interior
finish requirements for exposed insulation, see Section 12.3.30.2.
[Page 417]
Note h: Walls and ceilings shall be a minimum of Class II materials in individual rooms of not over
four persons capacity. Where a complete approved automatic fire suppression system is
provided, the minimum requirement for interior finish shall be Class II.
TABLE 12.14
INTERIOR FLOOR FINISH REQUIREMENTS
Note a: For requirements for rooms and enclosed spaces, see Section 12.3.24.15.
Note b: For requirements for use of other than carpet materials, see Section 12.3.24.16.
Note c: For classifications of floor finishes required herein, see Section 12.3.24.17.
[Page 418]
12.3.24.14 Test report: All carpet required by this Section to meet critical radiant flux limits in
accordance with Section 12.2.6.2 shall be tested by an approved agency. A copy of the test report
identifying and representing the style to be installed shall be provided to the code enforcement officer
upon request. The test report shall identify the carpet by manufacturer (or supplier) and style name, and
shall be representative of the current construction of the carpet. The carpet shall be identified as to
manufacturer (or supplier) and style by a hang tag or other suitable method, which shall indicate the
classification of the material based upon the limits specified in Section 12.3.6.2.
12.3.24.15 Rooms and enclosed spaces: Requirements for rooms or enclosed spaces are based upon the
spaces being enclosed with partitions extending from the floor to the ceiling. Where partitions do not
satisfy this criteria, the room or space is considered part of the corridor.
12.3.24.16 Other materials: All carpet manufactured for sale in Nigeria is required by Federal
regulations to pass tests as prescribed by the SON. If a material other than carpet is used, the material
shall be shown to be at least as resistant to flame propagation as a material which passes relevant SON
standards.
12.3.24.17 Classifications: The classifications in Table 12.3.24.12 correspond to that determined by
ASTM E648 listed in the Schedule as follows: Class 1,0.45 Watts/cm2: Class II, 0.22 Watts/cm2.
12.3.25.1 Attachment: Where interior finish is regulated by the requirements of this code, interior finish
materials shall be applied or otherwise fastened in such a manner that they will not readily become
detached when subjected to room temperatures of 93 degrees C or less for 30 minutes, or otherwise
become loose through changes in the setting medium from the effects of time or conditions of occupancy.
12.3.25.2 Application to structural elements: Interior finish materials applied to walls, ceilings or
structural elements of a building or structure which are required to be fire-resistance rated or to be
constructed of non-combustible component materials shall be applied directly against the exposed surface
of concealed spaces created thereby fire stopped where in excess of 3m in any dimension (see Section
12.3.23.12).
12.3.25.3 Furred construction: Where walls, ceilings or other structural elements are required to be
fire-resistance rated or to be constructed of non-combustible component materials and interior finish is set
out or dropped distances greater than 44mm from the surface of such elements, only material of which
both faces quality as Class I shall be used.
12.3.25.4 Exceptions
1. Class II finish materials shall be permitted when protected on both sides by an approved
automatic fire suppression system in which case Class I or II materials shall be used.
2. Class II or III materials shall be permitted when attached to a non-combustible backing
complying with Section 12.3.25.7 or to furring strips applied directly to such backing as
provided in Section 12.3.25.2.
[Page 419]
12.3.25.5 Type 4 construction: Interior finish materials shall be applied directly to the wood members
and decking of Type 4 construction, or to furring strips applied to such members or wood decking as
provided in Section 12.3.25.2.
12.3.25.6 Class II and Class III materials: Interior finish materials, other than Class I materials, which
are less than 6mm in thickness shall be applied directly against a non-combustible backing or a backing
complying with the requirements of Section 29.5.2 unless the tests under which such material has been
classified were made with the materials suspended from the noncombustible backing.
12.3.25.7 Backing material: Backing for interior finish materials shall be a continuous surface with
permanently tight joints, equal in area to the area of the finish, and extending completely behind such
finish in all directions; and shall be of fire-retardant treated wood or any materials meeting the
requirements of this code for non-combustible classification of material under Section 12.3.4.7.
When the backing does not constitute an integral part of the structural elements or system, it shall be
attached directly to the structural elements or furring strips as required for the applicable of finish
according to Section 12.3.25.2, or shall be suspended from the structural members at any distance
provided concealed spaces created thereby shall be fire stopped in accordance with Section 12.2.23.
12.3.26.1 General: Except as provided in Section 7.17 for stairs and Section 8.17, the use of combustible
materials in or on floors of buildings of Types 1 and 2 construction shall be as herein specified.
12.3.26.2 Sleepers, bucks, and grounds: Floor sleepers, bucks, nailing blocks grounds shall not be
constructed of combustible materials, unless the space between the fire-resistance rated floor construction
and the flooring is solidly filled with non-combustible materials or fire stopped in accordance with
Section 12.3.23.13, and provided such open spaces shall not extend underside through permanent
partitions or walls.
12.3.26.3 Flooring: Wood finish flooring is permitted to be attached direct to the embedded or fire
stopped wood sleepers, and shall be permitted and cemented directly to the top surface of approved
fire-resistance rated construction or directly to a wood sub floor attached to sleepers as provided in
Section 12.3.26.2. Combustible insulating boards not more than 13mm thick and covered with approved
finished flooring are permitted for sound deadening or insulating when attached directly to a
non-combustible floor assembly wood sub flooring attached to sleepers as provided in Section 12.3.26.2.
12.3.27.1 General: In buildings of Use Groups A, C, F-2, F-3 and H-1, all current draperies, hangings
and other decorative materials suspended from ceilings shall be non-combustible or maintained flame
resistance meeting requirements of Section 12.3.6 as herein specified.
12.2.27.2 Non-combustible: The permissible amount of non-combustible decorative hangings shall not
be limited.
12.3.27.3 Flame-resistant: The permissible amount of non-combustible decorative hangings shall not
exceed 10 percent of the total wall and ceiling area.
[Page 420]
12.3.28.1 Gutters and leaders: All gutters and leaders hereafter placed on buildings or structures of
other than Type 5 construction, buildings of Use Group H-3 and private garages and similar accessory
buildings shall be constructed of non-combustible materials.
12.3.28.2 Architectural Trim: Architectural trim shall be constructed and insulated in accordance with
Section 12.3.28.3 through to 12.3.28.5.
12.3.28.3 Construction requirements: All architectural trim, such as cornices, veneers and other
exterior architectural elements, which exceeds 12m in height above grade shall be constructed of
approved non-combustible materials and shall be secured to the wall with metal or other approved
non-combustible brackets. Combustible architectural trim, other than fire-retardant treated wood
complying with Section 12.3.5 for exterior use, shall not exceed 10 percent of an exterior wall surface
area where the fire separation distance is 1.5m or less.
12.3.28.4 Location: Where combustible architectural trim is located along the top of exterior walls, it
shall be completely backed up by the exterior wall and shall not extend over or above the top of exterior
walls.
12.3.28.5 Fire stopping: Continuous exterior architectural trim constructed of combustible materials
shall be firestopped as required in Section 12.3.23.
12.3.28.6 Combustible half-timbering: In buildings of Types 3 and 4 constructions that do not exceed
three stories or 12m in height above grade, exterior half-timbering and similar architectural decorations
are permitted to be constructed of wood or other equivalent combustible materials, provided such trim is
backed up solidly with approved non-combustible materials.
12.3.28.7 Balconies and similar appendages: All balconies, porches, decks and supplemental exterior
stairs attached to or supported by buildings of Types 1 and 2 construction shall be constructed of
non-combustible materials. Such appendages attached to or supported by buildings of Types 3, 4 and 5
construction shall be of either noncombustible or combustible construction. Such appendages of
combustible construction, other than fire-retardant treated wood, shall afford the fire-resistance rating
required by Table 6.1 for floor construction or shall be of Type 4 construction as described in Section
6.2.5 and the aggregate length shall not exceed 50 percent of the building perimeter on each floor.
12.3.28.8 Bay and oriel windows: All bay and oriel windows attached to or supported by walls of other
than Type 5 construction shall be of non-combustible construction, framed with brackets of steel,
concrete or other approved non-combustible materials.
Post-Construction Stage / Section 12 Post-Construction Requirements / 12.3 FIRE
RESISTIVE CONSTRUCTION / 12.3.29 Roof Structures
12.3.29.1 General: All construction, other than aerial supports, cloths dryers and similar structures less
than 3.6m high, tanks and cooling towers as hereinafter provided and flog poles erected above the roof of
any part of any building or structure more than 12m in height shall be constructed of non-combustible
materials.
12.3.29.2 Scuttles: Trap doors and scuttles as required by Section 7.17.28 shall be not less than 60cm by
90cm in size. In Types 1 and 2 construction, trap doors and scuttles shall be of approved non-combustible
materials.
[Page 421]
12.3.29.3 Penthouses: Penthouses shall be considered a part of the next lower storey, and the enclosure
shall conform to the requirements for exterior walls of the building type as regulated by Table 6.1 and
(see section on Materials, ext. walls) except as modified herein.
12.3.29.4 Recessed walls: When the exterior wall of a penthouse is recessed 1.5m or more from the
exterior wall of the next lower storey and the exterior wall of the next lower storey is required to have a
fire-resistance rating of greater than 1½ hours, the penthouse exterior wall shall be constructed with a
fire-resistance rating of not less than 1½ hours, covered on the outside with noncombustible,
weatherproof material and supported on protected steel or reinforced concrete construction.
12.3.29.5 Doors, frames, and sash: Doors, frames and window sash, except where otherwise
specifically required to be fire-resistance rated under this Code, shall be constructed the same as other
similar elements in the building or structure.
12.3.29.6 Other enclosed roof structures: Enclosed roof structures, other than penthouses as defined in
Part 2, shall be considered a storey of the building and shall conform to the requirements for the building
type as regulated by Table 6.1 and Part 21.
12.3.29.7 Mansards and other sloping roofs: Mansards and other sloping roofs shall comply with
Sections 12.3.29.8 and 12.3.28.9
12.3.29.8 High slope roofs: Every mansard roof or other sloping roof having a pitch of more than 60
degrees (1.05 rad) to the horizontal hereafter erected on any building or structure of other than Type 5
construction more than three storeys or 12m in height shall be constructed of non-combustible materials
with a fire resistance rating of not less than 1 hour . When the building is more than seven storeys or
25.5m in height, such roof shall afford the same fire-resistance rating required for the exterior walls of the
building, but need not exceed 11/2-hour fire-resistance rating.
12.3.29.9 Low slope roofs: Where the pitch is 60 degrees (1.05 rad) or less to the horizontal, the
mansard or other sloping roof located on any building shall be constructed of not less than the same
materials as required for the roof of the building shall be constructed of not less than the same materials
as required for the roof of the building.
12.3.29.10 Dormers: The sides and roofs of dormers shall be of the same type construction as the main
roof, except that where a side of the dormer is vertical extension of an exterior wall it shall be subject to
the same fire-resistance rating requirements as apply to the wall of the building. The roofs of dormers
shall be protected with approved roof coverings complying with (refer to Section on Roofs and Roof
coverings). The sides of dormers shall be protected with approved roof coverings or with material
permitted for covering the exterior walls of the building.
12.3.29.11 Water tanks: Water tanks shall be constructed and installed in accordance with Section
12.3.29.12 through to 12.3.29.16.
12.3.29.12 Supports: Water tanks having capacity of more than (2,200 litres) placed in or on a building
shall be supported on masonry, reinforced concrete, steel or other approved noncombustible framing or
on timber conforming to Type 4 construction; provided that, when such supports are located in the
building the lowest storey, they shall be fire-resistance rated as required for Type 1A construction.
[Page 422]
12.3.29.13 Emergency discharge: A pipe or outlet shall be located in the bottom or in the side close to
the bottom, or the tank shall be fitted with a quick-opening valve, to enable the contents to be discharged
in an emergency to a suitable drain complying with the plumbing code listed in the Schedule.
12.3.29.14 Location: A tank shall not be located over or near a stairway or elevator shaft unless a solid
roof or floor deck is constructed underneath the tank.
12.3.29.15 Tank cover: All roof tanks exposed to the weather shall have approved covers sloping
towards the outer edges.
12.3.29.16 Hoop and strap protection: When metal hoops are used in the construction of wood tanks,
they shall be protected with approved corrosion-resistive coatings or manufactured from approved
corrosion-resistive alloys.
12.3.29.17 Cooling towers: Cooling towers erected on the roofs of buildings when the base of the tower
is more than 16.5m above grade shall be constructed of noncombustible materials or of fire-retardant
treated wood.
12.3.29.18 Miscellaneous roof structures: Except as herein specifically provided, all towers, spires,
dormers or cupolas shall be erected of the type of construction and fire-resistance rating required for the
building to which they are accessory as regulated by Table 6.1 and 501. When the height of such
appurtenant structures exceeds 25.5m above grade or when the area at any horizontal section of the tower,
spire, dormer or cupola exceeds 18.6m2, or when it is used for any purpose other than as a belfry or
architectural embellishment, the structure and its supports shall be of Type 1 or 2 construction, or of
fire-retardant treated wood complying with Section 12.2.5. Radio and television towers and antennae
shall be constructed to comply with Section 8.25 and 8.26.
12.3.30.1 General: Insulating batts, blankets, fills or similar types of materials other than fibreboard
insulation, including vapour barriers and breather papers or other coverings, incorporated in construction
elements shall be installed as required by this Section. Fibre board insulation shall be installed as required
by (see section on Materials Fibreboards).
12.3.30.2 Exposed installations: Such materials, when exposed as installed in rooms or spaces,
including attics and crawl spaces of buildings or any type construction, shall have a flame spread rating of
25 or less and a smoke developed rating of 450 or less when tested in accordance with ASTM E84 listed
in the Schedule. Plenum installations shall comply with the requirements of Section 12.2.31 and the
Mechanical Code listed in the Schedule.
12.3.30.3 Concealed installations: Insulating materials, when concealed as installed in buildings of any
type construction, shall have a flame spread rating of 75 or less and a smoke developed rating of 450 or
less when tested in accordance with ASTM E84 listed in the Schedule.
12.3.30.4 Facings: Where such materials are installed in concealed spaces such as wall, floor or ceiling
cavities, attics or crawl spaces in buildings of Types 3, 4 and 5 construction, the flame spread and smoke
developed rating limitations do not apply to facings, provided that the facing is installed behind and in
substantial contact with the unexposed surface of the ceiling, floor or wall finish.
[Page 423]
12.3.30.5 Cellulosic insulation: Cellulosic insulation shall meet the requirements of CPSC Standard 16
CFR, Parts 1209 and 1404, listed in the Schedule.
12.3.31 Plenums
12.3.31.1 General: Supply and return air plenums shall be limited to uninhabited crawl spaces, areas
above a ceiling or below the floor, or attic spaces, Plenums shall be limited to one fire area. Fuel-fired
equipment shall not be installed within a plenum. Plenums shall be classified as non-combustible plenums
(Section 12.3.31.2), as combustible plenums (12.3.21.8) or as stud and joist space plenums (Section
12.3.31.11).
12.3.31.2 Non-combustible plenums: Plenums shall be constructed with non-combustible material.
Combustible material shall not be exposed within a plenum except as permitted in Section 12.3.31.3
through to 12.3.31.7.
12.3.31.3 Pipe: Pipe shall be non-combustible and, where insulated, the insulation shall have a flame
spread of 25 or less and smoke developed rating of 50 or less when tested in accordance with ASTM E84
listed in the Schedule.
12.3.31.4 Ceiling and thermal material: Thermal and acoustical materials shall have a flame spread of
25 or less and a smoke developed rating of 50 or less when tested in accordance with ASTM E84 listed in
the Schedule.
12.3.31.5 Ducts: Rigid or flexible ducts and connectors shall conform to the Mechanical Code listed in
the Schedule.
12.3.31.6 Duct coverings: Duct coverings, linings, tape and connectors shall conform to the Mechanical
Code listed in the Schedule.
12.3.31.7 Wire: Wire shall be low voltage or power-limited wire or cable. Wire shall have a peak optical
density not greater than 0.50, an average optical density not greater than 0.15 and a flame spread of not
greater than 1.5m when tested in accordance with UL 910 listed in the Schedule.
12.3.31.8 Combustible plenums: In Types 3, 4 and 5 construction, the plenum shall be constructed with
approved material. Combustible material, pipe or wire exposed within the plenum shall be permitted.
12.3.31.9 Size: Combustible plenums shall be draftstopped every 279m2 in area.
12.3.31.10 Exception: Plenums shall be limited to one fire area without draftstopping in buildings
equipped throughout with an approved automatic fire suppression system.
12.3.31.11 Stud and joist spaces: The space between studs or joists shall not be used as a plenum for
supply air. The space between studs or joists used as a plenum for return air shall not be part of a required
fire-resistance rated assembly. Air shall be removed from one floor level only. All connections shall be
fire-stopped and draft stopped.
12.3.32.2 Vent size and spacing: The vent area and the spacing of the vents shall comply with Table
12.3.32.
12.3.32.3 Releasing devices: Smoke and heat vents shall open automatically by activation of a
heat-responsive device rated 38 degrees C to 104 degrees C above ambient. The releasing mechanism
shall be capable of operation such that the vent shall fully open when the vent is exposed to a
time-temperature gradient that reaches an air [Page 424] temperature of 260 degrees C within 5 minutes.
Vents shall be capable of being opened by an approved manual operation.
12.3.32.4 Curtain boards construction: Curtain boards shall be provided to subdivide a vented
building. Curtain boards shall be constructed of material that will resist the passage of smoke and is
consistent with the building type of construction. Curtain board location and depth shall comply with
Table 12.3.32. The bottom of the curtain board shall be level.
Part III
Enforcement
Section 13
Control of Building Works
Sections
13.1 Establishment of Control of Building Works
13.2 Scope
13.2.1 Pre-Design Stage
13.2.2 Design Stage
13.2.3 Construction Stage
13.2.4 Post-Construction Stage
13.3 Violations and Sanctions
13.4 Board of Petition
13.5 Unsafe Buildings, Structures, Building Services and Equipment
13.6 Notices
13.7 Inspections
13.8 Special Inspections
13.9 Served Orders and Notification
13.10 Connection to Utilities
13.11 Certificate of Use and Habitation
13.12 Workmanship and Supervision
13.13 Alternative Materials
13.14 Used Materials and Equipment
13.15 Research and Investigations
13.16 Test
13.17 Records
13.18 Existing Structures
13.19 Rehabilitation and Maintenance
13.20 Demolition of Structures
13.21 Temporary Structures
13.22 Listed Buildings
13.23 Exempt Buildings and Works
[Page 429]
13.1.1.1 There shall be established in all Federal, State and Local Government Urban Development
Agencies, a Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit in their Development Control Department.
13.1.1.2 Composition: The Building Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit shall comprise the
following registered professionals: Architects; Engineers; Town Planners; Fire Officers; Land Surveyors;
Builders; Quantity Surveyors; Estate Surveyors and Valuers; Public Health and Safety Officers. Any of
the professionals listed in Section 2.2.4 may head the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit.
13.1.1.3 Powers and duties of Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit
13.1.1.3.1 The Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit shall enforce the provisions of this Code
through the appropriate registered professionals.
13.1.1.3.2 The Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit shall have power to implement the provisions of
this Code to secure the intent thereof.
13.1.1.3.3 The Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit shall on request, so far as is required in the
discharge of official duties, receive the assistance, and co-operation of other Officers in all Government
Ministries, Departments, Parastatals, Police, and other Law Enforcement Agencies.
13.1.1.3.4 Access to premises: The Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit or an authorised
representative may enter any and all premises or buildings at all reasonable times to inspect same or to
perform any duty imposed by the enforcement of this Code, provided that if such building is occupied, he
shall first present proper credentials and request entry; and if such building or premises be unoccupied,
shall first make reasonable effort to locate the owner or other person having charge or control of the
building or premises and request entry. Where entry is refused, or cannot be ordinarily secured, the
official shall have recourse to every remedy provided by law to secure entry.
13.1.1.3.5 Emergency measures: The Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit shall issue all necessary
notices or orders to remove illegal or unsafe conditions, to require the necessary safeguards during
constructions, to require adequate exit facilities in existing buildings or structures, and to ensure
compliance with all the Code requirements for health, safety and general welfare of the public. He shall
also have powers in respect of the followings:
13.1.1.3.6 Vacating structure: When, in the opinion of the Code Enforcement Division /Section/Unit,
there is actual and immediate danger of failure or collapse of a building or structure or any part thereof
which would endanger life, or when any structure or part of a structure has fallen and life is endangered
by the occupation of the building or structure, the Code Enforcement Officer is hereby authorised and
empowered to order [Page 430] and require the inmates and occupants to vacate the same forthwith. The
Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit shall cause to be posted at each entrance to such building, a
notice reading as follows: “This Structure is Unsafe and its Use or Occupancy has been prohibited by the
Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit”. It shall be unlawful for any person to enter such building or
structure except for the purpose of making the required repairs or for demolition of same.
13.1.1.3.7 Temporary safeguards: When, in the opinion of the Code Enforcement
Division/Section/Unit, there is actual and immediate danger of collapse or failure of a building or
structure or any part thereof which would endanger life, the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit
shall cause the necessary work to be done to render such building or structure or part thereof temporarily
safe, whether or not the legal procedure, herein described, had been instituted (Section 3.8).
13.1.1.3.8 Closing streets: When necessary for public safety, the Code Enforcement
Division/Section/Unit shall temporarily close streets, sidewalks, buildings and structures and places
adjacent to such unsafe structure, and prohibit the same from being used.
13.1.1.3.9 Emergency repairs: For the purposes of this Section, the Code Enforcement
Division/Section/Unit shall employ the necessary labour and materials to perform the required work as
expeditiously as possible.
13.1.1.3.10 Costs of emergency repairs: Costs incurred in the performance of emergency work shall be
paid from the treasury of the jurisdiction on certificate of the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit.
The legal counsel of the jurisdiction shall institute appropriate action against the owner of the premises
where the unsafe building or structure is, or was, located for the recovery of such costs.
13.1.1.3.11 Inspections: The Code Enforcement Officer shall make all the required inspections, or the
Code Enforcement Officer shall accept reports of inspections by approved agencies or individuals, and all
reports of such inspections shall be in writing and certified by a responsible officer of such approved
agency or by the responsible individual.
13.1.1.3.12 The Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit is authorised to engage such expert opinion as
deemed necessary to report upon unusual technical issues that arise subject to the approval of the
appointment authority.
13.1.1.3.13 Credentials and identification: The Code Enforcement Division/Sec-tion/Unit and
authorised representatives shall carry proper credentials and identification of their respective office for the
purpose of inspecting any and all buildings and premises in the performance of duties under this Code,
and shall be appropriately attained in an approved form.
13.1.1.3.14 Proposals for amendments: The Code Enforcement Division/ Section/Unit may propose
amendments to existing requirements, or additional requirements to ensure applicability due to local
climatic, cultural or other conditions; provided that such proposals shall not have the effect of waiving
structural or fire performance requirements specifically provided in this Code or violating accepted
professional practice involving public safety.
Such proposals shall be made to the National Code Advisory Committee for consideration and decision.
[Page 431]
13.1.1.3.15 Records: The Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit shall keep official records of
applications received, including drawings and other documents, permits, and certificates issued, fees,
collected, reports of inspections, notices, and orders issued. Such records shall be retained in official
archives, and properly and safely stored.
13.1.1.3.16 Activity reports: The Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit shall submit at stipulated
periodic intervals, a written statement of operations to the appointing authority in the form and content as
shall be prescribed by such authority.
Part III Enforcement / Section 13 Control of Building Works / 13.2 SCOPE
13.2 SCOPE
Part III Enforcement / Section 13 Control of Building Works / 13.2 SCOPE / 13.2.1
Pre-design Stage
13.2.1.1 Requirements
i Perimeter survey and topographical survey of the site.
ii The Development Permit for the proposed development obtained by the owner from the Planning
Authority.
13.2.1.2 Enforcement: The Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit shall ensure compliance with the
above requirements.
Part III Enforcement / Section 13 Control of Building Works / 13.2 SCOPE / 13.2.2
Design Stage
Part III Enforcement / Section 13 Control of Building Works / 13.2 SCOPE / 13.2.3
Construction Stage
Part III Enforcement / Section 13 Control of Building Works / 13.2 SCOPE / 13.2.4
Post-Construction Stage
13.2.4.1 Requirements
i Certificate of Fitness for Habitation.
ii As-Built Drawings.
iii Building Maintenance Manual.
iv Building Condition Survey Report.
13.2.4.2 Enforcement: The Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit shall ensure compliance with the
above requirements.
It shall be unlawful for any person, firm or corporation to erect, construct, alter, extend, repair, remove,
demolish, use or occupy any building or structure violating the provisions of this Code.
[Page 432]
The Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit shall serve a notice of violation or order in writing; on the
person responsible for the erection, construction, alteration, extension, repair, removal, demolition, use or
occupancy of a building or structure in violation of the provisions of this Code, or in violation of a detail
statement or a plan approved thereunder, or in violation of a permit or certificate issued under the
provisions of this Code. Such order shall direct the discontinuance of the unlawful act and the abatement
of the violation and shall be complied with, within twenty-one (21) working days.
If the notice of violation is not complied with within the stipulated period, the Code Enforcement
Division/Section/Unit shall request the legal counsel of the jurisdiction to institute the appropriate
proceeding at law or in equity to restrain, correct or abate such violation or to require the removal or
termination of the unlawful use of the building or structure in violation of the provision of this Code or of
the order or direction made pursuant thereto.
13.3.5 Sanctions:
Any person who shall violate a provision of this Code or shall fail to comply with any of the requirements
thereof or who shall erect, construct, alter or repair a building or structure in violation of an approved plan
or directive of the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit, or of a permit or certificate issued under the
provisions of this Code, shall be guilty of an offence punishable under the existing law.
The imposition of the penalties herein prescribed shall not preclude the legal counsel of the jurisdiction
from instituting appropriate action to prevent unlawful construction or to restrain, correct or abate a
violation, or to prevent illegal occupancy of a building, structure or premises or to stop an illegal act,
conduct, business or use of a building or structure on or about any premises.
13.4.1 Petition:
Any person to whom the provision of this Code applies who has been served with an unsafe order or
structure or a duly authorised representative who has been served with an unsafe order and notice to make
such structure safe, secure, or habitable or to take down such structure shall have the right, except in cases
of emergency, to demand the appointment of a Board of Petition (as specified in Section 2.4.2) if that
person deems such order to be unnecessary, improper or reasonable. Such demand shall be in writing with
a statement of the reasons therefor.
The Board of Petition shall have powers to inspect a building or structure and to confirm, modify or
revoke the order of the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit as is just and proper in the interest of
public health, safety and welfare. They shall have the duty of determining the extent of reconstruction,
restoration or rehabilitation in the repair of an unsafe building or structure in the case of disagreement or
dispute.
The Board of Petition shall determine its findings and submit a report in writing affirming, modifying or
nullifying the order of the Code [Page 433] Enforcement Division/Section/Unit in whole or in part and
recommending the remedial steps to be taken where applicable to render the building or structure safe or
to abate the violation.
The findings and decisions of any three members of the Board shall be deemed conclusive and certified
copies of the report shall be filed with the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit and with the owner or
his representative and shall be binding on all parties.
All buildings or structures regulated by this Code and other related technical codes which are structurally
inadequate or have inadequate means of egress, or which constitute a fire hazard, or are otherwise
dangerous to life and property are, for the purpose of this Section, unsafe.
g. Building service equipment and installations regulated by such codes, which constitute a fire,
electrical or health hazard, or unsanitary condition, or is otherwise dangerous to human life is
for the purpose of this section, unsafe;
h. any use of buildings, structures unable to sustain the design loads specified in this Code are
hereby designated as unsafe building appendages;
i. all such unsafe buildings, structures or appendages and building service equipment and
installations are hereby declared to be public nuisances and shall be abated by repair,
rehabilitation, depletion or removal in accordance with the procedures set forth in this Code.
13.6 NOTICES
13.6.1 A person carrying out building works shall give the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit
notice in writing of:
(i) The commencement of work, at least seven days, in advance.
If the person carrying out the work does not inform the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit as
stated above, he shall comply with any notice in writing from the Code Enforcement
Division/Section/Unit requiring him within a reasonable time to cut into, lay open or pull down so
much of the work as prevents the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit from ascertaining
whether any of the provisions of this Code has been contravened.
(ii) When the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit has given notice in writing which specifies the
manner in which any work contravenes the requirements of this Code, a person who has carried out
any further work to secure compliance with this Code, shall within a reasonable time after the
completion of such further work, give notice in writing to the Code Enforcement
Division/Section/Unit of its completion.
(iii) The completion of any stage of work, not more than seven (7) days after such completion.
(iv) The completion of the building, not more than (7) days thereafter, or (if a building or part of a
building is occupied before total completion) not less than seven (7) days before occupation as well
as not more than seven (7) days after completion.
[Page 434]
(v) Before the commencement of any construction works, a site signboard showing the names and
addresses of the client, professionals and contractor involved in the project shall be erected in a
place to be seen clearly by the general public.
For the purposes of sub-section 3.5.1, the calculation of number of days, Saturdays, Sundays and Public
Holidays shall be excluded.
13.7 INSPECTIONS
13.7.1 General:
All construction or works for which an approval is required shall be subject to inspection by the Code
Enforcement Division/Section/Unit and certain types of construction shall have continuous inspection by
special inspectors as specified in Section 3.7
A survey of the plot shall be required by the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit to verify that the
structure is located in accordance with approved plans. It shall be the duty of the permit applicant/holder
of permit to cause the work to be accessible and exposed for inspection purposes. The Code Enforcement
Division/Section/Unit shall not be liable for expense incurred in the removal or replacement of any
material required to allow inspection.
It shall be the duty of the person carrying out the work authorised by a permit to notify the Code
Enforcement Division/Section/Unit that such work is ready for inspection. The Code Enforcement
Division/Section/Unit may require that every request for inspection be filed at least one working day
before such inspection is desired. Such request shall be in writing. It shall be the duty of the person
requesting any inspections required either by this Code, or any other related technical codes, to provide
access to and means for proper inspection of such work.
Work requiring a building permit shall not be commenced until the permit holder or his agent have posted
an Inspection Record Card to allow the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit to conveniently make
the required entries thereon regarding inspection of the work. This card shall be maintained in such
position by the permit holder until certificate of use and habitation has been issued by the Code
Enforcement Division/Section/Unit.
The permit holder shall give three (3) days notice in writing to the Code Enforcement
Division/Section/Unit, indicating the part of the Building, or structure that would be ready for inspection
in accordance with this Code.
If the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit does not inspect or cause to be inspected the works
indicated in the notice within seven (7) days, the work shall proceed as if such inspection had been made.
Re-inforcing steel or structural framework of any part of any building or structure shall periodically
inspected by the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit.
The Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit upon notification from the owner, or his agent, shall make
the following inspections and shall either approve that portion of the construction as completed or shall
notify the permit holder or his agent wherein the same fails to comply with this Code.
[Page 435]
13.7.5.1 Foundation inspection: To be made after excavation for footings are complete and any
required re-inforcing steel is in place. For concrete foundations, any required forms shall be in place prior
to inspection. All materials for the foundation shall be on the site except where concrete is ready-mixed in
accordance with the provisions of this Code.
Where the foundation is to be constructed of approved treated wood, additional inspections may be
required by the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit.
13.7.5.2 Concrete slab or under-floor inspection: To be made after all in-slab or under-floor building
service equipment, conduit, piping accessories and other ancillary equipment items are in place but before
any concrete is placed or floor sheathing installed including the sub-floor.
13.7.5.3 Frame inspection: To be made after the structural frame at each floor level, fire blocking and
bracing are in place and all pipes chimneys and vents are complete and the first fix electrical and
mechanical, (plumbing, heating wires, pipes and ducts) are approved.
13.7.5.4 Final inspection: To be made after finish grading and the building is completed and ready for
occupancy.
13.7.6.1 General:
All building service equipment for which a permit is required by this Code shall be inspected by the Code
Enforcement Division/Section/Unit. When the installation of any building service equipment is complete,
an additional and final inspection shall be made. Building service equipment regulated by the technical
codes shall not be connected to the water, fuel or power supply or sewer system until authorised by the
Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit.
Building service inspection shall not prohibit the operation of any equipment installed to replace existing
building service equipment in occupied portion of the building provided for inspection of such building
service equipment has been filed with the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit not more than 48
hours after such replacement work is completed, and before any portion of such building service
equipment is concealed by any permanent portion of the building.
In addition to the called inspections specified above, the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit may
make or require other inspections of any construction work to ascertain compliance with the provisions of
this Code, or technical codes and other laws which are enforced by the Code Enforcement
Division/Section/Unit.
13.7.8 Re-inspection:
A re-inspection fee may be assessed for each inspection when such portion of work for which inspection
is called is not complete or when corrections called for are not made.
This subsection shall not be interpreted as requiring re-inspection fees the first time a job is rejected for
failure to comply with the requirements of the technical codes, but as controlling the practice of calling
for inspections before the job is ready for such inspection or re-inspection.
[Page 436]
Re-inspection fees may be assessed when the permit card is not properly posted on the work site, the
approved plans are not readily available to the inspector, for failure to provide access on the date for
which inspection is requested, or for deviating from plans requiring the approval of the Code
Enforcement Division/Section/Unit. To obtain a re-inspection, the applicant shall file an application in
writing upon a form furnished for that purpose, and pay the prescribed re-inspection fee.
In instances where re-inspection fees have been assessed, no additional inspection of the work will be
performed until the required fees have been paid.
13.8.1 General:
In addition to the inspections required by Section 3.6 the owner shall request a special inspection or
employ a special inspector during construction on the following types of work:
13.8.1.1 Concrete: During the taking of test specimens and placing of all re-inforced concrete and
pneumatically placed concrete.
Exceptions
a. Concrete for foundations conforming to the minimum requirements of this Code, provided the
Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit finds that a special hazard does not exist.
b. For foundation concrete when the structural design is based on a specified compressive strength
no greater than 2000 psi (KN).
13.8.1.2 Ductile moment-resisting concrete frame: For moment resisting frames designed for seismic
load in structures within designated seismic zones in Nigeria, a specially qualified inspector who would
provide reports to the person responsible for the structural design shall provide continuous inspection of
the placement of the re-inforcement and concrete and shall submit a certificate indicating compliance with
plans and specifications.
13.8.1.3 Re-inforcing Steel and Pre-stressing Steel
a. During all stressing and grouting of pre-stressing concrete.
b. During placing of rei-nforcing steel, placing of tendons and pre-stressing steel for all concrete
required to have special inspection by Section 3.7.1.1
13.8.1.4 Welding
a. Ductile Moment Resisting Frame
Welded connections between the primary members of ductile moment-resisting steel frames,
shall be tested by known destructive methods for compliance with U.B.C standard welding 27.6
and job specifications. (Refer structural welding code-steel, ANSI/AWS D1.1-88.)
b. All structural welding, including welding of re-inforcing steel.
13.8.1.5 High-strength bolting: During all bolt installations and tightening operations.
Exceptions
a. The special inspector need not be present during the entire installation and tightening operation,
provided he has:
(i) inspected the surfaces and bolt type for conformance to plans and specifications prior to
start of bolting, and
[Page 437]
(ii) will, upon completion of all bolting, verify the minimum specified bolt tension for 10
percent of the bolts for each connection with a minimum of two bolts per connection.
b. In bearing-type connections when threads are not required by design to be excluded from the
shear plane, inspection prior to or during installation will not be required.
13.8.1.6 Structural masonry: During preparation of masonry wall prisms, sampling and placing of all
masonry units, placement of re-inforcement, inspection of grout space, immediately prior to closing of
clean-outs, and during all grouting operations.
Exception: Special inspection need not be provided when design stresses have been adjusted to permit
non-continuous inspection.
13.8.1.7 Insulation concrete fill: During the application of insulating concrete fill when used as part of a
structural system.
Exception: The special inspections may be limited to an initial inspection to check the deck surface and
placement of re-inforcements. The special inspector shall supervise the preparation of compression test
specimens during this initial inspection.
13.8.1.8 Spray-applied fireproofing: As required by relevant technical code.
13.8.1.9 Piling, drilled piers and caissons: During driving and testing of piles and construction of
cast-in-place drilled piles or caissons. See Items 3.7.1.1 and 3.7.1.3 for concrete and re-inforcing steel
inspection.
13.8.1.10 Special grading, excavation and filling: During earthwork excavations, grading and filling
operations inspection to satisfy requirements of this Code.
13.8.1.11 Special cases: Work, which in the opinion of the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit,
involves unusual hazards.
13.8.1.12 Special inspector: The special inspector shall be a qualified person who shall demonstrate his
competence, to the satisfaction of the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit, for inspection of the
particular type of construction or operation requiring special inspection.
13.8.1.13 Duties and responsibilities of the special inspector: The special inspector shall observe the
work assigned for conformance with the approved design drawings and specifications.
The special inspector shall furnish inspection reports to the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit, the
project architect, engineer, and other designated persons. All discrepancies shall be brought to the
immediate attention of the constructor for correction, then, if uncorrected, to the architect and to the Code
Enforcement Division/Section/Unit.
The special inspector shall submit a final signed report stating whether the work requiring special
inspection was, to the best of his knowledge, in conformance with the approved plan and specifications
and the applicable workmanship provision of these codes.
The Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit shall serve a contravention notice when a building or
structure in any way violates any of the provisions of this Code, or the prosecution of work on any
building or structure or parts [Page 438] thereof is carried on in such a manner as to be in conflict or
subsequently violate the provisions of this Code. Such order shall direct the discontinuance of the illegal
action or condition and the abatement of the violation.
Upon notice from the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit, that work on any building or structure is
being prosecuted contrary to the provision of this Code, or in an unsafe and dangerous manner, such work
shall be immediately stopped. The Stop Work Order shall be in writing and shall be given to the owner of
the property involved, or to the owner’s agent, or to the person doing the work, and shall state the
conditions under which work will be permitted to resume.
No further work shall continue on any building work on which a Stop Work Order has been served unless
the order is revoked, in writing. Any person who shall continue any work in or about the structure after
having been served with a Stop Work Order, except work that has been instructed as abatement shall be
liable to a fine the sum of which shall be determined by the appropriate authority.
Whenever any building or structure regulated by this code is being used contrary to the provisions of this
Code, or has been declared unsafe, dangerous and unsuitable for habitation, or is slated for demolition, or
is being used in a manner as to constitute nuisance or hazard, the Code Enforcement
Division/Section/Unit may order the building or structure or parts thereof vacated by serving a Quit
Premises Order on the owner, or any person occupying the building or structure.
(i) Quit Premises Order shall only be revoked upon complete abatement of the violation(s) or unsafe
and dangerous conditions.
(ii) When a Quit Premises Order is served to facilitate demolition of a building or structure, the
Enforcement Agency may demolish or remove such structure after seven days of issuing the Quit
Premises Order Notice, except in cases of emergencies when the order shall take immediate effect.
(see section 2.3.6.2).
The Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit may serve a Demolition Order Notice in respect of any
building or structure which does not cannot in any way be made to conform with this Code. The
Demolition Order Notice shall instruct the owner to remove the dangerous or defective structure within
seven (7) days, at the expiration of which the building or defective structure shall be removed by the
Enforcement Division/Section/Unit and the cost of effecting the order shall be recovered from the owner.
13.9.5.1 Notices, orders and other documents required or authorised by the provisions of this Code to be
served on the owner or occupier of any premises shall be deemed to be properly addressed if addressed to
the description of the “Owner” or “Occupier” of such premises without further name or description.
13.9.5.2 Every notice, order, and other documents required or authorised by the provisions of this Code
to be served on any person may be served by:
a. pasting in a conspicuous place on the premises with photographs taken;
b. and by delivering same to the addressee in person;
[Page 439]
c. or if the person addressed with an Order Notice cannot be found within the city after diligent
search, then such Notice shall be served by registered post, or certified mail to the last known
address of such person;
d. or by publication in the local daily papers.
No person shall make connections from a source of energy, fuel or power to any building service
equipment which is regulated by the technical codes and for which a permit is required by this Code until
approved by the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit.
The Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit may authorise the temporary connection of the building
service equipment, fuel, or power for the purpose of testing building service equipment, or for use under a
temporary certificate of habitation.
A building or structure hereafter erected shall not be used or occupied in whole or in part until the
certificate of use and habitation shall have been issued by the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit.
A building or structure hereafter enlarged, extended or altered to change from one use group to another or
to a different use within the same use group, in whole or in part, and a building or structure hereafter
altered for which a certificate of use and habitation has not been heretofore issued, shall not be occupied
or used until the certificate shall have been issued by the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit,
certifying that the work has been completed in accordance with the provisions of the approved permit.
Any use or occupancy, which was not discontinued during the work alteration, shall be discontinued
within 30 days after the completion of the alteration unless the required certificate is secured from the
Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit.
Upon written request from the owner of an existing building or structure, the Code Enforcement
Division/Section/Unit shall issue a certificate of use and habitation, provided there are no violations of
law or orders of the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit pending, and it is established after
inspection and investigation that the alleged use of the building or structure has heretofore existed. This
Code shall not require the removal, alteration or abandonment of, or prevent the continuance of, the use
and habitation of a lawfully existing building or structure, unless such use is deemed to endanger public
safety and welfare.
After a change of use has been made in a building or structure, the re-establishment of a prior use that
would not have been legal in a new building of the same type of construction, is prohibited unless the
building complies with all applicable provisions of this Code. A change from one prohibited use, for
which a permit has been granted, to another prohibited use, shall be deemed a violation of this Code.
Upon the request of the holder of a permit, the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit shall issue a
temporary certificate of habitation for a building or structure, or part thereof, before the entire work
covered by the permit shall [Page 440] have been completed, provided such portion or portions will be
occupied safely prior to full completion of the building or structure without endangering life or public
welfare.
Part III Enforcement / Section 13 Control of Building Works / 13.11 CERTIFICATE
OF USE AND HABITATION / 13.11.6 Contents of certificate:
When a building or structure is entitled thereto, the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit shall issue a
certificate of use/habitation within ten (10) days after written application. The certificate shall certify
compliance with the provisions of this Code and the purpose for which the building or structure will be
used in its several parts. The certificate of use/habitation shall specify the use group, in accordance with
the provisions of Chapter 4 the type of construction as defined in Chapter 5 and any special stipulations
and conditions of the building permit.
13.11.7 The Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit may in writing, suspend or revoke a certificate of
use/habitation issued under the provisions of this Code.
13.11.7.1 Revocation: The Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit may, in writing, suspend or revoke
a certificate of habitation issued under the provisions of this Code whenever the certificate is issued in
error, or on the basis of incorrect information supplied, or when it is determined that the building or
structure or portion thereof is in violation of any ordinance or regulation or any of the provisions of this
Code.
13.16 TEST
Whenever there is insufficient evidence of compliance with any of the provisions of this Code or
evidence that any new material or construction method does not conform to the requirements of this
Code, the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit may require tests as proof of compliance to be made
at no expense to the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit.
Test methods shall be as specified by this Code or by other recognised test standards. If there are no
recognised and accepted test methods for the proposed alternates, the Code Enforcement
Division/Section/Unit shall in consultation with relevant specialists determine test procedures. All tests
shall be made by an approved Agency. Reports of such test shall be retained and stored by the Code
Enforcement Division/Section/Unit.
13.17 RECORDS
In all cases, the application for modification of existing structures and for building permit as well as the
final decision of the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit, and all supporting tests or reports shall be
in writing and shall be officially recorded in the permanent records of the Code Enforcement
Division/Section/Unit.
The legitimate use and occupancy of any structure existing on the date of promulgation of this Code, or
for which it has been heretofore properly approved, shall be permitted to continue without change, except
as is specifically covered in this Code, or other relevant regulations listed in the Schedule.
It shall be unlawful to make any change in the use or occupancy of any structure or portion thereof which
would subject it to any special provisions of this Code without the approval of the Code Enforcement
Division/Section/Unit, and the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit’s certification that such structure
meets the intent of the provisions of regulations governing building construction for the proposed new use
and occupancy, and that such change does not result in any greater hazard to public safety or welfare.
Additions, alterations, or repairs to any structure shall conform to that required of a new structure without
requiring the existing structure to comply with all the requirements of this Code. Additions, or alterations,
shall not be made to any existing structure or building which will cause the existing building or structure
to be in violation of any of the provisions of this Code, nor shall such additions or alteration cause the
existing building or structure to become unsafe or in any way adversely affect its stability, ventilation, fire
safety means of egress, sanitation or the general performance of the building.
The totality of any building so altered which involves a change in use or occupancy, shall not exceed the
height, number of floors, and area permitted for new buildings, including the new additions if any.
[Page 442]
Alterations, or additions shall not be made to any existing building or structure when such a structure or
building is not in full compliance with the provisions of this Code, except when such addition or
alteration or repair will result in the existing building or structure being in full compliance with the
provisions of this Code.
13.19.1 Maintenance:
All buildings and structures, and all parts thereof, shall be maintained in a safe and sanitary condition.
All devices or safeguards which are required by this Code shall be maintained in good order.
The owner or his designated agent shall be responsible for the maintenance of buildings and structures.
The Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit shall cause the re-inspection of any building or structure to
determine compliance with this sub-section.
13.19.2 Application:
Application or notice to the Code Enforcement Division/Sec-tion/Unit shall not be required for ordinary
repairs or rehabilitation provided that such repairs or rehabilitation shall not include the cutting away of
any wall load bearing, partition or portion thereof, the removal or cutting of any structural beam or
bearing support, or the removal or change of any required means of egress, or re-amendment of parts of a
structure affecting the existing requirements, nor shall ordinary repairs include addition to, alteration of,
replacement or relocation of utility pipes or conduits, drainage, sewer, electrical or mechanical
installations affecting public health or general safety.
Building Condition Survey Report for buildings of five (5) floors and above shall be carried out every ten
(10) years by the registered professionals involved in the original design and construction stages of the
structure, and be submitted to the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit.
Part III Enforcement / Section 13 Control of Building Works / 13.20 DEMOLITION
OF STRUCTURES
Before a structure can be demolished or removed, the owner or agent shall notify all utilities having
service connections with the structure such as water, electricity telecommunications, gas, sewer and other
connections.
A permit to demolish or remove a structure shall not be issued until the respective service connections
and appurtenant equipment, such as meters and regulators, have been removed or sealed and plugged in a
safe manner.
Only when written notice has been given by the applicant to the owners of adjoining plots and to the
owners of wired or other facilities, of which the temporary removal is necessitated by the proposed work,
shall a permit be granted for the removal of a building or structure.
Whenever a structure is demolished or removed, the premises shall be maintained free from all unsafe or
hazardous conditions by the proper regulation of the plot, restoration of established grades and the
erection of the necessary retaining walls and fences in accordance with the provisions of Part III, Section
6.0.
13.20.4 Demolition shall not be carried out in a manner or with such equipment that violates the
provisions of Part III, Section 8.0, or in any way constitute a hazard to life, property or environment,
before, during or after the demolition exercise.
[Page 443]
13.21.1 Definition:
Buildings and structures moved into or located within an area to which this code applies, shall comply
with the provisions of this Code for new buildings and structures and shall not be used or occupied in
whole or in part until the certificate of use and habitation shall have been issued by the Code Enforcement
Division/Section/Unit.
Temporary structures such as reviewing stands and other miscellaneous structures, sheds, canopies or
fences may be erected by special permit from the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit for a limited
period of time. Such buildings or structures need not comply with the type of construction or fire resistive
time periods required by this Code. Temporary buildings or structures shall be completely removed upon
the expiration of the time limit stated in the permit which shall not exceed 60 days.
13.22.1 Definition:
Listed buildings are structures that have been designated by official action of the Federal, State, or Local
Government as having special historical, architectural, artistic and aesthetic significance.
Repairs, alterations, and additions necessary for the preservation, restoration, rehabilitation, or continued
use of a building or structure may be made without conformance to all the requirements of this Code
when authorised by the Code Enforcement Division/Section/Unit, provided that:
a. any unsafe conditions as described in this Code are abated;
b. the restored building or structure will be no more hazardous based on life, safety, fire safety,
and sanitation than the existing building;
c. the building shall not be put to any use or occupancy when the abatement of the unsafe aspects
do not adequately remove hazard to life, safety, fire etc., or when the adequate abatement of
such unsafe aspects shall substantially detract from the historical, or artistic significance of the
building or structure.
13.23.1 Requirements
a. A building intended to remain where it is erected for less than 60 days such as a stand for a
temporary exhibition;
b. a building used only by people engaged in the erection, extension, alteration, demolition, or
improvement of a building or fences erected for the protection of the public during the course of
that work;
c. a detached building which does not exceed 10m2 in floor area, 4m in height and which contains
no sleeping accommodation.
Nothing in sub-section 1.9.1 shall preclude the need to engage the services of appropriate registered
professionals in the development of such building to secure reasonable standards of health and safety in
or about them.
Part IV
Schedules and References
Section 14
Referenced Standards
[Page 449]
The following is a listing of the standards referenced in this Code, the effective date of the standard, the
promulgating agency of the standard and the sections) of this Code that refer to the standard.
ASTM SECTION 4
Standard Title Referenced in
Reference Code Section
Number
D92 Flash and fire points by Cleveland Open Cup- Table 4.7.2 (a)
Method of Test for ..............................................
D93 Flash point by Pensky – Martens Closed Table 4.7.2 (a)
Tester- Method of Test for ..................................
NFiPA495 Code for Explosive Materials ............................ Table 4.7.2 (b)
Notes
EC/TC/NFSC/UBC SECTION 5
[Page 450]
UBC SECTION 7
[Page 451]
ASTM
Standard Title Referenced in
Reference Code Section
Rumber
90 Airborne Sound Transmission Loss of Building 9.2.12.2
Partitions Laboratory, Measurements of ..................
492 Impact Sound Transmission Through Floor 9.2.12.3
Ceiling Assemblies Using the Tapping Machine
Laboratory, Measurement of ....................................
G.A 600 Fire Resistance Design Manual ................................ 9.2.12.4
NCWA TEK STC Values of Concrete Masonry Walls ................ 9.2.12.4
69A
B1ATN5A Sound Insulation Clay Masonry Walls .................... 9.2.12.4
[Page 453]
NIS/BS SECTION 10.14
BS SECTION 10.14
[Page 454]
BS SECTION 10.14
[Page 455]
NCP2/NCP1 SECTION 10.22
Standard Reference Title Referenced in Code Section
Number
NCP2 (1973) Table 1 22.2
NCP2 (1973) Table 2 22.2
NCP2 (1973) Table 3 22.2.7
NCP2 (1973) Table 4 22.3
NCP2 (1973) Table 5 22.4
NCP2 (1973) Table 6 22.5
NCP1/ASME SECTION 8
[Page 456]
AWPA/NfoPA/BS/ASTM SECTION 8.9
[Page 457]
AWPA/NfoPA/BS/ASTM SECTION 12.2
Section 15
Compliance Forms
Forms
Setting out Compliance Form
Foundation/Basement Compliance Form
Roofing and Closing Compliance Form
Superstructure Compliance Form
Mechanical Installations Compliance Form
Electrical Installations Compliance Form
Finishes Compliance Form
Stop Work/Removal/Discontinuation Notice
[Page 461]
Project title
Name of owner
Site location Plot No.
Operations
Excavations Dimensions Remarks
Depth Complied
Not complied
Justifications
Width Complied
Not complied
Justifications
Shuttering/Supports Required Not required Remarks
Treatments
[Page 463]
Concrete work,
Foundation bases, Not Designed Achieved
Complied Justificatio
Column beams and complied strength strength
ground beams
Quality control cube
7 days 14 days 28 days Justification
test
Testing house
General remarks
Depth
Backfilling Depth Progressively Rammed Justification
compacted
[Page 464]
[Page 465]
Registered Architect
I certify that I supervised this stage of work and that the work is in accordance with the approved design and specificatio
Name/Registration No of Architect
Signature/ARCON Seal
Date
Project title
Name of owner
Site location Plot No.
Operations
Wall plate Material used Adequacy in Adequacy in Justification
(where applicable) size strength and
quality
[Page 466]
[Page 467]
General Remarks/Workmanship
Professional Attestation
Registered Builder
I certify that I have physically managed the production process of this work and confirm that the quality is as designed a
specified in the
approved documents.
Name/Registration No. of Builder
Signature/CARBON Seal
Date
[Page 468]
I certify that this stage of work is in accordance with the structural details as designed and approved.
Name/Registration No. of Structural Engineer
Signature/CARBON Seal
Date
Registered Architect
I certify that I supervised this stage of work and that the work is in accordance with the approved design and specificatio
Name/Registration No. of Architect
Signature/CARBON Seal
Date
[Page 469]
Project title
Name of owner
Site location Plot No.
Operations
Formworks /Supports Material used Adequacy in Adequacy in Justification
size strength and
quality
Columns and beams Designed/ Constructed Justification
Re-inforcements bars Specifications
(sizes)
Nature of curing
[Page 470]
Staircases
(where applicable)
Risers/Treads Goings Anti slip Nosing Justificatio
Reinforcement
Strength Cube test at Cube test at 14 Cube test at 28 Justificatio
achieved 7 days days days
Depth
Painting (Burglary Material used Adequacy Adequacy in Justification
bars) in size strength and
quality
[Page 471]
Depth
Quality Control (Cube Designed
7 days 14 days 28 days Justificatio
Test) strength at
Testing House
General Remarks/Workmanship
Professional Attestation
Registered Builder
I certify that I have physically managed the production process of this work and confirm that the quality is as designed a
specified in the
approved documents.
Name/Registration No. of Builder
Signature/CARBON Seal
Date
[Page 472]
I certify that this stage of work is in accordance with the structural details as designed and approved.
Name/Registration No. of Structural Engineer
Signature/CARBON Seal
Date
Registered Architect
I certify that I supervised this stage of work and that the work is in accordance with the approved design and specificatio
Name/Registration No. of Architect
Signature/CARBON Seal
Date
General Remarks/Workmanship
[Page 474]
Professional Attestation
Registered Builder
I certify that I have physically managed the production process of this work and confirm that
the
quality is as designed and specified in the approved documents.
Name of Registered Builder
Signature/CARBON Seal
Date
Registered Mechanical Engineer
I certify that this stage of work compiled with the structural details as designed and
approved.
Name/Registration No. of Structural Engineer
Signature/CARBON Seal
Date
Registered Architect
I certify that I supervised this stage of work and that the work complied with the approved
design and specifications.
Name/Registration No. of Architect
Signature/CARBON Seal
Date
[Page 476]
General Remarks/Workmanship
Professional Attestation
Registered Builder
I certify that I have physically managed the production process of this work and confirm that the quality is as designed a
specified in the
approved documents.
Name/Registration No. of Builder
Signature/CARBON Seal
Date
[Page 477]
Registered Architect
I certify that I supervised this stage of work and that the work is in accordance with the approved design and specificati
Name/Registration No. of Architect
Signature/CARBON Seal
Date
[Page 478]
[Page 479]
General Remarks/Workmanship
Professional Attestation
Registered Builder
I certify that I have physically managed the production process of this work and confirm that the quality is as designed a
specified in the
approved documents.
Name of Registered Builder
Signature/CARBON Seal
Date
[Page 480]
Registered Architect
I certify that I supervised this stage of work and that the work is in accordance with the approved design and specificatio
Name/Registration No. of Architect
Signature/CARBON Seal
Date
Renovation,
situated .................................................................... at without:
a First obtaining an approved plan;
b Complying with the specifications of the plan.
2. In accordance with Section 53 of Decree 88 of 15th December, 1992, you are hereby ordered
to:–
Stop work forthwith,
Alphabetical Index
Alphabetical Index
A B C D E F G H I J K L M N O P Q R S T U V W X Y Z
Alphabetical Index / A
Alphabetical Index / B
B
Balcony .................................................................................... 2.15 12
2.16 12
Basement .................................................................................. 2.17 12
Bay .......................................................................................... 2.18 12
Bearing
load...................................................................................... 2.71 16
values of soils .................................................................... 8.9.2 256
Binders .................................................................................... 10.14 329
Block(s)
cement stabilised ................................................................ 10.25 351
pre-cast concrete ................................................................ 10.3.14 317
sand-crete .......................................................................... 10.3.13 316
Board
of petition .......................................................................... 13.4 432
Bonds
and liability insurance ........................................................ 7.34 210
Building .................................................................................... 2.19 12
agricultural ........................................................................ 2.2 11
area...................................................................................... 2.2 12
condition survey report ...................................................... 2.21 12
construction
classifications ................................................................ 5 43
requirements ................................................................ 11 357
design
classifications ................................................................ 4 29
requirements ................................................................ 7.1 85
8.1 227
9.1.1 279
9.2.1 300
11.4 357
height
in storeys ...................................................................... 2.22 12
y
of .................................................................................. 2.63 15
line...................................................................................... 2.23 12
listed.................................................................................... 13.22 442
maintenance manual .......................................................... 2.24 12
materials and components requirements ...................... 10 307
plans.................................................................................... 2.25 12
post-disaster ........................................................................ 2.9 17
public.................................................................................. 2.92 17
works.................................................................................. 2.26 12
Alphabetical Index / C
Certificate
of
compliance .................................................................... 9.1.8.14 284
use and habitation ........................................................ 2.27 13
13.11 439
Citation
and commencement ............................................................ 1 5
Classification(s) ...................................................................... 4.2 29
building
construction .................................................................. 5 43
design ............................................................................ 4 29
construction ........................................................................ 5.2 43
use group K – doubtful use ................................................ 4.13 40
Code Enforcement Officer (C.E.O) ........................................ 2.29 13
Components ............................................................................ 10.1.2 307
capacity of egress .............................................................. 7.9 182
materials and ...................................................................... 8.6 227
9.1.6 279
9.2.7 300
Concrete(s) .............................................................................. 10.3 311
aggregate
for .................................................................................. 10.2.6 309
reinforced ................................................................ 10.2.5 309
evaluation for acceptance of .............................................. 10.3.7 314
filled steel pipe and tube piles ............................................ 8.9.17 266
footings .............................................................................. 8.9.10 260
materials used for .............................................................. 10.3.3 311
members carrying masonry or ............................................ 5.14 62
mixing and placing of ........................................................ 10.3.9.3 314
precast ................................................................................ 10.3.12 316
pre-stressed ........................................................................ 10.3.11 316
quality ................................................................................ 10.3.4 313
Conflagration hazard ................................................................ 2.31 13
g
Construction
and general requirements .................................................... 5.8 58
classification ...................................................................... 5.2 43
combustible material or ...................................................... 2.3 13
fire resistive ........................................................................ 12.3 393
non-combustible ................................................................ 2.81 16
stage .................................................................................... 13.2.3 431
type
1.................................................................................... 5.3 44
2.................................................................................... 5.4 51
3.................................................................................... 5.5 53
4.................................................................................... 5.6 54
5.................................................................................... 5.7 57
Contract
documents .......................................................................... 2.32 13
Contractor ................................................................................ 2.33 13
Control
of building works .......................................................... 13 429
Conveyors ................................................................................ 9.1.8.26 295
Corridor .................................................................................... 2.34 13
service ................................................................................ 2.1 17
Court ........................................................................................ 2.35 13
Alphabetical Index / D
Alphabetical Index / E
Egress
hazards to means of ............................................................ 7.25 203
means of ............................................................................ 2.76 16
7.3 176
9.2.3 300
types and location of means of .......................................... 7.8 179
Electrical
engineering design requirements ........................................ 9.2.0 300
installations compliance form ...................................... Form 6 475
systems, wiring and installations ........................................ 9.2.9 300
Element .................................................................................... 2.43 14
level of exit discharge passageways used as an exit .......... 7.12 188
Elevator
and dumbwaiter machinery and equipment ........................ 9.1.8.19 290
car emergency signals signs .............................................. 9.1.8.22 291
dumbwaiter and conveyor equipment, installation and
maintenance .......................................................... 9.1.8.10 282
opening protection .............................................................. 9.1.8.21 290
Environmental
and general building requirements ................................ 6 73
requirements ...................................................................... 6.1 73
Escalators ................................................................................ 9.1.8.27 296
and moving walks .............................................................. 7.2 201
Establishment
of
building code advisory committee (BCAC) .................. 3 23
control of building works ............................................ 13.1 429
Exceptions ................................................................................ 7.3 208
Exempt
buildings and works .......................................................... 13.23 443
Existing buildings .................................................................... 7.5 177
7.48 215
8.8.6 228
9.1.8.4 280
9.2.5 300
11.3 357
and installations .................................................................. 9.1.8.32 299
repair, alteration, addition to and change of use of ............ 7.43 212
p , , g
Existing installations ................................................................ 9.1.8.16 286
9.2.9.6 302
Exit(s) ...................................................................................... 2.45 14
access passageways and corridors ...................................... 7.11 187
horizontal ............................................................................ 7.15 193
maintenance of .................................................................. 7.6 178
9.2.6 300
number of .......................................................................... 7.1 183
signs and lights .................................................................. 7.23 203
Alphabetical Index / F
Alphabetical Index / G
Garage
private ................................................................................ 2.56 14
public .................................................................................. 2.57 15
General .................................................................................... 4.1 29
9.1.8.1 279
9.2.9.1 300
10.1 307
10.3.1 311
building limitations ............................................................ 6.3 77
requirements for all signs .................................................. 7.35 210
Glass ........................................................................................ 10.4 318
Grade ........................................................................................ 2.58 15
Guard(s) .................................................................................. 2.59 15
7.27 206
Guardrails ................................................................................ 5.17 63
Alphabetical Index / H
Habitable
attic .................................................................................... 2.14 12
space (room) ...................................................................... 2.6 15
Hallway .................................................................................... 2.61 15
Handrails .................................................................................. 7.28 207
Hazard(s)
conflagration ...................................................................... 2.31 13
health .................................................................................. 7.6 221
to means of egress .............................................................. 7.25 203
g
Hazardous
materials ............................................................................ 10.1.1 307
production material (Hpm) ................................................ 2.62 15
Hereafter .................................................................................. 2.64 15
Heretofore ................................................................................ 2.65 15
Hoists ...................................................................................... 7.56 219
Hoistway
enclosures and venting ...................................................... 9.1.8.18 289
Hollow .................................................................................... 2.66 15
House
apartment ............................................................................ 2.7 11
pent .................................................................................... 2.87 17
Alphabetical Index / I
Alphabetical Index / L
Alphabetical Index / M
Machine
rooms and related construction for passenger and freight
elevators and dumbwaiter ...................................... 9.1.8.20 290
Maintenance ............................................................................ 7.47 215
12.1 361
and accidents ...................................................................... 9.1.8.15 284
rehabilitation and ................................................................ 13.19 441
Maisonette ................................................................................ 2.73 16
Manlifts .................................................................................... 9.1.8.23 291
Marble ...................................................................................... 10.2.4 308
Material(s)
alteration ............................................................................ 2.74 16
alternative .......................................................................... 13.13 440
and components .................................................................. 8.6 227
9.1.6 279
9.2.7 300
bituminous .......................................................................... 10.16 337
change of use ...................................................................... 2.75 16
fixing and joining .............................................................. 10.15 332
other .................................................................................... 10.23 348
paint .................................................................................... 10.19 343
paints and paints ................................................................ 10.17 342
removal of waste ................................................................ 7.53 218
used for concrete ................................................................ 10.3.3 311
Mean(s)
of egress .............................................................................. 2.76 16
7.3 176
9.2.3 300
doorways ...................................................................... 7.13 189
lighting .......................................................................... 7.24 203
Mechanical
engineering design requirements ........................................ 9.1 279
installations compliance form ...................................... Form 5 473
systems, elevators, conveyor equipment and
dumbwaiters ............................................................ 9.1.8 279
Membrane ................................................................................ 2.77 16
Mezzanine(s) ............................................................................ 2.78 16
5.22 68
Minister .................................................................................... 2.79 16
Ministry .................................................................................... 2.8 16
Alphabetical Index / N
Alphabetical Index / O
Alphabetical Index / P
Alphabetical Index / Q
Quality
Q y
concrete .............................................................................. 10.3.4 313
control requirements .......................................................... 10.3.9 314
Alphabetical Index / R
Alphabetical Index / S
Sampling
and preparation of test pieces ............................................ 10.7 324
Sand
for mortar, plaster, rendering or floor screeds .................... 10.2.7 309
Sanitation ................................................................................ 7.61 221
Scaffolds .................................................................................. 7.55 219
Scope ........................................................................................ 8.8.1 227
5.1 43
13.2 431
title, aim and ...................................................................... 1.2 5
Semi-detached .......................................................................... 2.99 17
Service
corridor .............................................................................. 2.1 17
engineering design requirements .................................. 9 279
Sewer
and water supply data ........................................................ 9.1.8.29 297
Shaft ........................................................................................ 2.101 17
enclosures .......................................................................... 5.12 60
Shall ........................................................................................ 2.102 17
Shot-crete ................................................................................ 10.3.10 315
Sign(s)
elevator car emergency signals .......................................... 9.1.8.22 291
existing .............................................................................. 7.32 209
general requirements for all ................................................ 7.35 210
ground ................................................................................ 7.36 211
illuminated .......................................................................... 7.41 212
miscellaneous and temporary ............................................ 7.4 211
portable .............................................................................. 7.42 212
posted ................................................................................ 2.91 17
projecting ............................................................................ 7.39 211
roof .................................................................................... 7.37 211
unsafe and unlawful .......................................................... 7.31 209
wall .................................................................................... 7.38 211
Signage .................................................................................... 7.29 208
g g
8.3 227
9.1.3 279
Slide escape .............................................................................. 7.22 202
Soil
test procedure .................................................................... 8.9.4 258
Solar
energy collectors ................................................................ 5.2 65
Solid ........................................................................................ 2.11 18
Space
horizontal service .............................................................. 2.67 15
vertical service .................................................................... 2.123 19
Stage
construction ........................................................................ 13.2.3 431
design ................................................................................ 13.2.2 431
post-construction ................................................................ 13.2.4 431
pre-design .......................................................................... 13.2.1 431
Stairway(s) .............................................................................. 2.108 18
and ladders .......................................................................... 7.57 220
exterior .............................................................................. 7.19 201
interior ................................................................................ 7.17 194
Stand-Pipe (A Standpipe System) ............................................ 2.105 18
Steel grillages .......................................................................... 8.9.9 260
Stones ...................................................................................... 10.2 307
Storage .................................................................................... 10.2 344
Storey ...................................................................................... 2.106 18
first .................................................................................... 2.107 18
Street ........................................................................................ 2.103 18
Structural
frame .................................................................................. 5.9 58
loads/stability ...................................................................... 8.8 227
steel piles ............................................................................ 8.9.16 265
Structure(s) .............................................................................. 2.104 18
accessory ............................................................................ 2.1 11
appurtenant ........................................................................ 2.9 11
demolition of ...................................................................... 13.2 442
existing .............................................................................. 13.18 441
temporary .......................................................................... 13.21 442
Systems
duct, stock and refuse conveyor ........................................ 9.1.8.9 281
emergency electrical .......................................................... 9.2.9.7 303
fire protection .................................................................... 12.2 369
plumbing ............................................................................ 9.1.8.28 296
standby power .................................................................... 9.2.9.8 303
waste and linen handling .................................................... 9.1.8.7 281
water supply ...................................................................... 9.1.8.31 298
Alphabetical Index / T
T
Alphabetical Index / U
Alphabetical Index / V
Alphabetical Index / W
Wall(s)
apron .................................................................................. 2.1 11
party .................................................................................... 2.85 17
rammed earth ...................................................................... 10.24 350
retaining .............................................................................. 8.9.24 273
signs .................................................................................... 7.38 211
Waterproofing
and damp-proofing ............................................................ 8.9.25 274
Working
drawings and specifications ................................................ 2.124 19
Workmanship .......................................................................... 10.3.15 318
and supervision .................................................................. 13.12 440
Alphabetical Index / Y
Alphabetical Index / Z